ue. Ad iF ae sire} 4 yng HET Aas tpn Abad flo MSs dh eMail HR tahe, , : i ong y ane . (i ye seap* gay ty ! ‘Aal igi a outed) Falke Lae er + aot pe fal 4 ee bahay iy 5} Piearieaa Gti ant ands See Phe wh et i paths Se hyd) pay §i aa ati oy a7 : i Minvanhae ; (yao Moat ltl fees nat anh Y 4 Saleen. h wer Lj ve vs Rept + pi LAPT A BT | Xe j 3 wi MMe Lmsbrakds ‘ ¢ nin OO ! oy ie pdrter tsi t at Cait hh . < } iqallt ys : raines + fs * / it + * Tish abi ety du ta OR ia ree ; rit - 4 bait +) 4 oath 4 u uy 2 7 Wik ois" \ pier yy yh eit leh } * «) 4 NE oe ew r phe eeceery ’ Mannion @ pe bagel ry hae nh We at My “4 r tb 716 bai tales eae iy rf anata Pay te vy 7 oni) Jes eile at mt Hr ye 2) ain its Ste! aha if) Sin by V-ton A = = es: ~~ + Ae ’ \ Ly ee Vy Bag ta Ty VF YUM S NS a taltia) 17) , yi’ LN SLL aA it 8 balou ey eae okt gtavee ayy vai MASP THT Aint #) } i) Pukey 0 +0 hab 4) : 7 ¢ i Pela ret Let ri i ah ar es 4 Half HE , rier) : 4} . , j i Tesentahs : hate og boas F ‘ Ut bites ermlii @)h)a! us mit ne Sune rH) ie TTL RN Lae Mise Look bl ' f ay i f apie) ; ‘ eh / + yi sd Hi ATWO a) Satta ets! abel § iG tyApit Phin yy) ” J bite ya PAE Nox UP UR gee eng tryy tet iit es hy yr , } ee tala ae hss ab re sy i , gery iis We HIF é + H A Pasty dite Pie yeen eb gs Tahoe dd tp de Sign fh peten. APR y : Win hsp eae SP ete? he a ee DF Ded PHD Y Hs ga sete if CS Sed ae oe PY feet T 944 4 1 44 ape 7” ‘y ws 4 f 7 . PA AY salad Tal iy end f te, Py Lai ikte awe as ee the FAS aR ie : / : tes iby Ph i$ Pear erg ptt et te Nialaeaty Pi be aie aA ; : a fy Mabe SH } ¥ ; : : Leip peterpan ; oh lhe Fe he bythe Vets tee ey yet Beg ihe) Oyarere yy Ts HPV eP AW hy set an redlie nh ja pde Pee 4h SF * sas ape ee i) ¢ yh we isagyst 7 ,4 wi vi ‘ n jas tie i ¥, . Vabheaiit Sth Tog et i bined on a eke 94, 4 4 4 f A a! eben EN eae ieveber sry Hey i PL CAT Oe Juste ( { j aes t Pea edan so “yd Oy ; By) ; my yy) ;: ; : is e 4 tb ok nn | PMA fib. 7a Says ; tary Sod AN 1939 THE INTERNATIONAL CRITICAL Commentagy . JAl Dd ve A CRITICAL AND EXEGETICAL COMMENTARY ON THE GOSPEL ACCORDING TO ST. MARK BY THE Ruy, EZRA P. GOULD, S:T.D. PROFESSOR OF THE NEW TESTAMENT LITERATURE AND LANGUAGE, DIVINITY SCHOOI. OF THE PROTESTANT EPISCOPAL CHURCH, PHILADELPHIA NEW YORK CHARLES SCRIBNER’S SONS 1913 COPYRIGHT, 1896, BY CHARLES SCRIBNER'S SOF £ PREFACE THERE is a lack of critical commentaries in the English language on the Gospel of Mark, and especially of commentaries based on the more recent criticism of the sources, and of the history con- tained in the book. Commentaries corresponding to those of Meyer, Weiss, and Holtzmann, not in ability, but in critical method and results, are wanting. This volume is an attempt to supply this lack. ‘This criticism is based on the evident inter- dependence of the Synoptical Gospels, unmistakable proof of which is found in the accumulated verbal resemblances of the three books. The generally accepted solution of this Synoptical problem makes Mark the principal source of Matthew and Luke, his account being supplemented and modified by material taken from the Hebrew Zogia of Matthew. This critical result is accepted by many English and American scholars, but no com- mentary based on it has appeared among us. A modification of this theory makes the Zogia the older source, which Mark uses to a limited extent, the principal source of his information being the Apostle Peter. A few passages in which this dependence is probable have been noted and discussed. The critical theme of this volume is thus the interrelation of the Synoptics. In carrying out this plan, the relations of the Synoptical Gospels, their harmonies and divergences, and especially their interdependence, have been made a special study, and, where the fourth Gospel is parallel to Mark, their relation has been discussed. vi PREFACE An important part of the critical question is the historicity of the miracles. This doubt—for the question has grown into a widespread doubt—I have attempted to meet on the general ground of the credibility of the narrative as contemporaneous history, and of the verisimilitude of the miracles. But after all, since the result of criticism has been to establish the historicity of the Synoptical accounts of the ministry of our Lord, the main attempt has been to interpret him in the light of this history. I have not attempted to make this book a thesaurus of opinions, though the more recent critical literature has been cited and discussed. Nor have I sought to collect curious information of any kind for its own sake; but, by his- torical and literary methods, I have endeavored to arrive at the meanings of the life of Jesus as here set forth. It is recog- nized that this account is supplemented, and valuable additions made to it, by the other Gospels. But the use of it as the principal source of the other Synoptical accounts gives it an importance which it is hard to overestimate. What it has to say, therefore, about the life and character of the founder of Christianity, it has been the main endeavor of this volume to set forth. Other things have been used, but not for their own sake. Everything has been pressed into this service. The volume contains, besides the Notes, an Introduction, stating the Synoptical problem, a discussion of the character- istics of Mark, and an analysis of events; a statement of the Person and Principles of Jesus in Mark; a discussion of the Gos- pels in the second century; a review of Recent Literature ; and a statement of the Sources of the Text. ‘There are also Notes on Special Subjects scattered through the book. E. P. GOULD. PHILADELPHIA, January, 1896. CONTENTS SEGURA fe) ot) 'e (4) -e! ese we ete: ve) PT EGIUCTION..: « ue se) ee) 6) 8s 6 THE PERSON AND PRINCIPLES OF JESUS IN THE GOSPELS IN THE SECOND CENTURY . meceny CermicAL, LITERATURE. .« .« « « ROTOR TA oo) al!\ on: Oo Gi lence; aelie. wai, Ye PUBREVEATIONS . (“a 0 « © 0 @ ¢ « 6 « COMMENTARY <« « « s «© « coe ee INDEX . . . e e e i e ° e e e e e e MARK’s GOSPEL PAGE vV-vl 1X-xVii X1X—xXxXxil XXxlli—xlii xliii-xlix li-lv lvii 1-309 311-317 ia mi J Wha er ee hk Re i 4 aah VS (Te ae ee ete) Mims agers vag anes A COMMENTARY ON THE GOSPEL OF MARK INTRODUCTION THE main question in a study of any one of the Synoptical Gospels is its relation to the others. This is especially true of the questions belonging to Introduction. If writings are independent, the matter of their origin can be considered separately ; but where an analysis shows intimate relations between them, the question must be discussed with reference to this relation. Now, our study of the Synoptical Gospels shows both interdependence and inde- pendence. There are two parts of the story where the indepen- dence amounts to divergence. In the account of the early life of Jesus given by Matthew and Luke, Bethlehem is in Matthew not only the birthplace of our Lord, but also the residence of his parents. Nazareth is introduced only as the place to which they turned aside after their return from Egypt, because Judzea was rendered unsafe for them by the succession of Archelaus. But in Luke, Nazareth is their residence, from which they go to Bethle- hem only on account of the Roman census, and to which they return after the presentation in the Temple. And these marks of independent origin are found in the entire story of the infancy in Matthew and Luke. And in the account of the events from the resurrection to the ascension, Matthew and Mark, omitting the closing verses of the latter, make the scene of Jesus’ appearance to his disciples to be Galilee; whereas Luke places them all in the vicinity of Jerusalem, and on the day of the resurrection. In fact, one of the great arguments for the omission of the closing verses of Mark is that the scheme of appearances is that of Luke, and plainly out of gear with that of the previous part of Mark. Evidently, here, then, in the beginning and end of the Gospel 1X x INTRODUCTION narrative, the Gospels are quite independent of each other. And in the body of the history, containing the account of our Lord’s public ministry, there are not wanting evidences of the same inde- pendence. The general arrangement of events is the same, but individual events are scattered through this general scheme with a decided independence. Luke distributes discourses which Matthew collects into connected discourse, e.g. the parts of the Sermon on the Mount. And single events, such as the call of Peter, Andrew, James, and John, are given with differences of detail, which show marked independence. But, after all, the general impression made in this body of the narrative is that of interdependence. One of the most striking features of this is the selection of events and discourses out of the great body of material open to writers. The matter peculiar to either of the Gospels is very small, compared to the common material, and yet the whole is very small, compared with all that Jesus said and did. There is some individuality shown in this selection, especially of the discourses of our Lord, but it is not considerable. And we have noticed already the similarity in the general arrangement of events. We can imagine that in the interval of a generation between the close of our Lord’s life and the appearance of the Gospels, the oral tradition, which was for the time the chief source of knowledge of that life, may have acquired something like a fixed form in both these particulars. And so we may use the oral tradition, perhaps, to account for these items in the general account of interdependence. But when we come to the verbal resemblances existing between the Synoptical Gospels, our depen- dence on this solution of the Synoptical problem ceases. It is enough to say in this connection, that the oral tradition must have been in Aramaic, the language of Palestine, while these resemblances are in Greek Gospels, and verbal resemblances dis- appear in translation. But it is unnecessary to introduce this consideration even, in the face of such striking resemblances as these. Oral tradition does not tend to fix language to this extent. This verbal similarity is found in the Synoptics, wherever they give parallel accounts of the same event. Good examples of it are the accounts of the call of Peter, Andrew, James, and John, Mt. 4°” Mk. 1°”; and of the healing of the demoniac in the synagogue, Mk. 17 Lk. 4°**”. The effect of this verbal resemblance is very INTRODUCTION xi much enhanced, of course, when the words common to two or more accounts of the same thing are themselves uncommon words. £.g. the words rpwroxaGedpias and mpwroxAuoias in Mt. 2 3°, and the parallel passage, Lk. 11%; Mk. 12%, and the parallel passage, Lk. 20%; and in a similar connection in Lk. 147°; do not occur elsewhere outside of ecclesiastical writers. éxoAdBwoe, Mk. 13”, and the parallel passage, Mt. 24”, is a rare Greek word, and is used in these passages, moreover, in an unusual sense. répara, Mk. 13”, and the parallel passage, Mt. 24”, does not occur else- where in the Synoptics. dypumvetre, Mk. 13”, and the parallel passage, Lk. 21%, does not occur elsewhere in the Synoptics, and only twice in the N.T. éuBarrw and rpvBdAiov, Mk. 14”, and the parallel passage, Mt. 26%, are not found elsewhere in the N.T. These verbal resemblances can be explained only by the interde- pendence of the written accounts. Either the Gospels are drawn from each other, or from some common written source. These phenomena of the Synoptical Gospels have given rise to a most protracted and intricate discussion, in which various the- ories, ¢.g. of original writings from which our Gospels were drawn, and of the priority of one Gospel or another, from which the rest were drawn, have been presented and thoroughly sifted. Fortu- nately, we are at the end of this sifting process, for the most part, and are in possession of its results. Tradition and internal evi- dence have concurred in giving us two such sources, one of which is the translation into Greek of Matthew’s Zogza, or discourses of our Lord, and the other our present Gospel of Mark. There is ample evidence that the Zogza cannot be our present Gospel of Matthew, and on the other hand, there is no evidence that there is any original Mark, distinct from our second Gospel. Papias, writing about 130 to 140 A.D., says that Matthew wrote his Zogia in Hebrew, and each man interpreted them as he was able. _Ire- nzus, Panteenus, and Origen all testify to the same, and in fact, there is no early tradition of Matthew’s writing which does not record also its Hebrew character. It is also against the identifi- cation of the Zogza with our present Matthew, that the latter contains matter that does not come under the head of Zogia. It is, moreover, dependent in its narrative portions on Mark, which is scarcely within the range of possibility, if it was itself the work of an eye witness. Papias tells us also that Mark, having become xii INTRODUCTION Peter’s interpreter, wrote down accurately all that he remembered, not however in order, both of the words and deeds of Christ. And tradition is consistent also in regard to this dependence of Mark on Peter. Moreover, this account agrees with the character of the second Gospel. It bears evident marks of the eye-witness in its vividness, and in the presence of those descriptive touches which reproduce for us not only the event, but the scene and surroundings as well. Is there any evidence that Mark’s Gospel was in part a compila- tion? Did he draw upon the Zogia in his account of discourse and conversation? Does not the supposition of the entire inde- pendence of Mark imply two sources of the Synoptical narrative in certain cases, in which the matter of the different Gospels would suggest only one? In the parables, ¢.g., we have a larger group in Matthew, and a smaller group in Mark. And of course, if Mark is independent here, as elsewhere, this supposes two sources. But the parables themselves, by their homogeneousness, would suggest rather one source, from which both drew. Moreover, Mark’s state- ment that Jesus used many such parables, in this connection, is another hint of a longer account containing more parables, from which he made selections. And the one parable peculiar to him- self would show that this was a third source, independent of either Matthew or Mark. ‘Turning now to the parable of the Wicked Husbandmen, Mk. 12'”, we find Mark supplemented by Matthew in the same way. Mark says that Jesus spoke to them in parables, and proceeds to cite one parable, while Matthew gives us three parables in the course of the same controversy; that is, Mark implies in the plural zapaBodais, a source giving more abundant material than he uses, and Matthew apparently gives us that more abundant material. Moreover, the traditional source of Mark’s Gospel is unfavorable to the production of long discourse. And accordingly, we find only one example of such discourse in this Gospel, the eschatological discourse in ch. 13. Whereas, we find frequent examples of such discourse in Matthew and Luke, and it is a natural inference that it is characteristic of the Zogia from which they both drew. It seems probable, therefore, that this one discourse in which Mark follows their example comes from the written Zogia, and not from his transcription of Peter’s oral discourse. INTRODUCTION Xili INDIVIDUALITY OF THIS GOSPEL. ANALYSIS OF EVENTS Mark has a way of his own of handling his material. Whatever may be his reason, the fact is, that he dwells on the active life of our Lord, the period from the beginning of the Galilean ministry to the close of his natural life. The introduction to this career, including the ministry of John the Baptist, the baptism and the temptation, he narrates with characteristic brevity. But it is not brevity for the sake of brevity ; it comes from a careful exclusion of everything not bearing directly on his purpose. The work of John the Baptist is introduced as the beginning of the glad tidings about Jesus Christ, and the material is selected which bears on this special purpose. The baptism is told as the inauguration of Christ into his office, and only the baptism, the descent of the Spirit, and the voice from heaven are narrated. And the tempta- tion is merely noted in passing. All of these things have a value of their own, but they are evidently regarded by the writer as in- troductory to his theme, the active ministry of Jesus, and are abbreviated accordingly. But beginning with the Galilean ministry, our Gospel is as full in its narrative of separate events as either Matthew or Luke. He omits events and discourses, but what he does tell he tells as fully as they. Inthe matter of discourse, especially, still more of pro- longed discourse, this Gospel is resolutely either brief or silent. As regards the general distribution of material, there is an earlier group of narratives, in which Matthew and Luke are parallel to each other; another further along, in which Matthew and Mark are parallel; and then a third, in which Luke stands alone. But what Mark tells in this period he narrates with pictorial fulness. When we come, however, to the account of the resurrection, and of the appearances to the disciples after the resurrection, this Gospel returns to its policy of brevity regarding what precedes and follows the period of the public ministry. These appearances are to the disciples alone, they are mainly mere appearances, and Mark gives merely the announcement of the resurrection to the women by the angels, and closes with this. This, instead of being strange, and requiring explanation, is quite in accordance with the character of Mark disclosed in the narration of the early events. Xiv INTRODUCTION Those were introductory, these are supplementary of the subject, and both are treated therefore with the same conciseness. We have discovered a like parsimony in the choice of material for this main theme, the public ministry. But this is for the sake, evidently, of sharpness of impression, and, for this purpose, Mark joins with it an effective grouping of his matter. He is not telling a number of disconnected stories of our Lord’s work, but the one story of his public ministry, and he selects and groups his material in order to show the progress of events, their division into separate periods, and their culmination in the final catastrophe. The first period is one of immediate popularity, and of a corre- sponding reserve. The effect of Jesus’ miracles in spreading his fame, and in drawing a multitude after him, is emphasized, and at the same time Jesus withdraws from the multitude, and forbids the spreading of the report of his miracles. We are not told about the subjects of his teaching, but of its impression, and its effect in increasing his popularity. The second period, beginning with Jesus’ return from his first tour in Galilee to Capernaum, is marked by the contrast between this continued popularity and the growing opposition of the Phari- sees. We are shown in a series of rapid sketches the causes of this opposition in the revolutionary character of Jesus’ ministry, and his quiet disregard of Pharisaic traditions and customs. He calls a publican to the inner circle of his disciples, and eats with publicans and sinners; he decries formal fastings, heals on the Sabbath, defends eating with unwashed hands, and denounces all traditionalism. ‘There can be no doubt that this rapid succession of events, all of the same character, is intended to produce the effect described, and to show us how, early in the ministry of Jesus, he was forced into opposition to the ruling sect, and so the way was prepared for the end. But the picture has lights as well as shadows, and the mixture with these conflicts of other events, such as the appointment of the twelve, the sending of them on a separate mission, the teaching in parables, and sundry miracles, produces the biographical effect. But at last this short ministry in Galilee comes to an end, and is followed by a period in which Jesus journeys with his disciples into the Gentile territory about Galilee, and there prepares them for his death at the hands of his enemies. There is added to this INTRODUCTION XV the confession of his Messianic claim, the story of his Transfigu- ration, a few miracles in the strange places where these travels take him; but the characteristic mark of the whole period is this secret conference with his disciples about the crisis in his life. The succeeding period, beginning with his final departure from Galilee, and ending with his entry into Jerusalem, is one into which Matthew and Luke have put much of their characteristic material, and in which Mark is unusually brief. And the matter selected by him is of an unusually mixed kind. It begins with one of those disputes between him and the Pharisees which mark these last days. It proceeds with various conversations and in- structions, in which different aspects of the kingdom of God are shown ; it gives a strange picture of the impression of fear pro- duced on Jesus’ disciples by his manner on the road to Jerusalem ; and it tells of one miracle at Jerusalem. In brief, this is a period of waiting, in which the events themselves, and ihe turn given to them, foreshadow and prepare for the final crisis. Then comes the last week, with its story of the final conflicts between Jesus and the authorities at Jerusalem, of his trial and death. The entry into Jerusalem is evidently intended to be his announcement of himself as the Messiah, and the cleansing o the Temple a manifestation of his authority. This authority is immediately challenged by the Sanhedrim, and in the parable of the Wicked Husbandmen, Jesus makes his charge against them. ‘hen they ply him with their legal puzzles, attempting to discredit his teach- ing, and their discomfiture only hastens the end. This brief analysis will show the principle on which Mark selects his material and groups it. Both contribute to the one object of sharpness of impression. The different periods are marked off, and the effect is not blurred by the introduction of confusing or voluminous detail. The life of Jesus has not made on him the effect of mere wonder which he seeks to reproduce in disconnected stories, but of a swift march of events toward a tragic end, and he marks off the stages of this progress. But Mark’s effectiveness as a story-teller is due not only to his selection and grouping of material, but also to his pictorial fulness. He gives us the scene of events more frequently than the other writers, whether in the house, or by the sea, or on the road. On XVI INTRODUCTION one occasion, this vividness, where he tells of the green grass on which the five thousand reclined, gives us an invaluable mark of time, telling us what we should not know from the other Synop- tics, that there was a Passover during the Galilean ministry. He tells us of the multitudes about Jesus, and gives us a lively de- scription of the way in which they ran about as he entered one village after another, bringing the sick to him on their pallets. He tells us of the astonishment and fear of the disciples, as Jesus went before them to Jerusalem. His style lends itself to the same purpose. He uses the imperfect, the still more effective jv with the participle, and the historical present. But he does it all in the rapid and effective way characteristic of him. It is by a stroke here, and a bit of color there, that the effect is produced. ACCOUNT OF MARK The places in which Mark’s name occurs in the N.T. are Aets 12% * 13° 8, 16") Col. 4%, 2 Tim: 47) Philem.”, 1 Pores From these we learn that he was the son of Mary, to whose house Peter went after his release from imprisonment, and cousin of Barnabas. His original Hebrew name was John, and to this was appended a Roman surname Mark. Peter includes him in the salutation of his first epistle, and calls him his son (in the faith). He makes his first appearance in the history as the companion of Barnabas and Saul, whom they took back to Antioch with them on their return from Jerusalem, where they had been to carry the offerings of the churches on the occasion of a famine. And when they start, immediately after, on their first missionary journey, Mark accompanies them, but only to turn back again after the completion of their mission to Cyprus. Then, at the beginning of their second missionary tour, he becomes the source of conten- tion to his superiors, Barnabas wishing to take his cousin along with them again, and Paul refusing his company on account of his previous defection. But in the epistle to the Colossians he appears again as the assistant of Paul, being mentioned by him as one who sends greetings to that church. And in 2 Tim., Paul writes Timothy to bring Mark with him as one who is useful to him in the ministry. Again, in the epistle to Philemon he is with Paul, and is included in the salutations of that letter. INTRODUCTION XVii DESTINATION OF THE GOSPEL. TIME OF ITS WRITING. PLACE Mark was evidently written for Gentile readers, as it contains explanations of Hebrew terms and customs.’ Tradition says that it was written after the death of Peter and Paul. There is one decisive mark of time in the Gospel itself. In the eschatological discourse attention is called to the sign given by Jesus of the time of the destruction of Jerusalem, which leads us to infer that the Gospel was written before that time, but when the event was im- pending. This would fix the time as about 70 4.p._ Tradition says also that it was written at Rome. And there is a certain sup- port given to this by the use of Latin words peculiar to this Gospel.” 1 #.g. the explanatory ris TadtAaias after Na¢gapér; the translation of Boavepyés ; of Tadvdd, covu; the explanation of rowais xepoi aS = avinrois; the translation of "E¢daba; the statement of the Jewish custom of ceremonial washing; of the Sad- ducees’ denial of the resurrection; of the custom of killing the Paschal lamb on the first day of the feast; the translation of ToAyo0a, and of ’EAwi, "EAwt, Aaua oaBaxOavei; and the explanation of rapackxevy aS = rpocdBBarov. 2 Eg. xpa8atrov, Lat. grabatus, where the other Synoptists use xAivn, KAcvidtor ; onexovaAdtwp, Lat. speculator; xevrupiwv, Lat. centurion, Fe one? han ie i" ome 1S a Aig 4 ine Lae 7 os vey Hi y eae iii cone rat THE PERSON AND PRINCIPLES OF JESUS IN MARK’S GOSPEL ad MATTHEW begins his account of Jesus’ public ministry, as Mk. does, with the statement that Jesus came into Galilee after the imprisonment of John, and began to proclaim the good news of the coming kingdom, accompanying this with miracles of healing. But he follows this immediately with the Sermon on the Mount, which serves as a basis for all the subsequent teaching, and gives us as the subject of that teaching the Kingdom of God. Lk. introduces this in another place, giving first some of the detached sayings, and so preparing the way for the connected discourse, instead of making the connected discourse an introduction to the detached sayings. But the effect of the discourse, and its relation to the teaching as a whole, are the same. Mk., on the other hand, gives only detached sayings, unrelated to any central group of teachings, and in his gospel, therefore, we have to study out the problem of our Lord’s life and teaching after a different fashion. He appears in the first place as a herald of the kingdom, taking up the work of John. Then he calls four men into personal association with himself. His first Sabbath in Capernaum is a memorable one. It is evident that he is regarded as a teacher, for he is asked to preach in the synagogue, and his hearers are impressed with the note of authority in his teaching, so different from the manner of the Scribes, the recognized authorities. But they are still more impressed with a miracle performed by him, and as soon as the law allows, they bring all the sick of the city to him, and the whole town is in an uproar. The two things together stamp him as a prophet, making a decided advance on the char- acter of teacher, in which he appears at first. But so far as he is recognized at all, the popular voice after this accords to him these two titles, rabbi and prophet. xix XX THE PERSON AND PRINCIPLES OF JESUS But Jesus evidently sees elements of danger in this popular uprising. The emphasis is on the wrong side of their lack, and of his power. If his message had reached them, and they had clamored to hear more of that, and especially had shown any disposition to follow his teaching, he might have stayed to preach, instead of going out to pray. But he did not wish to pose as a miracle-worker, and to have the inference “ Messiah” follow from that in the popular imagination. And so he retires to pray, he refuses the clamorous call to return, and when a man whom he has healed disobeys his command to keep it silent, he retires into the wilderness to escape the inevitable effect of this publicity. Now Mk.’s method begins to appear. Jesus does not lay down a programme of the Messianic kingdom in a set discourse, but the principles regulating his activity are slowly evolved by the occa- sions of his life. And after the same fashion Jesus himself begins to appear on the canvas—a herald of the kingdom of God, a teacher, a prophet, a miracle-worker, who represses and depre- cates the impetuous desire of the multitude to emphasize the miracle-worker rather than the prophet. This is the picture so far, and it is full of promise and suggestion. Then in connection with another miracle, Jesus claims the power as the Son of Man to forgive sins. The way it happened was this: the man’s disease was occasioned by some vice, and Jesus announces the cure therefore as a forgiveness of the sins which had caused it. Then, this being challenged by the Scribes as blasphemy, he adduces the cure itself as an example of the power which he had to remove the evils caused by sin. Here is another step forward, for here is a real, but veiled claim of a Messianic title, and the authority coupled with it is that of for- giveness, which forgiveness consists in the removal of the various ills of mankind wrought by sin. The Messianic claim is there, but it is veiled, for we do not find that the people understood him to make the claim, though after this he uses the title familiarly. And the title chosen, Son of Man, is such as to show that Jesus emphasized that side of his work which allied and identified him with man. | This intimation that his work has to do with sin, as a physician has to do with disease, is repeated when he calls the tax-gatherer into the circle of his disciples, and defends himself by the state- THE PERSON AND PRINCIPLES OF JESUS xxi ment that he came to call not righteous men, but sinners. And when they charge him with collusion with Satan in his expulsion of demons, his answer is substantially that his attitude is opposi- tion to Satan, and that his power to cast out demons can have been obtained only as the result of a conflict, in which he had overmastered Satan. Here, as in the case of the paralytic, this aspect of his work as a conflict with sin comes out in connection with his cures, and this is really the only chance that he has to present it, as he has had as yet very little opportunity to deal with sin as sin, only in its occasional intrusion into other than the moral sphere. But he deals with it as already master of the situation. He can despoil Satan of his instruments, because he has already met him and bound him. He can deal with sin in others victori- ously, because he has met and mastered it in himself. But meantime, another element in the situation is making itself felt. In dealing with the people, Jesus has to contend against a sudden and superficial popularity, and is able only to cure their diseases, not to cope with their sins. But the necessary and unavoidable conspicuousness of his work bring him under the notice of their leaders, and here he encounters active opposition. It develops only gradually. It is evident that the Scribes and Pharisees are watching him at first, as it is always possible that religious enthusiasm may play into the hands of the religious authorities. But the elements of opposition accumulate at every step. The first is the evident lack of sympathy or affiliation with them, and Jesus’ association with men at the other end of the social and ecclesiastical scale, the despised people whose igno- rance of the law made them dangerous company for the scrupu- lous Pharisee, with the remote and insignificant Galilean, and even finally, the hated servant of a foreign government, the Jewish collector of Roman tribute. Jesus’ answer, that, as a physician, his business is with the sick rather than the well, is complete, but like all such answers, it only increased the irritation. The next question is more vital, as it has to do not with themselves, but with their system. Pharisaic Judaism was the climax and reductio ad absurdum of religious formalism. For ethics it substituted casuistry, for principles rules, for insight authority, for worship forms, for the word of God tradition, for spirituality the most absolute and intricate externalism. Jesus did not seek to break xxii THE PERSON AND PRINCIPLES OF JESUS with it, but it was inevitable that the break should come. The law prescribed an annual fast, but they had multiplied this into two a week, whereas, it is recorded of Jesus that he came eating and drinking, and himself called attention to this characteristic. When he is challenged about this practice of his disciples, he shows that fasting, like everything else that has a proper place in religion, is a matter of principle, and not of rule. Men are not to fast on set days, but on fit occasions. And in general, he shows the absurdity of attempting to piece out the old with the new, or to pour his new wine into their old wine-skins. The next place where they made a stand against Jesus’ innovating views was in the matter of their absurd Sabbatarianism. That it was absurd, the occasions of their attack show ; first, plucking ears of corn to eat on the spot, and secondly, healing. These things, forsooth, were expressly forbidden on the Sabbath. In answer, Jesus does not attempt to meet them on the ground of casuistry, but, as usual, lays down principles. First, the Sabbath was made for man, and not man for the Sabbath; and secondly, to refuse to confer a benefit in case of need is to inflict a positive injury, on the Sabbath as well as any other day. Here the narrative pauses, and passes over to other matter. But it is evident that Mk. has grouped this material for a purpose. He wishes to show how, with one occasion after another, the teaching of our Lord acquired substance and shape, and encoun- tered a sharp and well-defined opposition. And how boldly and greatly the figure of Jesus himself begins to stand out. How it is becoming evident that sanity, breadth, insight, ethical and spiritual quality, are in this man not relative, but absolute. And as he faces the gathering storm, how steadfast he is, and regardless of everything but truth. It needs only a little reading between the lines to see how the next events come in. ‘The evidence is accumulating that our Lord’s own career is to last not very long, and that he must have followers, successors, to whom he can commit his work, and that these must be men whose close attendance on himself will famil- iarize them with his message. Hence the twelve are appointed. And it is expressly stated that his family had started out to restrain him, at the time when he pointed out that his real family were the disciples who did the will of God. His own family was not to be THE PERSON AND PRINCIPLES OF JESUS XXI11 classed among his enemies, but it is evident that they sought to protect him against what they considered his own extravagance. And the parables also grew out of the immediate situation. They are the first direct statement of the nature of the kingdom of God. The postponement of the subject, and the veiled pre- sentation of it, both show it to be a matter that Jesus approached with extreme caution. But what he treated with so much reserve in the presence of the others, he explained frankly to his disciples. This means that the time had come when the situation, even among the disciples, needed clearing up. They were not repelled by his differences with the Pharisees; the indications are rather that they were in sympathy with him. But their difficulty, which the parables were intended to meet, came from their sharing the national expectation, that the kingdom was to be set up by a “our de force, an expectation which Jesus’ methods and delay, if not defeat, discouraged. This is the immediate occasion of the para- bles. But their immense importance appears from the fact that . they are the only direct statement of the nature of the kingdom, which otherwise we should have to gather from side-lights and inferences. The kingdom is seed ; it is subject to all the vicissi- tudes of seed sown broadcast into all kinds of soil; it is neverthe- less sure of success because it is native to the soil; humanity as such is hospitable to it, and its small beginnings do not interfere with ultimate greatness. The next event requiring special notice is Jesus’ visit to Naza- reth, where he encounters his first rejection. Other places have known only the greatness of his public life, Nazareth, unfortu- nately, knows the obscurity of his private life, and they reject his greatness as spurious. Here, therefore, he finds even his miracles impossible, whereas in other places, cut off from everything else, he does find a place for these. Jesus marvelled at their unbelief, and no wonder. It was here that this perfect life had matured, grown into an unmatched beauty and power, and yet they had missed it all because it lacked outward greatness. But one is reminded by this episode of a singular fact in our Lord’s life — that he appears largely as a miracle-worker. It was not a role that he coveted, but, for the most part, it was all that he could do. We have some record of the way in which he dealt with the other and larger half of human ill and need. We have the story of XXIV THE PERSON AND PRINCIPLES OF JESUS Matthew and Zacchzeus, and the sinful woman, and the rich young man, and Peter ; we know that he was the friend of publicans and sinners. But, for the most part, he was shut out from all this, and shut up to physical healings. Even here, he found a unique field for the display of his greatness. His possession of a divine power he shared with other men, but his divine use of that power is his own; he shares it with no one. But if he had had an equal chance to show us the other side of his power, what a story there might have been. But the time has now come for Jesus to try his disciples in the work. They have heard his message and seen his miracles, and he sends them out to carry forward both the preaching and the healing. His instructions to them are, briefly, to pay no attention to outfit nor entertainment, but to be occupied solely with their ministry. On Jesus’ return to Capernaum, the opposition to him comes to a head. His enemies are there on the watch for him, and in that apparently careless and unscrupulous life they soon find their opportunity. To be sure, it seems only a slight thing that the dis- ciples should be eating with unwashed hands. But to those men it meant liability to every defilement mentioned in the law. It is their opportunity, but then it is Jesus’ opportunity too. It gives him his chance to strike at traditionalism and ceremonialism, the twin foes of spiritual religion. Over against tradition, he sets the word of God, — against the idea that a thing is true because it is handed down, he posits the word of God, which becomes more true as humanity grows. And against ceremonialism, the idea that man’s spirit can be reached for either good or evil from the outside, he puts the eternal truth, that it is reached and affected only from within, by things akin to itself. This really marks the end of Jesus’ work in Galilee. It has resulted in proving the inaccessibility of the people to his spiritual work, in the unsympathetic attitude of his family, in his total rejection at Nazareth, and in active hostility on the part of the religious leaders. But his work with his disciples is not ended, and he accordingly departs with them to Syropheenicia. Here, he desired to keep his presence unknown, as his work was not with Gentiles, but Jews. But the extraordinary faith of the Syro- phcenician woman overcame his scruples, so that he healed her THE PERSON AND PRINCIPLES OF JESUS XXV daughter. This confinement of his work on earth to his own nation, while evidently announcing the broadest universalism, is easily explained. He was laying foundations, and the human material for that, such as it was, existed in only one nation. On the occasion of only a brief return to Galilee, during this Wanderjahr, the Pharisees make another attack on him, demand- ing a sign from heaven. They want something plainly and indis- putably of heavenly origin, not open to the suspicion of collusion with Satan, nor of originating in the lower air, and plainly nothing more nor less than an attestation by God of our Lord’s claim. Something merely a sign, not complicated with other characters and purposes which might obscure the plain issue, was their demand. Jesus refused it. He would do his work, including cures and miracles, and let that tell his story, but a mere sign he refused to give. We must pause again to notice Mk.’s method, and to say now that it bears all the appearance of being the method of Jesus himself. He meets questions as they arise, instead of projecting discourse from himself. But the wisdom and completeness of his answer anticipates the controversies of Christendom. This question of signs, ¢.g., of external evidence, our Lord answers by refusing a sign, and he emphasizes it by his allusion to the generation which had seen fim. He was his own sign, and needed no other. The question belonged to that age, but no age nor any other man has arrived at the wisdom of the answer. We are coming now to the close of Jesus’ ministry, and his method has not yet led him to any declaration of himself nor of his mission. It would almost seem as if he had no consciousness of a mission of any definite sort, so content has he been to let things merely happen, great as has been his use of these happen- ings. But now the time has come, not for him to declare himself, but to bring the thought of men about him into expression. And first of all, his own disciples. He asks them what men say about him, — what they call him. They say briefly, a prophet. Then he asks them if that is all they have to say. Vo, Simon Peter says; we call you the Messiah. ‘The value of this is in the fact, that it is not their assent to his claim, but their estimate of his greatness. They, as Jews, had inherited an idea, an expectation of a man in whom human greatness was to culminate. As far as XXVI THE PERSON AND PRINCIPLES OF JESUS Jesus’ activity went, the answer of the people was enough. But the feeling of the disciples was, it may describe his activity, but is inadequate to describe his own greatness. The race has culmi- nated in him, and he is therefore the Messiah whom we are to expect. There are two things noticeable here: first, the title itself, and then the manner of its assumption. It is no wonder that Jesus was dissatisfied with the title prophet, when his real title was king, king of men. And when we examine what he says in elucidation of this claim, we find that there are just two things which he emphasizes as involved in this, viz. love and obedience. Careless of everything else, he proposes to himself just this, to conquer for himself the love and obedience of all men everywhere and in all things. There is no lack of definiteness nor adequacy in this. And yet, though Jesus is very explicit in this, we are altogether missing the point, as usual. We are very busy organizing his church, devising the ways and means of his worship, defining his person, and meantime the world, the flesh, and the devil are dictating terms not only to government and society, but to the church. They are well satisfied to have the church scatter its fire, instead of concentrating its energy upon doing the will of its Lord, and getting that will done. But besides the title, and of almost equal importance with it, is the manner of its assumption. Jesus waits for men to give it to him. ‘This does not mean any lowering of his claims, any disposition to meet men half-way, and accept some compromise with them. It means just the opposite of this, the most absolute and apparently extravagant claim that he could make. It means mastery, not from without, but from within, —a mastery of convictions, affections, and will, and from that centre controlling the whole of life. He will have, not the enforced obedience of men who would throw off the yoke if they could, or any part of it, but the self-devotion and homage of those who come voluntarily to him, — the unforced mastery of man over man. By this means, and in this sense, he will rule the world. To be sure, since it is included in his programme that he is to die and still be king, that rule is to be exercised from heaven, that centre from which the network of law and self-enforcing order overspreads the world. But that universal law leaves one domain free, and within the sphere of human action it exercises no com- THE PERSON AND PRINCIPLES OF JESUS XXVI1 pulsions but those which leave the spirit free. And yet within that province, it is meant that God shall exercise absolute control. This is the meaning of our Lord’s words in the light of all that he said and did, and of all that has happened since. But at present, he has said only that he is king, the Messianic king, and he has said it to men sure to misunderstand it if he leaves it in its present unconditional form. Hence he immediately puts over against it the prediction of his own fate. He is to be rejected and put to death. Their idea of the Messianic king was that through him righteousness was to be victorious. God had been holding off for his own wise purposes, not asserting himself, but in the times of the Messiah, he was to intervene with his almightiness, and sin was to be put down, and righteousness established. And this power to put down all enemies was to be lodged in the Messiah. This was the Jewish Messianic pro- gramme. We have seen already that Jesus, in all probability, did not, at any time before his death, predict his violent death and his resurrection with any definiteness. The utter dismay of the disciples over the actual event, their hopelessness between the death and the resurrection, and their failure to accept the fact of the resurrection, make such a prediction psychologically impos- sible. But it is equally evident that he did make statements which, in the light of the later events, they saw implied and involved those events. And this means Jesus’ repudiation of the Jewish Messianic programme. His enemies were not to be in his power, but he in theirs. God was not to intervene in his behalf, nor was his own divine power to be used in this way. But Jesus is not satisfied with the statement about himself, which might make it appear that his fate was unique, and that his case stood by itself. But he goes on to state that any one who wishes to follow him must deny himself and take his life in his hands in the same way. In his kingdom, to save is to lose, and the only way to save is to lose. Instead of getting God on his side so that he is saved from the ordinary mishaps of life, the disciple only multiplies indefinitely the chances of mishap without adding anything to the safeguards. Any one can see that if righteousness was to become a spiritual power in the world, it could only be by such a sacrifice of safety. A padded and steel- clad righteousness protects the person, but its power to propagate XXVIli THE PERSON AND PRINCIPLES OF JESUS is gone. And as we have seen, the Transfiguration itself was not a revelation of the glory that was covered up and concealed by this human weakness of our Lord, but of the glory of the sacrifice itself. It is as much as to say that gentleness, self-effacement, and weakness, instead of power, are in themselves glorious, and are to be crowned. But the disciples themselves give Jesus an opportunity to define himself still further. They were disputing who among their num- ber was greatest. He does not deny that there is such a thing, nor that it is to be coveted, but it is the greatness of humility and service. In the world, greatness is the power to make others tributary to yourself, but in the kingdom of God, the greatness even of the king is service, the power to contribute to the com- mon weal. At last, then, Jesus has declared himself. He is the divinely appointed king of men, and as such demands obedience, and finds greatness in service. But the obedience is to be voluntary and unenforced, and his own road to kingship is through repudia- tion and death. This absolute self-effacement is, moreover, the principle of the kingdom, and required of all its members. From this, he passes over again to more incidental matters. John brings to his attention the case of a man whom they had caught casting out demons in his name, but who had not attached himself to the circle of disciples. Jesus’ reply is, virtually, that they ought to have inferred from his casting out the demons that he really belonged with them, instead of from his not associating with them that he had no right to cast out the demons. This shows that whatever exclusiveness has grown up since then among his followers did not originate with Jesus. He did not organize a society, though his principles justify the later organization; but those principles exclude a hierarchy. With the beginning of Jesus’ ministry in Judza, begins a series of discourses occasioned by the attempt of the Pharisees to put his authority as a teacher to the test, and, if possible, to discredit it. In general, the questions propounded were either in dispute be- tween the different schools, or the standing puzzles of the school- men. It is significant, as showing that Mk.’s development of Jesus’ position in occasional, rather than set, discourse, is the method of Jesus himself, that some of his most important teach- THE PERSON AND PRINCIPLES OF JESUS XXIX ing is occasioned by these questions. And it shows his position as a teacher that these answers are final, revealing in every case the principles involved. His treatment of divorce is one of the safeguards of civilization. His answer to the question about pay- ing tribute to the Roman government shows that citizenship in the kingdom of God does not conflict with citizenship in the State. The one, as the other, is based on fundamental facts. Their question is an inference from their politica! conception of the kingdom of God. His answer is a corollary from his spiritual conception. His answer to the Sadducees about the resurrection not only puts that question to rest, but establishes the right to argue from fundamental conceptions of God, the right of reason in matters of faith. In what he says about the two great com- mands, he establishes fundamental principles and sentiments in- stead of rules, in control of life. But more than this, he selects the one principle that does contain in itself all righteousness, and which still condemns the essential parts of life. And still more, he shows the final and conclusive reason why the kingdom is spiritual. Outward conduct can be controlled by civil authority, but love is capable of only inward enforcement. Meantime, other things have been happening by which his posi- tion is still further defined. The scene with the rich young man whose wealth alone kept him from following our Lord leads him to say that his difficulty is not peculiar to him, but belongs to his class. The difficulty that all men have in accepting the principle of the kingdom becomes, in the case of wealth, a human impossi- bility to be overcome only by God. This means only that the principle of the kingdom is self-sacrifice and love, and that the acquisition and possession of wealth, on the other hand, tend almost certainly to selfishness. Christ’s entry into Jerusalem is his public claim of the Messianic kingship. This is followed immediately by his one act of author- ity, the cleansing of the temple. But the power is only that of a masterful personality, — the power of a prophet or righteous man. But he not only claims authority for himself, he denies the author- ity of the constituted authorities to judge his claim. He puts them to the test, as they have put him, by putting them a ques- tion in regard to John the Baptist, which will show whether they can judge such a case or not. The question of authority in XXX THE PERSON AND PRINCIPLES OF JESUS the kingdom of God is a question of fitness, of ability to do the thing. Jesus has one more word to say to his disciples. It is the pre- diction of the destruction of the temple, city, and nation, and the transfer of the kingdom from them to others. He sees that their rejection of a spiritual Messiah, and their insistence on political independence and greatness, will certainly lead to destruction. That, moreover, will be a coming of the Son of Man in clouds, clothed with power. Not that that will be the beginning of his reign, for he is to be seated at the right hand of power, and to come in the clouds, immediately. But this is to be his first great appearance as the arbiter of human affairs. The overthrow of the nation will come directly, as for the divine side of it, not by force, but by the inevitable operation of cause and effect, from the denial of his principle of a spiritual kingdom. And so, by the operation of the same inexorable law working in human affairs, his principles are to be everywhere vindicated. And at the same time, the spiritual power accumulated in his life and death are to be wielded by him in the spiritual sphere, until finally, in the exercise of both powers, his kingdom becomes universal. Two things remain to be spoken of: the death of Jesus, and his enshrinement of that in a memorial rite. The way has been opening ever since that time for a right understanding of that event, and yet even now one needs to weigh his words to speak with even partial truth about it, let alone adequacy. In the first place, then, looked at simply as a matter governed by the ordinary conditions of human life, it was natural and necessary. Nothing else could come of the opposition that he encountered from the religious and civil authority. There were two ways of escape morally possible to any other man, but not to him. One was to compromise in some way with the authorities, or to make some alliance with the people, that should neutralize the opposition of the Sanhedrim. His insight, his grasp of principles, his mastery of the situation, his influence with the people, might have given him political power, to which his instinct for righteousness would have given the last touch of greatness. But that was the way of compromise, which was demanded at every turn of the perplexing situation. And that admits us to one secret of the uniqueness of Jesus’ death. It was entirely for righteousness’ sake. The oppo- THE PERSON AND PRINCIPLES OF JESUS ——-xxxi sition to him was purely on that account, unmixed with any other oppositions or repugnances, growing out of the ordinary weakness or disagreeableness of men. But Jesus died because his righteous- ness was uncompromising and absolute, not because its manner was hard and obtrusive. Another way of escape was by the use of his supernatural power. Both friends and enemies saw this. The Jews did not expect deliverance, except supernaturally, and the hope of the people was that Jesus, who evidently possessed this power, would use it in the appointed way. And the Jews taunted him, because at the last moment his power had forsaken him. But Jesus died because he would do his work as a man, and under the ordinary conditions and limitations of humanity. In other words, Jesus’ death crowned the complete self-surren- der of his life. All of us know that just here is where ordinary righteousness is lacking. It is righteousness with a saving clause. We follow it just so far as it does not involve a complete sacrifice of self-interest. Some draw the line in one place, and some in another, but everybody somewhere. Jesus seeing more clearly than any other the sacrifice involved, undertook the task of abso- lute righteousness, and carried it out to the end. And he would accept no immunity, wield no power, and exercise no self-defence, that would mar the completeness of that ideal. But he was, nevertheless, king. He did not propose to himself simply to be righteous, in which case men might have let him alone. He proposed to establish this complete, and principled, and radical righteousness in the world as its supreme law. Men felt in his first words the note of authority, and he did not attempt in any way to disguise the uncompromising nature of his demand. He told them that if any one would follow him, he must deny himself as ke did. And in his own life, he showed them how, at every turn, the acceptance of this principle involved the hostility, not of the vicious and degraded, but that opposition of the con- stituted authorities, and of the higher class, which means loss of caste. But we must not think of Jesus’ death as simply sacrifice to a principle. He died primarily because he loved men supremely. He was the Son of Man, whose life was bound up with the life of the world, who was identified with humanity. Here was where the danger came of abating any of the demand that he made upon XXXll THE PERSON AND PRINCIPLES OF JESUS men, since in the law which he sought to enforce is the only true life of man, and any abatement meant something less than his highest good. Nay, more, it meant the admission somewhere of the opposite principle to sap and undermine the whole fabric, and the danger also of abating any of the rigor of his demand upon himself, since his own righteousness was the foundation of his authority, and loss of power here meant loss of power to confer this highest good. And here is where the bitterness of his death came in. Here was a man who loved men supremely, to whom any evil or lack of men was known so surely and felt so deeply, and to whom in his own death was revealed the whole depth and bitterness of that human ill which was to find its only cure in him. And, finally, it is this self-surrendering love which makes the cross to-day the very seat and secret of his power. For love is Lord of life, and love culminated here. It is the constraint and inspiration of his love that makes him king of men. A clear- sighted and far-seeing love which chose for himself the thorn- crowned road to power and kingship, and that leads men over the same long and hard way to ultimate and complete good. And, as we have said, he enshrines this death in a memorial rite. He bids men take the bread, which is his body, and the cup, which is his blood, and find in them the food and drink of their souls. It is in his death that he wishes especially to be remembered. But, above all, it is in his death that he wishes to be understood, and to have himself brought intimately into the life of men, until the things that made him die have become the material and substance of man’s spiritual life. THE GOSPELS IN THE SECOND CENTURY ee aaa THE reason that this subject is given a large place in N.T. Introduction is the fact that prominent and influential literature will leave its traces upon other writings just as soon as that litera- ture has time to circulate, and so the later literature becomes a witness to the earlier. Especially is that the case with what is called Scripture. Scripture is a court of appeal in regard to religious matters to which other writers on the same subject necessarily refer, and that a thing is written, that is, a part of Scripture, establishes its authority. In turn, other religious litera- ture becomes thereby a test by which we may determine whether any particular writing which claims to be Scripture is put in that category at any period, or is extant even. For instance, if we found Paul’s writings generally accepted as Scripture, and, at the same time, lack of reference to Galatians, it would raise doubts about that epistle. However, Scripture is not in a class by itself in this matter ; it presents only an extreme case of a general fact which applies to all prominent and influential literature. The question whether the Gospels were in existence early in the sec- ond century —a really vital question — is one to be answered by the second-century literature. Considering the unique position of Jesus in Christianity, no writings of any account telling the story of his life are going to be ignored, — and this entirely apart from the question whether they are classed as Scripture. But there is another still more vital question, whether the Jesus of the Synoptical Gospels is a true, historical figure. Now, supposing that we found no special reverence attached to the Gospels them- selves, and yet nothing else quoted in the earliest succeeding Christian literature in regard to him, the inference would be con- clusive that these were regarded at the time as the only standard books on the subject, which would go far toward establishing the historical character of the writings themselves and of the person- Xxxili 7 XXXIV THE GOSPELS IN THE SECOND CENTURY age presented in them. But, on the other hand, supposing that this earliest succeeding literature quoted from other, extra-canon- ical sources freely and without apology, and yet the historical figure remained unchanged, the additional matter, whether meagre or abundant, being almost entirely in keeping with the account in the canonical Gospels, the historicity is more triumphantly estab- lished by the corroborative testimony than by the absence of other witness. In fact, this state of things in the second-century litera- ture would be the most favorable possible for historicity. And the historical character of these Gospels— not whether they are the only Gospels, nor even whether they are Scripture —is the main question in Apologetics. What, then, is the relation of the second-century literature to the Synoptical Gospels? We have, in the first place, two epistles bearing the name of Clement of Rome. The second of these is wrongly attributed to Clement, but belongs to the same period. In the genuine epistle, then, the O.T. is quoted frequently and at great length. But the N.T. quotations are very few and meagre. With one exception, too, the writers are not mentioned. The words of our Lord are quoted as his, but not the writer who reports them. In one case, 1 Cor. is quoted as St. Paul’s, but this stands alone.' The quotations from the Gospels are only two, and these are so inexact as to make it doubtful whether the writer had before him at the time our present Gospels.’ In the spurious writing, the number of quotations from the Gospel history is considerably greater, and the comparison with the amount of O.T. matter much more favorable. But, on the other hand, the mixed origin and uncertain character of these citations are equally noticeable. Four of them are quoted with considerable exactness.* Five are quoted ad sensum, but so as to indicate that the passages in our Gospels were in the writer’s mind, but were cited by him from memory.’ But three, which Lightfoot assigns to the Gospel of the Egyptians(?), contain strange matter. In one, our Lord says, “If you are gathered 1 Par. XLVII. 2 Par. XIII. Mt. 57 614 71.2 Lk, 631. 36-38; XLVI. Mt. 2624 186 Mk. 1421 942 Lk, 2222 171. 2, 8 II. Mt. 918 Mk. 217; III. Mk. 1239; VI. Mt. 624 Lk. 1615 Mt. 1626 Mk. 836, 4 III. Mt. 1082 Lk. 128; IV. Mt. 72; VIII. Lk. 1610-11; TX. Mt. 1259; XIII, Lk. 682. 35, THE GOSPELS IN THE SECOND CENTURY XXXV with me in my bosom, and do not my commands, I will cast you out, and say to you, Depart from me, I know you not whence you are, workers of lawlessness.” ? In another, after Jesus’ statement, “You will be as lambs in the midst of wolves,” Peter says, “ If then the wolves scatter the lambs?” and Jesus answers, “ Let not the lambs fear the wolves after their death. And you, fear not those who kill you, and can do nothing to you, but fear him who, after you die, has power over soul and body to cast into the Gehenna of fire.” Then, as to the coming of the kingdom, he says that it will be “ whenever the two (things) are one, and the outside as the inside, and the male with the female, neither male nor female.” * In the seven epistles of Ignatius, quotations are infrequent, but the N.T. is treated quite as generously as the O.T. There are, however, only three unimportant passages from the Gospels, but, in these, the language is significantly preserved.* But, in a fourth, our Lord’s language, “‘ Handle me, and see. For a spirit hath not flesh and bones, as you see me have,” becomes, “‘ Handle me, and see that I am not a bodiless spirit’””— dayonov. This use of Saiudvoy is foreign to the N.T. vocabulary.° The Epistle of Polycarp, belonging to the same period, bristles with quotations, mostly from the N.T. Of these, however, only five are from the Gospels. Of these, four preserve the language so as to show undisputed acquaintance with our Gospels, and without mixture of matter derived from other sources.* The fifth presents such a resemblance to the mixed quotation in Ep. of Clem. XIII. as to suggest a common extra-canonical source.’ In the Teaching of the Apostles, which belongs apparently to the very beginning of the century, there are sixteen quotations from the Synoptics. In these, the words of our Lord are quoted quite exactly, the supplementary matter attached to them being evi- dently the writer’s own reflections. But the title, which gives the 1IV. 2V. ext. 4 Eph. XIV. Mt. 1233; Smyrn. I. Mt. 315; VI. Mt. 1912; Poly. II. Mt. rolé, 5 Smyrn. III. 6 II, Mt. 53-10; V. Mk. 9%; VII. Mt. 618 2641 Mk. 1438; XII. Mt. 544. 711. Mt. 71. 2 Lk, 638-38 81, Mt, 2237. 39 gM4. 46 Lk, 627. 28. 32. 33. 35 Mt. Ce 629. 30 Mt. 526; IIT. Mt. 55; VII. Mt. 2819; VIII. Mt. 65.913 Lk. 1124; IX. Mt. 76; X. Mt. 2431; ‘XII. Mt. 219 eg see ix. 1988 ? XIII. Mt. 1019; XVI. Mt. 2518 Lk. 1285. 40 Mt, 2qlo. 24.30 Lk, 2112 t, 24 7 e XXXVI THE GOSPELS IN THE SECOND CENTURY authority of the apostles to an inferior and frequently trivial writing of the second century, is an instructive commentary on the way in which great names may be misused for pious purposes. The Epistle of Barnabas — not, however, the companion of Paul, and possibly no Barnabas at all — is rich again in O.T. quotations, but poor in N.T. sayings, there being only four quoted from the Synoptics.? The Shepherd of Hermas contains infrequent reflections of scriptural language rather than quotations. ‘The one quotation, therefore, of the language of Mk. in regard to the difficulty obstructing a rich man’s entrance into the kingdom, is the more noteworthy.” Justin Martyr is rich in quotations, which are not scattered, as in the other writers of this period, but collected mostly in a group in the first Apology, for the purpose of showing for apologetic purposes what our Lord’s teaching was. The variations from the synoptical accounts would be more difficult to deal with, if we did not find the same freedom of quotation in the passages from the O.T. As it is, we have to find a common cause, and that is to be found in Justin’s idiosyncrasy, which makes him more than usually independent and individual in his handling of quotations. £.g. he quotes our Lord thus: “If ye love them that love you, what new thing do you? For even fornicators do this.”* This same “new thing” appears again just below in regard to lending with hope of return, and coupled with a like inexactness in regard to the sinners who do the same thing.2 Again, “ Whosoever shall be angry is in danger of the fire.”* This is quoted quite out of its connection, and in the original, he who is angry is liable only to the judgment (of the local tribunal which tries minor offences), while only he who calls his brother a fool is liable to the Gehenna of fire. In the great commandment he makes our Lord require the worship of God alone, instead of love, and in this, and other places, | he calls attention to God as the Creator, a pure interpolation.* Another singular variation is in his quotation in regard to those who claim association with Christ, but whom he has to turn away as disobedient. He has mixed together here sayings from Mt. 1IV. Mt. 2214; Vv. Mt. 918; VI. Mt. 2016? XII. Mt. 2245, 3 1 Apol. ch. 15. 2 XX. Mk, 1023. 4 41 Apol. ch. 16. THE GOSPELS IN THE SECOND CENTURY XXXVIl and Lk., and made the men say, “ Did we not eat and drink in thy name?” instead of “in thy presence?” ! On the whole, it is remarkable that with all this variation in form Justin quotes no extra-canonical sayings of our Lord. As for the peculiarities of these sayings, the combination of the different accounts in the Synoptics, a habit of free quotation, an evident eye for the point of a saying, which allows freedom of detail — in other words, the strong individuality of the writer —will account for these phe- nomena. But, on the other hand, Justin introduces several extra- canonical incidents. These are the birth of Jesus in a cave,’ the miraculous fire in the Jordan at the baptism,’ and the statement in regard to his work as a carpenter, that he made plows and yokes.‘ These can be traced directly to their sources in uncanonical Gospels. The birth in a cave we find in the Protevangelium of James, and the Arabic Gospel of the Infancy ;° the fire in the Jordan in the Gospel according to the Hebrews; and the plows and yokes in the Gospel of Thomas.’ This settles the fact that Justin used such writings. By parity of reasoning, if we trace the sayings, in spite of certain difficulties, to the Synoptics as the main source, these incidents are to be credited to uncanonical Gospels. Moreover, he quotes the Acts of Pilate in confirmation of the miracles, evidently referring to the testimony of those healed by Jesus at the time of his trial before Pilate.’ On the whole then, the testimony is conclusive, that Justin used the Synoptics, but also other Gospels. Athenagoras, in his Apology, makes two quotations from Mt.,° and two in which he combines Mt. and Lk.’ It has been doubted whether these are quotations, but the freedom of quotation is slight, certainly not greater than the N.T. writers use in quoting from the O.T. In the fragments preserved to us from Papias, the statements in regard to Mk.’s Gospel and the Zogia of Mt. are the most impor- tant, and they occupy the same rank among the second-century wit- nesses to the canonical Gospels.” We should not expect to find 1 Apol. ch. 16. 3 Dial. with Trypho, ch. 88. 2 Dial. with Trypho, ch. 78. 4 Dial. with Trypho, ch, 89. 5 Protev. of Jas. par. 18, 19; Arab. Gos. of Inf. par. 2, 3. 6 Gos. Thos. par. 13. 9 Mt. 54 49 Lk. 627. 28 Mt. 546 Lk, 632. 34, 7 Apol. ch. 48; Acts of Pil.ch.6,7,8. 1° Euseb. CZ. Avs. III. 8 Mt. 528 Mt. 19%. XXXVili THE GOSPELS IN THE SECOND CENTURY much in the way of quotation, as he says expressly that he prefers the oral testimony of men who had associated with the disciples to anything that he could get from the books.’ But he does make one quotation from Mk.? He is one writer who gives us distinctly strange, apocryphal matter in regard to Jesus’ life and teachings, the general absence of which is so noteworthy and important in this second-century literature.® In Tatian, a heretical writer of the last part of the century, before the discovery of the Diatessaron, there was little contribut- ing to our subject. The only complete work of his, at that time, an oration to the Greeks, contains several quotations from J., but none from the Synoptics. But, in a few fragments preserved in other writings, we find two quotations from the Synoptics.* The Diatessaron of Tatian, however, a compilation of the four Gospels made some time in the third quarter of the century, is one of the most important of the recent discoveries. It was partly known before through a commentary of Ephrem the Syrian. The only important omissions are the genealogies of our Lord in Mt. and Lk., and the account of the woman taken in adultery from J. 8. The genealogies were omitted, not as a matter of evidence, but of opinion. The Appendix to Mk. is inserted, but this is not impor: tant, as we already have the testimony of the versions to its exist: ence in the early part of the century, and the real question of its authorship remains untouched. But the real value of the Dia- tessaron is in the fact, established at last, that it was compiled from the four canonical Gospels, and from no other source. The importance of this is unmistakable. In the Clementine Homilies, an Ebionite production of the latter part of the century, falsely ascribed to Clement of Rome, there are over seventy quotations from the Synoptics, and thirteen either entirely strange, or very considerably modifying the synop- tical account. Our Lord is represented as exhorting his disciples to become good money-changers, which obtains a significant meaning from the mixed quality ascribed to the Scriptures in the Homilies, making it necessary to discriminate carefully between the good 1 Ferm. de vir illust. 18; Eus. III. 39; Georg. Hamartolus. Chron. 2 Mk. 10%. 39, 3 Iren. Her. V. 33, 3, 4; Cramer, Catena ad Acta S. S, Apos. p. 12 sq. 4 Clem. Alex. III. 12, 86; Mt. 619 Lk. 20%, THE GOSPELS IN THE SECOND CENTURY XXX1X and bad, between the genuine and counterfeit coin of Scriptures.! In the same connection occurs several times a serious modification of the text in which our Lord charges the Sadducees with not knowing the Scriptures nor the power of God, where, for “the Scriptures’ is substituted “the true things of Scripture,” distin- guished from the false." In the account of the Syrophcenician woman, her name is given as Justa, and the account of the con- versation is paraphrased.” But this is a part of the romancing of this work, and does not need to be treated seriously. Several times the saying, “The tempter is the wicked one,” is attributed to our Lord.? The idea of the money-changers is extended into this saying: “ It is thine, O man, to prove my words, as silver and money are proved among the exchangers.” * The blessing which Jesus pronounces on the faithful servant is changed to a blessing on “the man whom the Lord shall appoint to the ministry of his fellow-servants.”* His prediction that many shall come from the east and west, and recline with Abraham, Isaac, and Jacob in the kingdom of God, is changed to “ many will come from the east, west, north, and south, and will recline on the bosom of Abraham, Isaac, and Jacob.”® ‘Gold and silver, and the luxury of this world,” are added to the things promised to Jesus by Satan in the temptation.’ Different parts are run together in the saying about false teachers, so that it reads: “ Many will come to me in sheep’s clothing, but inwardly they are ravening wolves.”*® So also Justin, Apol.i. ch. 16. And Satan is made to promise to “send apostles from among his subjects to deceive.’’® As an offset to the state- ment that stumbling-blocks must come, but woe to him through whom they come, Jesus says that “good things must come, and blessed is he through whom they come.’”’® And then we have the entirely strange exhortation, “ Give no pretext to the evil one,” ” and this enlargement of the idea of the wvornptov in our Lord’s remarks on his parabolic teaching, “‘ Keep the mysteries for me and the sons of my house.” The apocryphal Gospels are of interest, not because they con- tain important matter, most of it being quite trivial and impossible, but because they are the only writings outside of the canonical PIL. ch. 51; III. ch. 50; XVIII. ch. 20. 6 VITI. ch. 4. 9 XII. ch. 29. =01. eh. 19. 4 III. ch. 61. 7 VIII. ch, 2x. 10 XIX. ch. 2. 8 III. ch. 55. 5 III. ch. 60. 8 XI. ch, 35. 11 XIX. ch. 20. xl THE GOSPELS IN THE SECOND CENTURY Gospels which carry that name. Their date is very uncertain, but one of them, the lately discovered Gospel of Peter, is assigned a place in the second century. The Protevangelium of James, the Arabic Gospel of the Infancy, the Gospel according to the He- brews, and the Gospel of Thomas contain the apocryphal matter of Justin, whether they are the source of it or not; and the Acts of Pilate are quoted by Justin by name.’ Now, it is evident all through this second-century literature that the writers had and used other sources of information, in regard to the Gospel history, outside of the canonical Gospels, and Lk. himself speaks of many such accounts. The interest that attaches to these apocryphal Gospels, therefore, is that they are the only literary remains of this kind that have come down to us. What are they therefore ? They are mostly incredible accounts of the birth and infancy of Jesus himself, of his mother, of Joseph, of the trial of our Lord before Pilate, of his descent into Hades, and finally a docetic account of his death. The only extra-canonical matter in the second-century literature which can be traced to them is what relates to the infancy, the private life, and the baptism of Jesus, and possibly the rehearsal of the miracles in the Acts of Pilate. The unwritten sayings, and unfamiliar forms of the written sayings, are not to be found in them. While there are, therefore, extra- canonical sources quoted by the second-century writers, these Gospels can figure only slightly among these sources. The earliest attempt at a canon, or authoritative list of N.T. writings, did not come from an orthodox source, but was pub- lished by Marcion, a Gnostic heretic of the latter half of the cen- tury. He declared war against Judaism, and, since he believed the original apostles to be Judaistic in their tendency, he rejected them, and, with them, all the extant N.T. writings, except ten epistles of Paul (omitting the pastoral epistles) and a Gospel.’ What this Gospel was, we have to gather from Tertullian, who wrote at length against him, and this question has been one of the most debated critical problems, opinion wavering between a muti- lated Lk., and an earlier Gospel on which Lk. was based. Either theory makes Marcion a witness for Lk.’s Gospel, and certainly no 1 See paragraph on Justin Martyr. 2 Tertullian vs. Marcion V. 21, IV. 2, 3. THE GOSPELS IN THE SECOND CENTURY xli other theory is possible in view of the Pauline universalism that characterizes this Gospel. When we come to the close of the century, we are at last in the presence of a canon, not the same as our present canon, nor a definitely settled list, but still a selection of Christian literature regarded as Scripture, and put on the same footing as the O.T. Among the witnesses to this is the canon of Muratori. This was discovered in Milan during the seventeenth century ; the manu- script belongs to the eighth or ninth century, and the writing claims for itself a second-century date. Though this latter date is in dispute, it is probable if we make it late in the century. Unfor- tunately, there is a gap at the very beginning, so that Lk. is the first Gospel mentioned. But as the mention begins with the title, “Third book of the Gospel according to Lk.,’’ it becomes a wit- ness to the four Gospels, and to an acceptance of these among the rest as authoritative. What, then, is the conclusion of the whole matter? Clement makes two quotations, the canonical source of which is doubtful. Pseudo-Clement gives twelve, — nine of them canonical but free, and three extra-canonical ; Ignatius, four, — one of them probably uncanonical; Polycarp, five,— four canonical but free, and one probably extra-canonical ; the Didache, sixteen, quite canonical ; Pseudo-Barnabas, four, canonical ; Shepherd of Hermas, one, nor- mal ; the rest mere reflections of Scripture. Justin quotes largely but freely, and introduces incidents from apocryphal sources, one of which, the Acts of Pilate, he cites by name as authority for the miracles of our Lord; Athenagoras, four, quoted freely ; Papias, one from Mk., with distinctly apocryphal matter. The Clementine Homilies give us canonical and uncanonical matter in the propor- tion of about seventy to thirteen. One of these, about good money-changers, is a distinct addition to the probable sayings of our Lord. Finally, we have the testimony of Papias to the com- position of Mk., and of the Zogia, the probable witness of Marcion to Lk., the more than probable testimony of the Canon of Mura- tori to the canonical Gospels, and the Diatessaron of Tatian, with its unmistakable use of the four Gospels as the exclusive source of information about the Gospel history. The conclusions are inevi- table : first, that the second-century literature certainly uses extra- canonical sources of information about our Lord, and does it freely xlil THE GOSPELS IN THE SECOND CENTURY and without apology ; secondly, that the four Gospels were the main stream to which the rest was tributary, — the standard writings on the subject ; thirdly, they were not Scripture in the sense which we attach to that word,—they were not separated from other writ- ings by any such line; fourthly, that the amount and importance of extra-canonical matter is after all small. Substantially, the Jesus of the second-century literature is the Jesus of the Gospels. This fact is, as we have seen, the most important and favorable result to be obtained, more important in every way than the attempted exclusion of extra-canonical sources. The unrestricted use of extra-canonical sources, without any important change of the record or of the historical figure, is an ideal result. RECENT CRITICAL LITERATURE —_—__$. WuaT we may call the newer criticism of the Gospels accepts the historical character of those writings as being substantially contemporaneous history. It receives our present Gospel of Mk., and the Zogza of Mt., both of them coming from the inner circle of the disciples, as the basis of our Synoptical Gospels. Criticism thus confines itself at present — and this may be taken as an ultimate position—to the details of these documents, and has ceased to attack, or even to minimize, the historicity of the documents themselves. But there is one reservation which some of the critics feel themselves justified in making as one of the axioms, — the accepted data of historical criticism, — the axiom, namely, that miracles do not happen. How plausible this position is becomes evident when we consider how universally, and as a matter of course, we apply it outside of the Biblical history. And, in general, we can say with perfect confidence that the grounds on which it rests are such as to establish the @ f77o77 improbability of any miracle, and to justify historical criticism in scrutinizing with extreme care any story of supernatural happenings. If we ask, then, in this matter, for an ultimate result, an accepted con- clusion, we shall not find it. But, on the other hand, the acknowl- edged historicity of the Gospels, we believe, carries with it a strong presumption of the verity of the miraculous element in their story. And when we add to this the verisimilitude of these miracles, we are convinced that the inherent improbability is, in the case of these miracles, quite overcome. It is a modification of this adverse criticism when the miracles are reduced, as they are by some critics, to those cures which can be explained by the extraordinary action of Jesus’ unique personality on the minds of men, and the reaction of this on their bodies. This review of the literature is confined to the writers repre- senting conspicuously this newer criticism. This is done with xlili xliv RECENT CRITICAL LITERATURE more confidence because they are, for the most part, trustworthy exegetical guides, and in this department, as in that of criticism, give a largely antiquarian or historical interest to the preceding literature. The first of these is Meyer, whose commentary on the entire N.T.—that part of it written by himself, including everything from Mt. to the pastoral epistles — being easily first among com- mentaries. He had the exegetical faculty beyond all other com- mentators, so that you can omit any other in studying a book, but Meyer no scholar can omit. He represents the school of which we are speaking, accepting the history, criticising the details with combined freedom and caution, and, as for miracles, accepting the general fact while criticising single cases. The next is Weiss, the posthumous editor of Meyer, with a commentary of his own on Mk. and its Synoptical parallels, a Zz/e of our Lord, an Introduction to the N. T., and a Biblical Theology of the N. T. Like Meyer, he is a conservative critic, but far behind Meyer in the keenness and sureness of his exegetical sense. In his treatment of the Gospels especially, we have to deal with idiosyncracies of opinion that make one forget the real value of his contribution to biblical learning. At the very outset, he denies that our Lord’s teachings form an independent, and especially a superior, source of Christian doctrine. This is not of so much consequence, but the reason for it betrays a singular lack of discernment, and involves a far-reaching and destructive theory of the Gospels. It is that the source of both these and the other N.T. writings is apostolic, and that therefore you cannot expect any different view of the Gospel in the one and the other. This is to forget several essential things. First, the act of reporting is distinct from that of original presentation ; and my ability to keep myself out of a report is a test of my fitness. Just how far it is done has to be decided in each case; and there are decisive proofs that the Synoptical writers have made a considerable suc- cess of it. In the first place, while the Synoptics are not inde- pendent, there are two distinct sources of their account, viz. Mk.’s apostolic authority and the Zogza of Mt. But the unity of the matter drawn from these sources—the impress of one strongly differentiated and individual personality upon it all—dis the most marked impression left by the three accounts. Furthermore, the RECENT CRITICAL LITERATURE xlv person and teaching of our Lord in them make a distinct type, with individual characteristics that make them stand out as clearly as the figure of St. Paul. To take one instance of the way in which the apostolic source has reported teaching different from the apostolic teaching about the same, — it taught the immediate- ness of the second visible coming of our Lord, but it does not report him as teaching the same. Another example of the way in which the Christ of the apostolic source is differentiated from its representation of the same thing in other persons is its story of his miracles compared with the morals of the apostolic miracles. Again, Weiss maintains that Jesus upheld the entire Jewish law, — ceremonial and moral alike, — but without the traditions of the Pharisees. It is enough to say, in reply to this, that Jesus abol- ished the distinction between clean and unclean, and denied the possibility of external defilement of the inner man. But the diffi- culty lies deeper. It involves forgetfulness of the conflict between priest and prophet in the O.T. itself, and of the impossibility that any man should maintain both sides of an irrepressible conflict. It represents our Lord, of all men that ever lived, as unable to distinguish between things that differ. Finally, Weiss asserts that it was the intention of Jesus to set up a political kingdom in Judzea in accordance with the national expectation, and in fulfil- ment of the natural and obvious meaning of the prophecies ; only, it was to be a righteous kingdom ;— it required as the indispen- sable condition the conversion of the nation, and it was to be established as the voluntary act of the people, not by violence. The point is, however, that the kingdom was to come by a Divine tour de force. The form which it ultimately took, involving the final overthrow of the national hope, was due to the final refusal of the people to repent. Here is a place in which definitions and discriminations are absolutely necessary. If by a political king- dom is meant an enforced rule, —and this is the only meaning that accorded with the national expectation, — then Jesus did not intend nor expect any such kingdom. All that he says implies a spiritual kingdom, with worldly power arrayed against it, and no Divine power to meet this hostile power on its own ground. All the subsequent history is of such a spiritual kingdom, and what our Lord says implies that this was not an afterthought, but the permanent policy of God in ruling his kingdom. xlvi RECENT CRITICAL LITERATURE As for the miracles, Weiss admits them, and does not attempt any reasoned discrimination among them. But he does show his sense of the strength of the unbelief in the supernatural by insist- ing on leaving a way of escape to the naturalistic explanation of at least some of them, lest the unbelief in the miraculous involve the whole history in a common ruin. Beyschlag, in his Leden Fesu, is another example of the same school, which combines acceptance of the apostolic source and historical character of the Synoptical accounts with free critical handling of the details. He modifies the theory of Meyer and Weiss, and before them Weisse, in regard to the origin of the Synoptics, by relegating our Mk., as well as Mt. and Lk., to the rank of secondary documents, and making the sources of all three to be an original Mk., and the Zogia of Mt. But this does not materially alter the general conclusion. His work does not show the abundant learning of Weiss, and it is not so carefully orthodox, but it is more sympathetic; it has a finer historical sense and a sounder judgment. Its point of view is expressed in the author’s repeated statement that the Jesus of our faith is identical with the Jesus of history, and is not a product of Aberglaube. Beyschlag’s theory of miracles includes the most of those performed by our Lord, but omits those in which the law of cause and effect is manifestly broken, such as the miracle of the loaves and fishes. The cures of our Lord he traces to his marvellous personality, its power over other men’s spiritual natures, and the well-known reac- tion of a powerfully moved mind on the bodily condition. But where the process and connection of events is plainly lacking, and there is only a word, — a command, — he rejects the miracle as a violation of natural law; that is, to him, as to the ordinary unbe- liever in the supernatural, the miraculous, in the sense of the inexplicable, does not happen. The difference is that the ordi- nary anti-supernaturalist proceeds from this denial to a disbelief in religion generally, and especially in Jesus. Beyschlag, by explaining the miracles, putting them in the ordinary sequence of nature, defends the historicity of the Gospels even from the point of view of the anti-supernaturalist. The particular sequence in our Lord’s miracles — the reaction of mind on body — is com- mon enough, only in Jesus’ unique personality it is raised to the nth degree. RECENT CRITICAL LITERATURE xlvii Holtzmann, in his Commentary on the Synoptical Gospels, and in his Introduction, is the clearest and cleverest of the exponents of this now accepted theory of the Synoptical Gospels. It would be hard to find a more transparent or convincing piece of critical work than his discussion of the Synoptical problem in the Intro- duction to his commentary. He wavers somewhat in his consid- eration of the question whether our Mk. is the original Mk., but is decided in his statement that the two are for substance identical, and that for all practical purposes, it is our Mk. which may be taken as the basis of Mt. and Lk. These Gospels were formed by the combination of Mk. with the Zogia. This Mk.-hypothesis he characterizes strongly, but justifiably, as no longer hypothesis, but established and accepted critical fact. Moreover, he regards both of these sources as historical, and all the Synoptical Gospels, there- fore, as having a historical basis. They are not historical in their purpose, since what we may call their apologetic aim is evident in all three. They are intended to represent Jesus as the Messiah, and to show that his death, so far from defeating his purpose and disproving his claim, was foreseen by him, and included in his purpose. But the events and teachings used in this showing are, substantially, facts. The miracles Holtzmann rejects, however ; and, while the obvious reason for this is his acceptance of the critical assumption that miracles do not happen, and are therefore to be set aside simply as miracles, nevertheless, his showing up of them as echoes of O.T. miracle-stories is very clever, although fallacious. That a writer of his unusual clearness and judgment should not see the contradiction between the general historicity of these books and the spuriousness of the miracles is wonderful. And that the absolute verisimilitude of the miracles should escape him is even stranger still. But that Holtzmann, with his evident skepticism, and his absolute and unqualified rejection of mere traditionalism, should accept the general historicity of the Synop- tics, is the most noticeable element in the whole situation. It would be unfair to close this review of the literature which combines criticism and faith without mentioning an admirable American contribution to it by Dr. Orello Cone.’ He says that the total result of,criticism is, ‘‘ that the divine doctrine of Jesus 1 Gospel Criticism, G. P. Putnam’s Sons. xIvili RECENT CRITICAL LITERATURE stands forth clearly defined, and of his personality there emerge not only ‘a few ineffaceable lineaments which could belong only toa figure unique in grace and majesty,’ but the figure itself emerges in its majesty and grace.”’ For a balanced statement of the pre- dominance of the Jewish outlook in Mt., and of the Pauline uni- versalism in Lk., which, however, does not prevent either writer from introducing material which shows the true middle ground of fact, we can commend this book. And this is only a sample of the careful and judicious spirit characterizing the whole. His estimate of the legendary and dogmatic element in the Gospels is exagger- ated, to say the least, but his acceptance of their historical kernel is hearty and important. Of a very different sort is the commentary of Dr. James Mori- son, to which the present writer has had frequent recourse, and gladly acknowledges indebtedness. There is an abundance of helpful information in it, especially in regard to the various Eng- lish translations. . And his summarizing of different views is, in many passages, exhaustive, and his archeological information extensive. But, while his exegetical sense is sometimes fine, it is far from that on the whole. In his criticism of the text, he is free, and his textual conclusions agree with those of the estab- lished critical texts in the main. But in the higher criticism, he seems to lack judgment and fairness. He is as well informed in this as in other departments. But when, after a long review of the literature in regard to the Synoptical problem, he concludes that all the theories are alike baseless, and that there is really no problem there; that the resemblances are not uncommon, nor such as may not be accounted for mostly by the growing fixity of the oral tradition, his case becomes hopeless. And his conclusion, after a minute examination of the last twelve verses of ch. 16, that the omission is probably due to an accidental omission in some early copy, and that the “whole fabric of opposition and doubt must, as biblical criticism advances, crumble into dust,” is amazing. In view of the universal discarding of this critical theory of the Synoptics by English commentators, it is well to call attention to the cumulative nature of the proof. The phenomena of verbal resemblance, on which the traditional view of independence goes to pieces, are not isolated, but prolonged and repeated. And the RECENT CRITICAL LITERATURE xlix same is true of the verbal peculiarities of the last twelve verses, which many English textual critics reject, but which English com- mentaries defend with unanimity and spirit! Dr. Morison thinks that he answers this objection by citing with each case a paral- lel instance from some other author. But the real question is whether he can match the accumulation of these in the same space elsewhere. 1] should note one exception, — a commentary by Dr. W. N. Clarke, published in Philadelphia by the American Baptist Pub. Soc., who shows here the admirable judgment characteristic of his general work, a my 4 EW + 4ane Ah ae rie Ave : Rt Ny AW hd ft pp. a mi ‘4 5 Aas tatu" iv a 4 j i fi { b ¥ Sarat Pr ‘ , ‘ ‘ { « ‘ ¥4 i ’ A f f v) hy , 4 A P i (Se. ¥ } j f i m4 , i i ry F >» ' i 4! { : 4 i ; 7 4 L J j Wy ‘ ip? ) iy 5 in De _ iy! by ij i hy ; Pe, a, ate a sh oa hy i Nt ia {iy and ) a8 ; a (hea att 4 10 al Ci THE TEXT ee THE text followed in this commentary is not either of the critical texts, the author preferring to choose in each case between the several texts on the strength of the evidence. His authority for the texts has been Scrivener’s edition of the text of Stephens, with the various readings of Beza, Elzevir, Lachmann, Tischendorf, Tre- gelles, Westcott and Hort, and the Revised Version, Cambridge, 1887. The text of Treg. is based too entirely on the older authori- ties for independent use, while that of the Revisers is too conserva- tive to satisfy a critical judgment. Either the text of Tischendorf’s edition, or of WH., would be satisfactory, but an independent text, based on both, but following neither without exception, seems still better. The authority for the sources is Tischendorf’s magnum opus, the Edito Major of his eighth edition. An analysis of the various readings adopted shows something like 650 variations from the Tex. Rec., and in these the several sources appear as follows: WHOLE NuMBER, 6571 Seca rt (4°) 16 ££} 59 2). 108 6 | 20988) 258 4 | g0r ‘I meee 1 i 29°) 15k | Go fF | 115 8 | 218-1) 259° 1 | 340 I Peso 25) 22) 2). Gf. (5 1-116 2 1 225: 2.) 262. = | 546' 55 ease WN 62 y 27 (2) GF 3 1 18 30) 229° 5 | 27% 3.) 406 2 Seo. | WG 1 25 114] 64, 2] 121 F 4237 2 | 282 3 | 433. 2 Peete me | 37450. 2) 66 8 | 122°2 | 238.8) 2090. 7 1.435 3 moeas | . 42.1353 45) 67 41 124 50] 239. ¥ | Lat. Vet. . 303 aon A 440 | 40° '§ | 69 102) 127, 7 | 240. 3 | Vulg. . 152 Pease | 6S | 42 2) 9h 2) Fgh 17 | 24t 3 |. Memph: 293 = 52 ig £0) Rr eae Sh gee. rh 2een a) Dheb:, 53 eee a 8 Sen 98 eb .597)) 6 |244 | 4 | Pesh. 115 ee GO Se a Oe og) eee 8h aae. 2) Efarel. |... | go apse | 10.27) 56) 2 | £02. 39.) 2or 2] 248 1 dae ce me 8, Sees ee 1G Be 2) TOs. EB) 205-2 | 251 6.1 Jer. Syrs «| 25 Beraa) ts 85) 59 ¥)| 106 .'5:| 206.2 | 253° 3. 1 Numbers approximate only, li lii THE TEXT It changes somewhat the proportions of the above statement, that in C, about three chapters are wanting, in L 32 verses, in F 86 verses, in G 19 verses, in H 19 verses, in N some 7 chapters, in P all but fragments, T4 the same, in X the first 6 chapters, and in I' nearly 3 chapters. The Theb. version is also in fragments only. From this analysis, it appears that substantially the critical text of to-day, as it appears in Tisch. and WH., is that of s and B, the two oldest mss. of the N.T., both of which belong to the fourth century. It is, moreover, strongly supported by C and D of the fifth and sixth centuries, by L of the eighth, and A of the ninth century. The only first-rate authority that can be excepted from this convergent testimony is A of the fifth century. The testi- mony of the versions is to the same effect, the older versions furnishing strong support to the readings of these oldest mss. The Old-Latin version, ¢.g., concurs with them twice as frequently as the Vulgate, and the Peshito, the oldest Syriac version, twice as frequently as the later versions in the same language. And one of the strong supports of these readings is the Memphitic, which is of about the same age as these oldest Latin and Syriac versions. As far as the material now in hand goes, then, it points strongly to the conclusion of the textual critics that the oldest texts extant are comparatively pure. If s and B stood by themselves, we might say that possibly they had been more open than usual to corrupting influences, and that a purer form of the text was to be found in some later text of a purer strain. But, as a matter of fact, as we get back towards the fourth century, we find the text converging towards the form of these oldest extant sources, which shows conclusively that they belong in the main current of the text, and not in some side-stream more or less impure. A, which stands nearest to & and B in point of time, furnishes us with a convenient comparison. Here is a text different from the combi- nation * B, and very much nearer the later texts. Does this represent the main stream, and & B the divergence, or the reverse? The fact that, as we go back, the text converges towards & B, and not towards A, proves conclusively that the older mss. are comparatively pure. We have, in the oldest ver- sions, and in the Fathers, some traces of the state of the text in the first two centuries, and these confirm the type of text found in 8 B. There is a distinct type of text in these and in their cognates which lacks the smoothness and orthodoxy of the later THE TEXT lili texts: ¢.g. the omission of Kai vyoreda in 9” is contrary to second- century and later orthodoxy ; and, to take a more important case, the omission of 16°”, with its account of the resurrection and ascension, subtracts not from the creed, but from confirmations of the creed. The onward movement of the text is toward smoothness and conformity, the later text supplying here and there the apparent deficiencies of the earlier type. Now, as we get still further back, going from the fourth century to the third and second, we find the reverse movement toward a certain rough- ness and non-conformity still kept up, which shows still further, and more strongly, that the great textual critics have not been lacking in critical judgment in giving to & B and their cognates the preference naturally due to the oldest known type of text. THE PRINCIPAL MSS. AND VERSIONS Necessarily, the information in regard to the sources of the text possible in a volume like this is very slight. The student is referred to the Prolegomena of Tischendorf’s Hatto Major, edited by Dr. C. R. Gregory, and to Scrivener’s Introduction to Zhe Criticism of the NV. T., London, 1894. Oncials 8 = Codex Sinaiticus, discovered by Tischendorf in the convent of St. Catha- rine, Mt. Sinai, 1859, and now at St. Petersburg. A manuscript of the fourth century. B =Codex Vaticanus, in the Vatican Library at Rome, where it seems to have been brought very soon after the founding of the Library in 1448. Also of the fourth century, and slightly older than x. A =Codex Alexandrinus, in the British Museum from its foundation in 1753. Brought from Constantinople, in 1528, as a present from the patriarch Cyril Lucar to Charles I. Belongs to the fifth century. C =Codex Ephraemt, in the Royal Library of Paris. Brought from the East by the Medici family in the sixteenth century, and into France by Catharine de Medici. A valuable palimpsest of the fifth century. D =Codex Bezae, a Greco-Latin manuscript of the Gospels and Acts, pre- sented to the University Library at Cambridge by the reformer Theo- dore Beza in 1581. Previously in the monastery of St. Irenzeus, Lyons. Belongs to the sixth century. A singularly corrupt text, but bearing important witness to the accepted critical text. The corruptions are largely interpolations, and the text on which these are inlaid contains abundant confirmation of the purer form of the text. liv THE TEXT L =Codex Regius, in the Royal Library at Paris. Belongs to the eighth century. Contains the four Gospels, with some omissions. Those in Mk. are 10/630 152-2, Though of this late date, it is so evidently a copy of an early manuscript that it acquires great value in the criticism of the text. A = Codex Sangallensis of the four Gospels, in the great monastery of St. Gall, Switzerland, where it probably originated. It is evidently, like L, a copy of an old manuscript, and of great critical value. Other uncials of less importance are: = Codex Basiliensis, of the eighth century. “ Borelli, of the ninth century. = “ Wolfit A, of the tenth century. ma fae «“ 8B, of the ninth century. = “ Cyprius, of the ninth century. = * Campianus, of the ninth century. = “ Purpureus, of the sixth century. Guelpherbytanus A, of the sixth century. = “ Vaticanus 354, of the tenth century. = fragment of Lectionary, containing in Mk. only 11-3 123-9, = Codex Nanianus I. = “ Mosquensis, of the eleventh century. = “ Monacensis, of the tenth century. = “ Tischendorfianus, of the ninth century. = “ Petropolitianus, of the ninth century. II Fax dca eMNAZeAToOo i Curstves 1 = Codex Basiliensis, of the tenth century. 13= “ Regius 50, of the twelfth century. 2 * “ 379, of the eleventh century. etd « 14, of the eleventh century, called “The Queen of the Cursives.”’ 69 = Codex Letcestrensis, of the fourteenth century. 10o2= “ Sibliothecae Mediceae. 209 An unnamed, valuable manuscript. 346 = Codex Ambrosianus 23, of the twelfth century. : Versions Latin : Vetus, or Itala. This version itself belongs to the very beginning of the second century, though there are no copies earlier than the fourth century. Vulgate, the Latin version of Jerome, made in the latter part of the fourth century. THE TEXT lv The Egyptian versions are : - Memphitic, or Bohairic, in the dialect of Lower Egypt, and belonging to the second century. . Thebaic, or Sahidic, in the dialect of Upper Egypt; belonging also to the second century. Extant only in fragments. The Syriac versions are: . Leshito, of the second century. . Harclean, which contains itself a statement of its date= 508. Value largely due to Thomas of Harkel, from whom it derives its name, and who collated it with the aid of three Greek mss. These marginal additions give this value. . Jerusalem Syriac, a lectionary of the sixth century. ABBREVIATIONS a aed The Fathers are quoted in the manner usual in critical commentaries (Amb., Aug., Chrys., Jer., Orig., etc.). Egyptt. . Memph. . Theb. Aeth. att: Lat. Vet. Vulg. . Syir. . Pesh. Harcl. Hier. va. BR a RV. marg. . Tisch. Ereg: . WH... Beng. De W. Mey. . ° Bib. Die. Thay.-Grm. Lex. . Win. . e lvii Egyptian Versions, Memphitic. Thebaic. Ethiopic Version. Latin Versions. Vetus Latina. Vulgate. Syriac Versions. Peshito. Harclean. Jerusalem Lectionary. Authorised Version. Revised Version. Revised Version marg, Tischendorf. Tregelles. Westcott and Hort. Bengel. De Wette. Meyer. Smith’s Dictionary of the Bible (Ist or 2d edition). Thayer’s Grimm. Winer’s Grammar of N. T. Greek. hhh GOsPEi OF MARK BEGINNING OF THE GLAD TIDINGS 11-8. Beginning of the glad tidings concerning Jesus in the authoritative proclamation of John the Baptist. Prophe- ctes of this preliminary work tn the Old Testament, the appearance of John, his proclamation of repentance, his bap- tism, and his announcement of the coming One mightier than he. It is evident that the key to this paragraph is found in this IU cron of the One mightier than John. Who and what the man was who made it, the general character of his mission to the nation, into the course of which it was introduced, and the way in which it fulfilled prophecy in regard to the preparation for the Messianic advent, we are told of course, but the theme itself is the announcement. That is the beginning of the good news , about Jesus which is the title of the section. There are two renderings of our EV. which obscure this intention of the para- _graph, viz., the translation gosfe/ for etayyediov, v.', and preach \for xnpvoow, v.47. The technical meaning which both these words ‘have acquired in our language renders them frequently unfit to translate the Greek words, but especially in this passage, the character of which is such as to make a close adherence to the specific meaning of the original words quite necessary. The state- ment is, that with the proclamation, xypvocev, of the coming One by John began the glad tidings, edayyédvov, concerning Jesus. Furthermore, it is stated that this beginning is in accordance with prophecy, which foretold the sending of a messenger, dyyedos, to prepare the way of the Lord. The prophecy is further identified | with the event by the description of the messenger in the second part of the prophecy as @ voice crying in the wilderness, corre- sponding to the statement about John that he made his appearance ' B | — | 2 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [I. 1-8 in the wilderness. The general work of John is shown to consist in his baptism of the crowds (including mostly the people of -Judaea) who came to him, his proclamation being that of a bap- _tism of repentance for remission of sins. That is, he performed a rite of outward purification, and explained that it meant an inward purification looking to the forgiveness of sins. This message -would be understood by the people to foreshadow the coming of the expected deliverer, since repentance was the acknowledged condition of national deliverance, and this public call to it would naturally therefore create expectation of his advent. As for John’s appearance, his wilderness life and food and his rough dress recall Elijah, as they are evidently intended to do, the item about the Zather girdle reproducing the language of the LXX in regard to Elijah’s dress (2 K. 1°). It is obviously the picture of a man who has revolted from the evil world and prefers hardness to the unclean associations of its comforts. It is a significant commen- tary on the manners of the place and time that they should lead to such revolt not in Greece or Rome, but in Judaea. It is such a man as this, who in the midst of his own great work of impress- ing on the nation his sense of its sin, and issuing to it the old prophetic cry, Wash you, make you clean, interjects the beginning of the evangel, the first news that the Messiah is actually at hand. _ This announcement takes the form of a comparison between him- self and the personage announced by him. There comes one stronger than he, with whom he is not to be compared. So far, the announcement is in line with Jewish expectation, but there is an absence of the material, and an emphasis of the spiritual ele- ment in what follows, which does not spring from Jewish Messian- ism, and would not have led to John’s later doubt. It is a comparison between his baptism and that of Jesus, making the latter to be the spiritual reality, of which John’s was merely the ritual expression. It was to be a baptism in the Holy Spirit, the element of spiritual purification, while John’s baptism was in the material element of water, which could only represent that purification in a figure. 1. This verse is a title or heading of the paragraph in regard to the work of John the Baptist.1 That work, but especially the 1 Hence the absence of the article before 'Apxn, Win. 19. I, a: x. 1] BEGINNING OF THE GLAD TIDINGS 3 announcement of the coming of the one mightier than he, is the beginning of the evayyéAuov, the good news about Jesus Christ. evayyeAiov. — This word, which in the later Greek means glad tidings, is in the N.T. restricted to the good news about Jesus, or of the kingdom which he came to establish, or of the salvation accomplished by him. It is under this last head, that it comes to have the technical sense of the scheme of truth relating to him and to his saving work, which has come to be so associated with the word gospe/ as to render that a misleading translation in a passage like this. This word is also associated with the written accounts of our Lord’s life, the Gospels, which is also confusing here.” ‘Inood Xpicrod.— This gen. may be either subj. or obj., the good news brought by him, or that “concerning him. “Here it is evidently the latter, as John is the bearer of the ectayyéAuov. "Incots is the personal name of our Lord (Mt. 17). It is a descriptive name, as the passage in Mt. indicates, meaning Saviour. It is used once in the N.T. as the Greek form of Joshua (Heb. 4°).2. Xpucrod — the official title of Jesus, denoting him as the Messiah, the Anointed. ‘The word itself is of frequent occurrence in the O.T., where it is applied to kings as anointed of God. But as a title of the coming King, the hope of the Jewish nation, it does not occur. It is first used of him in the Book of Enoch 48” 52*, about the close of the second century B.c.,? and afterwards frequently in the uncanonical literature. It appears from this literature, that the general national expectation of deliverance and greatness characteristic of the O.T. period had at this time taken the definite shape of an expected deliverer in the Davidic line. And the N.T. furnishes abundant evidence that this expectation was common at the coming of Jesus, and during his life. The title Xpuoréds became a personal name later, and the absence of the art. would indicate that this is the use here. 4 viod tov @cov— Son of God. RV. puts this into the text, and ‘es it in the margin, which seems a good statement of the critical evidence. ‘This term, Son of God, like the title Messiah, a applied to the Messianic King in the uncanonical Jewish litera- ture. But its use is purely theocratic and official, corresponding 1In Homer, it means a reward given to the bearer of good news; in Attic Greek, a thank-offering for the same. The LXX form of the word seems to be a ae Thay.-Grm. Lex. "Inoovs is the Greek form of the Heb. yw, yw, or according to a still later form, ny. The first two mean Whose “e/p is Fehovah, The last means simply help, or deliverer, and it is probably this later form to which this use is to be referred. ; 2 On this book, see Schiirer, V. Zg. Div. II., Vol. III. § 32, V. 2. On the Messi- anic hope of the people in the time immediately preceding the life of Jesus, see Schiirer II. II. § 29; and on the name Messiah, see II. II. 29,3. The Heb. form is mw, Chald, snywn, Messiah. A THE GOSPEL OF MARK [Me aye to the O.T. use to denote any one whose office specially represents God among men, such as kings and judges (see J. 10%). Its use to denote the relation to God springing from the miraculous con- ception is confined to Lk. 1”, and its application to Jesus’ meta- physical relation to God is not found in the Synoptics. The term is applied by Jesus to himself in his discourse without any expla- nation, whereas it would require explanation if it was intended to convey any other meaning than the historical sense with which the people were familiar. It is applied to him in the theophany at the baptism, where the aor. evddxnoa, meaning / came to take pleasure in thee, limits the title and statement to his historical manifestation, his earthly life. It is used by Peter in his confes- sion, where its association with the title Christ, or Messiah, — thou art the Christ, the Son of the hving God,—also indicates the theocratic sense. In the question of the High Priest at the trial of Jesus, whether he is the Christ, the Son of God, the same collo- cation involves the same conclusion. In fact, there is nowhere in the Synoptics any indication that the title is used so as to involve any departure from the current theocratic sense ; and indications, such as the above, are not wanting, that the title does retain its common meaning at the time. When we get outside of these historical books, we come upon the metaphysical sonship as pos- isibly the prevalent meaning of the term. Son of God means here, then, that the Messianic kingdom is a theocracy, in which God is the real ruler, and the Messianic king represents God. Only, with ‘the new meaning that the life and teaching of Jesus had put into all these current phrases, it would signify to a Christian writer that ‘this representation was real, and not merely official, that in Christ ithe ideal of the theocratic king had been realized, a prince who ‘really represented the mind and spirit of God, and established the Divine law among men after the Divine method. viod rod Oeod T. R. AEFGHKM etc. and Versions generally. vio Qceov RV. Treg. WH., marg. s* BDL 102. Omit Tisch. WH. RV. marg. x* 28, 255. Omission confirmed also by passages in Iren. Epiph. Orig. Victorin. 2. év rots tpopytats. — There is no doubt that this is a correction of the original, to meet the difficulty of ascribing the double quo- tation from Malachi and Isaiah to Isaiah alone. The reading of all the critical texts is év rd “Hoata ro rpodyty. év r@ ‘Hoata r@ rpopdyjry Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDL A 33 Latt. Memph. Pesh. Hier. Harcl. marg. This quotation is intended to prove from prophecy that the good news about Christ had its appointed beginning in the procla- jmation of a forerunner who was thus to prepare the way for him. ‘The first part is from Mal,.3,, the second from Is. 40% In the } I. 2, 3] BEGINNING OF THE GLAD TIDINGS 5 original, the passage from Mal. reads, Behold, J send my messenger who shall prepare the way before me. Jehovah is the speaker, _and he is not addressing some one else, whose way is to be pre- pared by God’s messenger; but he declares that he is coming . himself to his temple to purge it of the profanations of the priests, ‘and that he sends his messenger to prepare the way for him. Moreover, the messenger is the prophet himself, my messenger being in the Heb. "s859, Malachi, the traditional name of the prophet. The prophecy has thus a distinct historical sense. The evil of Malachi’s time, as is evident from the entire prophecy, was this abuse of their office by the priests, and the prophet announces that God is coming to do away with this abuse, and the prophecy is to announce this coming, and make ready for it. Here, it is adapted to Messianic use by the change of my and me to thy and thee, and is applied to the mission of the forerunner to prepare the for the Messiah. ‘This Messianic use of a passage having _ | another primary sense is the rule, and not the exception, in Messi- MPEG RL OS janic prophecy. ‘The principle underlying it is, that the Messianic | _ kingdom founded by Jesus is the real culmination of Jewish his- tory, and that its prophecies of near events somehow all point forward also to him. And especially, in this case, the underlying fact is that the Jewish nation is a theocracy, and that the crises in its history are due to a Divine appearance and intervention; a coming of God, moreover, for which way is made by his messen- gers the prophets. This common feature being shared by the culminating intervention, gives the Messianic turn to the original prophecy. éumpoobév cov is omitted by Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. It is supported by few good authorities, and is an evident emendation. The quotation is a free translation from the Heb. The LXX reads *Id00 éfarooré\dXw Tov dyyeddv pov, kal ériBd\éVerat 66dv mpd mpogwrov pov. The form in which it is quoted by Mk. is also that of the other places in which it is cited in the N.T. (Mt. 111° Lk. 727), pointing to some common Greek source, not the LXX, with which the evangelists had become familiar. See Toy, Quofa- tions in N.T., p. 31. 3. dwvyn Bowvros év TH épnuw— The voice of one crying in the wilderness. ‘This passage is quoted directly from the LXX of Is. 40°." Here, as in the quotation from Mal., the coming to be |prepared for is that of God to his people. The purpose of his |coming is to deliver his people from.their captivity in Babylon by ithe hand of Cyrus.? It is the note of deliverance which is com- mon to this with the Messianic advent and intervention, and the preparation for this by the prophetic message is shared by this with the passage from Mal. 1 avrod is substituted for rod @:0d judy after rpiBous. 2 See Is. 41% 4314 4426-454 461. 2 471-15 48%, 6 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [I. 3, 4 év 77 éphuw in the Heb. belongs with érowudoate. See Is. 40%, RV. But it is evident that Mk. intends to join it with Bo@vTos, as this makes the prophecy anticipate the appearance of John in the wilderness. Kupiov — the Lord, stands for Jehovah, or Yahweh, in the origi- nal, this being the LXX. rendering of that name of God. But it is probable that Mk. understands it to refer to Jesus, this being one of his familiar titles. In this way, the passage becomes more directly adapted to his purpose, making the advent, and the mis- sion of the forerunner both figure in prophecy. 4. In this verse, the art. should be inserted before Bamrifwv, without any doubt. Whether xai should be dropped before Kypvoowv, on the other hand, admits of much doubt. [If it is dropped, the passage reads, John the Bapiizer came preaching. If it is retained, it reads, John came, who baptized and preached, RV. On the whole, the reading without xai is preferable. 6 Barrlfwy Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDL A 33, Memph. kai xnptcowv Treg. (kat) Tisch. RV. s ADLP A, Verss. generally. Omit cai WH. Treg. marg. B. 33, 73, 102. In order to get at the right connection of this verse, we must read it as if the preceding quotations were omitted — Beginning of the good news of Jesus Christ... John came, etc. éyévero— there came, or appeared. ‘The verb is used to denote the appear- ance of a person on the stage of history. The wilderness in which he made his appearance is the wilderness of Judaea, on the south- ern banks of the Jordan, just before it empties into the Dead Sea. Knpvoowv — proclaiming. ‘The word means to exercise the office of a herald, to proclaim officially, and with authority. John is not represented as preaching, taking baptism for his text, but as mak- ing public proclamation, calling men to his baptism." Bartioua petavotas —a baptism of repentance. This rite of immersion in water signified the complete inward purification of the subject. It took up into a symbolical rite the figurative wash- ings of such passages ag Is. 1 4* Jer. 4 Ez. 36” Zech. 13° Psogas Outwardly, it had its counterpart in the Levitical washings of the law (Ex. 29* Lev. 14° 9 is” 8. 10. 13. 16. 21. 22. 27 167 28 I qe etc;): But its use by John was quite unique.” peravoias — of repentance. The gen. denotes the significance of the rite, the inward act of which it is the outward sign and pledge. ‘The word denotes primarily a change of mind, such as comes from an afterthought. A person 1 This word is one of several, such as carayyéAdw, evayyediecbar, having different shades of meaning, but all translated preach in the EV., whenever sacred matters are spoken of. 2 The question of the outward form of this rite has been discussed so thoroughly that it is unnecessary to go over it again in this place. In this passage, the indica- tions corresponding to the common usage of the word itself are the river, the immersion into the river, the going up out of the water, but especially, the entire- ness and completeness of etavoia, Which is expressed by the rite. i. 4-6] BEGINNING OF THE GLAD TIDINGS 7 does something from failure to consider certain things necessary to wise action, and when afterwards these neglected things come to him, there comes the corresponding change of attitude and pur- pose. It denotes in the N.T. a change, arising from such recon- sideration, from a life of sin to rectitude and holiness. Such a call to repentance was not unexpected by the Jews, who believed that it was the sin of the nation which delayed the coming of the Mes- sianic King. The call to repentance therefore, by one wearing the prophetic appearance and authority, would signify to the nation that the deliverer was at hand, and that they must prepare for his coming. eis adeow duaptiav — for remission of sins. This states the purpose of the baptism of repentance. It is the repentance evidently which is the real cause of the remission, repentance being the normal and constant Scriptural condition of forgive- ness.' Baptism is related to the repentance as the outward act in which this inward change finds formal expression. Baptism is an act of profession, and is related to repentance as the declara- tion of forgiveness is to forgiveness itself. It is contended some- times (so Meyer and Weiss) that this is an anticipation of the significance of Christian baptism, in which the forgiveness of sins was first realized. But surely, if this was a baptism of repentance, it would result in forgiveness, since repentance and forgiveness are necessarily connected. 5. wavres Should be removed from its position after éBarriLovro, so as to follow ‘IepoooAvpira, and the verse reads,... and all the inhabitants of Jerusalem, and were baptized.... ‘Tepocohvulrac ravres kal €Bamrrl{ovro Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDL A 28, 33, 102, Latt. Memph. etc. mwaca...mavtes—all. These words are to be taken rhetori- cally. We know that John’s severity must have turned many away (Mt. 37 Lk. 37). And the leaders of the people did not believe in him (Mk. 117). But the Aads, the people, all recog- nized John as a prophet (Mk. 11”). This general outpouring was to be expected from the nature of John’s proclamation, since a prophetic call to national repentance would be hailed as a call to national deliverance. éefopodkoyovpevor — confessing. This con- fession of sins gave reality to the baptism, making it a baptism of repentance. 6. tpixas KaynAov—camel’s hair. Since it says camel’s hatr, and not skz or fur, we are to understand probably a coarse cloth 1On the relation of repentance to forgiveness, see Is, 116-18 Ez, 3314-20 Hos. 14 Amos 510-15 Jon. 34-10. In fact, the whole burden of prophecy is, that the nation is afflicted because of its sins, but that it needs cnly to repent. 2 In its compound form, this is a Biblical word. The later language, Win. says, loves compound verbs which bring out something implied in the principal verb, 16. 4. B. 6. The preposition here denotes that what is hidden comes ow# in confes- sion. 8 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [I. 6, 7 made of the hair. There are examples moreover of the cloth, but not of the skin, being used in this way. dvyv Sepparivny — a leather girdle. This is selected to describe Elijah’s general appearance in 2 K. 1% And it is a distinguishing mark of coarse dress, the girdle gathering in the loose robe about the waist being generally a place for luxury and display in dress. There is some reason to suppose, too, that the description, Zazry man, may refer to Elijah’s dress, which would be another corre- spondence. So RV. mazg. kai €cOwv axpidas Kai pede ayptov — and was eating locusts and wild honey} écOwv Tisch. Treg. WH. & BL* A 33. This food was wilderness food, and corresponds to the coarse dress. ‘Together, they represent the spirit of the man, his con- tempt of ease and luxury, his revolt against a sinful generation, everything which caused him to dwell apart from men, and to contemn their manners. Locusts were an article of food espe- cially allowed by the Levitical Law, and they are still eaten, pre- pared in various ways, by Eastern peoples. By wld honey may be meant that made by wild bees, and deposited in hollow trees, and other places in the woods ; but as a matter of fact, the term péAt dyptov seems to be applied generally to the sweet sap of certain trees. 7. éxnpvoce —he was proclaiming. ‘The translation preached is especially out of place here, since what follows is not the general subject of the Baptist’s preaching, but only that particular an- nouncement of the coming of the Messiah which has led the writer to say that the proclamation by John in the wilderness was the beginning of the good news about Jesus Christ. He was mak- ing proclamation by virtue of his office as kypvé, the herald of the Messianic King. ‘The whole work of the Baptist in this Gospel is treated as this dpxy edayyeAlov, a peculiarity which is obscured in our version. éxjpvoce continues the impfs. Av évdeduuévos and €cOwv, denoting John’s habit of life and speech in the wilderness. 6 icxupdrepds pov? — he that ts mightier than I (RV.). This description of the coming one is common to all the Synoptics, but in Mt. and Lk. it is introduced between the statement of John’s baptism and that of Jesus’ baptism in such a way as to show more distinctly than in Mk.’s account that in these different baptisms is contained the point of the ioyvpdrepos. Jesus is might- ier than John by reason of his baptizing in the Holy Spirit. Mk.’s order shows this also, but not so distinctly. oricw pov — after 1 ¢6(é)wy is in the same construction as évdeduuévos, was clothed ...and was eating. éwv is a poetic form of the participle. 2 See Meyer’s Note. 8 The art. indicates the definite person had in mind. I. 7, 8| BEGINNING OF THE GLAD TIDINGS 9 me.' ov ovK eipi txavos—of whom I am not fil. ... This is a rhetorical statement of John’s depreciation of himself by the side of the coming one. He was not fit to tie his shoes. ixavés denotes any kind of sufficiency or fitness. /7¢ is a good transla- tion in this case. iuavtTa T. Urodnuatwv — the thong of the sandals. The sandals protected the soles only, and were bound to the feet by a thong. xvas. — This apparently superfluous addition about s/ooping serves to heighten the impression of the menial character of the act. 8. éyw éBarrica vdar.— [ baptized you with water. Omit wév after éya Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BL 33, 69, 102, 124, Lat. Vet. mss. Vulg. Memph. Pesh. etc. Omit év before vdare Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. & BH A 16, 33, 56, 58, 258, Vulg. etc. Without the prep. the element vdatc becomes the instrument with which the act is performed. See Win. 31. 7. d. év Ivevpare “Ayiw —in Holy Spirit. We are not to look for Christian terms, nor Christian uses of terms, in John’s teaching. The line that divides them in this matter of the Holy Spirit is fine, but distinguishable. In the Jewish conception, personality is ascribed to the Holy Spirit only figuratively. In the Christian use, on the other hand, the impersonal sense is the figurative one, ¢.g. where it speaks of a pouring out of the Holy Spirit (Tit. 3° Acts 2” 18), But the Spirit of God, or of Yahweh, or the Spirit of holiness, figures more or less largely in the O.T. as the animating power in the universe, as the inspiration of the prophet, the sol- dier, the king, and even the workman. And the possession of this Spirit by all men is prophesied as one of the marks oy Israel’s golden age. See Job 26% 334 Ps. 104” Is. 42) 61' Mi. 3° Jud. 3” 6% Is. 117 Joel 2% Is. 59” Ex. 31°. John’s reference to the Holy Spirit, the wap mn, would not therefore be strange to his Jewish hearers. The absence of the art. indicates that the Spirit is | regarded here as an element, a pervading presence, like the air, | in the ocean of which we are submerged. The epithet Zo/y would ' not in itself suggest moral quality, as it denoted what is invested with awe or reverence, and only secondarily and rarely, moral purity. But in the connection, since the Spirit is regarded here as the purifying element, it is evidently holiness in the moral sense that is predicated of it. The contrast between the work of | the Baptist, and that of the Messiah, amounts to this, that the mightier one who is to follow John will do the real work of which the Baptist is able to perform only the sign. Water cleanses only the body, and represents figuratively the inward cleansing of the man. But the Holy Spirit is the element in which man is cleansed 1 On the use of the adverb as a preposition, see Thay.-Grm. Lex.; Win. 54. 6. IO THE GOSPEL OF MARK [I. 8-11 inwardly and really, and it is this real baptism which the coming one was to perform. So far as it is given us in the Gospels, John’s -annunciation of the Messiah includes only the spiritual side of his anticipated work, and thus corresponds with the historical fact. But John’s later doubt could have arisen probably only from the failure of Jesus to carry out the kingly part of the Jewish Messianic expectation. See Mt. 117". And it would be quite improbable that John would be so far separated from his time as to expect a purely spiritual Messiah. In this paragraph, the signs of Mk.’s use of the Logia are not wanting. In the first place, O.T. citations are not common in Mk., but are quite characteristic of the Logia. And especially, the first part of the double quotation is, in Mk. 12-2 Lk. 727, taken unquestionably from that source. The somewhat clumsy junction of the two passages is due apparently to bringing together what was separated in the original source. And Mt. 3} Lk. 317 show signs of being connected with what precedes in the original source. Mk. omits this, but gives what precedes with the identity of language that shows a common source for all three. For the verbal resemblance, implying the interdependence of the Synoptics, cf. Mk. 1° Mt. 33 Lk. 34, especially the change of rod Oceod judy, LXX, to avrod in them all (Mk. 1* Lk. 3° Mk. 15-6 Mt. 345-6 Mk, 17-8 Mt. 344 Lk. 336). THE BAPTISM OF JESUS 9-11. Jesus 1s baptized by John. The Holy Spirit descends upon him, and the voice from heaven attests his Divine MISSION. Among the rest, Jesus comes to John’s baptism. As he comes up out of the water, the Spirit descends on him in the form of a dove, preparing him for the work into which baptism has inau- gurated him and signifying the gentleness of his reign; and a voice out of heaven proclaims him to be the Messianic Son of God who has won the special Divine favor. With this paragraph begins the story of Jesus’ life, but as it treats of events preceding his public ministry, the story of the baptism and of the temptation conforms to Mk.’s plan outside of that ministry, and is given briefly. #.g. Mk. does not consider it necessary to explain the evident difficulty attending the baptism of Jesus, as Mt. does, but gives only the fact. The visible form taken by the Spirit in its descent upon Jesus is evidently intended to be, like the voice, a theophany, attesting his mission. But the Spirit itself is intended to prepare him for his work, and so descends upon him now at the beginning of that work; cf. v.% 7/9; 10] THE BAPTISM OF JESUS II 9. Kat éyevero MADev '— ev Exeivats Tals puepats —in those days. This is a general designation of time, and denotes here the period of John’s ministry. Naaper ris TadtAaias — Wazareth of Galilee. The explanatory rs TadtAaias is for the information of the unin- formed, and is a sign therefore, that this Gospel was written for Gentile readers. ‘This is the only place in Mk. where Nazareth is mentioned, though Jesus is called a Nazarene in several places (1% 10“ 16° 14%). It was the home of Jesus during his private life. According to Lk, 126 24 99.51 416, this was owing to the previous residence of his parents in Nazareth. Mt., however, tells us that they took up their abode there after their return from Egypt, because they were turned aside from Bethlehem by the succession of Archelaus to his father’s throne, which made Judzea no longer a safe place for them (27). Nazareth was in the interior about midway between the Lake of Galilee and the Mediterranean. It is at present a town of about 5000 inhabitants, going by the name of En Nazira.’ eis tov lopdavynyv —into the Jordan. The prep. here coincides with the proper meaning of the verb, indicating that the form of the rite was immersion into the stream. ‘The prep. é« in the next verse, — going up out of the water, — implies the same. 10. Kai evOis — And immediately? avaBaivwv éx — going up out of. éx (instead of dd) Tisch. Treg. WH.RV.& BDL 13, 28, 33, 69, 124. oxilopévovs Tors ovpavois — the heavens opening, not opened. The pres. part. denotes action in its progress, not completed action.* ws TepioTepav— as a dove. Lk. 3” says that this resemblance was in bodily shape. And the language itself implies that. The dove was the emblem of guilelessness (Mt. 10). It was not a bird of prey. The appearance accords with the gentleness of Christ’s reign. The descent of the Spirit was moreover a real event, while the appearance was only a vision. It was not merely a sign that here was a person endued with the Spirit, but a special influence beginning at the time, and preparing him for his new work. It was like the descent of the Spirit at Pentecost, prepar- ing the disciples for their new work. Neither event implied in any way that the Spirit was not present in their lives before.” And 1 This circumlocution for the simple verb is a translation of the Heb. 1 197»), and is foreign to the Greek idiom. The absence of a conj. between the two verbs is also a solecism. 2 See Bib. Dic. On the form of the Greek name, see Thay.-Grm. Lex. 3 This adverb is one of the marks of the style of this Gospel. It is used by Mk. nearly twice as often as by Mt. and Lk. together. evdévs is substituted for ev@éws in the critical texts in most of these passages in Mk. See Thay.-Grm. Lex. 4 See Burton, V.7. Moods and Tenses, 125. 5 On this office of the Spirit, cf. Is. 11°. 12 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [I. 10-12 we find in all the Synoptics mention that Jesus began his ministry under the impulsions of the Spirit. See Mt. 12 Mk. 1? Lk. 4° *™. This descent of the Spirit is moreover indicative of the meaning of our Lord’s baptism. It has already been indicated that the real baptism, of which that in the water is only the sign, is a bap- tism in the Holy Spirit, and it is this which is signified by the baptism of Jesus, but without the accompanying repentance which belongs to the baptism of the rest of the people. 1l. kai povn (éyevero) — And a voice (came). Omit éyévero Tisch. (WH.) x D ff.?. Xd ef 6 vids pov 6 ayarntds — Thou art my beloved Son. This is one of the passages in the Synoptics which indicate that the Synoptical use of vids (rod @eov) applied to Jesus, conforms to current Jewish usage, omitting the metaphysical Sonship, and including only the theocratic, or figurative meaning of the word. The aor. etdoxynoa, J came to take pleasure, denotes the historical process by which God came to take pleasure in Jesus during his earthly life, not the eternal delight of the Father in the Son. The title here would denote one, therefore, who has been received into special love and favor by God, as Paul calls Timothy his son (1 Tim. 1°). It accords with Lk.’s statement, that Jesus grew in favor with God and man (Lk. 2”).' év aol evddxnoa — in thee I came to take pleasure. év gol (instead of év @) Tisch. Treg. WH. RV.x BDLP 1, 13, 22, 33, 69, Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Pesh. THE TEMPTATION 12,13. Jesus retires into the wilderness, where he remains forty days, tempted by Satan, and attended by angels. Immediately after the baptism, Jesus is impelled by the Spirit who has taken possession of him into the wilderness. He remains there forty days, surrounded by the wild beasts, attended by angels, and tempted by Satan. It is especially the story of the temptation, in the period pre- ceding the public ministry, which is abbreviated by Mk. He gives us simply the fact of the temptation, the place, the wild- erness, the time, forty days, and the descriptive touch, that he was with the wild beasts. 12. Kai cis — And immediately, viz., after the baptism. This event, with its accompaniments, is of the nature of an inaugural 1 On this use of the aor., see Win. 40, 2; Burton, V. 7, Moods and Tenses, 55. I. 12, 13] THE TEMPTATION 13 act. And it is followed immediately by his retirement into the wilderness. The time, the circumstances, and the nature of the temptations, all point to the probability that this retirement was for the purpose of meditation upon the work into which he had been inaugurated. Moreover, the IIvetua, the Spirit, connects this with the account of the baptism. He begins now immediately to act under the impulsions of the Spirit which he has just received. éxBadrAe -— thrusts him out. Mt. and Lk. both use the milder ayewv, fo lead, to describe this. tiv épnuov — the wilderness. This is the same general region in which the baptism took place. But, inasmuch as it was from the wilderness into the wilderness, and Mk. adds that he was with the wild beasts, it must mean that he penetrated still further into its solitudes. 13. Kai jv év TH épypw TecoepaKovta nuepas — And he was in the wilderness forty days. ‘This period is given by both Mk. and Lk. as that of the temptation, though Mt. and Lk. both give us the three special temptations following the forty days. Mt. makes these the only temptations. etpalduevos — tempted. Used here of an actual solicitation to evil. The proper meaning of meipdfeuv is 4o ¢ry, in the sense both of attempt and zest. It is through the latter meaning that it comes to be applied to the test of character, whether by trial, or by solicitation to evil. Xatrava — Satan.' The name is Hebrew, but the personage does not figure much in O.T. narrative or discourse (1 Chr. 21! Zech. 3~" Job 1*° 2%). In the N.T., he is represented, in accordance with current Jewish ideas, as the ruler of a kingdom of evil, having subjects and emissaries in the shape of demons, corresponding to the angels who act as God’s messengers. His special function is to tempt men to evil. pera trav Oypiwv — with the wild beasts. The desert of Judza is in parts wild and un- tamed, and abounds in beasts of the same description, such as the leopard, the bear, the wild boar, and the jackal. This descrip- tive touch, in which, just as with a word, the wildness and solitari- ness of the scene are brought before us, and equally, the omission of details of the temptation, are characteristics of Mk. The omis- sion accords with the plan of his Gospel, but, also, with a certain objective quality belonging to it. See Introduction. dunxovowv — were ministering.’ This ministry, like the temptations, is rep- resented in Mt. as taking place after the forty days. In our account, it is evidently an offset to the presence of the wild beasts. The visible things figuring in the scene were these beasts, but there were invisible presences as well, and these were minister- ing to him. Mk. does not tell us what the ministrations were. (Nor Mt.) 1 A Heb. word, meaning the Adversary. 2 The impf. describes the act as taking place during his stay in the wilderness. 14 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [I. 14-20 The historicity of the account of the temptation is attacked with some plausibility. There are certain things about it on which a just historical criticism throws some doubt. ‘There is a concreteness about the appear- ance of Satan, and of the angels, an air of visibility even, an impression of actual transportation through the air, and the introduction of a typical number (forty), which can, however, easily be eliminated without touch- ing the essential history. The account which has been preserved is evi- dently the pictorial and concrete story of what really took place within the soul of Jesus. But the temptations themselves, just because they represent the actual temptations of his later life, are a portrait, and not an imagina- tive picture. Holtzmann, in his Note on the passage, gives an admirable statement of the way in which the story corresponds to the real temptations of Jesus’ life. But his argument that some one made up this story from those falls to the ground. It implies that some one understood that life better than any contemporary did understand it. BEGINNING OF JESUS’ MINISTRY 14-20. After John’s imprisonment, Jesus goes to Galilee, where he begins his ministry with the proclamation of the kingdom of God. After the imprisonment of John, Jesus departs into Galilee, where he begins his ministry with the proclamation of the good news of the kingdom of God, announcing the completion of the time for it. He finds Peter, Andrew, James, and John fishing in the lake of Galilee, and calls them to follow him and become fishers of men. The order of events in the Synoptics is as follows: MATTHEW. MARK. LUKE. Delivering up of John (mere mention). Departure into Galilee. Change of residence from Nazareth to Ca- pernaum. Beginning of Jesus’ teaching. Call of first disciples. Delivering up of John (mere mention). Departure into Galilee. Beginning of Jesus’ teaching. Call of first disciples. Delivering up of John (account), 329 2, Departure into Galilee. Beginning of teaching. Rejection at Nazareth. Coming to Capernaum. First miracles. General teaching in syn- agogues in Galilee. Call of first disciples. The general order of events is the same. ‘The evident intention of all is to connect the beginning of Jesus’ ministry with the close 1 Moses was in the mount forty days and forty nights (Ex. 2418, 3428), Elijah was in the wilderness forty days and forty nights (1 K. 198), and the Christophanies after the resurrection covered a period of forty days (Acts 13). I. 14, 15] THE FIRST DISCIPLES 15 of John’s work, though this is more evident in Mt. and Mk. than in Lk. They also mark at the beginning that it is a Galilean ministry. Mt. and Mk. tell us that it was the good news of the kingdom of God which was proclaimed by Jesus. Lk. also brings this in incidentally. He also introduces the rejection at Nazareth, evidently to account for the removal to Capernaum, and inserts the first miracles and a tour of preaching in Galilee before the call of the first disciples. 14. Mera d€ ré rapadoPnvat tov Iwavyvnyv — And after the deliv- ering up of John. Mt. and Mk. assume this as a well known fact. Lk. tells the story of it (3'*”). The others tell it later (Mk. 6”). eis THV VadtAaiav — into Galilee. ‘The connection of events is lost here in the brevity of the narrative. We are not told whether Jesus came into Galilee because of the imprisonment of John, and being there, began his ministry ; or whether he began his ministry because John’s ministry was ended, and chose Galilee as the scene for it. But, masmuch as Jesus is represented by the Synoptics as continuing his work in Galilee until the end, it is evidently the latter. It is the demands of his work that take him to Galilee, and John’s imprisonment is the occasion of his begin- ning his work, and only indirectly of his coming to Galilee. More- over, they do not tell us why Galilee became the scene of his ministry. But the reason is evident. It was not the headquar- ters of Judaism; and events showed that Jesus’ work would have been impossible in the stronghold of that unsympathetic faith. The fourth gospel tells of a preliminary work of eight months in Judza, but the Synoptics are not only silent about it, but exclude it by their evident intention to represent this as the beginning of Jesus’ work. Galilee, Heb. 5» 3, circle, was originally the name of only a small circuit in one of the tribes inhabiting the northern section of Palestine. But in the time of our Lord, it had come to be applied to the Roman province including the whole territory of the four northern tribes. It was inhabited by a oe population of Jews and Gentiles. See Jos. 207 21°21 K. g}! 2K.15”. 0 evayyéAtov Tod Ocod— glad tidings of God. Omit 77s Boowelas before tod Geod Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. BL. 1, 28, 33, 69, 209, mss. of Lat. Vet. Memph. | The glad tidings of God is here the glad tidings from God, who a aa i is the author and sender of the message (subj. gen.). The good news itself, as the next verse shows, is that of the kingdom. 15. The words, kai rAEywv, and saying, at the beginning of this verse, are to be omitted. 16 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [L 15 Omit cal Aéywv Tisch. WH. (kai A\éywv) & one ms. of Lat. Vet., Ore. The insertion of kal \éywy is caused probably by the interpolation of ris Bac.delas in the preceding verse. The two go together. /rerdynpwtat 6 kaipds — the time has been filled up, or completed. Fulfilled, EV. is etymologically correct, but misleading, on account of its technical use to denote the accomplishment of expectation, promise, or prophecy. What is denoted here is the filling up of the time appointed for the coming of the Kingdom. This idea of an appointment of times, as well as of events, is thoroughly Jewish, referring all things to God. But to Jesus,.who read the signs of the times (Mt. 16°), the language signified not only a theology, but a philosophy of events. The time revealed itself to him as ripe for the event. carne iyyxev 7 BactiAcia tod Ocot — The kingdom of God has come near. ‘This message assumes evidently the existence of the idea of a kingdom of God among the Jews as a familiar thought. The announcement is, that this expected kingdom is at hand. Jesus does not announce a new fact, nor does he enter here upon any exposition of the nature of the kingdom, such as belonged to his later teaching, but simply announces the expected kingdom. He does not enter into the question of the difference between his spiritual kingdom, and the earthly kingdom of Jewish expectation. It is enough for his present purpose to announce it as a kingdom of God, and so to prepare the way for his call to repentance. This announcement has to be located first, in the life and teaching of Jesus; secondly, in its relation to John’s message; and thirdly, in current Jewish thought. In Jesus’ own thought it is central; the kingdom of God is the subject of his teaching, and his object is to revolutionize the current idea; but that necessary change comes later. And moreover, in its con- nection with his later activity, it constitutes the announcement that the object of that was the establishment of the kingdom of God, and not merely the instruction of the people as to its nature. He was in his earthly work prophet, but also king. In its relation to John’s message, this announcement of Jesus was the continuation and development of that, repeating his call to repentance, but substituting for his announcement of the coming One, that of the coming Kingdom. This is in accordance with Jesus’ impersonal manner of treating his work. In its relation to current Jewish thought, this announcement fulfilled national expectations. This is evident from the reception given to Jesus by the nation, and from the uncanonical Jewish literature. This literature shows that the idea of Jewish deliverance and greatness, started in the prophetic books of the O.T., had not been allowed to lapse, but had gradually taken shape in the idea of a universal kingdom ruled by God himself, with the Messiah as his earthly vice-gerent, having Palestine as its centre and Jerusalem as its capital, and including in itself the righteous dead, who had been raised to I. 15, 16| THE FIRST DISCIPLES 17 share its glories. And the attitude of the people during the life of Jesus shows that this had become at this time a subject of fervid popular hope and expectation. fieravocire — repent. This is a continuation of John’s message. Katfmiorevere év Tw evayyeAiw— and believe in the good news, is, howéver, a distinct addition to that message. The evdayyédtor, good news, is that the expected kingdom is at hand. Our word gospel, with its acquired meaning, is again singularly out of place here, as it inevitably obscures this obvious reference to the evayyé- tov Tod @eov just mentioned. mucrevere, defeve, is another word that has to be evacuated of its theological sense. It is purely and simply belief of the message brought by Jesus, that the kingdom of God is at hand. If a crisis is coming, and men are to be pre- pared for it, the first requisite is, that they believe in its coming. 16. Kai rapaywv rapa— And going along by, Kai rapdywr, instead of repiraray 6e, is the reading of Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDL 13, 33, 69, 124, 346, Latt. Memph. Harcl. marg. etc. tiv Odraccav THs Todwraias—sea of Galilee. This lake was the scene of Jesus’ ministry. On its NW. shore were the towns of Capernaum, Magdala, Chorazin, and Bethsaida, referred to by Jesus himself as the district in which his mighty works were done. And its eastern shore, being uninhabited, was the place to which he used to retire to escape the multitudes. It was a lake 12 miles long, and 6 miles wide at the place of greatest width. The Jordan river enters it about 20 miles from its source. The use of @aX\acoa in its name is uncommon in Greek. In Lk., it is called commonly 4 Aluvn the dake; once, Lk. 5}, the /ake of Gennesareth, from the district on its W. shore. J. 21}, calls it the sea of Ytbertas, from the principal city on its shore. The Heb. name is 33 0» or M733 sea of Chinnereth, or Chinneroth. See Nu. 341! Jos. 1327 123, Sipwva Kat “Avdpéay tov adeAXhov Tod Zipwvos, dudifsdddAovras év tH Oaracon — Simon and Andrew the brother of Simon casting a netin the sea. (rod) Ziuwvos instead of adrod, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x» BAE?LM 1, 69, 102, Lat. Vet.(a) Memph. A number of other texts read avrod rot Ziuwvos. augdiBadrovras without auPlBrAnoTpor, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BE* FGHKLSUV. The repetition of the noun Sépwvos in a case like this is charac- teristic of Mk. dudiBdAyorpor is a thing thrown round another, 1 The regular construction after morevew is the simple dat. In the N.T. we find this, but also eis with acc. and émi with acc. or dat. This construction with éy is found only here, and in John 315, 2 The common construction after rapdywv is the simple dat. This repetition of mapa is not found elsewhere. Cc 18 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [I. 17-19 as a net about fish, clothes about a person. Hence dudiBaddAovTas, used absolutely here, and suggesting the dugiBAnotpov, the neZ, as it certainly does, means to throw the net about the fish." 17. dedre dricw pou— Come after me. Following is in the N.T. a figurative expression for discipleship, especially for that which involved personal attendance upon Jesus. This use of follow belongs to a general use by which it is applied to any per- sonal attendance, as of a soldier. dAtets avOporwv — fishers of men, cf. Jer. 16". This is the first instance of the use of para- bolic language, so common in the discourse of Jesus. The para- ble is not necessarily drawn out into a story, ora stated comparison ; it may be expressed in a word as here. In it, Jesus simply brings together things of the outer and inner world, expressing the unfamiliar in the terms of the common and familiar. The effec tiveness of it depends on the general likeness of the two worlds. 18. Kai cidis adevres ta dixtva— And immediately having left their nets. evOvs, instead of edOéws, Tisch. WH. & L 33. Omit adrdy after ra Slxrva Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL, some mss. of Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. This immediate following is due probably to a previous ac- quaintance with Jesus and his teaching. They had been attracted to him before, and so were prepared to heed this apparently abrupt call to become his personal followers. John 1”-* tells us that they became disciples a year before this, during the ministry of John the Baptist. 19. Kai rpoBas 6Atyov — And having gone forward a litdle. Omit éxeiOev thence, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. BDL 1, 28, 118, 124, 131, 209, Lat. Vet. (some mss.) Memph. Pesh. etc. "ldxwBov — James —the O.T. Jacob. He is named commonly before John, implying that he was the older brother. Ze«Bedaiov— Zebedee. Known only as the father of his two sons, and men- tioned only in connection with the present event (Mt. 4”). The mother was Salome.’ kai atrovs — who also, EV., gives the sense of these words. They express the identity of the occupation of these two with that of Peter and Andrew. They were also in their fishermen’s boat, though they were mending their nets, in- stead of casting them. xaraprilovras — mending.* 1 Thay.-Grm. Zex. explains the word as meaning ¢o throw aédout, first in one place, and then in another. 2 Acdre is a plural imperative, formed from the adv. Sedpo. The use of the adv. as a prep., dmiow pov, is a sign of the Hellenistic Greek of the N.T. (Win. 54, 6). 3 Cf. Mt. 2756 with Mk. 154°. 4 Karaprigeww Means in general to put in complete order, and may be applied either to the original fitting out, or to repairs. 1. 20-28 | THE FIRST MIRACLE 19 20. Kat eiOis éxarevev adtrovs — And immediately he called them. The immediateness here attaches to the call itself, in the former case to the response. He called them immediately, z.c., without any preliminary or preparatory act on his part. evOvds is here again substituted for ed@éws. In brief it is so substituted in most of the cases where it is used in Mk. It is unnecessary to cite the authorities in each case. drndOov éricw pou — they went away after him. This is a very good illustration of the way in which this act of following acquires its figurative meaning, and in which also the original and figurative meanings may be combined. Here the outward act was going away after Jesus, but the meaning of it was following in the sense of discipleship. The accounts of this call in the Synoptics furnish a good example of the varying relations of these gospels. Between Mt. 4!8” and Mk., there is the close verbal resemblance which can be explained only by their interde- pendence. Lk., on the other hand, presents a different version, evidently from an independent source, and it differs from the others just as we should expect independent accounts of the same event to differ. The points of difference in Lk.’s account are: (@) he found the boats empty; (4) the fishermen belonging to both were washing their nets; (c) the different occasion of the promise about catching men, which is in this case addressed to Peter alone; (d@) the introduction of the discourse to the multitude from the boat, and of the miraculous draught of fishes, which can be brought into the account of Mt. and Mk., but not in the connection given by Lk.; (¢) he makes the whole a single event in which all four men participated, while Mt. and Mk. give two calls addressed successively and independently to the men in each boat. THE FIRST MIRACLE 21-28. Healing of a demoniac im the synagogue at Capernaum. Jesus comes to Capernaum, and teaches in the Synagogue in such a way as to impress the people with the authority of his utterance, and with the marked difference in this respect between himself and the Scribes. The impression is deepened by his authority over demons displayed in healing a demoniac in the synagogue, and his fame travels over the surrounding country. This is the first miracle recorded in Mk. and Lk. And it is significant that the miracle selected, the casting out of demons, 20 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [Lam is the representative miracle in Mk.' The scene is in the Syna- gogue at Capernaum. This is another beginning, the synagogue being the chosen place for Jesus’ teaching in the early part of his ministry. The journey through Galilee, which immediately fol- lowed this event, is described as a preaching tour in the syna- gogues. The synagogue is again the scene in 3’, and in 6”. After that it drops out, and probably this means that the freedom of the synagogue was allowed him only at first. The effect of the mira- cle on the people, and Jesus’ refusal to follow up this effect, his evident desire to avoid the notoriety accompanying it, are begin- nings of a more important character. They show us at the very outset the kind of success which he had, and the estimate which he placed upon it. And we also get the impression which Jesus’ teaching made upon the people from the very start, in which it is expressly contrasted with that of the Scribes. He was without outward authority, while they were the acknowledged teachers of the nation ; and yet the impression which his teaching made and theirs failed to make, was that of authority. Holtzmann remarks that the sketchiness peculiar to Mk.’s opening verses ends here, and gives place in this account to greater amplitude of narration. 21. Kai cioropevovra cis Kadapvaovp — And they enter into Capernaum. Kag¢apvaovu Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BD 33, 69, Latt. Memph. WH. App. p. 160, say that Kazepvaovu is a distinctly Syrian corruption of the name. Kadapvaovy is substituted by Tisch. Treg. WH. in every place in which the name occurs. Mk. does not tell us that Capernaum became the residence of Jesus at this time. He does not even tell of his leaving Nazareth, though he has implied, v. 9, that that was his home at the time of the baptism. See Mt. 4% Lk. 4°. Mt. and Lk. have very much more the appearance of ordered narration, locating what is intro- duced into the narrative. Capernaum is on the NW. shore of the Lake of Galilee, though there is a dispute as to its more exact iocation. It does not appear in the O.T. The general opinion identifies Capernaum with Tell Hum, about three miles S. of the place where the river enters the lake. Some three miles further S., is Khan Minyeh, the site defended by Dr. Robinson. The only considerable ruins are at Tell Hum. 1 See v.39 67; cf. Mt. ro! Lk. gl. £2, 22 | THE FIRST MIRACLE 25 Kai «ibis rots ca8Baow'— And immediately on the Sabbath. Immediately on his coming into Capernaum, on the first Sabbath, he began his teaching in the synagogue. ¢édidackev eis Thy cvvayw- ynv* — he was teaching in the synagogue. Omit elceNOnv, having entered, before eis Thy cvvaywyhy Tisch. (Treg.) WH. marg. x CL 28, 69, 346, Memph. (2 edd.) Pesh. etc. The external evidence is not conclusive, but elcekOav seems to be an emendation of a form of expression characteristic of Mk.; cf. v.39 (Tisch. Treg. WH. RV.). The construction é¢6f5acxey eis is very nearly equivalent to the dat. of indir. obj., and denotes the direction of the act. See Thay.-Grm. Zex., eis, I, A, By De The provision of the synagogue service, which made it available for Jesus’ purpose, and caused him to choose that as one of his means of obtaining access to the people, was the freedom of its service. The performance of public worship or instruction was not committed to any officials, but to any one selected for the purpose by the dpyiovvaywyos, the ruler of the synagogue. For an example of the way in which Jesus connected this teaching with the Scripture reading, see Lk. 4’°*. The synagogue was the formal assembly in Jewish towns, or in the Jewish quarters of the Gentile cities, for instruction in the law. No provision for such an institution was made in the law itself, and it dates probably from the exile. The service consisted of prayer, reading of Scrip- ture, and exposition by any rabbi, or other person present and competent to teach. There was a body of elders, generally the civic authorities in Jewish towns, who had charge of the general affairs of the synagogue. The special officers were an dpxicuvdywyos, or synagogue ruler, who had charge of the synagogue worship, appointing readers and exhorters; the alms-receivers; and the trnpéra:, whose chief function was to bring forth the Scriptures for public worship, and to return them to their place, but who, in general, were the subordinate functionaries, the beadles of the congregation. 22. Kai éferAnooovro— And they were astonished. A strong descriptive word for amazement, meaning strictly Zo strike a person out of his senses by some strong feeling, such as fear, wonder, or even joy. dWdayy— teaching (RV.) not doctrine (AV.). The reason given for their astonishment concerned the manner of his teaching, not its substance. édidacxeyv —he was teaching, not he taught (EV.). ws éovciav éywv—as having authority (RV.). 1 Heb. naw, a rest-day. This dat. plur. of the third declension is frequent in the N.T., not in the Sept. The plural is used frequently in the N.T. for a single Sabbath, a use either corresponding to the plur. of festivals, ra éyxaima etc., or coming from the emphatic Chald. form x73. 2 This use of cuvaywyj to denote an assembly, or the place of assemblage, belongs to the N.T. In the Gr., it denotes the act of assembling. 22 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [I. 22, 23 What this authority was, the contrast with the Scribes indicates. They had, and constantly cited, external authority for their teach- ing. They said, Rabdi—says this. His authority then, which they did not have, was internal, proceeding from vision. The diffi- culty with the Scribes, and with men of their class, is that they carry external authority into the realm of intuitive truth. ot ypappateis + the Scribes." These were the men with whom Jesus had his chief controversy. They were the authors of the tradition, which he claimed made void the word of God. 7°”. The Pharisees were the party of adherents to this traditional law, whom they gathered about themselves. Their function was that of interpreters and expounders of the law, and especially the decis- ion of difficult cases under its different commands. ‘They sought in this way to apply such a general law as the Sabbath, e.g. to all possible cases that could arise under it, in such a way as to safe- guard it against possible violation. They were ignorant of the modern historical interpretation, and of Jesus’ spiritual exposition, and they systematized the allegorical method. To this body of casuistry and essentially false interpretation they gave an authority equal to that of Scripture, and even superior to it. The conse- quence was that they built up a system, in which the spiritual ele- ment of the O.T. was minimized, and the external, formal, positive element was emphasized. See Schiirer on Scribism, II. bie. 23. Kai ci6is — And immediately. Insert ev@0s between Kal and 4» Tisch. (Treg.) WH. RV. & BL 1, 33, 131, 209, Memph. etc. ed6s — immediately, here and in v.”, shows the rapid sequence of events after he entered Capernaum. He was no sooner in the city than he entered the synagogue, and no sooner in the syna- gogue than this demoniac appeared. év mvevpart axabdptw —in an unclean spirit. The prep. is used to denote possession by the evil spirit, in the same way as év Xptoto, in Christ, év Uvevpare ‘Ayiw, in the Holy Spirit, denote the intimate connection between the Christian and Christ, or the Holy Spirit. The two beings are conceived as somehow ensphering each other, and sometimes one, sometimes the other, is said to enclose the being identified with it. The demon, ¢g., is said to be in the man, or the man in the demon. In this case, the man is said to be in the unclean spirit, and v. 27, the unclean spirit is said to 1 In the Gr., ypauparevs denotes a clerk or recorder, and is applied to an official class whose general function corresponds to that of the clerks of judicial and repre- sentative bodies. Among the Jews, it meant a Jettered man, one acquainted with the sacred writings. They are called also voprxoi, Zawyers, or men versed in the law; vopodiddécxador, teachers of the law; icpoypauparers, because they dealt with the sacred writings; and Rabbis, great ones. I. 23-25] THE FIRST MIRACLE 23 come out of him. vetua dxaaprov is used interchangeably with datpoviov, demon (AV. devil), to designate these spirits.1 Beelze- bul is their chief, or Satan. See 3” *%, The reality of demoniacal possession is a matter of doubt. The serious argument against it is, that the phenomena are mostly natural, not super- natural. It was the unscientific habit of the ancient mind to account for abnormal and uncanny things, such as lunacy and epilepsy, supernaturally. And in such cases, outside of the Bible, we accept the facts, but ascribe them to natural causes. Another serious difficulty is that lunacy and epilepsy are common in the East, as elsewhere, and yet, unless these are cases, we do not find Jesus healing these disorders as such, but only cases of demoniacal possession in which these were symptoms. The dilemma is very curious. Outside the N.T., no demoniacal possession, but only lunacy and epilepsy; in the N.T., no cases of lunacy and epilepsy proper, but only demoniacal possession. See, however, Weiss, Life of Fesus, Il. 6. 24. Kat dvéxpage—and he cried out? ("Ea)ri jyiy wal co; — What to us and to thee, literally. What have we in. common which gives you the right to interfere with us ? Omit “Ea Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s* BD 102, 157, Latt. Pesh. Memph. etc, NAGes arroh€oat Huas;— aid you come to destroy us? The demons were afraid that Jesus was not only going to cast them out, but to remand them to the torments of Gehenna. See Mt. 8” Lk. 8°. oda oe tis & —L know thee who thou art. The change from the plural jpiv, fo us, to the sing. oida, J know, simply brings us back to the person speaking for himself, whereas in the jyiv, the demon speaks for his class. The question is, what have we demons to do with you? The statement of the demoniac, / know shee, is inspired by the demon, and is so explained in v.™, otdauev is substituted for ofa by Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. marg. x LA Memph. etc. A probable emendation to make this agree with the plur. Nev. 6 aytos Tov Meov — “he holy one of God. ‘The one consecrated to God, and employed in his service.2 See J.10%. It gives here the reason why the demon feared that a part of Jesus’ mission (7AGes) was to dismiss them to their place. 25. Kai éreriunoev atta 6 ‘Inoots, pipwOnri — And Jesus charged him sharply, Shut up. Omit Aéywr, saying, T. (WH.) & A*. It is inserted apparently to get over the roughness of éreriuncev alone. 1 This use of rycdua belongs to Biblical Greek. 2 The first aor. is “rare and late.” Sec. aor. avékpayov common. 8 The only other place in which this term is applied to Jesus is John 689 (Tisch. Treg. WH. RV.). 4 For other examples of this meaning of émriugv, see Mk, 839 312 Mt, 1216, 24 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [I. 25-28 diwwOynre — literally, d¢ muzz/ed.' Its metaphorical use to denote putting to silence in other ways belongs to later Greek. 26. orapagav — having convulsed him. It is used in medical writers of the convulsive action of the stomach in retching. And it is evidently in this secondary sense of convudsing that the word is used here, not of actual searing or lacerating. dwvycav povy peyadn — having cried with a great cry. Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BL 33, etc. dwvjoav instead of xpdgap. 27. wore cvlyntelv adtois —Sso that they discussed. avrovs, instead of mpds avro’s (éauvrovs) Tisch. WH.» B and miss. of Lat. Vet. . ouvlnreiv — to discuss, or question” Ti éote todo; didaxn Katy) Kar eovoiav* Kat Tois mvevpact, etc.—Whatis this? A new teach- ing according to authority. And he commands, etc. didax Kav Kar’ éovclay is the reading of Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BL 33-402. The critical texts which adopt the above reading, with the exception of Tisch., punctuate differently. They connect xar’ éfovctay with what follows, so that it reads, a mew ‘teaching; with authority he commands even the unclean spirits. But according to v.2, this new element of authority resides in the teaching itself, so that car’ éfovoiav belongs more naturally with day Kaw. This new, authoritative teaching makes the first ground of their astonishment. And in addition to this, not a part of it, is their astonishment at the submission of the spirits to his command. 28. «iOds, immediately. ‘This is the third instance of this word in this short paragraph. Lk., in spite of his general verbal resem- blance to Mk., omits it in every case. Here it shows the imme- diateness of the fame which followed such exhibitions of authority. mavTaxovd eis OAnv THY TEpixwpov — everywhere, into all the neigh- borhood? : Insert ravraxod Tisch. (Treg.) WH. RV. » BCL 69, Lat. Vet. (some mss.), Memph. tns TadtAaias is partitive gen., denoting the part of Galilee that lay about Capernaum. Lk. is parallel to Mk. here (43!-87), and the minute verbal resemblance again shows obvious interdependence. The secondary character of Lk.’s account appears unmistakably in the report of the popular discussion that followed the miracle. 1 For instances of the literal meaning, see 1 Cor. 99 1 Tim. 518. 2 This is a Biblical meaning. In Greek, it is restricted to its proper sense, #0 search together. The N.T. meaning is a legitimate derivation from that. 3 The proper ending of adv. of place with verbs of motion is o, not ov. The N.T. Greek does not observe this distinction, but invariably uses the ending ov. Our confusion of where and whither. The use of # mepixwpos with y7 understood is Biblical. I. 29-31] A POPULAR UPRISING 25 A POPULAR UPRISING 29-34. Healing of Peters wife's mother, followed by a popular uprising, bringing all the sick of the city to him, at the close of the legal Sabbath. This story is a continuation of the account of this first Sabbath in Capernaum. The miracle in the synagogue is followed by the healing at Peter’s house, and at evening, the whole population, who have been restrained only by their fear of breaking the Sab- bath, gather at the house, bringing all their sick to him. 29. Kai ci6is— And immediately. The characteristic use of this word continues in this paragraph. See v.”. It is omitted in the parallel accounts. The whole series, taken together, shows how straight events marched from his first appearance in Caper- naum to the climax of v.*. These two, v.” and *, show more particularly the immediateness with which the miracle at Peter’s house succeeded that in the synagogue. One miracle follows another, until! finally the whole city bring their sick to him. é&ed- Oovres HAGov — having gone out, they came. éfeNOdvres HAOov Tisch. WH. ¢xt. RV. ¢x¢. 8 ACL TAIL Vulg. Memph. Pesh. Harcl. tx. éfehOav HrOev, having gone out, he came, Treg. WH. marg. RV. marg. BD 1, 22, 69, 124, 131, 209, 346, Lat. Vet. 2 mss. of Vulg. Harcl. marg. 7nAVov — they came. The subj. remains the same as in v.”, viz. Jesus and his disciples, whose call to follow him is given in v.'*™. But, since Simon and Andrew are mentioned, the writer adds James and John specifically, in order to avoid the possible infer- ence that only Simon and Andrew are meant. ‘The touch of the eyewitness, Peter, is seen here. Holtzmann, by coupling this with Jesus’ instruction to his disciples (61°), that they should stay in any house that they entered, infers that Peter’s house became Jesus’ residence. But that injunction does not apply here, as it belongs to Jesus’ instructions about their conduct when they entered a town for only a short stay during a missionary journey. 30. KaTéxetto mupéccovoa— was lying prostrate with a fever. The language is descriptive, the prep. in xaréxeiro denoting the prostration of disease, and the part. the fire of fever. The imperf. denotes that this was her state at the time. 31. nyepev— raised her, i.e. he made her sit up.’ wai adjxe aitny 6 rupetos — and the fever left her. Omit ev@éws Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL 1, 28, 33, 102, 118, 131, 209, Memph. etc. 1 The vb, in Greek means to rouse, not to raise, 26 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [I. 31-34 Sunxdver abrots —she served, or waited on them. ‘This is added to show the reality and completeness of her recovery. 32. *OWias de yevouevns — And evening having come. ‘The Jew- ish day closed at evening, and as this was the Sabbath, this became the signal for the people, who had been restrained before by the strict Rabbinical interpretation of the Sabbath law, to bring their sick to him. Mk. adds Gre edu 6 nAtos, when the sun set, in order to make it more definite that the day was closed, dia being a general term including time before sunset, whereas the day closed with the going down of the sun. It is significant that Mt., who does not mention the Sabbath, omits also the sunset. rovs SatpoviLouevous — those possessed with demons, not devils, AV.2 8iaBodos is the word for devi/, and it is never applied to the evil spirits, though they are represented as subjects of the devil ; cf. on v.“. In the Gospels, demoniacs are placed in a class by themselves, separate from those afflicted with ordinary diseases. In this case, the people brought demoniacs especially, because it was the healing of a demoniac that had so excited them. daluwy is not a word of bad omen in Greek. In the earlier language, it is used interchangeably with eds, though more commonly it denotes the abstract notion of deity. In the later language, it denotes inferior deities, beings between God and man. 33. Wy OAn Hf rors emtovvynypevyn — all the city was gathered? It was all the sick that were brought, and all the city that gath- ered at the door. The miracle in the synagogue caused a popu- lar uprising. 34. rodXovs Kakds €xovtas . . . Satpovia toAdA — many sick, and many demons. It is held by most (Meyer, Weiss, Holtzmann, and others) that the many here is in contrast with the a// of v.*. But it does not mean necessarily that it was only many, out of the all who were brought to him, who were healed. It may mean equally well that the number included in the all was not few but many. Many sick is not necessarily the same as many of the sick. The latter requires the partitive gen. for its exact expression. Such a partial healing would not be inexplicable, since the condition of faith required by Jesus might not be present in all cases. But the explanation is unnecessary. Mt. 816 says that they brought many demoniacs, and he cast out the demons, and healed all the sick. Lk. says that all who had sick persons brought them, and he healed them, laying his hand on each one; and that demons went out of many. In Lk.’s account certainly, it is not intended to contrast the cure of many demoniacs with that of all the sick. 1 See Lk. 1314. 2 RV. text retains devils, marg. demons. American Revisers substitute demons in text in all passages where daipwr, Samoviov, OF Sarwovigouar OCCUTS. . 8 The double compound émovynyuévy is not found in classical Greek, though the simple compound ovvéyev is common. ém adds to the word the idea of gathering upon or towards some point. E 34-45 | JESUS’ POLICY OF SILENCE 27 Kai otk note Aadcly Ta Satpdvia, Ste yoeioav airov'— And he did not suffer the demons to speak, because they knew him. dadeiv is used in the N.T. with a direct obj., but not with 67x. Where the words follow, they are introduced with Acywy, saying; cf. Mt. 23° Mk. 6% Lk. 24° Where éru is used, without any intervening word, it is causal.2 The demons are said to speak, instead of the man, because the knowledge of Jesus is attributable to the demon, and not to the man. The man is represented as inhabited by an alien spirit, who used his organs of speech. Xpurrov eivac—zto be the Christ, after pdewav abrdv, they knew him, (WH.) RV. marg. s BCGLM 1, 28, 33, 69, 124, mss. of Lat. Vet. and Vulg. Memph. Harcl. etc. Omitted by ADEFKSUV Latt. Pesh. etc. Probable insertion from Lk. 4*!. This knowledge is one of the arguments for the supernaturalism of these cases, and one of the difficulties in the way of the naturalistic explanation of them. And it is not to be set aside lightly. But the reflections of the evangelists are to be distinguished from their statement of facts. And a supernatural cause once posited naturally gathers supernatural phenomena. JESUS’ POLICY OF SILENCE 35-45. Jesus makes a tour of Galilee, preaching and heal- ing. Cure of a leper. After the popular uprising following Jesus’ first day’s ministry in Capernaum, he withdraws to a solitary place to pray. His disci- ples beseech him to return to take advantage of his popularity, but Jesus refuses, saying that he came out to proclaim the king- dom elsewhere. In pursuance of the same policy, he enjoins silence on a leper whom he heals during this tour of Galilee, and the man’s disobedience forces him to retire from the towns and synagogues to uninhabited places, whither the people follow him. This section is of first-rate importance in this narrative of the beginning of Jesus’ ministry. He appears at the beginning as a miracle worker, and maintains that character consistently to the end of the Galilean ministry. But here, at the very beginning, he — is represented as maintaining whatever secrecy is possible about his miracles, and avoiding the notoriety attaching to them. And 1 fdve is a rare form of the impf. of adinu., from adiw, with the augment on the prep. See Win. 14. 3. b. _ 2 -Thay.-Grm, Lex. explains this as equivalent to repi rovtov ori, concerning this, that. But it supposes a difficulty requiring an explanation, whereas the causal sense of 61 leaves nothing to explain. 28 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [I. 35, 36 the only account of a miracle in this first missionary journey is that of one in which disobedience to this injunction of secrecy made it impossible for him to continue his work in the towns, so that he was forced to retire into solitary places. The reason for this secrecy about what was nevertheless a prominent feature of his work is to be found in the fact that he sought from men a faith which was hindered, not helped, by external signs. The miracles lent themselves also to false, outward conceptions of himself and his work. And evidently they had their raison d’étre in themselves, and not in any effect which they were intended to produce. ‘They are primarily works of benevolence, not of supernaturalism. 35. mpwi evvvxa Aiav —in the morning, a great while before day. RV. Literally, very much at night. évvuxa, instead of €vvvxoy, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL 1, 28, 33, 131, 209, etc. apwt denotes the last watch of the night from three to six, and évvuxa Aiav, the part of this watch which reached back very much into the night. épyyov rorov —a solitary place. The story points to some place of this kind near Capernaum. zpoontxero — he was praying. The imperf. denotes what he was doing when Simon and the rest pursued and found him. We are not told the subjects of Jesus’ prayers, except in Gethsemane. But the occasions are sig- nificant. The only other in Mt. and Mk. is after the miracle of feeding the 5000, where the fourth Gospel explains the urgency of Jesus to get rid of both disciples and multitude by the statement that they are about to force him to be a king. Lk. adds to these three, which are all of which we have an account in Mt. and Mk., several others of less significance. But he gives one of the same character. After the healing of the leper, Jesus is represented in that Gospel as not only retreating before the sudden access of his popularity, but as praying. One of these cases might not be enough to warrant the conclusion, but taken together they indi- cate that Jesus was praying that he might not be ensnared by this popularity, or in any way induced to accept the ways of ease instead of duty. 36. Karediwgev avrov— pursued him closely. See Liddell and Scott, Gr. Lex. The EV., followed after, is inadequate. kara, as in our expression, 40 hunt down, gives the idea of hard, persistent search. The word occurs only here in the N.T. kai of per airov 1 éyyvyos is properly an adj. meaning nocturnal. This is the only place where it occurs in the N.T., and its adverbial use is quite late. Zz 36-39 | JESUS’ POLICY OF SILENCE 29 —and those with him. Andrew, James, and John are meant. See v.™. 37. Kai evpov airév xai Aéyovow — And they found him and say. eUpov avrdv kai, instead of edpévyres abrév, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV.» BL one ms. of Lat. Vet. Memph. etc. ore mavtes Cntovoi oe— that all are seeking for thee All the people of Capernaum, which he has just left, are meant. The disciples bring him the news that the excitement of the previous day is not abated, and are anxious evidently that he should not fail to follow up so notable a success. 38. “Aywpev ddAaxod — let us go elsewhere? adAaxod, elsewhere, is inserted by Tisch. wires WH. RY. BC*L; 33; Memph. etc. €xopevas KwporroAes — neighboring towns. The noun denotes something between a village and a city, approximating a city in size, but unwalled.® eis TOUTO yap €&nAOov — for for this did I come out. The context shows plainly that he refers to his coming out of Capernaum, which has been mentioned just before, v.*. Not out of heaven, an expression and idea which belong to the fourth Gospel, and are not found in the Synoptics. Moreover, the purpose to preach to other towns than Capernaum is singularly inapposite as a state- ment of the object of his coming into the world. It is commensu- rate with his leaving Capernaum, but not with his leaving heaven. He did not wish to confine himself to one place, and his coming out as he did, early, would enable him to escape the importunity of the people, who sought to confine him to this. 39. Kai 7Adev xnptoowy eis Tas ovvaywyas aitav eis OAnV THY TadtrAaiav— And he came, preaching to their synagogues, into all Galilee, and casting out demons. HAGev eis, instead of Hv év, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BL Memph. The construction with this reading is not without difficulty, especially the use of eis with xnptcowyv, to denote those to whom the proclamation is made. And probably, this original form of the text was changed to avoid this roughness. But, while the Lexicons consider it necessary to explain this use of eis, they admit it. This leaves the second eds with éAnv rv Taki Aatay to depend on #dGev. Kat Ta, Satpovia éxBarkuv — and casting out the demons. Before, vv.” *4, this miracle is separated from the rest. Here it is men- tioned by itself without the rest in such a way as to represent loe, thee, turns this into direct discourse. An incongruous blending of direct and indirect discourse, more or less common in N.T., as in other Greek. 2 On this termination, ov instead of o, see footnote on ravraxod v.28. This word does not occur elsewhere in N.T. 3 kwudmoAts does not occur elsewhere in N.T. It belongs to the later Greek, 30 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [I. 39—42 them. Although it is the only miracle mentioned, it was evidently not the only one performed. It is selected as the great and rep- resentative miracle. And it is not improbable that it was, so to speak, our Lord’s favorite miracle, because here the physical and spiritual parts of his work coincided.’ 40. Aérpos — a leper. ‘The reason for introducing this one mir- acle, among the many belonging to this journey, is told in v.*. It turned him aside from his original purpose of visiting the neighbor- ing towns, and forced him into retirement. aapaxaAa@v airov Kat yovuretav, A€ywv aita — beseeching him and kneeling, saying to him? Omit avrév after yovurerav, Tisch. WH. L 1, 209, some mss. of Lat. Vet. Vulg. etc. Omit cal yovvrera@y a’rov Treg. marg. (Treg.) RV. marg. (WH.) BDG T 102, 124, some mss. of Lat. Vet. etc. Omit kat before Aéywv Tisch. WH. 8* B 69* Memph. etc. With this reading, A€ywy saying, is not co-ordinate with zapa- xad@v and yovurerav, but subordinate to them. éav OéAys diva- ca.—if thou wilt, thou canst. He does not doubt the ability, but the willingness of Jesus. This willingness is the point that all petition seeks to carry, the doubt that it seeks to remove. xaBapicat— cleanse. Leprosy was not only a repulsive and dan- gerous disease, but it made a man unclean ceremonially, so that lepers were cut off from intercourse with their fellows, and assigned a place by themselves outside the gates.2 It was a part of Jesus’ disregard of the merely ceremonial part of the law that he allowed these unclean persons to approach him. It did not accord with his nature to obtrude this disregard, but he had no scruples when- ever the law interfered with higher things. 41. Kai ordayyxvicbeis, éxreivas tiv xelpa— And having been moved with compassion he stretched out his hand+* Kail, instead of ‘O dé *Inaods, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BD 102, mss. of Lat. Vet. Memph. etc. nwaro avtov — he touched him. ‘The touch, or laying on of the hand, was the natural symbolical action accompanying the cure, being the sign of any benediction, common to Jews and Chris- tians.” 42. Kai ev0ds arndAOev . . . 4 Aéerpa — And immediately the leprosy departed, Omit eiréyros avrod before ed@vs Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDL 16, 69, 102, mss. of Lat. Vet. Memph. Pesh. etc. 1 See gll. 15. 22. 67. 13, 2 yovurerav belongs to later Greek. 3 See Lev. 134- 46, 4 The meaning and form of omdayxvigoua are late. omdayxvedw is the proper form, and its meaning is to eat the inwards of a victim after sacrifice, or to obtain auguries from them. The meaning compassionate comes from the Heb., which regarded the orAdyxva, the inwards, as the seat of pity and tenderness. 5 See 1016 Acts 818 gl7 133 1 Tim. 414 2 Tim, 18, I. 42, 43 | JESUS’ POLICY OF SILENCE 31 evOvs denotes the immediateness, and so the miraculousness of the cure. Mt. tells of twelve cures, in two of which he specifies immediateness ; Mk. of thirteen, in six of which he describes the cure as immediate; and Lk. of fourteen, in seven of which he uses the word zrapaypijya, on the spot. This includes only the cases in which either this word or ev@vs is used. There are others, in which such a phrase as from that hour is used. And not only the immediateness, but the completeness, of the cure is frequently dwelt upon.’ 43. é€uBpiunodpevos — AV. he straitly charged him. RV. strictly charged him. Fither of these is an inadequate translation. The N.T. meaning of the word is @o de angry, but the difficulty is to find any cause for anger. Weiss finds it in the fact that the man had broken the wholesome law forbidding persons with this dan- gerous disease from coming into contact with their fellows, and attributes Jesus’ urgency to get rid of him to the same cause. Consistently with, this, he supposes that the cure was only gradual, and that the leper was still liable to infect others when he left Jesus. Mk.’s story becomes secondary of course as it is plainly inconsistent with this hypothesis. Weiss thinks that Mk. introduces this word inadvertently, as it shows plainly a different version of the whole affair. The original account he finds in Mt. 87*. But it is Mk. himself who betrays this by his inadvertent éuBpiunodpe- vos. Verily, this is to hang much ona small peg. If anywhere, Mk. shows here the indubitable marks of originality. And how much more probable is his account of Jesus’ urgency to get rid of the man than Weiss’s, who lays it to the danger of infection, and so to an imperfect cure. Mk., on the other hand, attributes it to our Lord’s dread of the notoriety caused by his miracles. Weiss’s whole theory of the gradualness of Jesus’ cures, and of his regard for the Levitical law, of which this makes a part, is unsupported. But neither is Meyer’s explanation, that he foresaw the man’s dis- obedience, quite probable. It puts its finger on the source of the trouble, but it mistakes in making it foresight on the part of Jesus. Our Lord is vexed at the whole situation of which the man makes a part, at the clamor over the mere externals of his work, and this is expressed in some sharp word, with which he accompanies the thrusting of him out of the house (or synagogue). It may be translated, having spoken sternly to him? It does not denote the tone with which Jesus spoke the words given here, as the action of the verb and participle are apparently distinct. But it denotes some utterance accompanying the é€BaAev, and partaking of its spirit. 1 See 151. 44 212 Mt, 12138 Mk, 529 Mt. 932.33 Mk. 739, 2See Mt. 939 Mk. 145 J. 1153.38 for the other instances of N.T. use of word. Of these, Mt. 939 shares the ambiguity of this passage. The original meaning is to snort, which certainly makes room for it to denote an expression of feeling, as well as the feeling itself, 32 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [I. 43, 44 é€eBarev — AV. sent him away. RV. sent him out. Both in- adequate again. TZhrust, or put him out, conveys the idea. This, as well as éuBpiynodpevos, indicates the urgency of Jesus’ action. He wishes to repress the natural, but misguided, impulse of the leper to stay and contribute to the adulation and excitement gathering about Jesus. 44. “Opa, pydevi pndev eins — Take heed lest you say anything to anybody The reason for this prohibition is not the urgency of his performance of the legal requirements, with which nothing must be allowed to interfere, but the danger in which Jesus stood of just the results which followed his disobedience. His spread- ing the story prevented Jesus’ work in public, and forced him into retirement, and so Jesus forbade his telling it. And the words in which he warned him off this dangerous ground are made as sharp as possible. ceavrov detfov ro iepet Kai mpoceveyxe — Show thyself to the priest, and offer” is paptipiov aitots —for a testimony to them. These words are to be connected with detfov and teveyxe — show thyself to the priest, and make the prescribed offering, for a testimony to them. Take this official way, authorized and pre- scribed by the law, of testifying to your cure. This case, taken by itself, would be one of subservience to the law. And Weiss makes it the text of a discourse on Jesus’ strict conformity to the law, ceremonial as well as moral.’ But this is an evident overstate- ment, to say the least. Jesus’ general position is that of a Jew, conforming himself, as any sane man would, to Jewish law and custom. And yet, sometimes he acts as if there was no such law. But in both observance and non-observance, he acts simply as a rational spirit, bound by definite principles, but conforming to fixed rules only so far as they do not interfere with the principles. Take, e.g., what he says about the higher law in its relation to the Sabbath, and about the principle of fasting. In this very case, his touch of the leper made him unclean, so that his action com- bined both observance and non-observance. And in his discourse about eating with unwashed hands, he abrogates the distinction between clean and unclean. No, to judge of his action here in a large way, it is apparent that Jesus would not have encouraged the man to disregard the law, and might very likely have bidden him observe it, just as he would himself. But this insistence on it can scarcely be attributed to Jesus’ anxiety or scrupulosity about ceremonial law. But the provision for official announcement of the cure to a single person in Jerusalem, by taking the place of publishing it abroad in Galilee, gave Jesus an opportunity to sup- 1 See Win. 56, 2, 4, 8. On the double negative, nothing to nobody, see Win. 55,9, 4. 2 The prescribed ceremonial and offerings for the cleansing of a leper are found in Lev. 14. 8 Life of Fesus, II. ch. 11. I. 44, 45 | JESUS’ POLICY OF SILENCE 33 plement his prohibition with a reminder of what the law provided in such cases. 45. npfaro Kypvocew ToAAG Kal Siadynpilew tov Adyov — began to publish much (extensively) and to spread abroad the event. tov Adyov — is the object of both verbs. ypéaro — calls attention to the beginning of this action. He no sooner went out than he began to publish the affair. dore pnxére aitov divacbar— so that he was no longer able. An inability arising from the condition and principles of Jesus’ work. «is réAw — into a city. Jesus was on a tour, going about from place to place, and eis wéAw has therefore the proper meaning of the anarthrous noun. éz’ épypos Toros —in solitary, uninhabited places. wdvrobev— from all sides. wavrodev, instead of ravraxddev, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABCDL, etc. I, 33, etc. én’ épjuos Tisch. Treg. WH. BL A 28, 124. The command not to tell the story of the cure was not confined to this case, but was so frequent as to justify us in saying that it was the custom of Jesus. And this account gives the result of disobedience to it in an extreme case. It made a turning-point in the history of this mission, producing a change in our Lord’s plans, which is apparently the reason for introducing it here. But why should Jesus try to preserve this secrecy about his miracles? Evidently, his thought about them was different from the ordinary thought of the Church, as it was different from that of his own time. But the reason is very simple. The miracles were sure to be treated as external signs, whereas Jesus relied on internal signs. As external, moreover, exhibitions of a supernatu- ral power, they confirmed the people in their expectation of a national, worldly Messiah, and raised in them just the false hopes which Jesus was seeking to allay. And finally, by the excitement which they created, they interfered with the quiet methods of Jesus’ spiritual work. e THE MIRACLES OF JESUS Holtzmann rationalizes this miracle by explaining xa@apioa, the cleansing of the leper, as a removal of his ceremonial uncleanness by Jesus. The man was cured already before he came to our Lord, and he wishes Jesus to pronounce him clean, in order to save him the journey to Jerusalem. He admits that the evange- lists do not mean this, but intend to tell the story of a miraculous cure. But he contends that this simply shows how the story of D 34 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [I. 45 natural events grew into supernatural form in their hands. Un- fortunately for his hypothesis, he accepts the theory of the Synop- tical Gospels which traces them to apostolic sources, and especially makes Mk. the rehearser of Peter’s story. This does not give the required time for myths to grow. This first-hand testimony is the starting-point in establishing the credibility of the miracles. Then, they stand or fall with the historicity of the whole account of Jesus, which is not generally denied. One of the first princi- ples of a true criticism is, that any attempt to patch out a story with unreal details will betray itself by the incongruities of the addition. But you cannot separate the miracles from the rest of the story in this way. They are part of the texture of the story. Especially, they have a uniqueness which belongs to the character of Jesus, and to the principles of his action, and which makes invention an impossibility. A scheme of miracles which rigor- ously excludes everything but works of beneficence — all mira- cles of personal preservation, of punishment, of mere thaumaturgy, never occurred to any one but Jesus. The moment we go forward or back from him in Jewish history we find all these. And yet, the same generation tells us the story of Ananias and Sapphira, and of Elymas the Sorcerer, and, with entire unconsciousness of the difference, the story of Jesus’ miracles. His miracles are signs, not because of their power, but because of this divine unique- ness of their spirit. Jesus’ reticence about them, his endeavor to push them into the background, is another feature of this unique- ness. It is a revelation in action of his deep spirituality, the story of which is told by his contemporaries with evident unconscious- ness of its significance. In fact, the grounds of Jesus’ solitary greatness are to be found in the miracles, as in the rest of the life, and in the teaching, and they are of the same kind. THE PERIOD OF CONFLICT With this chapter begins the period of conflict in the life of our Lord. It is apparent in the preceding chapter that Jesus is not at all satisfied with the situation created by his sudden popularity, regarding it as a serious hindrance to his work. But now, instead of the superficial enthusiasm of the people, he has to encounter the growing opposition of their leaders. At first, this is aroused aE 1] THE CHARGE OF BLASPHEMY 35 by his extraordinary claims, then by his revolutionary act in call- ing Levi, the tax-gatherer, to become his personal disciple, and finally by his revolutionary teaching in regard to fasting and Sab- bath observance. Mk. produces this impression as plainly by his selection of events as if he had given this section the title Period of Conflict. Lk. gives the same grouping, while Mt. distributes these events. THE CHARGE OF BLASPHEMY II. 1-12. Jesus’ return to Capernaum. Healing of a paralytic. Jesus announces the cure as a forgiveness of the sins which have produced the disease. The Scribes protest against this blasphemy. Jesus defends his claim to forgive sins, and proves tt in this case by the cure. Immediately after the return of Jesus to Capernaum, the crowd gathers again in such numbers as to prevent access to him. But four men bringing to him a paralytic, not to be turned back, gain access to the roof of the house in which he was, tear up the roof, and let the paralytic down. In healing him Jesus says, Zhy sins are forgiven, meaning the sins that have produced the disease. The Scribes, who make their first appearance here, protest against this as blasphemy. Jesus meets their charge by showing that forgiveness is here only another name for cure. But he asserts his right to forgive sins, and proves it by the cure. 1. Kai cioeAOwv wadw . . . yKovcOn — And having entered again . it was heard. elceNOwv, instead of elo#Oev, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDé& L 28, 33, 124, mss. of Lat. Vet. Memph. etc. Omit xal before 4xovc@n Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BL 28, 33, 124, mss. of Lat. Vet. Memph. etc. madkw —again. See 1™. It isa peculiarity of Mk. that he notes the recurrence of scenes and places in his narrative. Lk. uses this word only twice, and Mt. uses it almost entirely to denote the different parts of discourse, not the recurrence of the same, or similar occasions. &’ jpepov — after (some) days." év oikw — in the house, or at home? év olky, instead of els otxov, Tisch. Treg. WH. 8 BDL 33, 67, most mss. of Lat. Vet. Vulg. 1 See Win. 47, 1. 64, 5. 2 The prep. with the anarthrous noun constitutes a phrase. 36 THE GOSPEL OF MARK (II. 2-5 2. kal swyyOnoav ToAAo’ — and many were gathered together. Omit ¢d0éws Tisch. (Treg.) WH. RV. 8 BL 33, 102, mss. of Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Pesh. GOTE pnKeTL xwpeiy pnde TA mpos THV Bipav—so that not even the parts towards the door (on the outside) would hold them any longer. Not only was the house too small for the crowd, but not even outside, near the door, was there room for them.’ kai éAdAe — and he was speaking. The imperf. denotes what he was doing when the bearers of the paralytic came. AV. preached. RV. spake. tov Aoyov— the word. The word of the Gospel, or glad tidings of the kingdom of God, with the accompanying call to repentance. See 1%? 3. mapadvutixov — @ paralytic. | 4. Kal pi dvvduevor mpocevéyxar — And as (they saw that) they were unable to bring him to him. a shows that their inability is not viewed simply as a fact, but in their view of it, as it influenced their minds.* mpocevéyxat, instead of mpoceyyioa, Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. RV. marg. x BL 33, 63, 72 marg. 253, two mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Harcl. etc. dmeatéyacay tiv oréynv — they unroofed the roof. Uncovered, EV., does not render the paronomasia of the Greek.> éfopvéavres —having dug it out. This describes the process of unroofing. It would imply probably some sort of thatched roof. Yad@ou Tov kpdBarrov — they let down the pallet. ‘The noun denotes any slight bed, such as might be used to carry the sick about the streets, a stretcher® dmov— where(on). &rrov, instead of 颒 @ Tisch. Treg. WH. ® BDL two mss. Lat. Vet. The roofs of Eastern houses were flat. Access to the roof would be easy by an outside stairway or ladder. The description, moreover, implies that this house had only one story, according with what we know of the humble position and means of Jesus and his followers. 5. tiv niotw abrav — their faith. That is, the faith of the paralytic and his friends. ‘That it was their faith, and not simply his faith, would show several things. First, that faith is not the psychological explanation of the cure, through the reaction of the mind on the body, in which case, the faith of the others would 1 ywperv is transitive and has 7a mpos thy Ovpar for its subject. On the repetition of the negative, see Win. 55,9, 4. On the construction of dere with wy and the inf. — always so in N.T. —see Win. 55, 2, d. 2 For other instances of this use of 6 Adyos to denote in a general way the subject of Christian teaching, see 44-33 Lk. 12. 3 This word belongs to Biblical Greek. The Greeks said mapadeAupevos. * See Win. 55: 5, & B. 5 This is the only case of the use of this verb in the N.T. 6 yaA@or. commonly means 7o slacken, or relax, and to let down, when this involves slackening. "xpéBarrov is a late Greek word copied from the Latin grada- tus. The Greeks said oxismovs. II. 5-8] THE CHARGE OF BLASPHEMY 37 have nothing to do with it, — but the spiritual condition of the miracle. ‘This is also shown by the cure of demoniacs. Secondly, that Jesus meant here by the forgiveness of the man’s sins only this removal of the physical consequences of some sin affecting the nervous organization. The removal of the spiritual penalty would be conditioned on the faith of the man himself. However, this is simply the reflection of the writer on the facts. And it is in the narration of facts, that the value of contemporaneous witness appears. In the historical judgment of the Gospels, this distinc- tion between facts and reflections has frequently to be remem- bered. Teéxvov, dpievtai gov ai apyaptiat— Child (EV. Son), thy sins are forgiven. aglevrat, instead of dpéwvrat, Tisch. Treg. WH. & B 28, mss. of Lat. Vet. Vulg. Pesh. Harcl. 6. Tav ypappatéwy — of the Scribes. This is the first encoun- ter of Jesus with the formalists and dogmatists of his time. So also in Mt. and Lk. And the matter in controversy, the extraor- dinary claims of Jesus, was sure to become an issue between them. The opposition to Jesus is easily explained. diaroyZowevor ev tals Kapdias — debating in their hearts. «apdia, in the N.T., does not denote, like our word hearé, the seat of the affections, but the inner man generally, and more specifically, the mind. This cor- responds to the Homeric use, the common Greek use being like ours. 7. Ti ovros ovTw Aare; BrAacdnuct.—Why does this one speak thus ? he blasphemes. Bracgpnpet, instead of BAacgnulas, Tisch. Treg, WH. RV. 8 BDL mss. of Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. BrAaodynpety is used of any speech derogatory to the Divine majesty. The generic sense of the word is zmjurious speech, among men, s/ander. In this case, the supposed blasphemy consists in the assumption of the Divine prerogative. ei py els 6 Meds; except one, God? ‘This is a good example of the ill usage that good principles receive at the hands of men who deal only with rules and formulas. As a general proposition, this statement of the Scribes is undeniable. The difficulty is, that they ignored the possibility of a man’s speaking for God, and the fact that they had before them one in whom this power was lodged preéminently.” 8. To mvevpat. aitov—in his spirit. This is contrasted with the knowledge acquired through the senses, ¢.g. in this case, by hearing what was said. Without their saying anything, he knew inwardly, intuitively, what was going on in their minds. Jesus knew generally their intellectual attitude, and their position towards 1 See on 122, 21In J. 20%, Jesus extends this power to his disciples. 38 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [II. 8-10 any attempt to live according to the spirit, instead of the letter of things, and the mere look of their faces would put him on the track of their thoughts. Aé€ye: abrots — says to them. héyet, instead of elev, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BL 33, mess. of Lat. Vet. Vulg. 9. Ti éorw eixorwtepov; Which is easter ?* Jesus does not make the contrast here between healing and forgiving, but between say- ing be forgiven and be healed. ‘The two things would be them- selves coincident, and the difference therefore would be only between two ways of saying the same thing. The disease being a consequence of the man’s sin, the cure would be a remission of penalty. “Adéievrai cov ai apaptia — Thy sins are forgiven. *Adlevrat, instead of "Adéwvrat, Tisch. Treg. WH. & B 28, mss. of Lat. Vet. Vulg. Pesh. Harcl. cov instead of oo, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BEFGHKL, etc. taye, instead of mepurdre, Tisch. s LW¢ A, and uraye eis Tov oikdy gov, D 33, mss. of Lat. Vet. A difficult case to decide, as mepirare. may be taken from Mt. and Lk., and uraye from v. II. 10. tva de eidnre — but that ye may know. Here was an oppor- tunity to put his power to a practical test. Asa general thing, the power to forgive sins admits of no such test, but only of those finer inward tests by which a change of spiritual condition and relation becomes known. But here the forgiveness was manifested in an outward change, making itself known in cure, as the sin had discovered itself in disease. éfovciav — authority, or right. ‘This is the proper meaning, rather than fower, and it evidently fits this case. 5 vids Tod avOpwrov— the Son of Man. This is a Messianic title, the use of which is to be traced to the Messianic interpre- tation of Dan. 7%". In the post-canonical Jewish literature, it appears several times in the Book of Enoch.’ It is the favorite title applied by Jesus to himself in the Synoptical Gospels, Son of God being used by Jesus himself only in the fourth Gospel.’ In the passage in Dan., the prophet sees in vision a fifth power suc- ceeding the four great world-powers, only this is in his vision like a son of man, while the preceding powers have been represented as beasts. And in the interpretation that follows (see especially v.87) this power is said to be the kingdom of the saints of the Most High. But later, when the hopes of the people were concen- trated finally on a Messianic king, this passage was given Messi- 1 eixomwtepov is a late word, and is used in the N.T. only in this phrase, evxo- motepov éott. The Greek word for which of two is wotepov. 7 means Strictly what, not which. 2 For passages, see Thay.-Grm. Zex. For a discussion of the date of the alle- gories, in which the Messianic portion of the book occur, see Schtirer, V.Zg. II. III. 32. 2, Schiirer, on the whole, favors the pre-Christian date. 3 ‘Son alone is used by Jesus in Mt. 1127 2181 2819, referring to the Divine Son- ship in the theocratic sense. EE. 10-12] THE CHARGE OF BLASPHEMY 39 anic interpretation, and Son of Man came to be a Messianic title, though not so distinctive, nor so commonly accepted, as the name Messiah. The choice of it by Jesus was partly for this reason. To have called himself plainly the Messiah would have precipi- tated a crisis, forcing the people to decide prematurely on his claim. And it is evident from the doubt of the people, not only about what he was, but in regard to this very point, what he him- self claimed to be, that the title used by him familiarly was inde- cisive. However, there can be little doubt, that the reason for the choice of the name Son of Man lay deeper than this, and is to be found in the significance of the name itself, aside from its his- toric sense. Everywhere, Jesus uses the Messianic phraseology of his time, but rarely limits himself to its current meaning. This name, Son of Man, was to the Jews a Messianic title, only that and nothing more. But Jesus fastens upon it because it identified him © with humanity, and owing to the generic use of the word Man in it, with the whole of humanity. His chosen title, as well as his life, showed that his great desire was to impress on us his brother- hood with man. éxt ths yns— upon the earth. Contrasted with the power of God to forgive sins in heaven. Of course, the power to forgive sins, involved in the mere cure of diseases resulting from them, is in itself small. But the significance of these words lies in the unity of our Lord’s work implied in them. As the redeemer and deliverer of mankind, he is appointed to cope with the whole power of evil among men, to strike at its roots, as well as its twigs and branches, and at its effects, as well as its causes. And the whole is so far the one power trusted to him, that one part becomes the sign of the other. ll. coi A\¢yw —This is to be connected with iva eidyre, the clause A€yee TH Tapadvtixw being parenthetical. ‘This is what he says in order to put his power to forgive sins to a test. éyetpe, dpov — arise, take up. Omit xai before dpov Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCD8'L 13, 28, 33, mss. of Lat. Vet. Memph. Pesh. 12. Kai qyépOn, Kai edOds dpas.. . e&mdADev Eurrpoobev — And he arose, and immediately having taken... went out before. kai ev@vs, instead of ev@éws, kai Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. » BC*L 33, Memph. éuspocev, instead of évayriov, Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. & BL 187 marg. The éumpocbev ravtwv, before all, is introduced to show the pub- licity attending Jesus’ proof of his power. There was a great crowd 1 éyeipw is transitive, and the active is used here in the sense of the passive or middle. On the meaning of the verb, see on 13! footnote. In the passive or mid- dle, in the sense peculiar to the N.T., the meaning is fo rise from a reclining position. 40 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [II. 12, 13 of people, Jesus had performed his miracle in distinct answer to a challenge of his authority, and the cure was therefore purposely public. It contrasts therefore with Jesus’ ordinary reserve in the performance of his miracles, and with his depreciation of their testimony to his mission. And one significance of the event lies in this indication of his varying method, and of his power to in- clude all the facts in the broad range of his action. e&(cracPar — were amazed) Sso0falew tov @eov—glorified God? cidapev — we saw. e(Sayuev, instead of efdouev, Tisch. Treg. WH. CD. The unusual form determines the probability of this reading. CONSORTING WITH SINNERS 13-17. The call of Levi the tax-gatherer. Jesus answers the charge of consorting with this and other obnoxious classes, many of whom had eaten with him. This is the second cause of offence. ‘The scene changes from the house to the shore of the lake, where Jesus finds Levi, a tax- gatherer, at the customs station. He calls this representative of a despised class into the inner circle of his disciples, and follows this up by entertaining at his house many of the same, and of the class of open sinners generally. Again it is the scribes who attack him for this open association with outcasts. Jesus answers that he is a physician, and his business is with the sick. 13. mapa thv Oaraccav — to the side of the sea. ‘This differs from repirarety rapa, which denotes motion dy ¢he side of, whereas this is motion Zo the side of. wadkw—again.* The only previous event at the lakeside had been the call of the four disciples, 17° sq. The week following, Jesus had gone on a tour through Galilee ; and now, on his return, he resorts to his usual place again. Caper- naum and the shore of the lake were the scenes of his ministry. NPXETO Tpos advTov, kal edidacxey — resorted to him, and he was teaching them. The impfts. here denote the acts in their progress, the gradual gathering of the crowd, and Jesus’ discourse as they came and went.° 1In Greek, é&iornut means fo displace or alter, and sometimes by itself, but generally with dpevav, Or rod dpoverv, to put one beside himself, to derange. Inthe N.T., it is used always in the sense of amaze, or be amazed, except 32! 2 Cor. 5}, where the stronger meaning, ¢o de distraught, reappears. 2 Sogagerv Means properly fo think, to have an opinion. To praise, or glorify, is the only N.T. use. 3 cidamer is sec, aor., With the vowel of the first aor. 4 See note on Mk.’s use of madupv, v.1 5 Note the difference from the aor. é7A@e which denotes the momentary past act. 1 24, 15] CONSORTING WITH SINNERS 41 14. Aevely tov rod "AAdaiov— Levi, the son of Alpheus. So Lk. 5”. In Mt. 9%, however, where the same event is told in almost identical language, Ma@@atov, Matthew is substituted for Levi. The two are to be identified, therefore, as different names of the same person. Alpheus is also the name of the father of James the less. But as Mat- thew and James are not associated in any list of the apostles, there is no sufficient reason for identifying this Alphzeus with the other. émt TO TeAwviov, Not 7” the toll-house, but near it. See Thay.- Grm. Zex. reAdvov denotes the place in which the customs were collected. It is a late Greek word. “AxoAovOer po. — follow me. This is the common language of Jesus in summoning disciples to personal attendance on himself, which is evidently the meaning here. The apparent abruptness of the call, and the immediate- ness with which it is answered, are relieved of their strangeness by the fact that Jesus had now been teaching long enough to call the attention of men to himself, so that the summons probably brought to a crisis and decision thoughts already in Levi’s mind. 15. Kai yiverat xataxetoba.— And tt comes to pass that he ts reclining (at table). ylverat instead of éyévero, Tisch. Treg. WH. 8 BL 33. Omit év ro before xaraxeio@a.— Tisch. Treg. WH. RV.s BL 13, 33, 69, 102, 124, Memph. KaraxeloOat airov év Ty oikia atrov — he was reclining at table in his house. Meyer, Holtzmann, and others say that this was the house of Jesus. This is contrary to the statement of Lk., who says expressly that Levi made him a great feast at his house. But the recurrence of the pronoun airov ... avrod makes it reasonably certain that they refer to the same person. Mt. does not insert any pronoun after v7 oixiéa, and that makes his language point in the same direction. And the fact that Mt. and Mk. use different language, which nevertheless points to the same conclusion, makes that conclusion doubly certain. The connection between this event and the call of Levi is thus simply that both show Jesus’ revolutionary attitude towards the despised classes of his time. TeX Gvat — tax-gatherers. The name pudlicans, given them in our Eng- lish Bible, comes from the Latin pud/icani, but in English it has become practically obsolete in that sense. Moreover, the Latin pudiicant does not apply to the whole class of tax-gatherers, but only to the Roman knights to whom the taxes were farmed out in the first instance. 1 The repetition of the somewhat peculiar émi 7d reAwriov in Mt. and Lk, is a strong sign of the interdependence of the Synoptics. 2 yiverar kataxeia@at, tt comes to pass, that, is a periphrase not unknown to the Greek, but its frequent recurrence in the Synoptics is probably due to Hebrew usage. 42 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [II. 15, 16 dpapTwAoi — sinners; i.¢. here, those guilty of crimes against society and law, the degraded and vicious class.’ cvvavexewto — were reclining at table with? paOnrats — disciples. The common word used to describe the followers of Jesus, corresponding to the title dudacxKaXdos applied to him. It is significant, that the names “eacher and pupil are chosen by Jesus and the disciples to describe the relations between them. It is probable, according to the best text, that the last two clauses of this verse are to be separated, so that the verse ends with modAoi.” The statement is, that there were many of this class of open sinners. It does not denote the number present, which would be superfluous, but the number of the class. Holtzmann calls attention to the situation of Capernaum on the borders of the territory of Herod as the cause of the number of tax-gatherers, as this made it an important customs station. ot ypap. tov Papic. — the Scribes of the Pharisees. The Pharisees were the sect that adhered not only to the Law, but to the rabbinical interpretation of the Law, which gradually formed a traditional code by the side of the written Law. Their scribes, therefore, would be the rabbis of the party that specially believed in the rabbis. Morison is right in calling them the arch-inquisitors, the genus inquisitor being the Pharisees. In the N.T., the use of ua@nral is confined to the Gospels and Acts. In the Gospels, it is applied to the twelve, who formed the inner circle of disciples, as well as the larger group outside. In the Acts, it is the general name for Christians, the official title 2fostles being given to the twelve. AxodovOouy instead of 7Kodovdncay, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BL mss. of Lat. Vet. Vulg. 16. Kat jxodovOovy atta Kai (ot) ypappare’s Tov Papicaiwv, Kat idovres Ste é€oOlce (HoOtev) pera TOv apapTwAdy Kai TeAwvar, EdEyov Tois paOnrais avrod, Tu pera TOV TeAWVOY Kal GuapTwArdv écBie; (Kal nive.) — And there followed him also (the) Scribes of the Pharisees, and having seen that he eats with the sinners and tax-gatherers, they said to his disciples, Why does he eat (and drink) with the tax-gatherers and sinners ? kal Ypaupatets Tov Papicalwy, cal iddvres, instead of kai of ypauparets kai of Papicaio, iddvres, Tisch. 8 BL A 33. T&v Papicalwy is the reading also of Treg. WH. RV. ¢xz._ Insert kat before idévres also Treg. dre eo Gia, instead of avrév écOlovra, WH. RV. B 33, mss. of Lat. Vet. Pesh. Memph. some edd. 8 obey Tisch. Treg. s DL mss. of Lat. Vet. Memph. edd. Harcl. dyuaprw@v kal TreAXwvay, instead of the reverse order, Treg. WH. RV. BDL 33, mss. of Lat. Vet. and of Vulg., Memph. edd. Omit ri before 1 The word auaprwaoi is rare in Greek writers. 2The double compound ovvavéxewro is found, outside of Biblical Greek, only in Byzantine and ecclesiastical writers. dvaxetua itself belongs to later Greek, the earlier writers using xetwac and xataxeiwar. See Thay.-Grm. Lex. 3 The insertion of cai before iddvres in v.16 makes it necessary to connect joe AovOovy with édcyor, instead of with joav. II. 16, 17] CONSORTING WITH SINNERS 43 ére Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. BL 33, 102, 108, 246.* Omit kat mlvec (Treg. marg.) WH. RV. marg. s BD mss. of Lat. Vet. etc. éru. . . €oOiar (kal miver) — why does he eat (and drink) ...?) This charge of eating with tax-gatherers and sinners was fitted to discredit Jesus’ claim to be a rabbi, or teacher. For the Scribes and their followers would not even associate with the common people for fear of ceremonial defilement; much less with the vicious class, to eat with whom was an especial abomination. The tax- gatherers were classed with sinners, that is, with the vile and degraded, not only by the Jews, but all over the Roman Empire. The secret of this was, that the taxes were collected, not by the paid agents of the government, but by officers who themselves paid the government for the privilege, and then reimbursed them- selves by extortion and fraud. They let it out to others, and these to still a third class, who were selected generally from the inhabi- tants of the province, because their knowledge of the people would expedite the work. This last is the class called reAGvat in N.T., and the unpatriotic nature of their employment was added to its extortionate methods, placing them under a double ban. 17. of icxvovres — they that are strong. EV. whole. The con- trast expressed figuratively by s¢vong and sick is given literally in the latter part of the verse in the terms vighteous and sinners. Jesus justifies his conduct in associating with sinners, from the point of view of the Pharisees themselves. Admitting them to be righteous and the publicans to be sinners, his office of physi- cian put him under obligation to the sick rather than the strong. But he shows elsewhere that he does not admit this distinction. The Pharisees were extortionate as well as the publicans; they devoured widows’ houses ; but they added to their wickedness by assuming a cloak of respectability, and thanking God that they were not as other men. The publicans, on the other hand, had the grace of honesty, and by their acknowledgment of sin, ful- filled the first condition of cure. GAA apaptwrovs — but sinners. Omit eis perdvowav, unto repentance, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 ABDKL mss. of Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Pesh. Harcl. etc. This omission leaves xadéoat to be explained. It means “ invite or summon; but to what? The answer is to be found by following out the terms of the figure. As a physician, Jesus sum- mons sick souls to be cured. Or, dropping this figure, as a Saviour, he summons sinners to be saved. Owing to the blind- ness of men, the ordinary relation between them is reversed. Instead of the sick summoning the physician, it is here the physi- cian who has to call the sick. 1 $7 is here the indirect interrogative, taking the place of the direct,a usage unknown to earlier Greek, but occurring a few times in the Sept. and N. T 44 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [1I. 18 NONCONFORMITY IN MATTER OF FASTING 18-22. Jesus answers the complaint of the Pharisees and of the disciples of John that his disciples do not fast. The third ground of complaint is the failure of the disciples, under the influence of the free spirit of Jesus, to observe the fre- quent fasts prescribed by the Pharisees as a part of their formal- ism, and by the disciples of John as a part of their asceticism. Jesus’ answer is divided into two parts. The first shows the incongruousness of fasting at a time when joy, and not sorrow, was the ruling feeling of the disciples, v.*”. The second shows the incongruousness of such observances as fasting with the new dispensation set up by our Lord. It is the incongruity of new and old. 18. of pabytai rod Iwavvov kal ot Papioator — the disciples of John and the Pharisees. of Papicato, instead of r&v Papicatwy, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABCD mss. of Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Harcl. Zz. etc. Yoav vnorevovtes — were fasting. Fasting, as a religious observ- ance, was prescribed in the Law only once in the year, on the great day of atonement. But the traditional code of the rabbis had multiplied this indefinitely. ‘Twice in the week was the boast of the Pharisee. And the importance attached to this empty piece of religiosity made it a part of the formal religion of the period. «ai épyovrar—and they come, viz. the disciples of John and the Pharisees. Mt. g!t names only the former. Lk. 5 makes this a part of the pre- ceding controversy with the Pharisees and Scribes, in which they call atten- tion to the practice of the disciples of John and of the Pharisees. of pabytal tov Bapicaiwy — the disciples of the Pharisees. Insert padnrai before rv apicalwy Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. RV. & BC* L 33, mss. of Lat. Vet. Harcl. marg. The disciples of the Pharisees is a singular expression, much as if one should speak of the disciples of the Platonists. The Phari- sees were themselves disciples of the Scribes, or Rabbis. ‘The dis- ciples of John and of the Pharisees were at one in regard to the 1 sy with the part. is a stronger form of expressing the idea of the impf. than the tense, It is characteristic of Mk., and belongs to the picturesqueness of his style, IT. 18-21 | NONCONFORMITY IN MATTER OF FASTING 45 act of fasting, but not in the spirit of the act. The Pharisees fasted in a formal, self-righteous spirit, and the teaching of John was directed against this spirit. So far as the fasting of his dis- ciples reflected the teaching of John and his spirit, it would be a part of the asceticism, the mortification of the body, characteristic of him. 19. viol r. vupdavos'—sons of the bridechamber. A Hebra- istic form of expression by which vios, with the genitive of a thing, denotes a person who stands in intimate relation of some kind to that thing. The sons of the bridechamber were friends of the bridegroom, whose duty it was to provide for the nuptials what- ever was necessary. The principle contained in this analogy is that fasting is not a matter of prescription, but of fitness. If you set times for fasting, the circumstances of the set time may be such as to produce joy, instead of sorrow, and so make your fast- ing out of place. Fasting, z.¢., is an expression of feeling, and is out of place unless the feeling is there which it is intended to express. But it is a matter, not only of feeling, but of fitness. If the circumstances of the time are such as to make sorrow the fit feeling, then it is a fit time for fasting also. od dWwavtTa vnorevev — they cannot fast. This is said, of course, not of the outward act, which is possible at any time ; but of fasting in the only sense in which it becomes a religious act, or the expression of the feel- ing to which it is appropriated. It is as much as to say, in a time of gladness it is impossible to mourn. 20. arap0y dr airay 6 vuudios —It is evident here that Jesus, still keeping to the figure, points forward to the time when he shall be taken away from the disciples, and then, he declares, will be the time for them to fast. This is the first time that he has prophesied of his taking away, but we can see that even as a pre- monition it is not premature, because of the revolutionary charac- ter of his teaching. He had already brought on himself the charge of blasphemy, consorted with publicans, one of whom he had intro- duced into the immediate circle of his disciples, and shown his indifference to the strict law of fasting. And he knew that there was much more of the same kind in reserve. orav— whenever. The expression leaves the time of the taking away indefinite. év €xeivn TH NuEepa—in that day. Days and that day in this verse are simply a case of oratio variata, both denoting in a general way a period of time. év éxelvy TH Nuéepa instead of the plural, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 ABCD KL mss. of Lat. Vet. Pesh. Harcl. etc. {2 21. ovdcis éxiBAnpa paxous dyvadov éripamrret ert iwarvov madatov * H de , if b , 2 CT age | \ A A ei O€ p17), alpet TO TWANPwUG ar avTOv TO Kalvov TOV maAalov— NO One 1 yuugwv is a Biblical word. 46 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [II. 21, 22 sews a patch of undressed cloth on an old garment, otherwise the new filling of the old takes from tt. Omit cat before ovels Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABCKLS A 1. 13, 33, 69, mss. of Lat. Vet. Memph. Vulg. Pesh. Harcl. etc. iudriovy madaidy, instead of dat., Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL 33. dm’ avrod, instead of avrod, Tisch. WH. RV. 8 BL, also A 33. The RV. translates else that which should fill it up taketh from it, the new from the old. But this seems to require a repetition of the prep. awd before rod wadaov. 7d Katvoy Tov waAatov is in apposition with 76 zAnpwpa, so that it would read literally, he fl/- ing takes from it, the new of the old. ‘The substitution of unfulled for new is necessary to make the parable an exact fit. It is the shrinking of the undressed cloth that strains and tears the old cloth to which it is sewed. 22. Kal ovdels BddXeL olvov vedov eis agKovs madaos* ei SE py, pyget 6 olvos Tovs doKors, Kal 6 olvos droAAvTat Kal ol doKoi — and no one puts new wine into old skins ; else the wine will burst the skins, and the wine ts destroyed, and the skins. phger instead of pjoce, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL 33, mss. of Lat, Vet. Vulg. Omit 6 veds after 6 oivos, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BC* DL 13, 69, 242, 258, 301, mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Pesh. etc. dwéAduTat, Kal oi doxol, instead of éxxetrat, kal of doxol dmroNodvra, after 6 oivos, Tisch.. Treg. WH. RV. BL. 102 Memph. Omit the clause ad\\a . . . BAnréov Tisch. (Treg. WH.) D mss. of Lat. Vet. Omit BdAnréov only (Treg.) WH. RV. x B 102. The omission is more in Mk.’s manner, and it looks as if the clause was borrowed from Lk., where it is undoubted. The substitution of skins for dottles, AV., is necessary to make the parable tell its story. The skins rot with age, and the new wine, as it ferments, bursts them. These analogies, among the homeliest and aptest used by our Lord, are a further answer to the question why his disciples do not fast. For this is evidently the part of the question which it is intended that he should answer, not why the disciples of John do fast. Nor is it simply a repetition of the preceding, showing the incongruity of fasting at this time under another figure.’ But it generalizes, showing the incongruity of the class of things with which fasting belongs with the new life of Christianity. The gen- eral teaching is that the new teachings and the old forms do not belong together. But this is expressed in the two parables in dif- ferent ways. In the first, it is the unfitness of piecing out the old religion with the new, like anew patch on an old garment. In the 1 So Weiss. 2 So Morison. II. 22-28 | ALLEGED VIOLATION OF THE SABBATH 47 second, it is the unwisdom of putting the new religion into the old forms. The whole is an anticipation of St. Paul’s teaching that Christianity is not a mere extension of Judaism, and that Jewish laws are not binding upon Christians. Dr. Morison sees in the figures employed by Jesus only an expression of the incongruity of fasting at a time better adapted to feasting. But this would be simply a repetition of the preceding teaching contained in the figure of the wedding, and not so apt an expression of it either. The principle of this interpretation is a good one, that it is well to seek in each parable the single point of comparison, and there stop. Here the single idea is that of incongruity. But surely the figure of the wedding has brought out not simply the idea of incongruity, but the special unfitness of this particular act. And it is no violation, therefore, of the rule of interpretation to make these other comparisons not merely suggest the general idea of incongruity, but show also the special incongruity involved. In the figure of the wedding, it is the incongruity of fasting and joy that is pointed out ; in these figures, it is the incongruity of new and old. The old religion attempted to regulate conduct by rules and forms, the new by principles and motives, and these are foreign, the one to the other. It is not fasting to which objec- tion is taken,.but fasting according to rule, instead of its inherent principle. As a piece of legalism, or asceticism, in which fasting per se becomes of moral obligation, it is incongruous with the free spirit of Christianity. ALLEGED VIOLATION OF THE SABBATH 23-28. Jesus defends his disciples for plucking ears of grain on the Sabbath. The fourth ground of complaint is the violation of the law of the Sabbath. Jesus and his disciples are going through the grain- fields on the Sabbath, and the disciples, careless of the strict Sab- batism of the Pharisees, pluck the ears of grain and eat them. Evidently there was the usual crowd following him, and the Phar- isees attack this act as unlawful. In the first part of his reply, . Jesus argues from an analogous case the admissibility of infringing the law to satisfy hunger. In the second part, he shows the nature 48 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [1x. 23-25 of the law itself, that it is the servant of man, and not man the ser- vant of the law, involving the lordship of the Son of Man over the law. 23. omopinwv —sown fields. npkavto dddov moveiv tiAXovTEs — began, as they went, to pluck, EV. ‘This is the translation natu- rally suggested by the context, as it prepares the way for Jesus’ explanation of their conduct by the parallel case of David. But the phrase 6d0v zovety does not mean fo make way in the sense of merely going along or advancing, but to make a road. ‘The middle, however, has the former sense. Moreover, this translation makes the participle, instead of the verb, express the principal thought. On the other hand, the translation, 70 make a road by plucking the ears, besides making Jesus’ answer quite unintelligible, presents an absurd way of making a road. You can make a path by plucking the stalks of grain, but you would make little headway, if you picked only the ears or heads of the grain. ‘There are two ways of explaining this. We can take 6dov zovety in its proper sense, but make the participle denote merely concomitant action, not the means or method. They began to break a path (by tread- ing down or plucking up the stalks of grain that obstructed their path), meanwhile plucking and eating the ears that grew on them. Or we can minimize the difficulties in the way of the ordinary interpretation, without doing much violence to the laws of speech. Surely, in a language so careless of nice distinctions as the N.T. Greek, it is not difficult to suppose that an active may be substi- tuted for the middle. And there seems to be no doubt that the active is used in this sense in Judg. 17:8. And as for making the principal and subordinate clauses exchange places, in this case the peculiarity is not so great. TZhey began to go along, plucking the ears is not so very different from they began, going along, to pluck. 24. 0 ovx eeatt.— what is not lawful. The Sabbath law is meant, which forbids work on that day. The casuistry of the rabbinical interpreter found here its most fruitful field in drawing the line between work and not-work, and managed to get in its most ingenious and absurd refinements. But the great difficulty, as with all their work, is that they managed so to miss the very spirit and object of the law, that they made its observance largely a burden, instead of a privilege. Whenever they speak of that which is lawful, or unlawful, their standard is not simply the writ- ten law, but this traditional interpretation of it. In the same way, we can conceive of men now accepting the Bible as their stand- ard, and yet admitting to an equal authority an interpretation of it contained in creed or confession, and really referring to this when they use the terms, Azdécal or undibiical. 25. Kai Neyer — And he says. II. 26] | ALLEGED VIOLATION OF THE SABBATH 49 Omit a’rés Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL 33, 69, mss. of Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. etc. éye, says, instead of €devev, said, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 CL 33, 69, mss. of Lat. Vet. Memph. etc. 26. oixov tov cov — the house of God is a generic term that would apply either to the tent or tabernacle in which the Jews at first worshipped, or to the later temple. Here, of course, the former. It was called the house of God, because in a sense God dwelt there, manifesting his presence in the inner shrine, the Holy of Holies. eri “ABidbap dpxtepews — in the high-priesthood of Abiathar. Omit rod before dpxtepéws Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. RV. 8 BLT etc. In the account of this in 1 Saml. 211, sqq., Abimelech was high-priest, and Abiathar, his son, does not become high-priest aut the reign of David. See .ch. 22". To be sure, other passages in the O.T. make the same confusion of names, making Abimelech, the son of Abiathar, high-priest in David’s time. But this does not explain our difficulty ; it only shows that there is the same difficulty in the O.T. account. Nor does it relieve it to suppose that this means simply that the event took place during . the lifetime of Abiathar, not during the high-priesthood. For the transaction took place between David and the high-priest, and the object of introducing the name would be to show in whose high- priesthood it took place, not simply in whose lifetime. The impro- priety would be the same as if one were to speak of something that took place between the Bishop of Durham and some other person in the time of Bishop Westcott, when, as a matter of fact, Lightfoot was bishop, and it was only during the lifetime of Bishop Westcott. And the phrase itself means strictly, during the high- priesthood of Abiathar. If such disagreement were uncommon, it would be worth while to try somewhat anxiously to remove this difficulty ; but, as a matter of fact, discrepancies of this unimpor- tant kind are not at all uncommon in the Scriptures. Tovs aptouvs THs mpobecews — the bread of setting forth. It isa translation of the Hebrew, oxen an dread of the face, or pres- ence, given to twelve loaves of bread set in two rows on the table in the holy place of the tabernacle, or temple, and renewed by the priests every Sabbath. S. Lev. 24°°. The Greek name, taken from the Sept., denotes the dread set forth before God. The Hebrew name, about which there has been naturally much curi- ous writing, seems to mean that the bread, in some way, symbol- ized God’s presence. rods tepeis — the priests. -Tovs iepets, instead of rots lepedor, Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. BL. Tovs iepets is the subject of dayeiv. The priests were allowed to eat the bread after it had been replaced by fresh loaves. In this case, there was no other bread, and when David and his hun- E 50 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [1I. 26-28 gry men appeared, it became a case of physical need against rit- ual law. Jesus cites it as a case decided by a competent authority and accepted by the people, showing the superiority of natural law to positive enactment, the same principle involved in the alleged illegal action of his disciples. And he evidently upholds the correctness of the principle, and not simply the authority of this precedent. 27. 70 caBBarov dia Tov avOpwrov — the Sabbath was made on account of man, not man on account of the Sabbath. This is introduced to show the supremacy of man over the Sabbath. The statement that the Son of Man is Lord of the Sabbath follows directly from this. If the law antedates man, having its seat in God, as the moral law does, it becomes a part of the moral con- stitution of things, resident in God, to which man is subservient. But if it is something devised by God for the uses of man, then the subserviency belongs to the law, and man can adapt it to his uses, and set it aside, or modify it, whenever it interferes with his good. The law of the Sabbath, if not moral, is either natural or positive. Regarded as natural law, the principle involved is that of rest, and this places it in the same category as the law of day and night. As positive, it is a matter simply of enactment, and not of principle. And in both aspects it is liable to exceptions. It is only moral law which is lord of man, and so inviolable. 28. xvptos —the noun is emphatic from its position. kat rod caf Barov— also of the Sabbath, as well as of other things belong- ing to the life of man. ‘This lordship, as we have seen, is true of everything else except moral law. Of that he would be adminis- trator and interpreter, but not Lord. He would be ruler under the supreme law, but without the power to modify or set aside, as in the case of that which is made for man. Weiss, Life of Jesus, contends that Jesus did not here, nor in fact any- where, assume an attitude of independence towards the Jewish Law, but only towards the current traditional interpretation of it. But surely, the statement that the Sabbath was made for man, not man for the Sabbath, puts the Sabbath law in a separate class, and subordinates it to the moral law. Whereas, the O.T. throughout, not only makes the Sabbath a matter of moral obligation, but of the highest moral obligation. Judaism is a system of rules, Christianity of principles. And so far forth as the Sabbath is a rule, that is, so far as it is Jewish, Jesus does abrogate it in these words. Weiss confuses matters by neglecting this distinction. This early statement of Jesus’ lordship, and its use of the term Son of Man as his official title, is a good specimen of the way in which he tacitly assumed his Messianic character under this title, while the doubt in which the whole nation stood of his claim shows that he was not understood to make it formally. ITI. 1-6 | ALLEGED VIOLATION OF THE SABBATH 51 THE PERIOD OF CONFLICT CONTINUED The third chapter continues the account of the Period of Con- flict. It contains matter, however, which belongs to the period, but not to the conflict. It shows us Jesus attended by larger crowds than ever, drawn by the report of his deeds from the whole country, as far south as Jerusalem, and as far north as Tyre and Sidon. The growth of hostility against him is thus shown to be accompanied by an access of popularity with the people. The combination of these two features seems to his family to make the situation so dangerous, and his own action so unwise, that they think him distraught and seek to restrain him. In the midst of this is introduced the account of the appointment of the apostles, evidently in the connection, as assistants to him in, his increasing work. ‘The occasions of conflict are, first, the heal- ing of a man with a palsied arm on the Sabbath, causing a renewal of the Sabbath controversy, and secondly, the charge of the Scribes that he casts out demons through Beelzebul, and that he himself | is possessed by that prince of the demons. He himself brings on! the controversy about the Sabbath by his question whether the Sabbath is a day for good or evil deeds, for killing or healing. And the charge of collusion with the devil he meets with the ques- | tion whether Satan casts out Satan. | HEALING ON THE SABBATH 1-6. Jesus heals a withered hand in the synagogue on the Sabbath, and stirs up fresh opposition against himself. The fifth offence of Jesus against the current Judaism is a case of healing on the Sabbath. It belongs evidently to a period when the freedom of Jesus’ treatment of this sacred day had created considerable notoriety, for his enemies are on the watch for him to give them a fresh charge against him. The scene is the synagogue, and the case is that of a man with a withered hand. Jesus himself is the challenger this time, as he calls the man out into their midst, and meets their scruple with the question, whether it is allowable to confer the good of healing, or to inflict the injury of refusing to heal. - 52 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [1II. 14 1. wdAw eis cvvaywynv — again into the synagogue.’ Omit rHv before cuvaywyyv Tisch. Treg. (Treg.) WH. 8 B102. The art. is an apparent emendation. The wdAw, again, keeps up the connection with preceding visits to the synagogue, after the manner of Mk. See 17. é£npappe- vnv tHv xeipa — the hand withered. ‘The article is the possessive article. The participle, éfypayppevny instead of the adjective, denotes a process, and not simply a state, and hence, an effect produced by disease, and not an original defect. 2. wapetnpovy — they were watching. ‘The imperfect denotes the act in its progress. There is no subject expressed here, but it is easily supplied from our knowledge of the class who insisted on these rigors of Sabbath observance. And v.° tells us that it was the Pharisees who went out and conspired with the Herodians against him. 3. THY Xetpa Exovre Enpdv (or Thy Enpav xetpa Exovre Tisch. ), Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BCL A 33, 102, one ms. of Lat. Vet. Memph. Harcl. etc. 3. “Eyeupe® eis 76 peoov — Arise (and come) into the midst. *Eyeipe instead of “Evyecpa:, Tisch. Treg. WH. s ABCDL A etc. This is a pregnant construction. The action begins with éyepe and ends with eis ro pécov; but between these, there is an inter- mediate act, of coming or stepping. By this act, Jesus challenged the attention of the carpers to the miracle that he is about to per- form. Not as a miracle, however, but as a case involving the principle in dispute between himself and them in regard to healing on the Sabbath. 4. "E&eort dyaborojoa *— Ts it allowable to do good? ayabo- moioat, and its contrasted verb xaxoroujoar, may mean to do good or evil, either in the sense of sigh¢ and wrong, or of benefit and injury. ‘The connection here points to the latter meaning. Mt. says that the Pharisees began by asking him if it was lawful to heal on the Sabbath; Lk., that he knew their thoughts, and so asked them the question about doing good and evil. Both are attempts to explain the apparent abruptness of Jesus’ question. This question of Jesus not only suggests the general principle that makes healing permissible on the Sabbath, but is aimed 1 The omission of the art. is probably due to the fact that cis cvvaywyjv had passed into a phrase, like cis otcov, or our ¢o church. 2 Lk. 66 says the right hand. Dr. Morison contends that this is the reason for the use of the art. But evidently, the art. is insufficient for this discrimination, as the other use, allowing it to apply to either hand, is so much more obvious. 3 On the use of éyecpe, see on 211, 4 ayaOororjoa is a Biblical word. evepyerety is the Greek word, or ed morein caxorocecy iS a good Greek word. III. 4, 5| ALLEGED VIOLATION OF THE SABBATH 53 directly at the specious distinction made by the Scribes. They admitted no healing, except where life was in danger, on that day. The point of Jesus’ answer is found in the substitution of the posi- tive for the negative in the second part of the contrast. ‘They regarded the ot healing as simply an omission of dyaboroqoat ; Jesus treats it as a positive xaxororyoat. Not to do good toa per- son needing it is the same as to do him evil; to withhold a good is to inflict an injury. But he deals more directly and boldly with their fallacy in the second part of the question, showing that not to heal is in any case to be classed with killing. The case in which life is in danger is not therefore a case by itself, but includes in itself a principle applicable to all cases of sickness. To weaken life is not the same thing in degree as to end life, but of the same kind notwithstanding, and therefore morally in the same class. The principle is analogous to that stated in the Sermon on the Mount, where Jesus shows that the law against murder is directed equally against any manifestation of anger. In all these discus- sions, beginning with 2”, Jesus appears as the emancipator of | the human spirit, revealing principles, instead of rules, as the guide of human conduct, and so delivering all men possessed of his spirit from the fetters of conventional morality. 5. éowwmrwv — they kept silence. This is a case in which the imperfect denotes the continuance of a previous state. er’ dpyijs) —Anger is legitimate in the absence of the personal element. | Anger caused by wrong done to me, and seeking to retaliate on \ the person doing it, is clearly wrong. But anger against wrong | simply as wrong, and without evil design or wish against the per- | petrator, is a sign of moral health. ovAAvmrovpevos — The preposi- tion in composition may denote merely the inwardness of the act, as in ovvo.da, to be conscious, t.e. to have inward knowledge ; or it may denote what is shared with others, as the same word civoida may mean 40 know with others, to be privy to. Probably it is the latter here, denoting the sympathetic character of his grief. He was grieved because they hurt themselves. éxi tH twpwoe. ris Kapdias — at the hardness of their heart. The expression does not denote, as with us, the callousness of their feelings, but the unsus-| ceptibility of their minds. They were hardened by previous con-| ceptions against his new truth. The collocation of anger and | sympathetic grief excited by the same act is significant of the’ nature of Christ’s anger, showing how compatible it was with | goodwill. dexareoraOy ' — it was restored. amekaresTa6y instead of adroxarecrdOn, Tisch. Treg. WH. 8 ABL etc. Omit cov after ry xetpa Tisch. (Treg.) WH. marg. BEMSUV I 102, 126, etc. Doubtful. Omit bycys ds 7 &\Ay Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 ABC* D etc. mss. of Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Syrr. etc. 1 On the double augment, see Win. 12, 7 a. 54 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [III. 6, 7 6. «v6is — The immediateness of this act is noted by Mk. only, and is quite characteristic of his style, hitting off a situation with 'aword. The immediateness is here a sign of the violence of the feeling excited against Jesus. To estimate their fanatical zeal, we must remember that they valued the Sabbath far beyond any mere \ morality, and reacted with corresponding violence against any sup- posed violation of its sacredness. Fanaticism is always busy and eager over the mere outworks of religion. tov “Hpwdiavav— the Herodians. The adherents of Herod Antipas, tetrarch of Galilee. ‘The Pharisees were zealous patriots, and as such were generally opposed to any foreign yoke. But here was an opportunity to use the foreign power against a com- mon enemy. The common opinion ascribed Messianic preten- sions to Jesus, and on more than one occasion attempted to force him to play the role according to the popular conception of the Messiah. ‘This would be the argument by which the Pharisees excited the temporal power against him, as they did finally at Jerusalem. The preceding paragraphs have given us a view of Jesus in his work of undermining one after another of the Phari- saic positions, and this conspiracy is the natural result. ovpBovALov éroinoav (or édidovv) '— they took counsel. érrolnoay, instead of érolovy, Tisch. 8 C A 238 etc. édldovv, Treg. WH. BL 13, 28, 69, etc. GROWTH OF POPULARITY 7-12. Jesus departs to the sea of Galilee, followed by a great multitude. The narrative of opposition is interrupted here, and we are introduced to a scene of another kind. The multitude about Jesus heretofore has been from Galilee, with a sprinkling of hos- tile Scribes and Pharisees (from Jerusalem?). But now we see it swelled by people from Judzea, and from the Gentile districts both north and south. It is an eager crowd, moreover, who fall upon him and threaten to crush him in their attempt to obtain his heal- ing touch, so that Jesus has to procure a boat to be in attendance on him. The meaning of it all is, that the period of conflict does not signify a loss of popularity, but rather that the great access of favor with the people swells the tide of opposition. 7. dvexopnoev — withdrew. ‘The verb is used of such retire- ment from public view as would be natural in such a position of 1 guuBovAvov belongs to later Greek. III. 7-10] GROWTH OF POPULARITY 55 danger as Jesus found himself in. . Mt. uses the same verb, 12”. It does not seem probable, in these circumstances, that he would choose the part of the lake near to Capernaum which was the scene of his usual work, because it was a place of resort. ‘This time, he was seeking retirement, and he would find it in some more secluded part of the lake. 8. The last clause of v.’ should be included in this verse. As it stands in the T.R., the first statement, with 7KxoAovOyncev as its verb, goes as far as zépav tov ‘lopddvov ; the second, with 7A@ov as its verb, begins with of wept Tupov. But with the omission of ot before zrepi Tvpov, we can make the break where we please. Tisch. makes it at the end of v.’, transferring 7xoAov0ynoev to the end of the verse. But this separates Judzea and Jerusalem in an unwar- rantable way. Most probably, the first statement is about Galilee, the district near at hand, and the second includes all the remote districts beginning with Judza. Those from the neighboring Galilee are represented as following him, and those from the remote districts as coming to him. Read, And a great mulitude JSrom Galilee followed. And from Judea, and from Jerusalem, and from Idumea, and beyond Jordan, and about Tyre and Sidon, a great multitude, hearing what things he ts doing, came to him. AxodovOnoev, instead of AKodovdncay, Treg. WH. ABGLT etc. mss. of Lat. Vet. Vulg. #xoAov@noay Tisch. 8 CEFK etc. mss. of Lat. Vet. This verb is transferred to the end of v. 7 after rs "Iovdalas by Tisch. WH. marg.x C A 238 Lat. Vet. Vulg. Placed after 77s TadcAalias by Treg. ABL T etc. Memph. Syrr. After ‘Iepoco\vuwv by WH. 235, 271. The separation of Judzea and Jerusalem caused by the transfer is clearly against it. Omit at7@ after qKodov@noev Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. » BCL Memph. etc. Omit of before rept T¥pov Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x*2"4 ¢ BCL A mss. of Lat. Vet. Pesh. etc. dxovovres instead of dxovcavres Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s B A 1, 13, 69, etc. mss. of Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. srocet, instead of érole, Treg. WH. BL. Internally probable. Idumza is the Greek name for Edom, a district situated E. of the Jordan, between Southern Palestine and Arabia. Tyre and Sidon were the two great cities of Syro-Phcenicia on the Mediter- ranean Sea, NW. of Galilee. 9. ere—he told, i.e. he gave orders. mpooxaptepy — should be in constant attendance. ‘The verb expresses this idea of assidu- ous waiting. It was rendered necessary by the crowd, which was in danger of crushing him. 10. wore émirinrew aitdé —so that they were falling upon him. Not in a hostile sense, but the verb is a strong word, like zpoo- Kaptepy and @AéBwour, and is intended to bring before us vividly the turbulent eagerness and excitement of the crowd. dpwvrar — touch him. They believed that there was some virtue in his touch, and that it made no difference whether he touched them, or they him. See 6". pdorvyas — scourges, a strong figurative term for diseases. 56 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [III. 11-14 Ll. ra rvevpara ra axabapta — The unclean spirits are here put by metonymy for the men possessed by them, because the action is directed by them. drav €Oedpovv'— whenever they beheld him. EOewpovv, mpocémimrov, . . . Expatov, instead of the singular, Tisch. Treg. WH. x ABCDL etc. Aéyovres, instead of Aéyorra, Tisch. WH. marg. * DK 61, 69 etc. mpocemirrov Kal éxpalov — would fall down before him and cry out. The impf. denotes repeated action. “Ore od*—6 vids Tov @cov — the Son of God. This title was a Messianic title, denoting theocratic sonship, and there is nothing here to indicate that it is used in any other than this common sense. The onus probandi is not on those who deny the use of the term in the Synoptical Gospels, of metaphysical sonship, but on those who claim this use. Unless it was accompanied by language pointing out the meta- physical sonship, no Jew would have understood it. APPOINTMENT OF THE TWELVE 13-19. Jesus goes up into the mountain, and chooses the twelve. The appointment of the twelve is put in different connections in the Synoptics. But in them all, the connection is such as to point to the growth of our Lord’s work as the occasion of the appointment. They are to aid him in his work of proclaiming the kingdom, and of healing. But after all, the other purpose named, the association with himself, is the one most in evidence in the subsequent history. 13. 16 dpos — the mountain, t.e. the one in the neighborhood. ovs 4Oedkev aitis— whom he himself wished. The pronoun is emphatic, the form of the verb being enough to indicate the per- son. Those who came to Jesus at this time came not of their own accord, but in accordance with his desire. 14. éroince Swdexa —he appointed twelve. This use of the verb comes under the head of making one something, — king or priest, for instance. Only here, that to which they were appointed is expressed, not as an office, but as the purpose of the appoint- ment. ‘This purpose is expressed under two heads, the first being 1 Srav é0ewpovy is a rare construction. Generally, éray is used with conditions belonging to the future, or with general conditions belonging to any time, and is construed with the subjunctive. The indefiniteness in the time of past conditions expressed in our -ever is denoted by -more. 2 On this use of é7: to introduce direct quotation, see on 114, III. 14-17] | APPOINTMENT OF THE TWELVE 57 association with himself, and the second, to act as his messengers in the work of proclaiming the good news of the kingdom and of healing the sick. Apparently, the former was the only one fully carried out during our Lord’s life, the second becoming their work when they were made necessarily independent of him by his death. And in accordance with this, the name generally given in the Gospels is dscip/es, and afterward, in the Acts and Epistles, they are called apostles. ovs kal droorbdous avduaser, whom he also named aposiles, is inserted after érolnce Swiexa by WH. RV. marg. x BC* A 13, 28, 69, 124, 238, 346, Memph. Harcl. marg. Tisch. thinks it has been copied from Lk. 61%, But on the whole, considering the strength of the testimony for it, it seems at least equally possible that Lk. found it in the original Mk. knpvocew — to herald, or here, where it is used absolutely, 7 act as heralds. The word conveys the idea of authority, a herald being an official who makes public proclamation of weighty affairs. The proclamation which they were to make was the com- ing of the kingdom of God. 15. éyew éfovoiav éxBddrrAav — to have power to cast out. This is in the same construction as xypvcoeyv, and denotes one of the objects of sending them forth. Omit Oeparevery ras vdcous, kal, to heal diseases, and, Tisch. Treg. (Treg. marg.) WH. RV. 8 BC* L A 102 Memph. With this omission, the casting out of demons is taken as the representative miracle. So frequently.’ 16. Kai éreOnke. Kai érolncev rovs Swiexa, and he appointed the twelve, is inserted before kat éré@nxe by Tisch. WH. RV. marg. 8 BC* A. kai éréOyxe interrupts the structure of the sentence, which is resumed in the next verse. The names that follow are in apposi- tion with rovs dwdexa in the inserted clause, and the enumeration is interrupted to give the descriptive names assigned to some of them by Jesus. Ilérpov — eter. Mt. gives the only explanation of this name given to Simon, in ch. 16:18. But neither in this passage nor in that, is there any definite indication that it was at either time that the name was given him. J. 1%, however, assigns the giving of the name to a time much earlier than either, immediately after the Baptism. Ilérpoy means a rock. The masculine form, instead of Ilérpa, is due to its being appropriated as the name of a man. 17. xai ‘IdxwBov— This resumes the structure of v.", as if v." read Sipwva & éereOnxe. Boavepyés. This is a modified form of the Heb. B35. BIT properly means ¢/umu/t or uproar, of any kind, and thunder, as a 1 See on 189, 58 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [III. 17, 18 secondary meaning, is not improbable, though we have no example of it in Hebrew literature. ‘The name probably describes a fiery, vehement temperament, rather than a thunderous eloquence, or a sonorous speech. The little that is told us about the disciples makes it impossible to follow out these hints about their character and temperament. These four, Peter, James and John, and Andrew, always stand first in these lists of the twelve, and among them, Peter is always first. Mt. calls him zp@ros. But Mt. and Lk. put Andrew into the second place, evidently to associate him with his brother. Mk.’s order is the order of their rank, Peter, James, and John being the three disciples chosen by Jesus to attend him on special occasions, e.g. the Transfiguration, the rais- ing of the daughter of Jairus, and the scene in the garden of Gethsemane. 18. ®{/\urrov — Philip heads the second group in all the Gos- pels, as Peter the first. The name is a Greek name. We hear nothing more about him in the Synoptics, though he is mentioned several times in the fourth Gospel. Baporonatov — This name does not occur in the Gospels out- side of these lists, and elsewhere only in Acts 1%. And in the passage in Acts, Bartholomew’s name is associated, as it is here, with those of Philip and Thomas. In the fourth Gospel, on the other hand, we find that Nathanael is associated with Philip and Thomas, as Bartholomew is in the Synoptics and the Acts. In J. 16, Nathanael is the one whom Philip introduces to Jesus, while in J. 21%, Nathanael’s name is associated with Thomas. This, together with the fact that so important a personage as Nathanael appears to be in J. is not mentioned in the list of the twelve, has led to the quite reasonable supposition that the two are to be identified. In that case, Bartholomew, which means Son of Tolmai, would be a patronymic, and Nathanael would be the real name. Ma66atov — On the identification of this disciple with Levi the publican, see on 2. He is not mentioned after this, except in Acts 1%. @wyuav—This disciple, who is a mere name in the Synoptics and the Acts, becomes a personage in the fourth Gos- pel. J. 11% 14° 20%. This group of four is the same anagem three Synoptics, but in Mt., Thomas precedes Matthew. "laxwBov tov tod "AAdatov — This James is probably the same as "laxwBos 6 pixpos, James the little, the son of Mary and Clopas. See 15* 16' J. 19%. The supposition, however, that in this pas- sage from J., Mapia 4 tod KAwza is in apposition with 4 pAjrnp avrov, and that thus the brothers of our Lord were his cousins and included in the list of apostles, is decisively negatived, first, by its giving us two sisters having the same name, Mary ; secondly, by the fact, that in Lk. 2’, Jesus is called the firstborn son of Mary, implying that there were other sons; thirdly, by Acts 1™, III. 18, 19} APPOINTMENT OF THE TWELVE 59 in which the brothers of our Lord are distinguished from the apos- tles; and finally, by J. 7° which states distinctly, that at the Feast of Tabernacles, six months before the death of Jesus, his brothers did not believe in him. @addatov — This must be the same as Lebbzus, Mt. 10%, and Jude the son of James, Lk. 6”. tov Kavavatov — the Zealot. Kavavatov, instead of Kavavirny, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL A 33, Latt. Memph. (Pesh.) etc. If this name meant an inhabitant of Cana, it would be Kavaiov. Probably, it comes from the Heb. x3), Chald. j822, with the termi- nation aos which denotes a party (Papicaios, XadSovxaios), and is the same as ZyAwrys zealot, the name given to him in Lk. 6". This was the name of a party of fanatic nationalists among the Jews, leaders of the national revolt against the foreign yoke. 19. ‘Ioxapudtrnv — Heb., nap vs Man of Kerioth. Judas is designated thus as an sahabitaat of Kerioth, a village of Judza. trapeéowKeyv — Lelivered up. ‘The word for betrayal i is mpocdwxev. There can be no doubt what significance Mk. means to give to the appointment of the twelve. It is preceded and followed in his account by the gathering of the importunate crowds about our Lord. And the connection points plainly to the conclusion that Jesus appoints them to be his helpers in the work thus growing on his hands. This is indicated in the purpose, “at he may send them forth to preach, and to heal; that is, to share in the work which has been described before as done by him.’ But we do not find that much of this active work was done by them during Jesus’ lifetime. The purpose which was more fully carried out was that of permanent association with himself, expressed in the words, that they may be with him. Instead of the fluctuating attendance on his person of the ordinary disciples, he desired for these twelve such constant association that they could afterwards be his witnesses, and carry forward his work. Mt. 9”—10* gives the same general reason, but the immediate occasion is a mission- ary tour made by Jesus through Galilee, in which he is impressed by the greatness of the spiritual harvest, and the small number of laborers. Lk. 6 places the concourse of people after the appointment of the twelve. The inclusion of Judas in the num- ber of the apostles is a certain indication that he was at the time 1 See 134, ed é S 60 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [III. 20-35 a genuine disciple. In his case, as in that of all the apostles, there was a failure to understand our Lord’s purely spiritual pro- gramme, but the personal equation, the faith in Christ himself, overcame this doubt at first. Later, the doubt predominated in the case of Judas, and even in the rest of the apostles it led to the temporary desertion of the ten, and to the denial of Peter. CHARGE OF DIABOLISM 20-35. Jesus, at home again, 1s met by the opposition of the Scribes, and by the attempt on the part of his family to restrain him. It is evident that there is both a logical and a chronological relation between this attitude of our Lord’s family and this new phase of the opposition of the Scribes. The logical relation is found in the language of the two. His family said, he zs destde himself; the Scribes said, he is possessed by the devil himself. The close juxtaposition of these in the narrative shows that Mk. had this logical relation in his mind. On the other hand, the interruption of the story of his family’s attempt to restrain him by the introduction of the other account, and the resumption of the former in v.*, is not explained so well by any other assumption as that there was really such an interval between the family’s original purpose and their arrival on the scene of action, which was filled up by the controversy with the Scribes. Jesus makes this opposition the occasion of teaching, of which it is easy to miss the point, and which has been badly misunderstood. In regard to the charge that he is in collusion with Satan in casting out demons, his point fully stated would be, that such collusion is possible up to the point where it involves an actual arraying of Satan against himself. And Jesus turns their charge against them- selves by his counter-claim that his whole action is hostile to Satan, making such collusion impossible. And this is the acumen of his statement about the sin against the Holy Ghost. In the case of the Scribes, their charge had been very close to that sin, when they said that the Spirit in Jesus was the Devil instead of the Holy Spirit, involving a complete upsetting of all moral values, }and a stupendous and well-nigh irrecoverable moral blindness in ——E III. 20, 21] CHARGE OF DIABOLISM 61 themselves. That is, their whole error lay in their failure to value the moral element in Jesus’ works. It is not implied at all that his family was in sympathy with the Scribes, their apprehension being simply that his mind was unsettled, and that he needed to be put under restraint. This lack of sympathy with him on the part of his human family led Jesus to point out the higher reality of spiritual relationship and association. 20. épxerar— comes. eis otkov is here probably the colloquial anarthrous phrase, equivalent to our ome. ‘The gathering of the Scribes from Jerusalem and the visit of his family would probably both of them be at Capernaum, and this points to his own house as the one meant here, RV. margin. épxerac instead of €pxovra, Tisch. WH. RV. 8 BT mss. of Lat. Vet. etc. Kai ovvepxerat radu (6) 6xA0s — And (the) crowd gathers again. 6 before dxXos Tr. (WH.) RV. 8 ABDL!- A 209, 300, Memph.e@¢, The article is rather favored by Mk.’s habit of correlating persons and things with previous mentions of the same in his account. mad. — again. This refers to 2'*, and denotes a repetition of what occurred then in the same place. pa divacba pndé — not able even. unde, instead of unre, Treg. WH. RV. ABKLU A 28, 33 etc. wore py. 21. of rap avrov—his family. v.",which is evidently a resump- tion of this part of the narrative, says zs mother and his brothers. Literally, this phrase would denote chose descended from him, but it has come to have this modification of its strict meaning. Kparnooa.— to lay hold of him, to get possession of him. ‘They wanted to protect Jesus against his own madness. For they said that he ts beside himself, é&éorn.” daxovoavres has for its object the preceding statement. Jesus’ permitting the multitude to gather about him in this tumultuous way and to engross him so entirely, seemed to them an unwarranted absorption in an entirely visionary work. This absence of prudence and of care of himself seemed to them misplaced. Weiss, with some show of reason, makes the subject of €\evyov the persons from whom the family received their account. But the more natural sub- ject is the same as that of é4X@ov, unless a different one is pointed out. And it is just as probable that the family inferred the éééorn from what they heard, as that it made a part of the report. 1 Where the inf. is used with ore, the N.T. invariably employs the neg. uw, even when the result is stated as a fact. See Win. 55, 2a. 2 See on 212, 62 THE GOSPEL OF MARK | [III. 22 Kat of ypapparets ot ad ‘lepocoAvpwv xaraBdvtes— And the Scribes who came down from Jerusalem. This delegation is introduced here with the article, as if it had been mentioned before. But the article may be taken as meaning the Scribes who were present, and oi karaBdvres as an incidental statement of the reason of their presence. This slight change of meaning would be indi- cated by a comma, — and the Scribes, who came down from Ferusalem. 22. KaraBavres—It was down from Jerusalem, which was situated on high land, to most other parts of the country. This is the first mention of the presence of Scribes from Jerusalem, and it is an indication of an increased activity and hostility of the religious leaders against Jesus. BeedleBovr exer — he has Beelzebul. This is a modification of a Heb. name, and is one of their names for Satan." One is said to have a demon, or here, the prince of demons, as he is said to have a disease, that is, to be afflicted with it. | The particular form of this charge, that he is possessed, not _ with an ordinary demon, but with the devil himself, is in order to ' account for his power over demons, as representing their prince. But we may suppose that they took a malicious pleasure in making his an exaggerated case. év t@® dpxovte Tov datmoviwy —in the prince of the demons. The preposition has the same force as in \ the phrases 7m Christ, in the Holy Spirit. It is a local designation of intimate union, as if the two were so absorbed in each other, that they dwelt, one in the other. The charge is, that Jesus cast out demons by virtue of this connection with their prince. It is not merely an attempt to explain these miracles, so as to do away with the effect of them, but a distinct charge on the strength of ‘them. They said, #kzs man 1s in collusion with the devil. ILtts evident all through his course, but this assumed miracle ts distinct proof of it. How else does this insignificant person coming among us without any credentials, get this extraordinary power over demons, unless there ts some connection between him and their ruler. The devil has power to order them round, and has author- ized this man to act for him, and so further the dangerous delusion about himself which is spreading among the people. There is no connection between the attitude of the religious leaders, and of Jesus’ own family here. Rather, the hostility of the Scribes was one of the dangers of the situation, to which Jesus himself seemed rashly indifferent, and which led his family to seek to restrain him. Mt. 1222-23 and Lk. 1114 give us a more immediate occasion for this charge in their account of the casting out of a demon at this time. In this Gospel, the connection is general, the charge being occasioned by Jesus’ frequent performance of this most prominent of all his miracles. 1 The Heb, is 5931 bya, 5931 being a rabbinical form of 53t. The whole means god of filth. III. 23-25 | CHARGE OF DIABOLISM 63 23. év mapaBorAats —A parable is an analogy. It assumes a Sileerieds between higher and lower things, such that what is true /in one department holds good in another. It serves the purpose ne only of illustration and of figurative statement, but also of proof. Here the apologetic purpose is evident. The analogy may be drawn out into a story, or description, as in most of Jesus’ parables, but.this is not essential. In this case, Jesus begins with an abstract statement of his position, and then gives several analogous cases proving the general principle. Laravas Sarava éxBadrAev— Satan is the Heb. name of the devil, the prince of the demons. It means the Adversary, and except in this passage, and Lk. 22°, the name is written with the article. Jesus shows the fallacy of the scribes’ position by call- ing their attention to one essential element in his casting out of demons, which makes it impossible to account for it in their way. And that is, that his action toward the demons is hostile action. | To be sure, his ordering them round, in itself considered, may be merely an exercise of the power which their ruler exercises over them. But when his authority is exercised, not for them, but | against them, and against everything for which they and their ‘ruler stand, he must be representing, not some friendly power, * but a distinctly hostile force. They are so identified with their ruler, that what he does to them he does virtually to himself, and he does not cast himself out from one of his principal vantage points, possessing a special strategic value for his cause. 24. kal éav Bactrcia Ef EavTnv pepicOy — And if a kingdom ts divided against itself. This is the analogy which lies nearest at hand. Indeed, it may be called the generic statement of the pre- ceding principle. Satan and his subjects constitute a kingdom, and what is true of any kingdom is applicable to them. There is no difference between human kingdoms and this kingdom of evil spirits, which would invalidate this common truth. In the form in which this analogy is stated, it contains the reason why it is morally impossible for Satan to cast out Satan. It is, that such division leads to destruction. The condition is here a general one, not confined to any time. 25. The second analogy is that of a house. The word is used by metonymy for the family inhabiting a‘Wétise. Here, too, divis- ion ends in destruction. od dvvjcerar— will not be able. The form of the conditional statement in this case belongs to the future, and not to a general condition. an eS: duvjoerat, instead of dtvara, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BCL A mss. of cat. Vet. and of Vulg. d¥vara: is an evident emendation, to correspond to v.44, 2 See on 113, 64 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ III. 26, 27 26. kai ci 6 Satavas dvéeorn ep Eavrov, euepicOn Kai ov Svvarar ornvat— And if Satan arose against himself, he was divided and cannot stand. éueploOn, kat instead of kal weuépiorat, Tisch. 8* C* A mss. of Lat. Vet. Vulg. kai éuepicOn Treg. marg. WH. RV. 8° BL. kai éuepioOn is a probable emendation to bring the aorists avéorn and éueploOn together, instead of éuepicOn and the pres. ov d¥varat. orjvat, instead of cra6jvat, Tisch. Treg. WH. » BCL. This verse applies the principle to the case in hand, and the form of conditional statement corresponds. It states the condi- tion as belonging to past time, and says of an event actually past, if tt was of such a character. In the conclusion, the aor. states what was involved, the pres. what zs involved. 27. ov dWwarat ovdels eis THY oikiav Tod iaxvpod civeAOwV TA TKEIH avTov Slapracat— no one can enter into the strong man’s house, and plunder his tools. eis THv oixiay Tod icxupod eiceMOav TA TKEU a’Tod, instead of Ta oKEvn Tov isxupot eicedOawv eis THv oiklay avrov, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BCL A 33, 102, Memph. Pesh. In what precedes, Jesus has simply taken the negative attitude towards their charge that he is in collusion with Satan, showing that that isimpossible. But in this verse he shows what is the real relation to Satan involved in his casting out demons. What it does mean is conflict with Satan, and victory over him. This also is stated in the form of an analogy, that no one can enter a strong man’s house, and despoil his tools, except he first bind the strong man. cs is here not possessions or goods, but utensils, and denotes the demons as Satan’s instruments, or tools. What Jesus says is not simply an inference from his casting out of demons, though that is the proof of it to others. But this victory over Satan is a part of his self-consciousness. He knows that he has met Satan here on his own stamping ground, where he has been accustomed to take advantage of the weakness of men for their undoing ; moreover, that Satan has approached him on this same side of his human weakness, and for once, has met his mas- ter. Instead of mastering, he has been himself mastered, and the mastery has been followed up by crippling; he has been bound. Here we come upon one of the deepest truths of Jesus’ life, that the real basis of his power, which is a spiritual power, is to be found in his own righteousness under difficulties, and those diffi- culties the same which are inherent in human nature, and due to the exposure of that nature to a subtle and victorious power of evil which had so far dominated the world. 1 Gvéorn and éuepioby are aorist, and it preserves the flavor of the original better to translate them as simple pasts, arose, and was divided, instead of perfects. III. 28, 29] CHARGE OF DIABOLISM 65 28. “Apnv— Verily." This has the. effect of solemn emphasis. mdvta apeOnoera . . . TA auaptypata — all sins shall be forgiven. The statement that all the sins of men shall be forgiven is not to be taken of individual sins, but of classes, or kinds of sin. ai Bracdnpuiaa — the dlasphemies. This word means primarily zjwrt: ous speech, and, as applied to God, speech derogatory to his Divine majesty. dca av BrAacdyynowow — Literally, whatsoever things | they blasphemously utter? ed pencemncrc ne ba. ai before BAacgyuia Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABCEFGHL A Memph. etc. 6éca, instead of dcas, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BDE* GH A etc. Blasphemy is not here regarded as that into which all sins may be resolved,’ but it adds to the general term szms, the special class to which the blasphemy against the Holy Spirit belongs. 29. «is To IIvetua 70 “Ayov — against the Holy Spirit! What is meant by the blasphemy against the Holy Spirit? The difficulty on one side, has been the consideration of this question without reference to the case in hand, and on the other hand, so superfi- cial an explanation of this case as to leave what Jesus says about the enormity of the sin involved practically unexplained. Plainly, | the Holy Spirit is not to be considered here in his independent ‘action, but as the inward source of Jesus’ acts. What Jesus says is occasioned by their charge that he had an evil spirit ; that is, ' that the power acting in him was not good, but bad. Now, the ' Holy Spirit is the Divine power to which the acts of Jesus are . attributed. The Spirit is represented as descending on him at his baptism, and driving him into the wilderness, and Jesus is said to have begun his ministry in Galilee in the power of the Spirit. Especially, Jesus ascribes his expulsion of evil spirits to the Holy : Spirit. Hence, a distinction is to be made between his other acts, _and those which manifestly reveal the Holy Spirit in him, and _ between slander directed against him personally, as he appears in ,his common acts, and that which is aimed at those acts in which ‘the Spirit is manifest. Just so far as there is in the man who utters the slander any recognition, however vague, of this agency, or so far as there is in the person against whom it is directed so manifest a revelation of the Spirit as should lead to this recogni- tion, so far, there is danger, to say the least, of this blasphemy 1’Ayyyv is the Heb. particle of affirmation from 128, to be firm, sure. » Its proper place is at the end of the sentence, and disconnected with it, like our 4men, This adverbial use of it, placed at the beginning of the sentence, belongs to the report of our Lord’s discourses in the Gospels, Elsewhere in the N.T. it is used after the Heb. fashion. 2 dca is the cognate acc. after BAacdynujowouv, and independent of both Baac¢n- piac and auapripara. See Col. 314, where é is used in the same way. 3 See Morison’s singular note. 4 In this use of a preposition after BAacdyuijeon, there is a return to the earlier construction, for which the N.T. employs the simple acc, F 66 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [III. 29-31 _ against the Holy Spirit. Moreover, this act of driving out evil _ spirits was the act in which the holiness of the Spirit operating in _ Jesus specially appeared. It is not in the power shown in the / miracles that the operation of the Holy Spirit is most evident, ' but in their moral quality. There is the moral uniqueness about the miracles of Jesus which appears in the rest of his life, only there, it is, if anything, most conspicuous. And this quality appears specially where he not only cures the bodily diseases of men, but frees them from an evil spirit which deranges their inner life. To call that evil, instead of good, and especially to ascribe ‘it to the very prince of evil, is the blasphemy against the Holy ‘Spirit. The only alleviation of it is the failure to recognize fully these facts. otk exer ddeow eis Tov aidva —hath never forgive- ness, adda evoxds éoTw aiwviov apaptnuatos — but is guilty of an eternal sin. dpuaprhuaros, instead of xpiocews, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BL A 28, 33 (C* D 13, 69, 346, duaprias), Latt. Memph. An eternal sin may be one subjecting the person to an eternal punishment, eternal in its consequences, that is.” But certainly it is equally allowable to suppose that it describes the sin itself as eternal, accounting for the impossibility of the forgiveness by the permanence of the sin, — endless consequences attached to end- less sin. This is the philosophy of endless punishment. Sin reacts on the nature, an act passes into a state, and the state continues. That is, eternal punishment is not a measure of God’s resentment against a single sin, which is so enormous that the resentment never abates. It is the result of the effect of any sin, or course of sin in fixing the sinful state beyond recovery. This is more accordant with the inwardness of Jesus’ ordinary view of things. 30. mvetpua dxdbaprov éxe. — he has an unclean spirit. The report of their saying above is, Ae hath Beelzebul, and it is changed here in order to make the contrast between zvetya axaOaprov and Ivetpa "Aytov, the Holy Spirit. 31. kal epxovrae 7 pyTnp adTov Kai of ddeXqol avrov, Kal ew oTHKovTes . . . Kadovvtes avtov—and there came his mother and his brothers, and standing outside . . . calling him. Kal &py(ovra), instead of “Epxovra: ofv, Treg. WH. RV. (Tisch. Kal %pxerat) § BCDGL A 1, 13, 28, 69, 118, 124, 209, Latt. Memph. Pesh. etc. h mArnp abrod Kat of ddedpol avrod, instead of of ddedpol kal 7 wAT yp avTod, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BCDGL A Latt. Memph. Pesh. or7xortes, instead of éor&res, Tisch. Treg. WH. BC A 28. kadovvres, instead of dwvobvTes, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL 1, 13, 28, 69, 118, 124, etc. 1 Literally, Zath not forgiveness forever. The Heb. form of the universal nega: tive, joining the negative with the verb, instead of with the adverb. 2So Meyer, Weiss, Holtzmann, etc. III. 31-35} JESUS’ SPIRITUAL FAMILY 67 Though the resumptive ovv is omitted, it is plain that this is a resumption of what is said about his family coming out to restrain him in y.”. The preliminary statement is put there, in order to connect é&AGov with its cause in the tumultuous gathering of the people. ‘Then it is interrupted by the story of the dispute with the Scribes, because that event precedes in the order of time. It is this unsympathetic attitude of his family in this visit which gives force to what Jesus says about his true family. On the brothers of Jesus, see on v.”®. ddeAdoi is used sometimes to denote less intimate relationship, but it is not at all common, and aside from usage, the supposition that the ddeA¢or of Jesus were anything else than brothers is quite against the evidence. ‘The names of these brothers are given in Mt. 13” as James, Joseph, Simeon, and Jude. Kat €£m oTnkovtes — and standing outside. Evidently on account of the crowd surrounding the house." 32. rept aitov— around him. kat réyovow atte» — and they say to him. kal éyoucur, instead of eirov dé, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL A 13, 69, 124, 346, mss. of Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Pesh. Harcl. marg. 9 pTNp gov Kal ot ddeAol gov Kal ai adeAdai cov — thy mother, and thy brothers, and thy sisters. kai at ddegal cov —Tisch. (Treg. marg.) WH. marg. ADEFHMSUV [ 22, 124, 238, 299, 433, mss. of Lat. Vet. Harcl. marg. Omitted probably to accord with v.*- 54, and with Mt. and Lk. 33. Kai dmroxpileis*® A€yea — And answering, he says. amoxpiHels Aéyet, instead of dexpiOn, Néywv, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BCL A Vulg. Memph. Harcl. kai oi ddeXgol you, and my brothers, instead of 7, or, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCGL A 1, mss. of Lat. Vet. Memph. Pesh. Jesus does not wish, in this question, to deny or underrate the human relations. But he feels with a strength, not common among men, the Divine relation and the human relations to which this gives rise. Moreover, the present errand of his family has made him feel that they come short of the real connection which alone gives worth to the family relation. 34. Tovs repli aitov KaOnuevous — those seated around him. v. has stated that the crowd was seated about him. But evidently from what follows, this was made up in this case of his disciples. 35. rod cot — Mt. 12” says rod warpds pov Tov év ovpave, which defines more closely the nature and reason of this relation. It is a common relation to the heavenly Father, and not to an earthly 32 1 See v.20, and especially Lk. 819. 2 With the acc., repi is used locally, with the gen., of subject matter — around a person or thing, and adout a subject. 3 The Greeks used the middle, instead of the pass. of aroxpivw, in the sense of answer, ‘This use is peculiar to N.T. Greek. 68 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [III. 35-IV. father, that is at the basis of the kinship acknowledged by him. Moreover, the relation to God is of the moral kind, shown by doing His will. It is due to a new nature begotten in the man by God, but it shows itself in obedience. Jesus’ own relation to God, making it his meat and drink to do his will, is the uppermost and central thing in his life, and those who share with him this relation come nearest to him. Spiritual kinship surpasses the accidents of birth. os dv movnon — whoever does. Omit yap, for, Tisch. (Treg.) WH. B mss. of Lat. Vet. Memph. ‘yap is an emendation. Omit pov, my, after ddedpy Tisch. Treg. WH. RV.& ABD LA mss. of Lat. Vet. The order of Mk. here, connecting this paragraph with the teaching in parables which follows, is also the order of Mt., and the latter marks this as a chronological order by the use of éri adrod AadobyTos, 12%, and év 77 éxelvy nuépa, 131. On the other hand, Lk. 1157 connects this attack of the Phari- sees with Jesus’ denunciation of them by another definite chronological mark, év 6¢ T@ Aadjuat. And Mt. puts this denunciation among the events of the passion week, and fixes it there by his introductory Tére. ‘This is a spec- imen of the disagreement of the Evangelists in their attempts to give chro- nological sequence to their narratives. Dr. Gardiner, Harmony, p. 70, explains this by the supposition that such expressions as €71 avrot AadovvTos and év T@ Aadfjoac may be used by the Evangelist to indicate that an event took place, not necessarily in the midst of that particular discourse, but simply of some discourse or other; that is, while he was talking, instead of walking, or healing or something. This is a good example of the ingenui- ties and curiosities of harmonizing interpretation. Such use of language by the Evangelists would discredit them equally with the inconsistencies that it is intended to remove. THE PARABLES OF JESUS IV. With one exception, the prophetic discourse of ch. 13, the parables are the only connected discourse in Mk. And it is the only specimen of teaching without any statement of the cir- cumstances in which it originated. Indeed, it follows from what Jesus says about the object of his teaching in parables, that it would be without any such ground in events or questions, as would furnish a key to the meaning of the parable. Like all our Lord’s teaching, it grew out of the conditions of the time, but the con- nection is not indicated, except as one reads the riddle of the parable itself. And in this way, it serves his purpose of veiling the truth, except to the initiated. But when one understands the pvorypiov, the secret of the kingdom, the occasion is obvious. That secret, not known at the time by any one but Jesus, and not to be communicated to outsiders, was that the kingdom is a seed Iv. 1-3] THE PARABLE OF THE SOWER 69 which grows, and not an authority to be externally set up and enforced. The occasion is thus the hindrances to the work of Jesus, the opposition of the rulers, the dulness and superficiality of the multitude, and the question even of the disciples, why he does not brush these obstacles away and set up the Messianic kingdom. THE PARABLE OF THE SOWER 1-9. Jesus comes again to the shore of the lake, where he ts followed by the usual multitude, whom he teaches From a boat in parables. 1. wa\ww—again connects this with the events by the shore of the lake, 3’ sq.; cf. 21%. kal ovvayeras rpos atrov dxXos tA€toTos — and there gathers to him a very great multitude. guvayerat, instead of cvvjx6n, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A 13, 28, 69, 124. mdetoros instead of wodvs, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A. The great multitude repeats the scene of the previous gathering at the shore of the lake, and the boat is apparently the boat which he ordered the disciples to have in readiness for him at that time, 3’°°. els wiotov éuBdvra (omit 7d), having entered a boat, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCKLM 1, 33, 118, 131, 209 etc. mpos THv Oardacoay eri THs yns Hoav — were towards the sea upon the land.’ noay, instead of qv, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A 33, mss. of Lat. Vet. Lk. 8'~* gives a different setting to the parable. According to him, it was spoken during a journey in the cities and villages of Galilee. 2. édidacKxev— he was teaching. The impf. describes the act in its progress. é€v mapaBod\ats—in parables” Here we have the parable drawn out into a story. év r7 didayy airod — in hts teach- ing. ‘The word denotes the act of teaching, not the doctrine, or thing taught. dxovere — hear, or “sten. It calls attention to what follows, after a manner common to our Lord. 3. 6 oreipwv — the sower, not a sowers 1 Mt. gives the same mark of the size of the multitude in this case. But it is one of the characteristic marks of this Gospel to emphasize the crowds that fol- lowed Jesus by some graphic touch. See 158 22 37. 20, 2See 373, note. 3 This is the generic use of the article, an individual being taken to represent the class. See Win. 18, 1. 70 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [Iv. 4-8 4. § wev—some. oméppa, seed is understood.’ mapa tiv 68ov — by the side of the road. We are not to think here of a wide road, with a fence or wall separating it from the field, but of a path traversing the unenclosed fields. ‘The unproductiveness is due of course to the hardness of the trodden soil. Jesus adds that the birds devoured the seed, and this is due to its lying on the surface without penetrating it. Omit rod otpavod, of heaven, after ra wére.va, the birds, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABCL A mss. of Lat. Vet. and of Vulg. etc. 5. Kai dAA\o — and other? kat &Xo, instead of &AXo de, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BC(D)L A two mss. of Lat. Vet. Memph. etc. To metpades — the rocky ground, not stony. A place where the rock came up near the surface, leaving room for only thin soil overlying it, is meant. Kal evOvs e€avérecke — and tt came up immediately. The thin soil had two effects ; first, the grain came up quickly, because it lay near the surface, and was more exposed to the generous influence of the sun and rain; and secondly, it was scorched and withered by the sun, because there was no room for the roots to penetrate. 6. Kat dre 6 jAwos avéereiXeyv — and when the sun arose. This reading, instead of 7Alov dé dvareldavros, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL A mss. of Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. éxavpaticOn — was scorched? 7. eis tas akdvOas —7.e. among the seeds of thorns or briers, which afterwards came up, dvéByoav, and choked the grain. 8. kal dAAa— and others; oméppara is understood, the word being taken individually, instead of collectively, as in the other parts of the parable. dda, others, instead of dddo, other, Tisch. (Treg.) WH. RV. & *andeb BCL 28, 33, 124, one ms. of Lat. Vet. Memph. etc. é3/Sov xdprov—gave fruit. Probably, in this case, as in v.’, this means the grain itself, and not the stalks, but in this case, the participles dvaBaivovra and atédvovra must agree with dda, and not with xaprév. The reading adgavouevov favored by T Tr. forces the agreement with xaprév. That of WH. RV. avgavopeva, forces the agreement with dAXa. The internal evidence thus confirms the latter reading ; cf. caprodopovow v.”. aviavduevor, instead of adédvovra, Tisch. Treg. ACDL A 238. avdiavdueva WH. RV. » B. 1 On this use of the relative in antithetical statements, see Win. 17, 14. 2 The proper correlative of 6 pév is 6 58 8 This verb belongs to later Greek. IV. 8-11] EXPLANATION OF THE PARABLE 71 cis TpiaKovtra — Up to thirty, denoting the degree of fruitfulness. els Tpidxovra, instead of €v rpidxovra, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A 28 etc. eis éfjxovra, and eis Exarov Tisch. Treg. WH. marg. RV. x C* A 28 etc. éyv with the last two WH. BLEFGKMUV I etc. 9. Kat edeyev, Os exer wWra axovelv, dxoverw— And he said, He who hath ears to hear, let him hear. ‘This is a familiar expression of our Lord’s used by him to call attention to what is especially worth hearing. Ye who have ears, prepare to use them now. Omit adrots, to them, after €deyev, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV.» ABCDL A Latt. Memph. Syrr.etc. os ye, instead of 6 €xwv, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. Ce * iD A. 10-25. Explanation of the parable. 10. Kai dre éyévero xara povas'—And when he came to be alone, z.é. after the departure of the crowd, which, however, followed probably the telling of the other parables. This is certainly so, if we adopt the reading ras zapafoAds at the end of the verse. ot wept avtov —The disciples generally, as distinguished from the multitude on the one hand, and the twelve on the other. Dis- ciples, because he separates them from those outside, as those to whom the mystery of the kingdom is entrusted. ras zapaBoAds — the parables uttered by him on this occasion, including those following the explanation of the Parable of the Sower. Kal re, instead of “Ore dé, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL A Latt. Memph. etc. 7pwTwy, instead of 7pérnoav, Treg. WH. RV. ABL A 33. npwrovy, Tisch. 8 C. ras wapaBodds, instead of Sing., Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A one ms. of Lat. Vet. mss. of Vulg. Memph. some edd. ll. ‘Ypiv dedora: 76 pvornpiov— Zo you has been given the mystery. ‘The mystery has been put into your hands. Omit yrdva, to know, after 5é5ora:, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 ABCKL one ms. of Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. some edd. etc. A mystery in the N.T. is not something hard to understand, but something hidden, revealed only to the initiated, like the Greek mysteries. The secret of the Kingdom of God set forth in these parables is the fact of its only partial success in this early stage. This fact seemed to those outside, not possessed of the secret of the kingdom, to be inconsistent with its nature as a heavenly kingdom. They thought, when God really set out to establish his Kingdom, its success would be speedy and sure. Supernatural powers would supersede natural processes, and every- thing would yield to them. The mystery, the hidden thing, set 1 The separation of carauévas into xara wdévas is simply a matter of interpreta- tion. «pas is to be supplied with poévas. 72 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [Iv. 11, 12 forth by Jesus, in this group of parables, is that the kingdom belongs to living, growing things, and is subject thus to the same laws as grain, leaven, mustard seed, and the like. Gradual- ness therefore belongs to its nature. éxeivors 8&¢ Tos ¢€£w— Zo those outsiders. The EV. translates trois ¢&w by them who are without. And we need to add some- thing to this to indicate the presence of the demonstrative. This can be done by emphasizing the word ¢hem (those), or by trans- lating rots €€w outsiders. Jesus has in mind probably the multi- tude just gone from them, whom he points out in €xeivous, and describes by rois ¢€w; cf. Mt. 13", where éxe/vois alone is used. The connection with r. BaowAreias 7. @cod in the preceding clause indicates that it is the kingdom of God outside of which he places them. Those inside the kingdom know its secrets, those outside do not know them. 71a 7avtra—al/ things. It is defined by. the context as all things pertaining to the mystery of the kingdom. év tapafsoAats —in parables. Instead of being stated in terms belonging to itself, the mystery of the kingdom is so stated in terms belonging to another realm, as to veil it. ‘The parable, z.e. by itself, without its key. If the truth is stated first abstractly, and then in terms of the analogy, the two help to the understand- ing of each other by showing that the phenomenon is not special, but common, a general fact belonging to the related realms of matter and spirit. But without this key, the parable remains a riddle, which is one of its meanings. 12. iva BAerovtes BX€rwot, Kal py lOwoi— in order that seeing, they may see, and not perceive. It is evident that iéwo. expresses a more inward and real sight than BAérwor. The idea is expressed thus, 72 order that in the act of seeing, there may be merely out ward seeing and not perception. ‘The contrast is more exactly expressed by the difference between dxovwor and cuvdct, hearing and understanding. pymote éeriotpepwow Kal apeOy avrots — lest perchance they may turn, and it be forgiven them. aeby is used impersonally. Omit Ta duaprhuara, their sins, after aden Tisch. Treg. ¢r¢t. WH. RV. x BCL 1, 22, 118, 209, 251, 340,* one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. The whole verse is a translation of Is. 6°, adapted freely from the Sept. It takes these phrases dxoy dxovoere k. ov py) oUVATE, k. BA€rovtes BAePovow Kk. ov py ldynte and pryrore éeriotpepwow Kk. idcouat avrovs out of their connection and pieces them together. In explaining this difficult passage, it is to be noticed, first, that the difference between the form of the quotation in Mt. on the one hand, and Mk. and Lk. on the other, corresponds to a like difference between the original Hebrew and the LXX. In the Hebrew, God says to his prophet, “Go, ... make the heart of this people fat and make their ears heavy, and shut their eyes, lest i: 12| EXPLANATION OF THE PARABLE 73 they see with their eyes, and hear with their ears, and understand with their heart, and turn again and be healed.” That is, God is represented as sending his prophet to harden the heart of the people by his prophetic message, as if Rubinstein should have been told to deaden people’s musical sense by his playing, or Bishop Brooks to stifle their religious sense by his preaching. In the LXX., on the contrary, the hardening is the cause, not the purpose. The people will not hear the prophet’s message because their heart is hardened, and they have shut their eyes. So in Mt., following the LXX., Jesus speaks to them in parables because their heart is waxed gross, and their ears dull of hearing. And espe- cially, the obnoxious pymore érictpéWwow xk. idcopat adtovs is in- cluded in the result of their own conduct, and not in the Divine purpose. Mk. and Lk., however, follow the original in making the failure to hear and see to be the purpose of the parable. But Lk. omits the obnoxious pjrore ériotpebwow k. dbeOy adrots. And yet, there is no doubt, from the identity of language, that Mk., and following him, Lk., quote from the LXX., while modifying it for some reason. That reason would seem to be, that Mk. had in mind the form in which Jesus quotes the passage, and that this was conformed to some Targum, preserving the spirit of the original. This confirms what is otherwise probable, that Mk., rather than Mt., preserves the original form of Jesus’ saying. But while Mk., and according to the above, Jesus himself, conforms to the original Hebrew, he does not preserve the irony which is the saving element of the passage in Isaiah. It is only ironically that God commands the prophet to harden the people by his pungent preaching, because he sees that this will be the inevitable result. Whereas, it is evidently in all seriousness, that Jesus describes this as the result of the parable. The parable is evidently regarded by Jesus as a form of teaching intended to veil the truth conveyed, and adapted, therefore, to esoteric teaching. Moreover, the teach- ing is esoteric ; it concerns the mysteries of the kingdom of God, not the ordinary facts in regard to it, but certain things intended not for the common ear, but only for the disciples. And the parable does so veil the meaning that it has to be explained even to them. There is a key to each of the parables, some funda- mental analogy, which is necessary to its explanation. In the Parable of the Sower, this is found in the statement that the seed is the word. Without this, the meaning is obscure. That is, the language of Isaiah, applied to the teaching of Jesus as a whole, would have the irony of the original ; but applied to the parables, it is to be taken seriously. This makes all plain sailing until we come to the obnoxious pymore émiorpepwow x. abeOy airois. There the irony reappears, for it would evidently be only ironically, and not earnestly, that Jesus would say of any of his teaching, that it was intended to prevent the forgiveness and conversion of the 74 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [Iv. 12-15 people. It makes the proper climax to the original passage, but is out of place in Jesus’ use of it. But, after the mechanical fashion, which often marks the reporting of discourse, Mk., re- membering only that Jesus used this quotation, reproduced the passage as he found it in the original, without omitting its irrelevant clauses. Mt., on the other hand, quoting from the LXX., without the modification introduced by Mk., has not involved himself in the same difficulty, but has not reproduced for us what Jesus said. Lk., seeing the difficulty involved in Mk.’s report, has omitted the obnoxious clause, giving us probably the genuine form of the quo- tation. Our Lord’s statement, then, is simply this, that the mys- tery of the kingdom, or its secret, is not intended for those outside of it, and that therefore he uses in conveying it to his disciples the contrivance of the parable, so that outsiders who have not the clue may hear without hearing. 13. ovk oldare kTA. This is treated by some of the critics and commentators as a question, and by others as a statement. Of course, the original text contained no intimation in which of these two ways it is to be taken, and there is little choice in the mean- ings obtained. Taken as a statement, the succeeding question is an inference from the fact that they do not know this parable. As a question, it already expresses surprise at the fact that they do not know this parable, and then follows the inference. Kat z@s 7doas Tas TapaBoras yuooerGe;— and how will you know all the parables? The argument is from the similarity of the parables. ‘This is not an unusual instance, but a good example of its class. The lack of perception shown in this case would extend to all similar cases. 14. rdv Adyov oreipe. tov Adyoy is emphatic, and contains the key to the parable. He is speaking of the sowing of the word, and pointing out the analogies between this and the sowing of seed. 15. ovrot 5é cicw of rapa THv 6d0v— And these are they along the road. ‘The seed and the soil are here confounded. The seed is the word, the soil is the mind of the hearer. The exact state- ment would be, chese are the road. épxerat 6 Saravas — Satan comes. One would say naturally that the birds in the parable were merely a part of the picture, and had no counterpart in the spiritual fact represented by it. One main principle in the interpretation of the parables is that only the one truth represented in the comparison is to be seized upon, and the details are to be treated as mere incidents, on the ground that things in the spiritual and material worlds correspond only in generals. And it is evident that Jesus generally treated the para- bles with this largeness and sobriety. But in this case, an oppor- tunity is given Jesus to introduce into his account of obstructions to the fruitfulness of the seed the agency of that kingdom of evil which complicates the whole problem. The primary result of sowing on this hard soil is that the seed remains on the surface, IV. 15-18 | EXPLANATION OF THE PARABLE as the secondary result is, that it is snatched away from the mind by the influences represented by Satan. The road, or path, repre- sents those whose spirits are impervious to the truth, into whom it finds no entrance at all. Tov Néyov Tov éorappévov év avrots (eis a’rous), the word which has been sown in them. év avrots, instead of év rats xapdlais, in their hearts, T. & CL A Memph. Harcl. marg. eis avrovs, Treg. WH. RV.B 1, 13, 28, 69, 118, 209. 16. dpoiws —in like manner, — by virtue of the same general resemblance. of . . . omeipouevo.— There is the same confusion of seed and soil as in the preceding case. ed6ds pera yapas — This corresponds to the ev@is éfaveretre of the parable, and denotes one side of the resemblance, the superficial readiness with which they receive the word. ‘They have been attracted by the pleasant things, and have not stopped to count the pains and oppositions that constitute the other side of the kingdom in this evil world. 17. pilav—voot. The analogy is so close, that the various terms belonging to the physical process and material have become familiar designations of the corresponding spiritual facts, such as seed, soil, root, fruit, and the like. Root denotes the hold which the truth has upon the spirit, securing its permanence. The absence of it designates the superficiality of this class of hearers. mpooxatpo. — ¢ransient. This describes the merely temporary effect of the word upon them, owing to their superficiality. @<- pews 7 Siwypot — affliction or persecution. We may suppose that this is not an exhaustive statement of the things destructive of the truth in the superficial hearer, that it simply represents them by the one thing operative in that early period of conflict. Only deeply rooted discipleship can withstand persecution. «ids oxavoar(lovra: — immediately they stumble. Immediateness is characteristic of this class on both sides. They receive the word immediately, and fall away immediately. Haste and superficiality go together. They do not wait to see if there is any other side to religion than the glad side, nor, on the other side, whether afflic- tion is a sufficient reason for giving it up. oxavdadLovrar — is found only in the N.T., and means 7 cause to fall or stumble, and in the pass., Zo fall or stumble. It is the opposite of fo stand. The translation of the AV., they are offended, gives a wrong idea of the word. RV. they stumble. 18. kai d\Ao. — and others. Kal &dXoz, instead of kal otra, and these, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x* BC* DL A mss. of Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. ol oTEeLpoOpmevol eis Tas axadvOas — those sown among the thorns. The confusion of seed and soil is repeated here. of rév Adyov axovoavres — who heard the word. 1 See 323, note. 76 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [Iv. 18-20 dkovoavres instead of axovovres, hear, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL A 13, 69, 124, 346, Memph. Pesh. 19. ai pépyyvar— the cares. Literally, the distractions. They are the things that divide the unity of the spirit, drawing it off differ- ent ways. Tov aiavos — the age. EV. world. ‘There is only one passage, Heb. 1°, in which there is any call to render this word world instead of age. Here it means the present evil time. It is contrasted with the aiwy ~éAAwv, the coming time, in which good, instead of evil, will predominate. Omit rovrou, this, after rod aidvos Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL At, 102, mss. of Lat. Vet. Vulg. etc. dndrn Tod mAovTov — deceit of wealth, the power which it has to deceive men with its enticements, representing itself as the great good. ra Aoura — not other things, but the remaining things. The article renders it definite. The other things of the same character as wealth are meant. ovpzviyovo.—the compound represents the completeness of the process, choke utterly.' dxapros — unfrutt- ful. The test of genuine appropriation of the truth is, that it produces effects of life and character corresponding to itself. The characteristic of this class of hearers is prepossession of the soil by alien things, which have not been weeded out. ‘The warn- ing against wealth in the dzary Tt. wAovrov is characteristic of our Lord’s teaching.” 20. Kai éxetvor — and those. éxetvor instead of ovra, chese, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A Pesh. We have three different pronouns, or adjectives, used in point- ing out the various classes of hearers. ovo, then obra dpoius, indicating a general resemblance ; then ado, denoting a specific difference ; and finally éxetvo, denoting contrast with all that pre- cede. of omapevres— that were sown. The part. in the other cases has been present, denoting the general fact about seed sown in such places. The aor. here confines it to the particular case of the parable. ofrwves —differs from the simple relative in that it generalizes the statement ; whoever, or such as. mapadexovrat — Always, in the N.T., this denotes a favorable reception, ¢o accept, the opposite of reject. Kapropopotow — bear fruit. This is what distinguishes the good soil from all others. What is planted in it bears fruit ; truth becomes virtue in that soil. It does not denote the labors or success of this class of laborers in propagating truth. Our Lord distinguishes between this kind of fruit and the obedi- ence which is the real test of discipleship, in Mt. 77". év tpidxovra 1 guurviyovar belongs to later Greek. 2 See 1023-25, But this depreciation of wealth is specially a trait of Lk.’s Gos- pel. See 620. 24 7215-21 769-13. 19-31, IV. 20-22] GENERAL REFLECTIONS 77 — literally zx thirty. The preposition denotes the number as that in which the fruit-bearing is accomplished. The choice between év and €v is a matter of interpretation, not of text, as the original had neither breathings nor accents. But all the accented uncials give év, also 1, 33, 69, 124, Syrr.; so Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. Latt. Memph. read év. Before the other numerals, WH. bracket é, on account of its omission by BC*. év gives the better construction, and is the prob- able reading, as the neuter éy has nothing with which to agree. GENERAL REFLECTIONS ON THE SUBJECT OF THB PARABLE Jesus is led on by the necessity of fruitfulness emphasized in the parable to present this under another analogy, of giving light. And this leads him to speak still further of the provision against hiding, or secrecy, in the Divine economy. Finally, to enforce what he has said of the way in which men treat the word, he enjoins on them to consider what they hear. It will be seen that there is a certain appositeness in the connection of these detached sayings. ut in the case of the statement about secrecy, another connection is possible, at least. 21-25. 21. kai éXeyev aitrois — And he said to them. This indi- cates a change of subject. Myr differs from m7, in strengthening the negative answer implied. Zhe lamp does not come at all, does wt? ind Tr. podiov— under the peck measure.| dvyvia— lamp- stand.” It corresponds to Avyxvos, damp, in the preceding part of the statement. Mt. introduces this proverb in the Sermon on the Mount, 5!*® with the meaning, Zhe light that is in you ts not meant to be hidden, but to shine forth in good deeds in the sight of men. And here, it is probably put into connection with the preceding statement about fruit-bearing, in order to enforce anew, under another figure, the fact that the ultimate end of truth in man is to come out into manifestation as virtue. Truth considered as seed, bears fruit ; considered as light, it shines, but the one fact expressed in both figures is that it results in character and conduct. 22. ov ydp €ori TL KpumTov, éav py iva pavepwOn — for there is nothing hidden, except that it may be manifested. Omit the relative 6 before éav wh, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABCKL A I, 13, 28, 33, 69, 102, 209. D 49, mss. of Lat. Vet. ddr’ iva, but that. 1 The word podios comes from the Latin modius, which denotes a peck measure. EV. bushel, 2 Avxvia is a later Greek form for Avyvecor. 78 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [Iv. 22, 24 The ultimate end of the hiding is manifesting ‘This is a case of the argumentum a minori. Even what is hidden is hidden only for the purpose of ultimate manifestation, and how much more is this true of anything that is in its nature light, instead of dark. Kpumtov is emphatic. The progress of all knowledge is the mani- festation of this principle. The earth is full of secrets, hidden treasures and forces, but they have been hidden away, only in order that man may bring them forth out of their hiding, and en- rich his life with them. ovde éyevero dmoxpypov — nor aid it become hidden away. This differs from the former by the difference between éyevero and éori. It points to the act of hiding, as that does to the state. Both are for the same purpose. God has secrets, mysteries, but they are not permanent secrets, only held in reserve for future revelation. This statement about hiding for the sake of revealing is con- nected immediately by yap with the preceding statement about hiding the light. But it would seem more natural to connect it with the pvoryptov, the secret of the kingdom, the preservation of which is said to be the object of the parable. With this addition, the statement about secret things becomes complete. It is only temporarily that the secret is kept by the parable. Ultimately, it becomes a means of revealing that which it temporarily hides. And this brings it under the great law stated by Jesus. 24. Kal édeyev airois —and he said to them. See note on v.”. BAémere ti axovere — Consider what you hear. Not beware what you hear, be on your guard against hearing anything prejudicial to others. ‘This meaning has been given to the words, because of a misunderstanding of the proverb which follows, which has been taken to mean here, as in Mt. 7°, that men will treat you as you treat them. But this leaves the whole thing without any connec- tion with the rest of the discourse, utterly irrelevant. Whereas it is evident that dxovérw and dxovere go together. And v.” is con- nected with this by yap. Some meaning must be found for this, therefore, that will justify this connection. ‘The meaning Consider what you hear is apposite to the connection with a parable which shows the consequences of inconsiderate hearing. év @ méeTpw perpetre, petpnOnoerar duiv—in what measure you measure it will be measured to you. As we have seen, the mean- ing of this familiar proverb in Mt. 7? does not fit here. In this passage, it means, Whatever measure you use yourself will be the one in which truth will be measured out to you. If a man accus- toms himself to small measures of truth, small measures will be dealt out to him, and wice versa. kal rpooreOjoerar tpiv—and it shall be increased to you. This is commonly interpreted to mean that not only the same, but a larger measure will be dealt out to them. But this is inconsistent with the statement that in what measure they measure it will be measured to them. zpooreOyoerat IV. 24-27 | THE LAND PRODUCING BY ITSELF 79 as well as petpyOycerac is modified by év @ pérpw perpetre. Ln what measure you measure tt shall be measured and increased to you. The measure and increase of their knowledge will both be proportioned to their own measures. Whatever they present will be filled. Omit Tots dxovovow, who hear, after dutv, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BCDL A 102, etc. Latt. Memph. 25. os yap éxae—/for he who hath. éxer, instead of av xy (who, instead of whoever), Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BCL A 13, 28, 69. This again is a general proverb, applicable to many things, made to do duty in this high and homely discourse. It means in this connection, // @ man has a well-stored mind, he will be continually adding to that store, and on the contrary, small knowt- edge tends to decrease. However, this does not apply to mental ability, but to the use that one makes of his ability, or, as it stands here, to the attentiveness with which he hears. It all depends on the principle that knowledge is a series of successive steps, in which each step depends on the preceding. On the other hand, if a man does not acquire knowledge, the disuse of his faculties implied in that will render them unfit for use. PARABLE OF THE LAND PRODUCING BY ITSELF It is significant that this most fundamental of all the parables is given by Mk. alone, who omits so many given by the other evan- gelists. It is fundamental, because it contains the truth about the adaptation of seed and soil, which underlies all these analogies drawn from the growth of the seed. 26-29. 26. ws avOpwros Ban. The omission of éay renders the construction difficult, which probably accounts for its introduc- tion by some copyist. Two constructions are possible ; either Ws avOpwros os BadAa; OF ws Cav avOpwros BaAyn. The omission of éay in the original is probably a slip. Omit éay after ds, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BD8# L A 13, 28, 33, 69, 118, 124, one ms. of Vulg. Memph. Tov odpov— the seed; the generic use of the article. 27. xabevdn k. eyeipntat vixta K. Huepav— sleeps and wakes dur- ing night and day. The acc. differs from the gen. in such desig- nations of time by denoting duration, instead of periods of time at which the action occurs. The statement connects the two 80 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [Tv 27-29 verbs, instead of separating them, and putting each with its appro- priate time. BAaord Kal pnkivyta'— sprouts and grows. ws ovK oloey adtds —avrds is emphatic ; how, Ae knows not. This does not exclude the processes of cultivation, but refers to the power of growth in the plant itself, beyond the reach or knowledge of the sower. 28. airouarn 4 yn°— the earth of itself. The absence of the connective yap gives force to the statement by the abruptness of its introduction. Omit yap, for, before 7 77, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 ABCL 102, etc. Memph.¢44. Harcl. This statement, that the land bears fruit of itself, is the fact underlying all these analogies of seed and soil. The land contains in itself the elements needed for the nourishment and growth of the plant, and hence the great thing for man to do is to bring together these mutually adapted things, the seed and the soil. And in the spiritual realm, there is the same adaptation of the truth to the spirit of man. The mind of man is related to the truth as the soil to the seed. There may be minor differences of soil, as set forth in the Parable of the Sower, but the prime fact is this generic fitness. All the trust of man in the greatness and prevalence of the truth is warranted by this fact alone. The mind is adapted to the truth, as the eye to the light. This single fact creates the confidence shown by Jesus in the ultimate establish- ment of his kingdom, in spite of the obstacles which obstruct its progress. mpatov xoptov, elrev oraxvy, elrev tANpys otros®*— first blade, then ear, then full grain. eirev, instead of efra, Tisch. WH.& B* LA. Anpns ctros, nom. instead of acc., Tisch. Treg. BD Memph. C* 271 read rAjpes otro. xoprov— literally, grass, ze. the part of the grain which is like grass, before the grain heads out. 29. drav 5é wapadot 6 kdpros— but whenever the fruit permits. mapadot, instead of rapad@, Tisch. Treg. WH. 8* BD A. 1 Bdaora is subj. from the form fAacréw. pyxvvytac means literally to lengthen. It is used only here in N.T., and Is. 4414 in the O.T. In both cases, it is used of the growth of plants, an unfamiliar use of the word. 2 airouaty occurs Only twice in the N.T. On its adverbial use, see Win. 54, 2. 3 The nom. makes this statement independent of the preceding structure, and so calls attention to it. 4So Thay.-Grm. Lex. Meyer, Weiss. The intrans, meaning, presents itself, is not attested. apadoi is an irregular form of the sec. aor. subj., instead of wapaéa. IV. 29] THE MUSTARD SEED SI ev0ds dmooré\Xe 76 Speravov—immediately he sends forth the sickle. Sickle is here put by metonymy for “he reapers. Imme- diately serves to mark vividly the time when man’s inaction ceases. No sooner does the fruit allow, than he puts in the sickle. TEACHING OF THE PARABLE The meaning of the parable is, that direct agencies, human or divine, are employed only at the beginning and end of the proc- ess of establishing the kingdom of God. At the beginning, there is the sowing of the seed, the dissemination of the word among men. And at the end, there is the gathering of the fruit, of men in whom the processes of spiritual growth have reached comple- tion, into his kingdom. During the intervening time, the result is left to the moral and spiritual self-action of humanity, which of itself acts vitally upon the word, turning it into truth of character and conduct. The emphasis of the parable is thus laid on the avrouatn 9 yn Kaptopopel, the carth of ttself bears fruit. So Meyer. Weiss and Holtzmann and others maintain that the parable is only an adaptation of the Parable of the Tares, with the tares left out, and the note of gradual growth introduced, in order to introduce this element into the parabolic teaching. But this is to omit the very point of the parable, the reason for the inactivity during the intermediate period, which is found in the self-activity of the soil, the human spirit. Moreover, this is one of the places where, even more than usual, our Lord lays bare the voof¢s, the essential principles of things. Morison also shows an equal ability to miss the mark, in his statement, that it is the seed which acts atroyuarn. It is not the seed which fructifies the earth, but the earth which fructifies the seed. PARABLE OF THE MUSTARD SEED There is one lesson of the analogy of the growth from seed sown in the earth which remains to be shown. And the Parable of the Mustard Seed is introduced to teach this—that the small beginning and gradual growth is not inconsistent with a great result. G 82 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [IV. 30, 31 30-34. 30. zs 6pordowpev THY BactAEiav TOv Deor, 7 év Tit adTHV napaBorn Oapnev ;'—How shall we liken the kingdom of God, or in what parable shall we set it forth, or place tt? IIds, instead of Tim, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A two mss. Lat. Vet. Harcl. marg. év rlu abrnv tapaBodf Odper, instead of rolg rapaBodF mapaBddwuev avtnv, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BC* L A Memph. Harcl. mars. 31. ws KoKKw owarews —as to a grain of mustard. os, orav » s+ 9 PLKpOTEpOV OV TaVTWY TOV OTEpHaTwV ... , Kal oTav oOTapy® — which, whenever it is sown upon the earth, being (is) greater than all the seeds upon the earth; and whenever tt is sown, etc. puxporepov dv (omit éori), Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BL A (L 6») two mss. Lat. Vet. uxpdrepdv éort D* M etc. peiloy ravTwv Tov Aaxavwv— greater than all the garden-herbs, or vegetables. petfov, instead of uelfwv, Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. RV. 8 ABCELV 33. This comparison is intended to denote the superiority of this plant to others of the class Adxava to which it belongs, which have no woody fibre, like trees and shrubs, so that it even passes over into the latter class, making great branches under which the birds can find shade. And this is contrasted with the unusual smallness of the seed. Mk.and Lk. say directly that it becomes a dévdpov.* aore Sivacat i706 THY Kav avTOD Ta TETELVA TOD OVpAvOD KaTATKY- vouv — so that the birds of heaven can lodge (tent, or camp down) under its shades. This is a different account from that given in Mt. and Lk., where the birds are said to lodge in the branches. Here its great- ness is described by saying that it affords shade for the birds. The parable means that the kingdom is like growing things in having small beginnings and a great ending. 1 The subj. in these verbs is the subj. of deliberative questions, in which the questioner consults another about the matter in hand. See Win. 414, 4. 2 This retains in the answer the construction of the question; supplying the omitted word, it would read, as xékkw oivdtews duordoouer, as to a grain of mustard seed we will liken it. 3 There is a double anacoluthon here; first, the neuter, as if the antecedent were onépua; and secondly, the participle, instead of the indicative. The whole sentence is thrown into confusion by this, so that a literal translation would read, which, whenever it is sown, being less than all seeds, and whenever tt 1s sown, comes up, etc. 4 See Hackett, ///ustrations of Scripture, p. 131. IV. 33, 34] THE MUSTARD SEED 83 COMMON FEATURES OF THE PARABLES In order to understand the significance of this group of para- bles, we have to learn not only their separate meanings, but their common features. They have a mystery of the kingdom to un- fold, namely, the gradualness of its establishment, in opposition to the prevalent notion of its immediate setting up by a Divine, supernatural power. And they give one common reason for this, that the kingdom belongs to the class of things that grow subject to natural laws, not to those that are set up full-grown by external force. More particularly, the Parable of the Sower shows that the present slow growth is due to the differences of soil; that is, of spirit in the hearers. It is a matter of the Word and of hearers of the Word, and the result is largely influenced by the different classes of hearers. The Parable of the Ground Producing by Itself shows that the growth depends on forces hidden in the soil itself, that is, on the adaptation of the spirit to the truth, and that this common fitness underlies all differences of soil. The mind of man and the word of God are at bottom adapted to each other. The Parable of the Mustard Seed shows that small begin- nings belong to the nature of the kingdom, but not less, large and complete results. 33. kat rowtrats mapafsorais odAals éAdder adtois tT. Adyov— and with many such parables he spoke to them the word. ‘That is, the mystery of the kingdom which he was teaching them on this occasion. He did not confine himself to parables on other sub- jects and occasions. Kabws ndvvavro dxovew!|—as they were able to hear. This modi- fication of the statement that he spoke to them in parables, does not mean that he spoke to them in such parables as they were able to hear, not going beyond that limit; but that he spoke to them in parables, as being the form of speech to which they were able to listen. He was not restricted by their only partial ability to hear to some parables, instead of others, but to parables in general, instead of some other mode of address. The mystery of the king- dom itself they were not able to hear, except in this veiled form. 34. rots idiois pabnrais — to his own disciples. Tots idtows wadnrats, instead of rots uadnrais avrov, Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. RV. s BCL A. 1 The earlier classical form of xa@és is «a6 or xadd. See Thay.-Grm. Lex, Win. 2, I, d, e. 84 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [IV. 35, 36 THE STILLING OF THE STORM ON THE LAKE 35-41. Jesus and his disciples cross to the eastern side of the lake, and are overtaken by one of the sudden storms pro- duced by the situation of this inland sea, which Jesus stills with a word. 35. éxeivy T. Huepa— that day, viz. the day on which Jesus uttered the parables. Mt. connects this stilling of the storm with the healing of Peter’s mother-in-law, and the gathering of the mul- titude about him at that time. Cf. Mt. 8”, and Mk. 1***. How- ever, the mark of time in Mt. is not definite enough to create positive disagreement. Lk. says simply on one of the days. éwias* —evening. It is either the time between three and six, or that between six and dark. Probably the former is meant here, as the latter time would not allow for the events that follow. AveAOwpev cis TO mépav > — Let us cross over to the other side. Jesus’ frequent crossing to the other side of the lake was due to its unpopulated condition, and to the comparative ignorance of himself there, giving him an escape from the wearing ministries to the crowd on the populous west shore, and also frequently from his enemies. 36. zapaAdauBavovow airov ws nv év Tt. TAOiw— they take him along as he was in the boat. This refers evidently to the boat from which Jesus taught the multitude, v.". The explanations of the parables, therefore, v.” sq.**, must have been made at some other time. It seems, according to this statement, that the dis- ciples dismissed the multitudes without Jesus leaving the boat, and then, without further delay or preparation, took him along in the boat: where he had remained all the time. Mt. makes the dif- ferent statement, that Jesus embarked in the boat, and his disci- ples followed him. Kat GAAa rAota wv pet avtov — And other boats were with him. Omit 6é after d\Aa, Treg. WH. RV. s BC* LA Latt.etc. mova, instead of rdodpia, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABCDKM A 1, 13, 33, 69, etc. per avtov, with him, settles the fact, that the other boats were in their company. Jesus was followed about from place to place, not only by the twelve regularly and by appointment associated with him, but by other disciples more or less intimately attached to his person. These would follow him in boats across the lake. Mk., with his usual eye for a picture, adds this to complete the scene, and to be carried in the mind when the story of the storm is reached. 1 bias is used as an adjective only, outside of Biblical Greek. It means /ate, 2 Av- in 8:éAOwper, like our word over, refers to the space to be passed through or over in reaching the point designated. IV. 37-41] STILLING OF THE STORM 85 37. Aatday—a storm marked by frequent great gusts of wind. Mt. uses cetouds, which means properly earthquake, but denoting here the turbulence of the storm. kal Ta Kvpata éréBadrev'— and the waves were beating into the boat. «is —into, not against. wate ndyn yepilecOa rt. rroLiov — 50 that already the boat was filling. Not full, AV. The verb is present, and denotes the act in its progress, not its completion. H5n yeulferOar 7d awrotov, instead of a’rd Hdn yeulferPa, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x* BCDL A most mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Harcl. marg. This repetition of the noun, instead of the pronoun, is quite in Mk.’s style. 38. Kal aités qv ev TH mpvpvy— And he was in the stern. The pronoun is emphatic. év TH mpvury, instead of ért, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 ABCDL A etc. This sleep is noticeable, because it shows the fatigue of Jesus after his day’s work, and his unconsciousness of the violent storm. Avdacxare — Teacher, not Master, by which the word is persistently mistranslated inthe EV. The title used by the disciples was prob- ably Rabbi. od pera cor; carest thou not? This question im- plies that they thought of Jesus as waking sufficiently to know what was going on, but going off to sleep again regardless of their fate. 39. éreriunoe — he rebuked. The verb contains in itself not only the notion of chiding, but also of restraint by that means. Proba- bly, all that Jesus said was vara, repipwoo, so that the chiding would be expressed in the tones of his voice. zediuwoo — be silent, be muzzled. Cf. 1 Cor. 9*, TR. The latter is not only a strong word in itself, but the perf. imp. strengthens the command, like our have done with tt. It means not only 4e s#/Z, but stay so. éxdrracev — ceased. This again is a descriptive word, denoting not only ceasing, but the ceasing of atired person. yaAnjvy peyaAn —a great calm, contrasted with the great storm. Cf. v.”. 40. Ti derol éore; ovtw éxere riot ;—Why are you fearful ? have you not yet faith? The lack of faith is in himself, in his power and disposition to care for them, and, as implied in the ovrw, after so many attestations of both. Their appeal to him while he was asleep had not been the calm invocation of a trusted power, but the frightened reproach of those whose faith is defeated by danger. ovrw, instead of ovrw; ms ovx, Treg. WH. RV. & BDL A, most miss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. 41. édoByPnoav pPoBov péeyav— they were frightened a great Jright® The subject is the disciples, who alone are mentioned 1 On this intransitive use of B4AAw and its compounds, see Win. 38, I. | 2 See Win. 43, 4. 3 See Win. 32, 2. 86 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [IV. 41-V. here. Mt., on the contrary, says ot dvOpwro. Tis doa— who then, a question inspired by what they had seen. dr1— chaz. But the conj. is causal, denoting the reason of their fright, and of the question that is forced from them. kat 6 aveyos xk. 7 Oaracoa — even the wind and the sea. Not only diseases and demons, but the ele- ments themselves. Their wonder in this case took the form of fear, corresponding to the feeling with which they regarded the power of the elements against which Jesus matched himself. wza- kove.— obeys him. ‘The wind and the sea are looked at collectively here, as making one great whole. Bair braxover, instead of brakovove.y, Tisch. Treg. WH. s* BCL A 1, 13, 28, 69, etc. Weiss and Beyschlag rationalize this miracle after the same general fashion. The rebuke of the disciples grows into a rebuke of the elements, and the confidence of Jesus in his Father’s deliv- erance into an assertion of his own power to still the waves. Holtzmann adds to this the presence in the narrative of O.T. material, which has been used in building up the account. Weiss is not so rationalistic in this as the others, as he is contending only against the notion that Jesus performs the miracles himself, instead of the Father. The command given to the elements, he thinks, would be an assumption of power over them by Jesus himself. But any more so than the commands given to the demons? He acts throughout as God’s agent, but such an agent can order about demons and storms. Holtzmann is prepossessed against miracles in general; Beyschlag against miracles in the sphere of inanimate nature, where spirit does not act upon spirit. But the apostolic source of the narrative renders this rationalizing futile. The general fact of the miracles is established by this, and by their absolute uniqueness, conforming them to the unique quality of Jesus’ whole life in the moral sphere. This leaves room to exclude individual miracles for special reasons, or even to discriminate among kinds of miracles, as Beyschlag does. But Beyschlag’s principle excludes, e.g. the miracle of feeding the multitude, the best attested of all the miracles. And there is no other special improbability about this miracle of stilling the storm—on the contrary, a certain congruousness, a manifestation of the fact that the power resident in nature is in the last analysis spiritual, and that Jesus was the Agent of that Power. ‘ RELATION OF THE SYNOPTICAL ACCOUNTS v. All of the Synoptics agree in correlating the three miracles narrated in this chapter. And Mk. and Lk. agree in general in the relation of these to events preceding and following. But VL 2| HEALING OF THE GERGESENE DEMONIAC 87 Mt. places them in an entirely different connection. According to him, the occasion of Jesus’ crossing to the other side was the gathering of the multitude about him owing to the miracles accompanying the healing of Peter’s mother-in-law. And the parables are said to be delivered on a day following, not preced- ing, the sending forth of the twelve, and removed from these events by a considerable interval. According to our account, the evident intention is to connect Jesus’ departure with the failure of Jesus’ mission to the Galileans marked by the veiled teaching of the parables. The recurrence of the same language in various places marks the interdependence of the Synoptics, as also the correlation of the events. But Mk.’s fulness of detail, in which he is followed to some extent by Lk., is characteristic. HEALING OF THE GERGESENE DEMONIAC 1-20. Jesus crosses the lake into Decapolis on the south- eastern shore, and heals a man said to be possessed of a host of demons. The demons, driven out of the man, enter with Jesus permission into a herd of swine, and the maddened beasts rush into the lake and are drowned. 1. eis Thy xwpav Tov Tepacnvav — into the country of the Gera- senes. Yadapnvav is the probable reading in Mt., and Tepyeonvav in Lk. The country of the Gadarenes designates the district gen- erally by the name of a principal city. Tepyeonvav is probably the name of the town in whose immediate vicinity the event occurred, which must have been on the shore of the lake. Tepacnvéy is more difficult to dispose of, as Gerasa is too far away to be the scene of the incident, or even to become a familiar designation of the general locality. And the similarity of name indicates that it has been confused with the nearer Gergesa.' Tepacnvey, instead of Tadapnvay, Tisch. Treg. 8* BD Latt. Tepyeonvav Treg. marg. WH. RV. LU A 1, 28, 33, 118, 131, 209, Memph. Harcl. marg. Internal, as well as external, evidence favors T'epacnvdr. 2. é&ehOovros adrod — The TR. gives the proper construction of the part., putting it in agreement with aire after iryvrncev. This improper use of the gen. absolute is a specimen of the inaccuracy of Mk. in dealing with the part., like the puxpdrepov ov of 47. The 1 See Thompson, Land and Book, Bib. Dic. 88 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [V. 2-5 TR. is an evident correction of this mistake by some copyist. Mt.’s repetition of the inaccuracy is one of the proofs of the interdependence of the Synoptics. Mt. 8”, Critical Text. éfeXObvrTos avrod, instead of éfeAOdvTe adr@, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BCL A 1, 13, 33, 69, 118, 124, 131, 209, 346, two mss. Lat. Vet. (Memph. Syrr.). vmrjvrnoer, instead of adrjvrycev, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BCDGL A I, 13, 28, 69, etc. éx TOV pvnuetwv — out of the tombs. These were natural or artificial excavations in the rocks, frequently cut laterally in the hills, and often left uncovered, which, like other caves, would be resorts for wild men and beasts. év wvevpate axafapto —in an unclean spirit.’ 3. pvyjpaow. This, like pvnpecwv, v.2, means properly monuments. Tombs is a Biblical meaning. ‘This adds to the previous statement that the man came from the tombs, that he had his home there. pvjpacty, instead of uvnuelois, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 ABCL ATI etc. ovde advoe ovkért ovdeis CSvvato — literally, and not even with a chain could no one no longer bind him. The RV. manages, by an ingenious arrangement of the negatives, to hide their barbarism. But the original couples them together without any mitigation of their effect. The TR. evidently omits ovxér to get over this roughness. ove, instead of ove, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL A 33, etc. adtoe, instead of advceowv, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. BC* L 33, two mss. Lat. Vet. ovcért before ovdeis Tisch. Treg, WH. RV. s BC* DL A 13, 28, 69, 124, 346, Lat. Vet. (most mss.) Vulg. 4. dia TO adrov roAAdKis 7édals Kal adver SedecOar — on account of his having been bound often with fetters and chains.2 The perf. inf. here, and in deoraoGar and ovvrerpipOa is used to denote the relation of these past acts to the present inability.2 édais Kai éAvoeot. — bonds for the feet and other parts of the body. de- orac0a Kx. ovvretpipbar — rent asunder, and crushed together. Breaking by pulling, and by the opposite motion of crushing, are denoted severally. Kat ovdeis toxvey airov dayaca — and no one had strength to tame him. ‘The statement of reasons for their inability to bind him ends with ovyrerpipOa, and this introduces another independent statement. 5. €v Tols pvyjpacw K. év Tots dpeat— in the tombs and in the mountains. Probably, these are specific and general designations of place — zn the tombs and in other parts of the hills. tw xpatwv k. katakortwv —he was crying and cutting. This vivid circumlo- 1 See on 322, 124, 2 On this use of &a with the inf. and art., see Win. 44, 6. 3 See Win. 44, 7. V. 5-8] HEALING OF THE GERGESENE DEMONIAC 89 cution for the impf. is characteristic of Mk. The forcible descrip- tions of the violence and frenzied strength of the demoniac are also peculiar to Mk. Mt. tells us simply that no one could pass that way, and Lk. that he went about naked. Two qualities in Mk. lead to this: first, his vividness of narration, and secondly, his desire to emphasize the greatness of Jesus’ miracles. 6. ard paxpddev — from a distance.’ rpocexivnce atta — he made obetsance to him.’ ‘The verb in the N.T. denotes prostration before another in token of reverence, but properly it denotes reverence by kissing the hand towards another. This act of homage seems inconsistent with the expostulation which follows. It is evident, throughout the narrative, that Jesus has to deal with a hostile attitude in the man, dominated, as he is, by the demon. But the demons, nothwithstanding, recognize Jesus’ mastery over them, and adopt a suppliant rather than a defiant attitude. The zpocexvve is not inconsistent with the opxilw, OF wapexdAre, v.'”", A€yet, says. The historical present, characteristic of Mk. This reading, instead of eize, said, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABCKLM A Harcl. etc. 7. Ti €uot kat cot —What have I to do with thee? This repro- duces the language of 1“, a more or less suspicious imitation. The language of the expostulation is exactly the same as in Lk. In Mt. it is Té Hpiv Kai coi, vié rov Meov; As this is probably a reproduction of what was spoken originally in Aramaic, the resem- blance points strongly to the interdependence of the Synoptics. The man speaks here under the influence of the demons possess- ing him, identifying himself with them, but not so as to represent their plurality stated in v.*. It was such addresses as this which led Jesus to prevent the recognition of himself by the demoniacs. pn pe Bacavions — torment me not. This would easily imply that Jesus’ command to them to vacate the man implied remand- ing them to the place of torment. And Lk.’s account follows this out in the aBvocov, 8". Also Mt. in zpo xatpov, 8%. But Mk. is not constructed on that basis, as he substitutes é€w rjs xwpas for eis THY GBvooov. According to him, this would represent therefore the man’s insane terror of being driven out of his haunts. 8. édeyev yap — The reason of the protest of the demons against Jesus’ interference with them was his command to them to vacate. It is difficult to find a place to put this in, as the man’s action and words in the preceding verse seem to succeed each other 1 waxpddev. The prep. expresses the same relation as the termination of the adv. On this redundancy, belonging to later Greek, see Win. 65, 2, The adv. itself belongs to the same period. 2 This use of the dat. is peculiar to later authors, the regular construction being the acc. See Win. 4, 31,14. 90 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [v. 8,9 immediately in such a way as to make one act, occasioned appar- ently by his sight of Jesus at a distance. But evidently this sequence must be interrupted somewhere to introduce this. aito— to him. Only the man has been mentioned before, which would lead us to refer this to him. But the command is evidently addressed to the demon. ‘The confusion is due to the identification of the two. "EéedOe, 70 wvevpa TO axabaprov — Come out, thou unclean spirit. 9. Ti dvoua oa ;—Whatis thy name ?* It is a curious question, why Jesus asked this question of the demoniac, and it has been curiously answered ; ¢.g. that Jesus saw the state of the case, and wished to bring it out in order to impress on the witnesses the greatness of the miracle. This ostentation we know to be far from the spirit of Jesus, who performed his miracles for beneficent purposes alone, and with secrecy, instead of ostentation. We are in the region of conjecture here, but we can guess at it somewhat after this fashion. May it not be, that the purpose of Jesus was hindered by this identification of the man with the demons, lead- ing him to resist the cure? In that case, Jesus might ask the question in order to bring before the man the nature of the power holding him in thrall, so as to make some break in the terrible sympathy and alliance of the two. But it is all mixed up with the question as to the nature of this possession, and how far the account of the cure has been modified by the view of it taken by the narrators. It is comparatively useless to discuss details where the main facts are so much in doubt. kai A€yer adita Aeyiwv — And he says to him, Legion. Aéye: ad7@, instead of dzexplOn, Néywr, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABCKLM AII text, two mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Syrr. Aeyiwy, instead of Aeyeay, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s* B* CDL A Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Syrr. Legion is the Roman name for a body of soldiers numbering, when full, 6000 men. Of course, it is a rhetorical and exagger- ated statement by the man of his state, as if he had said, / fee/ as if I were possessed by a thousand devils. Ott ToAAOL éopev — because we are many. Lk. puts this state- ment into the mouth of the Evangelist, saying himself that it was because many demons entered into the man. But it seems that Mk. is more correct, as he is certainly more effective, in making the demoniac say this; for it traces back to the man himself the hallucination which gives shape to the story. In Lk. the plural- ity, which formed a part of the man’s delusion, is transferred to the statement of facts. 1 On the use of the nom., instead of the voc., see Win. 29, 2. 2 On the omission of the art. with d6voua, see Win, Ig, 23, Ae 10-13] HEALING OF THE GERGESENE DEMONIAC QI 10. Kai mapexdde adrov ToAXG iva py aiTa adrocteikn — And he besought him much that he would not send them. avra, instead of av’rovs, Tisch. Treg. WH. BC A etc. But atra looks like an emendation. Here, again, the man identifies himself with the demons, but not so as to protest any longer against their expulsion. Only one demon has been mentioned before, vv.” *. But with v.°, it begins to be assumed that there is a host of them, and the plural is used. egw THS xwpas — out of the country.’ Lk. says eis riv &Bvacoy, into the abyss, t.e. into Gehenna, the place of evil spirits. And it has been supposed that our phrase means out of the earth, mak- ing it equivalent to this. But plainly, ywpa does not mean the earth as distinguished from the under world, but one part of the earth as distinct from another. 7 is the proper word for earth, or world. But just as plainly, the translation, out of the country (put into the mouth of the demons, so to speak), creates another diffi- culty. What preference they should have for one country over another is one of the mysteries connected with these stories of demoniacal possession. It can be explained only as part of the hallucination of the demoniac, to be referred possibly to his terror of city or town, and his unwillingness to be driven out of the soli- tary wild district haunted by him. Lk.’s statement is probably an attempt to remove the difficulty. 11. pods To dper — on the mountain side.’ T@ dpe, instead of ra dpn, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. and about all the principal sources. xoipwv — swine. The presence of these unclean animals, so abhorrent to the Jews, indicates, what we know from other sources, that the region was inhabited by a mixed population, in which Gentiles predominated.’ 12. Kal mapexaAecav attov—and they besought him’ Here the subject changes from the man speaking for the demons to the demons speaking through the man. mepivov — Lk. says, iva érirpeyy, that he would permit, a modifi- cation which Mk. introduces in his account of Jesus’ answer. Omit rayres oi Saiuoves with mapexddecar, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCLA I, 13, 28, 69, 102, 118, 131, 209, 251, 346, Memph. 13. Kai érerpepev— and he permitted them. Omit ev0éws 6 "Inoots, immediately Fesus, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCLA I, 28, 102, 118, 131, 209, two mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. Pesh. 1 On the use of éfw as a prep., see Win. 54, 6. 2 On the use of mpés with dat., see Win. 48¢. The art. denotes the mountain in the vicinity. 8 See Schiirer, VV. Zg. II. 1, 121. 4 The meaning deseech belongs to rapaxadciv only in later Greek. 92 THE GOSPEL OF MARK |'V. 13-15 cio AOov els Tovs xoipovs — entered into the swine. Itis evidently the intention of the writer that the man was possessed by a host of demons, and that this host of demons — no less would be re- quired — entered into the herd of (two thousand) swine. ‘This literalizing of the demoniac’s Zegion, the multiplication of the difficulty of possession by the thousands, and the addition of the difficulty of demoniac possession of swine, makes this part of the story a tax upon our belief. Demoniacal possession is in itself such a tax, but this story shows whereto such belief in a credulous age tends. ‘The facts in this case are the cure and the rush of the frightened swine. ‘The traditional account connects them in such a way as to make Jesus responsible for one as well as the other. Leave out now the elements of the story con- tributed by the idea of possession, and substitute the theory of lunacy, and the rational account of the fright and destruction of the swine is that it was occasioned by some paroxysm of the lunatic himself. Kal dppnoew 4 ayeAn Kara Tod Kpynpvod cis tHv Oadraccay, ws Surxidvoc— and the herd rushed down the dechvity into the sea, about two thousand (of them). Omit foav be, and there were, before as dirx thio, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BC* DL A 1, mss. of Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Pesh. kpnuvod, a perfectly good Greek word, occurs in the N.T. only in the parallel Synoptical accounts of this event, and the verbal resemblance is an important item in the proof of the interde- pendence of the Synoptics. os duryidot in the reading adopted is in apposition with 7 dyéAn — the herd, about two thousand (of them). 14. Kal of Bédcxovres abrovs Epvyov Kal dmyyyeiAav— And those feeding them fled and brought the news. Kal ol, instead of Ol 6é, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABCDLM A two mss. Lat. Vet. Syrr. avrods, instead of rods xolpous, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BCDL A 13, 69, 124, 346, Latt. Memph. Pesh. dmrnyyeday, instead of avyyyerar, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABCDKLM II etc. cis THY ToAW Kal eis Tos dypovs — lo the city and to the Jarms. rédw is the city Gergesa (Gerasa) in the neighborhood.’ dypovs denotes the farms or hamlets in the vicinity. al 7A@ov — and they came, viz. the inhabitants generally. HrOov, instead of e&MNOov, they came out, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. w° ABKLMU II* 33, etc. Memph. Harcl. 15. Kal Oewpodor rov Sapovi€opevoy KaOypevov ipariopevov — and they behold the demoniac sitting clothed. Oewporor, they behold, expresses the kind of sight directed towards notable objects.” 1 See on v.}, 2 See Thay.-Grm, Lex, Synonyms of Gewpetv. v. 15-19 | HEALING OF THE GERGESENE DEMONIAC 93 Satpovi€ouevov is timeless. The temporal relation would be expressed by the aor. dawovcb&vra.' iwariopevov — clothed. This implies what Lk. states, that the man in his previous state had torn his clothes from him. Lk. 8%. rov éoynxora rov Aeyrava — who had the legion. We have already seen how it is implied that Mk. accepts the man’s account of himself in telling the story of the swine. Here he does it expressly. kai époBnOnoav — and they were frightened. ‘The thought of the miracle alone produced this effect. 16. kal Supyjoavro—and... reported in full, rehearsed. The verb denotes the fulness of the account — “hey went through it all, 17. THEY BESEECH HIM TO DEPART This is the only case in our Lord’s ministry in which his mira- cles operated against him in this way, and it is to be accounted for by the strange element in this case, the mixture of gain and loss in the result. Men welcome a beneficent power, and so we find the multitudes following Jesus. But they are repelled from a destructive power, and all the more, if it is supernatural. This explains the singular treatment, but the infraction of our Lord’s rule, to use his power only for beneficent purposes, is itself to be accounted for. And it enforces the question already raised, if this is not one of the cases in which we have to separate between the facts and the explanations and inferences of the Evangelists. The facts are the cure of the man and the destruction of the swine. But is Jesus responsible for the destruction? The whole idea of possession is beset with serious difficulties, and in this case, the substitution of lunacy for possession removes not only these, but also this anomaly in the action of Jesus. 18. €uPaivovros — As he was entering. The present part. de- notes action contemporaneous with that of the principal verb. éuBatvovros, instead of éuBdvTos, was come, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x& ABCDKLM AII 1, 33, 124, most mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. 6 datpovicbeis — He who had been possessed with demons. The aor. part. denotes a state preceding the action of the principal verb.” iva pet avtod y — that he may be with him? 19. Kat ov« adjxev airov — and he did not permit him. kal, instead of 6 dé "Ingots, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABCKLM AII 1, 33, 102, two mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Syrr. 1 See Burton, V. 7. Moods and Tenses, 123. 2 See on rov Saporvigduevor, v.15, 8 On the use of iva with subj. after a verb of asking, see Win. 144, 8. Clearly, the clause with iva expresses the contents of the petition, not its purpose. 94 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [V. 19-43 Kai dmayyeAov doa 6 Kipids cou reroinxeyv—and report how much the Lord hath done for thee. amdyyetdov, instead of dvayyerdov, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BC A etc. metoinkev, instead of érolnce, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 ABCL II etc. This command, the exact opposite of the injunction of secrecy usually enforced by Jesus, is due to the fact that this was a region not frequented by him, and in which, therefore, the ordinary reasons for such silence were inoperative. His enemies were not here, nor his injudicious friends, nor the people to be blinded by his miracles to his more spiritual work. But it was a region rarely visited by him, and out of which he himself had just been driven, where therefore the story told by this man would be the only message of glad-tidings brought to the people. Moreover, the message which Jesus gives him does not concern our Lord him- self, but God, to whom 6 Kvptos evidently refers. The effect pro- duced would thus be, not a false Messianism, as in Galilee, but a sense of God’s presence and pity. The demoniac’s story would counteract the impression made by the destruction of the swine. And it would be kept in Decapolis, where it would do no harm, and away from the already excited Galilee. doa 6 Kipids cou reroinkev, kal 7AEenoe ce — how much the Lord hath done for thee, and pitied thee. 6 Kvptos — is evidently used of God, as neither the man himself nor his friends would understand its application to Jesus. And besides, this is a case in which Jesus would especially desire to call attention to what God had done for him. Lk. says 6 @eds, 8% 20. ty AexaroX\a — Decapols, the ten city district, is the name applied to the cities, east of the Jordan, liberated by Pompey from Jewish rule, which united in the ten city alliance. These cities had been Hellenistic since the Syrian conquest, had been con- quered and subjected to Jewish rule by the Maccabees, and were finally liberated by Pompey. Schiirer, II. 1, 23, 1. RAISING OF THE DAUGHTER OF JAIRUS, AND HEAL— ING OF THE WOMAN WITH AN ISSUE OF BLOOD 21-43. /esus, repelled by the people of Decapolis, returns to the western shore of the lake, and there ratses the daughter 1 The translation gives just the slight irregularity of the Greek; “ how much” is the object of the first verb; and an adverb modifying the second, which is pre- cisely the double use of 60a. So Meyer, who calls it seugmatisch. On the con- junction of the perf. and aor., see Win. 272. The perf. suggests the present condition as well as the past act, while the aor. denotes only the past action. : 21-23 | THE DAUGHTER OF JAIRUS O5 of a synagogue ruler by the name of Jatrus. On his way to the house of Jairus, he ts approached in the crowd by a woman with an tissue of blood, who is healed at the touch of his garment. 21. «cis TO repay maAW ovvynxOn — having crossed over to the other side, again there was gathered. els TO mépav wary, instead of wadduv els 76 wépav, Tisch. 8 D mss. of Lat. Vet. Syrr. It is more in Mk.’s manner to connect raduv with cur}y On. kal nv Tapa THY OdAacoay — And he was by the sea. According to Mt., Jairus came to Jesus while he was in the house. He places the events after the crossing of the lake in the following order: first, the healing of the paralytic, and the dispute about forgiveness of sins; then, the call of Matthew; then, the question of John’s disciples about fasting ; and then, while he was saying these things, the coming of Jairus. And these events are connected all the way through by marks of time, fixing the chronological connection. MELT. 22. Kai épxerat els TOv apxiovvaywywv '— And there comes one of the synagogue-rulers. Omit idov before épxera:, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDL A 102, mss. of Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Pesh. According to Schiirer, the dpy:ovvaywyos is to be distinguished from the dpxwyr, the officer having general direction of the affairs of the synagogue ; and he is not an official conducting the worship, for which no special appointment was made; but he is the officer entrusted with the care of public worship, including the appoint- ment of readers and preachers. Mt. calls Jairus an dpywv, and Lk. uses the two names interchangeably, which is explained by the fact, that the two offices, though distinct, might be com- bined in one person. Generally, there was only one dpyiovvaywyos in each synagogue, and els rév dpyicvvaywywv may mean one of the class simply. S. Schiirer, IT. 2. 27. 23. mapaxadet — beseeches. mapakandet, instead of rapexdder, desought, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 ACL 33, etc. éxet €oyatws — is at the point of death? Mt. says dptu éreAe’rnoev, just died, evidently confounding this 1 apxovvaywyos is found in profane writings only in Inscriptions. __ 2 éoxdTws is found in the N.T. only here. Its use to denote at the point of death, in extremis, is condemned by Atticists. See Thay.-Grm., Lex. 96 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [V. 23-25 with the message brought later by members of his household. Lk. says dreOvnoxev, was dying. iva éA\Owv ériOys — that you may come and lay.' iva owOy Kat (yoy — that she may be saved and live. tva owOH Kai (hoy, instead of Srws... Shoerat, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BCDL A 13, 69, 346, most mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. 24. qKodrovGa . . . (xAos) . . ., Kal cvveOABov —a crowd fol- lowed, and they pressed? THE WOMAN WITH AN ISSUE OF BLOOD There is a peculiar turn given to this story by the statement of Mk. and Lk. that Jesus recognized that power had gone forth from him. Mt. treats it as an ordinary miracle, in which Jesus con- sciously exercises his healing power. But Mk. and Lk. represent it as a miracle in which the woman herself, unknown to Jesus, draws upon his healing power, and Jesus knows it only by the departure of the power, of which he becomes conscious as he would be of any bodily change happening to him. It would seem that this is a case in which the miracle was performed directly by God, without the intervention of Jesus, of which Jesus becomes aware by the touch of the woman, but not by the loss of power. This makes an opening, as Mt.’s account does not, for the expla- nation of Mk. and Lk. The fact for which they try to make way in their account is the cure of the woman without the intervention of Jesus. But here again, we have to distinguish between the fact which they preserve for us, and their explanation, arising from reflection on the fact. The one is a matter of testimony, and the other of judgment. 25. Kai yuvy otoa — And a woman being. Omit tis, 2 certain, before odca, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 ABCL A mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Harcl. ovoa év pioe aiparos érn Swoexa — being in an issue of blood twelve years. There is nothing in the language, which is quite 1 This is explained by Win. as a weakened form of i imp. 43,5. My prayer is, that you may come. On the laying on of hands, see on 141, 2 guvé6A:Bov is found in the N.T. only in this passage. The change from the sing. nxoAovder to the plur. is due to the crowding being thought of, not as the act of the crowd collectively, but individually. 8 The prep. denotes the state of the woman. The pres. part. etca is used here of a past state continuing into the present, a temporal relation properly expressed by the perf. Burton, V. 7. Moods and Tenses, 131 ¢. V. 25-29] THE WOMAN WITH AN ISSUE OF BLOOD 97 general, not technical, to denote the nature of this hemorrhage, but it was probably menstrual. 26. roAAa wafotvca vrd TOAAGY latpOv — having suffered many things at the hands of many physicians.’ Sanravnocaca Ta rap’ éav- Ts mavta — having spent all that she had? pndev wpeAnPeioa — seeing that she was no way benefited? pndev is used, instead of ovdev, because of the writer’s way of conceiving what is nevertheless stated as a fact. He is giving here not only the facts, but the facts as they lay in the woman’s mind and became her reasons for coming to Jesus. He suggests that she knew all this, and reasoned it out this way, and this subjective view is implied in the use of pydév. Win. 55, g, B. 27. dxovoaca Ta wept Inoov — having heard the things concerning Jesus. ra is inserted before mepi by Tisch. (Treg. marg.) WH. RV. 8* BC* A etc. The things concerning Jesus were the reports of his miracles. So far, the participles have denoted the particulars of the woman’s state, previous to her coming to Jesus, and this identity of relation has led to the use of kai or dAAa to connect them. Now, the narra- tive passes over to a new relation, and the conjunction is dropped. eX\Ootoa— having come. Here, the long line of participles ceases to be elegant, and should have been replaced by 7A6e kai, she came and, 28. “Ori éav awpat Kav Tov ivatriav— Tf J touch his garments only éav dwua Kav Tov iwatidy, instead of kav Trav ivariwy... dywua, Tisch. Treg. warg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A etc. The woman seeks to be cured in this surreptitious way because of her uncleanness.° 29. eyvw 7H cdpat.—she knew in her body. The changed condition, like the disease itself, would make itself known physi- cally. dru tara dd THs paotvyos — that she has been healed of the 1 }ra differs from ara in such cases as denoting under, or at the hands of, an effi- cient cause, while a7) means merely from, an occasional cause. Win. 47 4. p. 364, 368, Thayer’s Translation. map’ éavtns is a case of attraction, the prep. taking the gen. after it, instead of the dat., as if it were connected with Saravyjcaca. See Win. 47 4. 66, 6. : 3 On the absurd medical treatment of such cases, see Geikie, Life of Christ, chap. 42. 4 Literally, ¢f J touch if even his garments, It is a case of condensed structure, with dwar repeated after cav, understood. ér. introduces a direct quotation. In translating the clause, only or even belongs with garments, not with touch.— // J touch his garments only, 5 See Lev. 155-27, H 98 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [V. 29-34 scourge. paoré is used in Greek writers to denote any calamity providentially, a waorE Geod. But the providential view does not appear in the N.T. use, but only a figurative designation of the effect of disease. 30. ev éavro—in himself. Denotes the inwardness of his knowledge, proceeding from his own feelings, not from his knowledge of what the woman had done. ‘This feeling is where Jesus’ knowledge of the facts began, and signifies that he had no conscious part in the miracle. Also the expression riv é€ abrod dvvapuv e€eXOovoav, the power gone out from him, indicates that the writer conceives of the cure as effected not by the conscious exer- cise of power by Jesus, but by power that went out from him involuntarily, and of which he became conscious only afterwards. Lk. relates the story from the same point of view. Mt. tells us that the woman expected to be cured in that way, but that Jesus felt the touch, and sought the woman out, after which the miracle proceeded in the ordinary way. It is possible that the cure took place without Jesus’ intervention, but by a direct Divine act, as in the other cases in which the throng about him sought to touch even the hem of his garment, and as many as touched were healed. Only, in this case, Jesus knew in some way that there had been a touch on him different from that of the crowd, and chose to trace it and bring himself into personal contact with the person from whom it proceeded, instead of allowing it to remain in the imper- sonal form which was necessary in the case of numbers doing the same thing. This has been interpreted by Mk. and Lk. into a miracle done not by Divine intervention, but coming from a spring of power in Jesus, which could be drawn on, but not without his feeling the efflux, the loss of power. While Mt. has reduced it to a miracle of the ordinary kind. 32. tHv TovTo Toncacav — her who did this. ‘This is anticipat- ing the result of his search. Jesus was ignorant who had done it, and so of course, whether it was man or woman. 33. hoBnbeicu x. tpeuovca — the aor. pass., denoting a past act, and the pres., denoting a present state ; having been frightened and trembling. 34. tzaye eis elpyvyv—go in health. An exact translation of the Heb./ niv’5) 45, the salutation used by them in saying /ave- well. ionvy does not have its Greek meaning, feace, but one imported directly from the Heb., gexeral wellbeing, or in this case, health. This is the primary meaning of the Heb. word, and eace only a secondary meaning, whereas feace is the only meaning of the Greek word. Our version translates it always peace, which is misleading. 1 iarac is a perfect pass. of the deponent verb idoua:, which has a passive signi- fication in the perf., aor. pass., and 1 fut. V. 34-43] THE DAUGHTER OF JAIRUS 99 kat oO bys — and be well, This must not be taken to mean that the cure was performed now for the first time, as everything in the story points to the fact that the cure was effected when she touched Jesus, v.”. THE DAUGHTER OF JAIRUS. This is the only case of raising of the dead related by all the Synoptics. Only Lk. tells of the case at Nain, 7'*”. The words, she did not die, but sleeps, lend themselves so readily to the sup- position that this was not a case of raising the dead, that it is no wonder that they have been so used. Beyschlag treats it as a case in which the state ordinarily called death has been reached, but in which there has been no final separation of soul and body, so that there is a possibility of awakening, which there would not be, if the connection between the two had been actually severed. Holtzmann treats the language more rudely as a contradiction within the story itself of its miraculous intention. Everything else in the three accounts favors the hypothesis of death. The announcement in Mt. is that the child is dead, in Mk. and Lk., that she is dying, and later, that she is dead. Lk. says that they knew her to be dead, an expression which is inappropriate, if it was their mistaken supposition. And Jesus signifies his sense of the momentousness of the occasion by taking with him only the three, a selection reserved for the critical periods of his life. On the other hand, the explanation of Jesus’ words, which makes she did not die, but sleeps mean that this was not an ordinary case of death, though really death ; but resembling sleep, since the child was to be raised, does not seem quite adequate. And Beyschlag’s explanation is worthy of serious consideration. But it is purely an exegetical consideration. His general objection to miracles of resurrection is a question by itself, and the theory of miracles to which it belongs discredits many of Jesus’ miracles without suffi- cient reason. He attributes the genuine cases to the immense influence of Jesus’ personality on other men, with its reaction on the body, and of course excludes all miracles on nature, and of actual reanimation of a dead body. When once the soul and body are finally severed, the possibility of reanimation ceases. Mean- time, it seems quite certain that the narratives themselves treat this as a case of raising the dead. 100 THE GOSPEL OF MARK |'V. 35-39 35. epyovrat dro Tov dpxicvvaywyou — they come from the syna- gogue’s ruler’s house. ‘The Greek says from the synagogue ruler, but he was with Jesus, and they bring the message to him. Sri} Ovydrnp cov améBave* ti ert oKvAXEs Tov SiddoKaAov ; — thy daughter has died; why troublest thou the teacher further ?* 36. “Incots zapaxovous — Jesus having overheard, i.e. heard what was not addressed to him. Omit et@éws before mapaxovcas, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDL A 1, 28, 40, 209, 225, 271, mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Pesh. etc. mapaxovcas, instead of dxovcas, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x* &¢> BL A one ms. Lat. Vet. _ povoy wiatreve—In accordance with the ordinary use of the present imp., this means, hold on to your faith, do not lose it.” 37. per airov ovvaxoAovOjou — Literally, 70 accompany with him. ‘The ordinary construction is the dat. per’ avbrod, instead of a’r@, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A one ms. Lat. Vet. Pesh. Tlérpov, x. “IdkwBov, x. Iwavvnv — The prominence here given to these three is repeated at the Transfiguration and in Gethsemane (9? 14%). The reason for admitting only these in this case is the same which led him to enjoin secrecy in regard to his miracles generally, but which is enhanced by the extraordinary nature of this miracle. His miracles generally earned him an undesired notoriety, but this would startle even one accustomed to them, and would excite a furor among the people. Note on 1”. 38. kai épyovrar . . . Kal Oewpet OdpvBov Kal KAatovras — and they come... and he sees a crowd and persons weeping. %pxovrat, instead of pxera, he comes, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 ABCDF A I, 33, some mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Pesh. «al before kdalovras, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 ABCLMU AII mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Syrr. dAaddlovras — wailing, is an onomatopoetic word, coming from dA\add, a cry uttered originally by soldiers going into battle, but afterwards adapted to other cries expressing various feelings. Elsewhere, in the N.T., it is used only in 1 Cor. 13', to denote the clanging of a cymbal. It is used very appropriately of the monotonous wail of hired mourners. 39. Ti BopvBetabe cat xrdaiere; —Why do you make a tumult and weep? Mt. also speaks of the crowd as OopvBovpevoy, and intro- duces aiAnrds, flute-players. There was the exaggerated noise and ostentation of hired mourners. 1 gxvAAecs Means properly ¢o fay, and is used in the weakened sense, #o ¢roud/e, only in the Biblical and still later Greek. In the N.T. it is a rare word, and its use here and in the parallel passage, Lk. 849, is one of the strong indications that the Synoptical Gospels are interdependent. 2 See Win. 43, 3 4. V. 39-43] THE DAUGHTER OF JAIRUS IOI TO TaLdiov ovK arébavev, GAG Kabevde. — the child did not die, but sleeps. This may be said from the standpoint of Jesus, who knows that she is to be raised, so turning her death into sleep. But see note at beginning of paragraph. Kai kateyéAwy avtov — and they laughed him down. ‘They under- stood him literally, and Lk. says that they knew the child to be dead. 40. avtos de éxBadwv mavras — but he, having put out all. avrds dé, instead of 6 6é, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL A 33, Lat. Vet. except one ms. Vulg. Memph. Kal Tous pet avtou— and those with him, viz. Peter, James, and John. Orov Hv TO Tatdiov — where the child was. Omit dvaxeluevor, lying, after radlov, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BDL A 102, mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. 41. TadwOa, xovijp— Maiden, arise. Tada is the Chaldaic xmrop, fem. of s15u, @ youth. xovp is the Heb. imp. O17. Kxodue of the TR. is the proper fem. form. «ovum is the masc. used as an interjection. The language of Jesus reproduced here is an indi- cation that he spoke in Aramaic, the language of Palestine at the time. Kovp (Kody, Treg.), Tisch. WH. 8 BCLM 1, 33, 271, one ms. Lat. Vet. éyeipe, instead of éyecpar, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABCDL ATI etc. Td xopdovov — Maiden.’ } 42. iv yap érav dwdexa —for she was twelve years old. This is introduced to explain the walking, nothing having been said about her age before. éféornoay evOds éxotrdoe peyaddAyn — they were amazed immediately with a great amazement.’ evOds after étéornoav, Tisch. (Treg. marg.) WH. RV. 8 BCL A 33, Memph. 43. SuecreiAato — he commanded? iva pndels yvot — that no one know. yvo?, instead of yv@, Tisch. Treg. WH. 8 BDL. Weiss contends that the words of Jesus, mazden, arise, do not mean that she is to awake from the sleep of death, but that the 1In the earlier writers, this word is used disparagingly, belonging, as it does, only to colloquial speech. It is a rare word in the N.T., and its use here and in the parallel account, Mt. 974, points in the same direction as the use of oxvAAets, v.35, 2 This is a weakened sense of both noun and verb, which denote the actual putting one out of his senses, beside himself, and it belongs to later Greek. On the use of the dat. akin to the acc. of kindred signification, see Win. 32, 2, at end. 8 The nearest approach to this meaning in earlier Greek is to decide or deter- mine, ‘This meaning belongs in the main to Biblical Greek, 102 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [v. 42-VI.2 maiden already raised from the dead by the power of God, is to rise from her couch. But this is pure assumption, there being nothing in common linguistic usage to justify this distinction. And it leaves out of sight the plain fact that the words of Jesus on such occasions are the signal for the performance of the miracle. Weiss is theory-bound in his treatment of the miracles. REJECTION AT NAZARETH vi.1-6. Jesus visits Nazareth, and teaches in the syna- gogue. His countrymen express their surprise at the wis- dom and power displayed by one so obscure in his origin, and Jesus is prevented by their unbelief from the usual exercise of his healing gifts. 1. Kat é&pd\Oev éxetOev — And he went out thence. With these words Mk. connects this visit with the events of the preceding chap. Mt. places this visit after the parables, saying expressly that it was after he had ended these parables! (13°). Lk. tells us of a visit to Nazareth at the beginning of his ministry, 4’°*, in which Jesus quotes the same parable as in this visit, of the prophet not without honor except in his own country. And the position in which he places this rejection at the beginning of the ministry in Galilee, and just before the record. of the beginning of Jesus’ resi- dence in Capernaum, seems to indicate a connection between these events in the author’s mind. However, Lk. inserts in v.” a reference to works done in Capernaum, which is inconsistent with the place which he assigns to the visit, previous to the set- tlement in Capernaum. Mt. also notes the leaving Nazareth and settling in Capernaum, but places this present event after the par- ables. The accounts cannot be harmonized, except on the suppo- sition of a repetition of the visit to Nazareth, and his rejection there. It is easy enough to suppose that Jesus visited his family several times, and met this ungracious reception at the hands of his countrymen, but it is also quite evident that the Evangelists have got hold of one story, marked by the same details through- out, and have placed this one rejection in different parts of the Gospel. Two things are evident in regard to the chronological arrangement of the Gospels ; first, that the Evangelists intended 1See Note on Relation of Synoptical Accounts at beginning of ch. 5, for the place of the parables in Mt.’s account. And notice how Mt. thus connects the visit to Nazareth with the healing of Peter’s mother-in-law, which Mk, and Lk. put at the beginning of the Galilean ministry, while Mt., though connecting the two events as they do, puts them both at a late period. : VI. 1-3] REJECTION AT NAZARETH 103 to make such an arrangement, and secondly, that their several arrangements do not always agree. Tv Tatpica avtov—his own country. Nazareth is the place meant, the residence of his family, and where he had lived him- self up to the beginning of his public ministry. epxeTat comes, instead of #AGev came, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. » BCLD Harcl. marg. 2. npgato didacKev év TH ovvaywyn. There was no regularly appointed person to perform this office in the synagogue, but the dpxicvvaywyos might select any one to read the lessons and to preach. If any Rabbi was present, they would avail themselves of him for the purpose. Jesus used this opportunity as long as it was open to him, but he seems to have been denied the syna- gogue after a time. Kat ot 7oAAOl axovovtes — and the many hearing him. Insert of before oddol, Tisch. (Treg. marg.) WH. RV. marg. BL 13, 28, 69. The many means here the multitude, all except a few? IldGev rovtrw tatta ;— Whence to this man these things? The demonstratives bring into sharp contrast the man and the things done by him; “Azs man of whom we know everything and nothing great, and these wonderful things. The same thing is repeated in the next clause, where rovrw replaces air@ in the Crit. text. They imply by their question, which is evidently contemptuous in its tone, that these things are unaccountable, and their inference is not creditable to him, as it might easily be, from such facts. They reason that anything legitimate of this kind would have shown itself in his early life. kai dvvdmes rovatrae . . . yevouevar. With this / reading, the question in this v. resolves itself into three, or rather two questions and an exclamation. ‘The substitution of the parti- ciple yivomevar for the verb in the last part makes it an exclamation. The picture is of several groups of objectors, of which one throws out the sneer, “‘ Whence fo this one these things ?”’ another takes it up in the same tone, ‘‘ dnd what ts the wisdom given to this one?” and a third exclaims, “And such miracles done through his hands /” TovTw, instead of a’r@, after dofetca, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A Memph. (most mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. 2/2). Omit 67: before kai duvdpes x Fete ABC? EFGHLMSUV AI, 13, 28, 33, 69, mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. yivopevat, instead of ylvovra:, Treg. WH. RV. x* ee BL A 33, mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. 3. 6 réxtwy — the wood-worker. Mt. says 6 tov réxrovos vids, — the son of the carpenter, 13°. The word réxrwyv, which is found in 1 See Note on dpxiovvaywyos, 522. 2 See Win. 18, 3, end of section, ad ened 104 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ VI. 3, 4 the N.T. only in these two parallel passages, means any worker in wood, rarely in any other substance. 6 vids trys Mapias — the son of Mary. The dropping out of Joseph in the gospel narrative probably indicates his death before this time of Jesus’ ministry. kat adeAdhos — and brother. On the nature of this relation, see on 38. It should be added, in proof of the improbability that these ddeAghoit were anything else than brothers of Jesus, that Lk. 27 speaks of Jesus as the first-born son. ‘There is no more baseless, nor for that matter, prejudiced theory, in the whole range of Bibli- cal study, than that which makes Jesus the only child of Mary. kai ddedpos, instead of ddedpds dé, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL A one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. Pesh. écxavoartLovro év atta — they were made to stumble in him, pre- , vented from proper action by what they saw in him. On the meaning of the verb, see on 4”. The prep. denotes the person in whom the stumbling block is found. But its use in such a con- nection is unusual in Greek. And the repetition of the exact language in Mt. 13” furnishes another item in the linguistic proof of the interdependence of the Synoptical Gospels. 4. Kai édeyev atrots 6 “Incots — And Jesus said to them. Kal @deyev, instead of €deyer dé, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL A 33, most mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Pesh. apopytns — @ prophet. The word means in classical Greek an interpreter of the gods, or of their oracles, and then in general, a seer. In the Biblical usage, it denotes an inspired teacher. ovyyevedow — kinsmen." ovyyevevouv, instead of cvyyevéor, Tisch. Treg. WH. B* D? EFGHLUV A I, 33, 69, 124, 209, 262, 271, 346. Insert avrod after cvyyeveitouv, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. BC* KLM? (A é€avrod) 28, 71, 218, 235, most mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Syrr. ' This proverb has various forms, among them the one stating the principle on which they are all based, being Famzlarity breeds con- tempt. It applies exactly to the case of our Lord at Nazareth, where he was brought up, and in that early private life showed no signs of the supernatural powers of his public ministry. There is always some difference that separates public from private life, a man not being called upon for the same exercise of his powers in the one as in the other. And to the unthinking person, this is a defect, because it seems to indicate something unreal, put on for the occasion, in the greatness of the man in whom it appears. And of course, if there is any real descent, the charge is true. But in the case of our Lord, there was only the difference that 1“ A barbarous declension,” Thay.-Grm, Lex. VI. 4-13] MISSION OF THE TWELVE 105 naturally belongs to the difference of. the two spheres. In the same way, a statesman does not continually air his wisdom in private, which may be a sign of his greatness. 5. ovk édivaro— he could not. Of course, this was a moral inability. Jesus required faith for the performance of his mira- cles, and that was wanting here; nay, there was a positive dis- belief, no mere doubt. He found elsewhere a poor wavering faith, but not enough lack to hinder his work of physical healing, though it kept him out of men’s souls. But here the general unbelief of the nation reached its climax, and prevented even this one good that his countrymen generally permitted him to do them. ei un €Ocparevoe — except that he healed appdoros —sick folk 2 6. €Javpacey dia tTHv amortiav aitayv—he marvelled at their unbelief* éJavuacer, instead of éGavuate, Tisch. WH. 8 BE*. Jesus’ wonder was a part of his humanity. He had a wonder- ful intuitive knowledge of men, and his proverb shows that he traced this unbelief to its source ; he could account for it, that is to say: but it exceeded his expectations, and excited his wonder. Tepinye Tas Kopas— he went round about the villages. Jesus had left Capernaum for a time, and being rebuffed at Nazareth, he does not return to the former place, but makes a tour of the villages about Nazareth. MISSION OF THE TWELVE 7-13. Jesus sends out the twelve to aid him in his more extended work. Hts instructions to them. Jesus is now engaged in one of those journeys through Galilee, in which he branches out from his more restricted work in the neighborhood of Capernaum, and instead of keeping the twelve with him after his ordinary custom, he sends them out in groups of two to help him in his work of proclaiming the kingdom, and preaching repentance, and healing the sick. His instructions, which are evidently practical in their nature, not ascetic, nor 1 The regular construction would require the inf. here, this verb being in the same construction aS zorqoar, and not ésvvaro. 2 This is exactly our word invalid, or infirm. 8 $a thy amcoriav is an unusual construction with ééavpnacer, in fact, the only case of itinthe N.T. (It seems quite improbable, both from the position and from the course of thought, that &a rodro in J. 722, belongs with v.21.) 106 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ VI. 7-9 involving any important principle, are that they should not encum- ber themselves with any unnecessary outfit, nor spend their time in finding better entertainment than that which first offers itself in any place that they enter. 7. Kal mpookaXirat Tovs dwdexa — This statement belongs imme- diately with the preceding zepinye Tas kdpas KikAw dvddoKwv. Evi- dently, this mission of the twelve is for the purposes of this wider work undertaken by him. In this going around from place to place, this attempt to cover more ground than usual, he calls in the aid of his disciples. péaro drooreAXev — Since the appoint- ment of the apostles, this is the first mention of such a general circuit as this, and hence this is designated as the beginning of Jesus’ sending them forth. So Meyer and others. Morison treats it as an idiosyncrasy of Mark’s, a part of his vividuess of style. And I am inclined to agree with him, that the general use of this verb in the Gospels is periphrastic and peculiar, many of the cases not yielding to treatment. But it is not peculiar to Mk., and this is a case in which there is evidently « beginning pointed out. dvo dto— two by two.’ eovoiay Tt. Tveparwy TOY axaldpTwv — authority over the unclean spirits. This is to Mk. the repre- sentative miracle, being mentioned by him frequently as if it were by itself, where it is evident that it must have been accompanied by other miracles. See 1” 3%, Tex. Crit. It was so accompanied in this case. See v.¥ ‘8. ei un paBdov povov — This was to be the only addition to their home outfit, the only thing that they were to take for the road. Mt. and Lk. do not make this exception, but expressly include the stick among the prohibited things. xy dprov, wy mHpav —no bread, no wallet (or haversack). This order, adopted by Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. is the natural order. The words belong together, as do fwvnv and yaAxdv. aypay is a leather sack, haver- sack, used to carry provisions. févynv is the girdle or belt, in which they carried money. yadxov means brass, or copper, and secondarily, soney of any kind. dprov uh mhpav, instead of mihpay uh dproyv, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BCL A 33, Memph. 9. tzrodedenevovs — The participle is put in the acc. as if to agree with a preceding acc. with an inf. The command to wear san- dals seems superfluous, but it is really a part of the injunction against any luxury in their outfit, being contrasted with shoes pro- tecting the upper part of the feet as well as the soles. ‘There is 1 $40 So — is a Hebrew fashion of expressing the distributive idea, where the Greeks would say ava or xara 8vo. VI. 9-11] MISSION OF THE TWELVE 107 no contradiction between this and the command not to buy san- dals for the journey, Mt. 10°, the latter being directed against the purchase of extra sandals over and above what they were wearing. But, while there is no contradiction, there is a difference ; they are two orders about this same matter of sandals. All that we can gather about it is, that Jesus gave some direction about san- dals in connection with the general direction for simplicity of equipment, of which the several Gospels have preserved different accounts. px évdvonobe do xtTavas — do not wear two tunics. Mt. and Lk. say that they were not to have or provide two tunics. But this forbids their wearing two, referring to a custom of dress belonging to persons of distinction, who wore two yrévas, an inner and an outer. See £476. Dic., article Dress, and Dic. of Antig., article Tunica. In general, these directions are against luxury in their equipment, and also against their providing them- selves with what they could procure from the hospitality of others. Evidently, if they took no food and no money, this dependence on others would be their only resort. See Mt. 10”. Treg. marg. WH. read évdvcac@a, which is also the reading of Beza and Elzevir, with B? S II*. L and some others read évdedtc6a:. Improba- ble and unsupported. 10. éxel . . . exeifev — there . . . thence. The first of these refers to oixiav in the preceding, and the second to dérov. They were to remain in the one house until they left the place. This injunction is directed evidently against a restless and dissatisfied changing from one house to another. They were to be satisfied with the hospitality offered them. See Lk. 10’. 11. os dv Toros py SeEnrat, unde dxovowow — With this reading, the subject changes in the second clause, so that it reads, “ what- ever place does not receive you, and they do not hear you.” Os dv réros wi SéEnTaL, instead of boo Av wh SéEwvra, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BL Aé 13, 28, 69, 124, 346, Memph. Harcl. marg. extivagate tov xovv — This was a symbolical act, signifying that the actor considered even the dust of the place as defiling. See Lk. 10". «is paprupiov airois — for a restimony unto them, not against them. It was to testify to the men themselves what the act signifies, viz. that these heralds of the Kingdom of God shook off all association with them as defiling. The rest of the verse is to be omitted. It is evidently copied from Mt. 10%. Omit auny Aéyw vuiv, Verily I say unto you, to end of verse, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BCDL A 17, 28, most mss, Lat. Vet. Vulg. 1 On this change from the indirect to direct discourse, see Win. 63, II. 2. The RV. indicates the change of structure by inserting sazd he. And the change in Umodedeuévous by inserting Zo go, 108 | THE GOSPEL OF MARK [VI. 12-14 12. éxnpvlav iva petavodow —they made proclamation that men should repent. On the meaning of the verbs, see on 1%. fa with the subj. denotes the contents of their proclamation, the same as the inf., not its purpose. See Win. 44, 8, a.) éxnpvéav, instead of éxjpvocor, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL A Pesh. Harcl. marg. 13. nradov élaiw— they anointed with ot. This is the only place in the N.T., except James 5", in which anointing and healing are mentioned together. Anointing was a frequent specific, how- ever, in ordinary medical treatment, and this would suggest its use in the symbolism of supernatural healing. dppwcrovs — this word occurs only four times in the N.T., and two of these, the only ones in Mk., are this and v.° In this account of what the disciples did, we have the purpose of their mission, which is only implied in v.". 3 HEROD’S CONJECTURE 14-16. Hevod hears of the miracles performed by the dis- ciples, and explains them by the supposition that Jesus is John the Baptist, whom he has beheaded, and who has risen Srom the dead. Herod Antipas, the tetrarch of Galilee, from his residence at Tiberias on the southern shore of the lake, would not hear much of Jesus. Our Lord never went there himself, owing probably to the unsympathetic attitude of the court, and its corrupting influ- ence on the Jewish element of the population.” But it is possible that the disciples, in this more extended tour, had come near enough to attract the attention of Herod, who was usually careless of the religious, or even of the possible political aspects of Jesus’ work. And the king, so called by courtesy, conscious stricken by his execution of John the Baptist, thinks that these miracles of which he hears are the work of the resurrected prophet. 14. nKxovcev — the object of this verb is evidently the things just narrated, the work accomplished by the twelve. qavepov yap éyeveTo TO Gvow.a.— this explains the preceding statement, showing how the works of the disciples led to these conjectures of Herod and others in regard to Jesus himself. Jesus became known 1 Morison makes a curious mistake in supposing that the aor. subj. of the TR. means might, while the pres. sub. means may. This difference is expressed in Greek by a change of moods, not of tenses. 2 See Schiirer, II. I. 23, 33. VI. 14, 15] HEROD’S CONJECTURE 109 through the works of his disciples, and hence Herod found it necessary to account for him in some way. The Herod who beheaded John was Herod Antipas, son of Herod the Great and Malthace, and in the partition of his father’s kingdom, he was made tetrarch of Galilee and Perza.! kal éAeyey OTe Iwavvys . . . €ynyeptat éx vexpov—and he said that John ... has risen from the dead. Kai édeyov, and they said, Treg. marg. WH. RV. marg. BD 6, 271 mss. of Lat. Vet. Improbable, as it makes Herod take up a common rumor, v.16, whereas it is evident that this strange conjecture started with the king’s conscience. éy7yepTat €k vexpa@y, instead of ék vexpdv 7yép6n, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDL A 33, Latt. Memph. Pesh. Herod’s superstition and his guilty conscience raised this ghost to plague him. It has been suggested that Herod makes the state- ment in regard to John’s resurrection in order to account for the difference between his natural life, in which he performed no mira- cles, and this report of wonderful works. But it seems doubtful if Herod went so curiously into the matter as this. Rather, he wishes to account for these phenomena, and he does it by attrib- uting them to a man who had proved himself so far above mortal man by his own resurrection, that any other wonders seemed natural for him. évepyovow ai duvapes év aire — the powers work in him, are active in him. In conjunction with a verb like évepyov- ow, dvvapets returns to its proper meaning of powers. 15. “AdAXox dé EXeyov — And others said. Insert dé after &\Xoe Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 ABCDEHKLS ATI Latt. Memph. Harcl. ‘HAias — Referring to the expectation that Elijah would return to the earth before the great day of the Lord (Mal. 4°). 61 mpopytys ws els Tav tpopytav — that it is a prophet like one of the prophets. ‘The words do not express the idea that he was just a prophet, like one of the ordinary prophets, in distinction from the great prophet Elijah. This would require the idea of ordinariness to be more definitely expressed. It is the likeness to the old prophets, rather than unlikeness to some special one of them, that is meant to be emphasized. We do not need to suppose that these different opinions were expressed by people in conversation with each other, which would lead us to dwell on the points of con- trast. But it is quite probable that they were isolated statements, uttered at different times, and brought together here. Omit éorly after rpopyjrns, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BC* L At, 28, 33, 209. Omit 7, or, before és, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 ABCL II mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Pesh. re EEA ESTE TE 2 aS, OL 1 On the genealogy of the Herodian family, see Bid. Dic. 110 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ VI. 16-29 16. 5 ‘Hpwdns édeyev, “Ov eyo arexepadrica — Herod said, John, whom I beheaded. Zrevev, instead of efrev, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. BCL A 33, one ms. Lat. Vet. Omit 87 before év, Tisch, Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDL 1, 28, 33, 67, 124, 209, Latt. Syrr. Herod’s conjecture does stand in contrast with these others, of which he has heard. 6v éyw dwexepadioa — Herod dwells upon the thought, that this prophet who has now risen from the dead was beheaded by himself. Hence the relative clause, which con- tains this statement of the beheading, is placed first and éyw is expressed. "lwdvvyv, odtos Hyép0n — John, this one was raised. Omit éoriv' adrés, after ovros, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8**&#¢ BDL A 69, 106, 346, mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. (Memph.). Omit éx vexp@v, from the dead, after nyép6n, Tisch. (Treg.) WH. RV. 8 BL A 33, 102, Memph. Hier. otros Wyép0n — this one was raised. The pronoun, which is not necessary to the construction, is introduced in order to continue the solemn emphasis of the whole statement. Lk. 9® says that Herod was perplexed by the report that John had risen from the dead, and said, “John I beheaded, but who ts this?” exactly reversing the positions of Herod and of the other parties to this discussion in our account. IMPRISONMENT AND EXECUTION OF JOHN 17-29. Wk. tells the story of John’s tmprisonment and death at the hands of Herod, in order to explain Herod's allusion to his beheading of John. Mk. has alluded to the fate of the Baptist, and now proceeds to tell the story of it. Herod Antipas had been married to a daughter of Aretas, king of Arabia, but on a visit to Jerusalem he had become enamoured of Herodias, the wife of his disinherited brother, and herself a member of the Herodian family, and had contracted an adulterous marriage with her. Here is where Mk. takes up the story, with John’s reproof of this adultery. It incensed Herodias especially, and though Herod imprisoned the brave prophet, he was so impressed with John’s saintliness, and even a sort of super- stitious fear of him, that he protected him against his wife’s fury. 1 This is a case of the noun being attracted from the principal into the relative clause, and taking its construction. VI. 17] FATE OF JOHN ret But Herodias, who was biding her time, took advantage of a birth- day feast given by Herod, and sent her daughter to dance before the king, and when the gratified king swore to give the girl any- thing she might ask, Herodias instructed her to ask for the head of John. The king was fairly trapped, and though sorely against his will, he sent a soldier and beheaded John in prison. Philip, commonly known as Herod, was son of Herod the Great and Mariamne, the daughter of the high priest Simon, and was disinherited by his father, living as a private citizen in retirement. Secular history tells of only one Philip, the tetrarch of Gaulanitis and other districts E. of Galilee, and Volkmar and Holtzmann contend that the Evv. have confounded him with the disinherited brother, who was known only as Herod. Winer, Meyer, Weiss, and others answer that there may have been two Philips, as there were two Antipaters, especially as they were only half-brothers. Herodias was niece of both her husbands, being daughter of Aristobulus, another of Herod’s sons. It was on the occasion of a feast given by Philip to his brothers at Jerusalem, that Antipas became enamoured of the beauty of Herodias, and she of his power, and they began the intrigue which ended in their adulterous mar- riage. Antipas became involved in a war with Aretas, king of Arabia, his father-in-law, on account of his desertion of his first wife for Herodias. The marital relations of the Herodian family were a most extraordinary mixture, though belonging to the gen- eral license of the age. This is one of the places where the Gospels bring us into contact with the Gentile world, the Herodians being Gentile in their extraction and spirit, though nominally Jews in their religion, and the note of that Gentile world was open vice and profligacy, while of the Jewish leaders it was hypocrisy. 17-29. 17. Airos yap “Hpwdys— for Herod himself. airis serves to keep up in Mk.’s account the emphasis which Herod had put on the éyo, v.°. éxpdryoe— seized) bru abriv eydpnoev — for he had married her. This states more particularly the connection between Herodias and the imprisonment of John, already denoted by &a “Hpwéidda. It is an independent statement of cause, usually introduced by ydp.?2_ But strictly, the causal conjunction is out of place, except in connection with John’s 1 On the use of the aor. for the plup. in Greek, see Win. 40, 5a. Burton, 52. Both of these, however, fail to accuunt for the infrequency of the plup. in the N.T. 2 See Burton, 232. 112 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ VI. 17-20 rebuke, of which it is the cause, and not of John’s imprisonment. Properly, this is one of the steps leading up to the imprisonment, and would be denoted by a relative clause, nv éyaunoev. 18. "EXeye yap “Iwavvns — for John had said.’ “Ort oix eeori co.— it is not lawful for thee. See Lev. 18% 20%. But John would emphasize not so much the departure from Jewish law, for which Herod had slight regard, but the broader ground of com- mon morals. 19. éveityey aira— AV. had a quarrel against him. But it is doubtful if the words had this meaning. It requires the ellipsis of rov xoAov to explain it, and it is unusual to leave so specific a word to be implied, though the use of rov xéAov with the verb is quite frequent. On the other hand, it would be quite common to supply a word like rév votdy with the verb, and that would give us the meaning, she kept her eye (mind) on him. But the phrase, though quite natural, does not seem to occur. A third supposi- tion is, that the verb may be used, like the Latin zzsv, intransi- tively, she followed him up, did not relax hostility against him. On the whole, this seems the best rendering. Thay.-Grm. Zex. kai nOcrev . . . Kal ovx novwaro— and wished... and could not. This representation, that Herodias was restrained from her ven- geance by Herod is not borne out by Mt., who says that Herod wished to put John to death, but feared the people (14°). Verse? says that he was grieved by Salome’s demand, but this was evi- dently, in Mt.’s account, for the same reason, viz. that he feared the people. 20. The statement of Mk. is that John’s righteousness made Herod afraid, and what John said both perplexed and delighted him, so that he preserved him. édofetro— feared. The kind of fear that Herod had of John is shown by the superstitious idea that he had of John’s resurrection. The prophet’s righteousness and holiness made him seem, even to Herod’s worldly sense, a man of God, and his fear therefore was of the God back of the righteous man. kal ovvernper aitov—and guarded him, viz. from the hostile intentions of Herodias. RV. 2ept him safe odd yrope— was much perplexed. ‘The perplexity arose from the conflict between his fear of John and his entanglement with Hero- dias. xat 75€ws — The peculiarity of the Hebraistic use of kai to tie together variously related statements is here curiously exem- plified? The gladness with which Herod heard John is the trib- 1See Burton, 29. In this case, the impf. contains an element of repeated action, not expressed by the plup. We combine both in he had kept saying. 2 AV. observed him. This comes probably from the meaning eep zz mind, but it is not a legitimate derivation, nor is the meaning consonant with the context. See Morison's Note. Also Meyer. 3 Win. 53, 34. It is to be said, however, that while xai itself is never strictly adversative, it is used to connect statements more or less adverse. Only «ai does not express the opposition. VI. 20-24 | FATE OF JOHN 113 ute which the moral sense, even in bad men, pays to the truth, and to boldness and freshness in the utterance of it. MOAN Hmdper, was much perplexed, instead of wodda émole, did many things, Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. RV. 8 BL Memph. 21. ipepas cixaipov— an opportune day, viz. for Herodias’ pur- poses. Tots yeveoious—on his birthday feast. This word is used in Greek for a service in commemoration of a dead friend. yevé- Oa is the word for a birthday celebration.’ peyoraéow — gran- dees. Alater Greek word. ytAidpyous —chiliarchs. If we render the word literally, it means commander of a thousand, and its equivalent in our military phraseology is colonel. ots mpdrows rT. TadtAaias — the first men of Galilee. His retainers, and especially his military officers, would be foreigners. These would be the men of the province. érroincev, instead of érote, after detrvov, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BCL A 13, 28, 69, 124, Latt. 22. ts Ovyatpos aitys tT. Hpwdiddos — the daughter of Herodias herself (RV.).? The intensive pronoun is used here because such dancing was an almost unprecedented thing for women of rank, or even respectability. It was mimetic and licentious, and per- formed by professionals. npecey—it pleased, rather than she pleased. ‘The latter would require the subject of the verb to be the noun of the preceding gen. abs., a quite unnecessary gram- matical irregularity. npecev, instead of kai dpecdons, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BC* L 33, mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. avrov, instead of atrjs, after @uvyarpds, WH. RV. marg. * BDL A 238. This means that it was Herod’s daughter Herodias, who performed the dance, and involves a curious historical error. But this is no reason for rejecting a reading so well attested. Meyer and Tisch. slight the evidence. Weiss and Holtzmann condemn it as an exegetical impossibility, since Herodias with the art. must be the Herodias of v.29. But in spite of all this, the reading itself is not to be lightly set aside. 6 de Bacireds cirev — and the king said. ‘This reading is neces- sary with the change from the part. to the indicative in ypecev. 6 dé Bactdeds eizev, instead of etrev 6 Bacideds, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. _bC* 1 A 33; Kopaciw— gird, See on 5". 23. wuocev — he swore. ‘This oath of Herod is the same that Ahasuerus made to Queen Esther, the éws juicous 7. Bactrelas pov, to the half of my kingdom, being the exact language of the Sept. in the O.T. story (Esther 5*° 77). 24. Kai e&edOotca — And having gone out. 1 See Win. 2,1d. Thay.-Grm. Lex. 2 Of the said Herodias, AV., would require the art. before airjjs. I 114 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ VI. 25-28 Kal, instead of ‘H éé, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BL A 33, Memph. airhowpat,! instead of airjooua, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV.8 ABCDGL A 28, 33, 124, 346. Basmrigovros, instead of Bamrriorod, ‘Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BL A 28, Harcl. 25. cis pera orovdns— immediately with haste. Evidently, this haste was lest the king’s ardor should cool. She and her mother both knew that nothing but the king’s oath would make him do a thing so contrary to his own desires. This urgency is shown also in her request that it be done é£avrijs, forthwith. rivax. —a platter. The word charger used to translate it in the EV. is practically absolete in this sense. 26. mepidvros yevopevos — the part. is used here concessively, though he was grieved, yet. Kai tovs dvaxenevovs —and those reclining at table. Omit cvy — with, in cvvavaxermévovs, reclining with him, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. BC* L A q2, Pesh. dOerqoa airyv — to refuse her. ‘The verb belongs to later Greek. 27. omexovAatopa — this is a Latin word, and means @ scouz¢, or secondarily, a member of the body-guara. omekovhdropa, instead of -rwpa, X ABL II 1, 108, 124, 131,157, Harcl. marg. grk. éréra&ev éveykar — commanded him to bring. évéykat, instead of évexOAvat, to be brought, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BC A ete: 28. Kai dreAOvv — And having gone out. Kat, instead of 6 dé, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. BCL A 1, 28, 124, most mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. ed. Pesh. dmrexehadtaoev — beheaded, a later Greek word. qdvAaxy — prison. Josephus tells us that John was beheaded in the castle of Mache- rus, and as this was one of Herod’s favorite resorts, it may well be that the feast, which was the occasion of the tragedy, took place there. And the whole story is framed on the supposition that the prison was near enough to the banquet hall to have the head brought immediately. Macherus was a ridge a mile long, over- looking a deep ravine, at one end of which Herod had built a great palace, while at the other end was the citadel in which John was confined. It was situated at the southern end of Perzea, and east of the northern end of the Dead Sea. Some have supposed that Tiberias was the scene of both the feast and the execution, and others that the feast was there, and the execution at Macheerus. But there does not seem to be any sufficient reason for setting aside Josephus’ testimony about the beheading of John, and in that case the narrative favors the supposition that the feast was in the 1 This is the subj. of deliberative questions, in which advice is asked. VI. 28-30 | RETURN OF THE TWELVE I15 same place. It is a piece of poetic justice that Aretas, the father of Herod’s rejected wife, made war upon his faithless son-in-law, and defeated him, so that Herod was saved only by the interven- tion of the Roman Emperor. 29. rraua—means a fall, or secondarily, something fallen, and with vexpod,—a corpse. But the omission of vexpod in this sense belongs to the later Greek. Mt. 14” adds to this the state- ment that the disciples of John came and told Jesus. RETURN OF THE TWELVE. FEEDING OF THE FIVE THOUSAND 30-44. Mk. now resumes his narrative of the mission of the twelve with an account of their return, and of their report to Jesus. On their return, probably to Capernaum, they are so beset by the multitude that they have no leisure even to eat, and Jesus seeks retirement with them on the other side of the lake. But the multitudes see them and follow on foot around the head of the lake. Jesus allows his compassion to get the better of his original purpose, and begins to teach the crowd which he found gathered when he landed. It is already late when it ts brought to his atten- tion by the apostles, that the multitude, in their eagerness to hear him, have failed to provide themselves with food. Whereupon, Jesus himself feeds them out of five loaves and two fishes which the disciples have brought for themselves. 30. ddaroAo. — it is noticeable that the twelve, who are gener- ally called disciples, are here given the name which describes their official work instead of their discipleship, and that the occasion, the only one in which the name is used in Mk., is one in which they were returning from that apostolic work. dca éroinoay, k. doa edidagav — whatever they did, and whatever they taught.’ Omit Kal, doth, before the first 80a, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BCDELV A 1, 28, 33, 102, 131, Latt. Memph. Pesh. etc. Tisch. omits second éca with x* C* 1, 271, Latt. Itis more in Mk.’s manner to retain the dca. kat N€yet adrots — And he says to them. _ 1See footnote v.17. This is one of the cases, where, owing to the close conjunc- tion of this with the principal verb, the absence of the plup. is most marked. But in relative clauses, the Greek rarely uses the plup. Win. 40, 54, 8B. 116 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ VI. 31-34 Aéye, instead of elev, said, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A 33, etc. dvaratoacGe,! instead of avaravecbe, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. ABCM A 40, 69, 108, 238, 346, 435, etc. 31. tpels atrol kat idiav —you yourselves apart. The language is selected to emphasize as much as possible the privacy which Jesus wished to secure for them. evdxaipovv —This verb belongs to the later Greek. It means Zo have opportunity or leisure for any- thing. As to the occasion of this departure, Mt. gives another account. According to him, Jesus took the disciples away to a solitary place across the lake when he heard the death of John the Baptist. Here, it is to give the disciples rest after their missionary journey, which it was impossible for them to get with the multi- tudes crowding about them and preventing even their eating. evkalpovy, instead of nvixalpovy, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x ABEFGHLV TA, etc. 32. Kal drnd\Oov — and they went away. The point of departure was probably Capernaum, as it was on the lake, and it would be the most likely place for a rendezvous after their journey. és épnuov tomrov — Lk. says that they went to Bethsaida, meaning the city on the east side of the lake. But when he comes to tell the story of the feeding of the multitude, he also says that it was a desert place (Lk. 9”). 33. kal «ldov avrovs trayovras, K. éyywoav mooi — and they saw them going, and many knew (them). Omit of 3x0, the multitudes, after drdyorras everything except a few cursives. €yvwoayv, instead of éréyrwoar, Treg. WH. B* D 1, 118, 209. Omit a’rév, him, after €yvwoav Treg. WH. RV. BD 1, 13, 28, 102, 118, 131, 209, Vulg. Substitute avrovs, Tisch. s AKLMU AII two mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. Syrr. nel(yn — on foot. They went around the head of the lake, and crossed the river at some ford. ovvédpayov— they ran together. The prep. describes the coming together of the crowd from the many starting-places to the point for which they saw the boat heading. poyjdAOov airo’s —outwent them. The verb means properly #0 go forward, to advance, or with the gen. # go before another. This use with the ace., meaning “0 reach a place before another, belongs to later Greek. ‘The rest of the verse is to be omitted. Omit Kal cuv@dOov rpds adréyv, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BL A 13, Vulg. Memph. 34. Kat e£eXOdv cldev toAiv dyAov— And having come forth, he saw a great multitude. The part. refers to the disembarking from the boat. J., who is here parallel to the Synoptics for the only time between the account of the ministry of the Baptist and 1 The aor. differs from the pres. imp. here, as denoting beginning, instead of continuance. Get rest expresses it. VI. 34-36 | FEEDING OF THE MULTITUDE RL. the final coming to Jerusalem, says that Jesus spent some time in the mountain with his disciples before the multitude came to him. Omit 6 *Incods after eidev Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BL 1, 20, 33, 69, 102, 124, 209, one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. avrovs, instead of avrois, after ém’ Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDF 245, 253, mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. éordayxvicOn — had compassion. py €xovta mroiweva — wy is used here, instead of ov«, because it denotes Jesus’ conception of the people, his thought about them. It is the fact, but the fact transferred to his mind.” This expres- sion is used also by Mt. 9”, in the passage which leads up to the account of the appointment of the twelve, and the sending them forth to supply the lack. It seems as if this feeling of Jesus towards the multitude had somehow impressed itself on the minds of the disciples especially at this period of his life, the period just preceding the close of the ministry in Galilee. The figure itself denotes the lack of spiritual guidance. Then, as always, there was no lack of official religious leadership, but the officials, priests and rabbis were blind leaders of the blind. Notice also the human quality of Jesus’ action here. He seeks a quiet place to escape from the crowd for a time; is defeated in his purpose by the multitude invading his retreat ; and he yields to their impor- tunity and to his own exacting pity. It is a distinctly human change of purpose, such as foreknowledge would have prevented, and as an attestation of his humanity it brings him blessedly near to us. 35. wpas rodAns yevomevns — much time of day having passed. The only other instance in the N.T., in which wpa is used to denote daytime is the parallel passage in Mt. 14”. See Thay.- Grm. Lex. Tisch. WH. marg. read ywouévns, coming to be a late hour, with s D Latt. ot paPnrat avrov édkeyov — his disciples said. édeyov, instead of Aéyove.y, say, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BL A 33, Memph. épnpos eat 6 toros — the place is desert; and so there is no place here for them to procure food. 787 wpa rodAAn — already it ts a late hour, and so there is short time for them to supply their wants. In their haste and eagerness to follow Jesus, they had neglected to bring anything with them, and in their absorption in his teaching, they had forgotten their ordinary wants. According to J. 6’, this conversation was started by Jesus. 36. dyopdcwow Eavtois Ti paywow — they may buy for themselves somewhat to eat. The subj. is that of a deliberative question. 1 On the form and meaning of this verb, see on 141, 2 See Win. 55, 52, Be 118 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ VI. 37-40 Omit dprovs after ayopdowow Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. BL A 28, 102, mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. ‘yap and ovx éxovey after 7i are to be omitted on substantially the same authority. 37. Syvapiwy Staxociwy — two hundred shillings’ worth. The Revisers do a somewhat curious thing in translating this word penny, and then explaining in the margin that it means evgh¢ pence halfpenny (RV. Mt. 18%). The actual paying power was much greater than our shilling, as it represented a day’s wages. The sum is evidently suggested here as their hasty guess at the amount required to purchase a frugal supply for the crowd. It would also be a sum quite beyond their means, so that the question is meant to imply the absurdity of the whole thing. ‘This question is not given in the other Synoptics, and in the fourth Gospel it takes the form of a statement that what is absolutely a large sum is quite inadequate for even a small supply of so big a crowd. dwcwpev adtois — give them. dwowpuev, instead of Sauer, Tisch. 8 BD 13, 33, 69, 124, 229**, 346. dwoowev Treg. WH. RV. AL A Latt. External evidence strongly favors dwowpev, internal slightly favors dwoouev, owing to the change of mood, which makes subj. an apparent emendation. 38. imayere, dere — Zo, See. Omit kal, and, between trdyere and Uéere Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BDL I, 33, 102, 118, 240, 244, two mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. Pesh. Kal yvovtes — and having ascertained. ‘The verb is used here in its inchoative sense “ /earn, instead of to know. The EV., and when they knew, leaves out the process which the Greek expresses. 39. dvaxdOnvar — to recline.' dvakNOjvar, instead of dvaxdiva, WH. RV. s B* G1, 13, 28, 69. cuprocia cvprdcia—by parties. The repetition of the noun to express the distributive idea is Hebraistic. The word itself means a drinking party, z.e. the entertainment, not the guests. This present use belongs to the later Greek. ézi td yAwpe xdpTo — on the green grass. ‘This is acharacteristic touch given by Mk. alone, with his eye for pictorial details, but it is more important than that to us; for the grass is green in Palestine, especially in this hot Jordan valley, only at the time of the Passover. And so, here is one intimation in the Synoptics of more than one year’s ministry. And this is also the place where the fourth Gospel inserts a passover between the first and the last. 40. kai dvérecay Tpacial mpacial, KaTa ExaTov Kal KaTa TEVTHKOVTA —and they reclined in (regular companies like) garden beds, by hundreds, and by fifties. 1 In this sense of reclining at meals, the use of compounds with ava belongs to later Greek. Win. 2,13. VI. 40-44 | FEEDING OF THE MULTITUDE 11g avérecay, instead of dvérecov, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BEFGHMV A I, 28. xard, instead of dvd, before éxardy and mevrixovra Tisch. Treg. WH. x BD Memph. This descriptive word mpactai, garden beds, gives an admirable picturesque touch. The disposition of the people in orderly groups was for the more convenient distribution of the food. 41. ciAoynoe — he blessed. ‘This word in Greek means / praise, and only in Biblical Greek does it signify 40 invoke a blessing on a person or thing, copying from the Heb. use. kal katekAace — and he broke in pieces.’ kai édidSov rots pabnrats iva mapatiacww abtrois — and gave to his disciples to set before them. Omit avrod after uaénrats Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BL A 33, 102, two mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. apariO@ouv, instead of rapaddcuy, ‘lisch. Treg. marg. WH. x* BLM * AII* 42, 63, 122, 229, 251 **, 253. maot.— vo all. In this, and the ravres éxoptacOynoav, all were filled, and 8ddexa kopivwy rAnpwpata, fillings of twelve baskets, and finally the wevraxuoyiAvor avdpes, five thousand men alone, are enu- merated the several things that point to the greatness of the miracle. 42. éyoptacbnoav — they were filled, or satisfied? xddopara (-rwv) dudexa kopivey tAnpwpata — fragments (or of fragments), jillings of twelve baskets. xddopara is put in an emphatic posi- tion, drawing attention to the quantity of fragments even. It is noticeable that xogxvo is used in all four accounts of this miracle, while in both accounts of the feeding of the four thousand, ozupides is used. There does not seem to be much difference, if any, between the kind of basket, and the identity of language in the Gospels in each account is the more remarkable. k\dopara, instead of kAacudrwv, Treg. marg. WH. RV.BLA. kdaoyud- Twy X 13, 69, 124, 209, 346. Kodplywy, instead of xodpivous, Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. RV. & B 1, 13, 69, 124, 209, 346. mAnpwuara, instead of mwdnpews, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BL A 1, 13, 69, 124, 209, 346. 44. revraxirxiduor dvdpes — five thousand men alone. av8pes is the Greek word for men, distinct from women and children. See Mt. 14”. The whole number then was much greater. This is, with the exception of the raising of the dead, the most remarkable of all the miracles recounted in the Gospels, being the one in which secondary causes are out of the question, making it a purely creative act, a creation out of nothing. The rest of the provision did not come somehow out of the five loaves and two fishes, but was added to it by the mere creative word. All talk 1 The prep. in composition denotes the separation of the bread into parts by the breaking. See Thay.-Grm. Lex. 2 Properly xoprdgew is used of the feeding of animals. 120 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ VI. 45 about acceleration of natural processes is mere talk, because there is here nothing to start from in such a process. Of course, this has led to all kinds of rationalizing. Paulus, and after him Holtz- mann, suppose that Jesus set the example of utilizing such provis- ions as they had, those who had sharing with those who had not. And even Weiss, in order to preserve the historicity of the account in the face of an increasing skepticism in regard to so stupendous a miracle, admits the possibility of this explanation, only insisting that we have here a miracle of providence in bringing together such supplies even in a natural way, and that Jesus relied with serene confidence upon it. Schenkel explains it as a materializa- tion of Jesus’ feeding of the multitude with spiritual food. But fortunately, we have here, as Weiss points outs, a concurrence of three eye witnesses, the Logia of Mt., the oral testimony of Peter, and the witness of John being all represented in the several accounts, and there is no doubt whatever of the fact that they represent it as an actual feeding of the multitude with five loaves and two fishes, after which there remained twelve baskets of fragments. OUR LORD WALKS ON THE WATER 45-52. Immediately after the feeding of the multitude, and probably owing to the excitement caused by that, Jesus dismisses his disciples with some urgency to embark in the boat for Bethsaida on the west shore of the lake, while he himself dismisses the multitude. Having taken leave of them, Jesus goes up into the mountain in the neighborhood to pray. Meantime, the disciples were having a hard time with a contrary wind on the lake, and it was past three o'clock in the morning, when Jesus came to them walking on the water. They thought that it was a ghost, but were reassured by his announcement of himself. With his coming, the wind ceased, and they were filled with an unreasonable amazement, not being prepared even by the miracle of feed- ing the multitude for this fresh wonder. 45. «ibis qvayxace — immediately be compelled. This language expresses haste and urgency, for which, however, Mt. and Mk. VIL 45-48 | WALKING ON THE WATER I21I give no reason. But the fourth Gospel states a fact, which would certainly account for this urgency, telling us that the people were about to come and seize him to make him a king (J. 6”). Accord- ing to this, Jesus knew that his disciples would side with the mul- titude in this design, and therefore dismisses them with this abrupt- ness and imperativeness. ByOcaiday — Lk. 9” tells us that this was the name of the place where the miracle was performed. There were two places of the name, one on each side of the lake. See Bib Dic. ws airés drodve.— while he himself dismisses. The avtos emphasizes the fact that Jesus himself, having forced his dis- ciples away, dismissed the multitude. It was an emergency in which he would trust no one but himself. dove, instead of drodvoy, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV.8 BL1. E* KT 28, 69, etc. read dmodvcet. 46. dmoragdapevos aitois—having taken leave of them. The verb is not used in this sense in the earlier Greek writers, who said, instead, dowalecOar. 16 dpos — the mountain, viz. in that place. mpocevgac6o.— to pray. Mt. adds to this only the scene in Gethsemane as an occasion when Jesus retired to pray. This Gospel gives, besides these two, the occasion of his first day’s work in Capernaum (ch. 1”). Lk. gives several others. The two mentioned in Mt. and the three of Mk. were crises in his life, two of them growing out of a sudden access of popularity, and the third out of the impending tragedy of his life. Prayer with Jesus was real, growing out of his human needs. 47. dWias — evening.’ It was already evening (Mt.), or late (Mk.), or the decline of day (Lk.), when the question of feeding the multitude came up. That was, therefore, the early evening, from three to six o’clock, and this the late evening, from six o’clock till night. 48. idwy . . . épxerar— And seeing them... he comes... instead of he saw them .. . and comes. idwv, instead of eidev, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDL A mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Omit cai, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BL A 102. BacaviLopevovs — distressed. ‘This is one of the words in which the notion of trial or testing has run over into that of distress, since difficulty and hardship are so frequent forms of testing. The verb is formed from Bacavos, a touchstone. édavvew —literally, driving. But the word is used frequently of rowing or sailing a boat. reraprnv pvdAaxny — the fourth watch. The Jews at this time divided the night into four watches of three hours each, and this was therefore the last watch, from three to six o’clock. They had been having a hard time therefore, having been, at a moderate estimate, some eight hours in rowing three miles. Cf. J. 6”. 1 See on 132, 122 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ VI. 48-50 ext ris Oaddcons— on the sea. It is one of the absurdities of rationalizing exegesis, that this has been made to mean on the shore of the sea, or in view of the obvious fact that the author cannot possibly have meant that, that the story, as it stands, is supposed to have arisen from a mythical handling of so common- place an event as walking on the shore. The miracle is one of those, moreover, that cannot, in our present state of knowledge, be explained away. Jesus’ miracles of healing can, most of them, be attributed to his extraordinary influence over the minds of those healed, though it may be doubted if the exceptional cases, such as the raising of the dead and the healing at a distance, do not so give the law to the rest as to turn even this possibility into an improbability. But here is a miracle upon inanimate matter, overcoming the difference in specific gravity between water and the human body, so that the water will support the heavier body. This miracle will yield to no rationalizing treatment, and in it, therefore, we are confronted with the problem of the miraculous without any alleviation. Nor does it yield any more to a legiti- mate historical criticism, which leaves our Lord’s miracles un- touched, unless we accept it as an axiom of that criticism that the miraculous does not happen. And so it is with the problem of the miraculous as a fact, with which the life of our Lord con- fronts us. Kal nOere tapeAety aitovs—and he purposed to pass by them, or was on the point of passing by them. See Thay.-Grm. Lex. Would have passed by them, EV., would be expressed by the aor. ind. of wapépyoua, with av. ‘This was what he was on the point of doing when he was interrupted by their cry. His purpose at the time was that, and he waited for some demonstration on their part to change it. 49. dri davtacpa éorww — that it is an apparition. The lack of substance, or material reality, is emphasized by the word. In the dark, they did not recognize Jesus, and they could attribute the appearance on the water to nothing solid. bri Pavracud ory, instead of Pdvracua eivat, Tisch. WH. RV. BLA 33. 50. mavtes yap atrov eldav — for all saw him. eiday, instead of eidov, Tisch. Treg. WH. B. D and mss. of Lat. Vet. omit the clause. 6 d¢ eibis EAdAnoe— and he immediately spoke. 6 5é, instead of xal, Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. RV. 8s BLA 33, one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. ev0us, instead of evdéws, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BLA. éyo eiut—TZ am it, where we say, z¢ zs J. The language of Jesus is reported in the same words by all the evangelists, except that J. omits Oapceire. 1 On this use of the vowel of the first aor. in the sec. aor., see Win. 13, I 4. VI. 51-53] EXCITEMENT IN GENNESARET 123 51. xai aveBy . . . eis tT. thotov—and he went up . . . into the boat. J. says, 6", that they purposed receiving him into the boat, but were prevented by the boat’s immediate arrival at the land. éxoracev 6 avenos— the wind abated. ‘This is evidently to be taken as a part of the miracle, as it is connected immediately with his coming to them. kat Aiav év éavrois eLicravtro— and they were exceedingly amazed in themselves. Their amazement was inward; they kept it to themselves. Omit é« wepicood, beyond measure (Treg.) WH. RV. 8 BL A 1, 28, 102, Pesh. Omit kai é0avuafov, and wondered, Tisch. Treg. (Treg. marg.) WH. RV. s BLA 1, 28, 102, 118, 209, mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. 52. émi tots aptors—this does not denote, as in RV., the object of the verb, concerning the loaves, but the ground of understand- ing, on the ground of the (miracle of the) loaves. The miracle of the loaves and fishes should have led to an understanding of the present miracles, but it did not have this effect.? aX’ jv airav 7 Kapoia TeTwpwuevy — but their heart was hardened. This hardness of heart is something quite different from our use of the same words, denoting blunted feelings and moral sensibilities. The Biblical xapdca denotes the general inner man, and here especially the mind, which is represented as so calloused as to be incapable of receiving mental impressions. GAN’ Fv, instead of Hv yap, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BLM? S A 33, Memph. Harcl. arg. JESUS CROSSES THE LAKE AGAIN TO GENNESARET, AND MEETS AN IMPORTUNATE AND ENTHUSI- ASTIC MULTITUDE WHEREVER HE GOES 53-56. On their return to the western side, Jesus and his disciples land in the district of Gennesaret, and are no sooner landed, than the people recognize them, and there ts a popu- lar uprising throughout the region. Those who first recog- nize him spread the report from village to village, and wherever Jesus goes, they bring their sick to him, and beg that they may as much as touch the hem of his garment as he passes. And as many as touched were healed. 53. émi thy yqv NADov eis Tevvnoapéer — they came upon the land to Gennesaret. Gennesaret was a fertile plain on the west side 1 On the meaning of this verb, see on 212. 2 Win. 48c, Mey. explain this by the German 4ez, as a temporal adjunct — zz connection with, at the time of. 124 THE GOSPEL OF MARK _ [VI. 54—VII. 23 of the lake, about three miles long and a mile wide, lying just south of Capernaum. See S76. Dic. This landing place was several miles south of Bethsaida, for which they had started origi- nally, showing how much they had been driven out of their course. tpocwpyicOnoav — they moored. éri riv yhv ArOov eis, instead of #Aoy eri rHv Tevvnoapér, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BLA 28, 33. 55. mepiédpayov oAnv THv xwpav exelvnv, Kal ypgavto— they ran about all that country, and began. mepiédpayov... kal, instead of mepidpaudvres, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BL A 1, 13, 33, 69, Memph. Pesh. Omit éxe? in clause d7rov Hxovoy dre éxe? éo7t, Tisch. (Treg.) WH. RV. 8 BL A 102, Pesh. kpaBarrous — pallets.' 56. Kal dzov av eiceropevero eis Kwpas 7 eis TOES 7 Eis GypoUs —and wherever he entered into villages, or into cities, or into hamlets. Insert es before néXecs and aypovs, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. BDFLA most ss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Harcl. érl@ecay, instead of ériovy, Tisch. Treg. WH. xXBLA. 7Warro, instead of nrrovro, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BD& L A I, 13, 28, 33, 69, 124, 346. Kpacréoou— the fringe or tassel appended to the hem of the outer garment, which served to remind Jews of the Law. But probably this ceremonial use is not in mind here, and it means just the edge of the garment, as if that slightest touch would be healing. J. gives a different account of what followed the storm on the lake, viz. that he landed at Capernaum, and delivered the discourse on the bread of life in the synagogue (J. 6”). 2 DISPUTE WITH THE PHARISEES ABOUT EATING WITH UNWASHED HANDS VII. 1-23. Certain Scribes and Pharisees from Jerusalem, seeing the disciples cating with unwashed hands, complain of the violation of tradition. Fesus denies the force of tradition, and the possibility of material defilement of the Spirtt. This dispute is occasioned by the disregard of the disciples for the ceremonial law about eating with unwashed hands. But the Pharisees, who make the attack, signalize it by complaining of 1 See on 24, 27 he N.T. uses av to denote indefiniteness in a relative clause with a past tense of the ind., where the Greek uses the opt. without ¢y. Burton, 315. Vii. 1, 2] TRADITIONALISM . 125 this unconventional act as a violation of the tradition of the fathers. And Jesus’ answer is at first directed towards this feature of their complaint. It is a case, he says, of the commandments of men versus the commandments of God, of tradition against law. They even set aside the law of God, in order to keep their tradition. But then, taking up the more immediate question of unwashed hands, Jesus strikes at the root not only of traditional- a ism, but of ceremonialism, saying that it was not what a man took into his stomach, but what came out of his heart, that defiled him. And this, Mk. says, had the effect of cleansing all foods. And of course, as the distinction between clean and unclean belonged not to tradition, but to the written law, this made a breach in the law itself. It released men from the obligation of a part of the law said to have been given by God to Moses. And it affirmed the distinction between outward and inward in religion. It was no wonder that Jesus’ fate hastened to its end, and that the next record of him marks practically the end of his Galilean ministry. 1. ouvdyovrat mpos avrov ot Papicato. — there gather together to him the Pharisees." The distinction made between “he Pharisees and certain of the Scribes would seem to mean that the Scribes were not so well represented. This renewed activity of the Scribes and Pharisees against Jesus is another indication that there was a Passover at some time just before this, at which either the presence of Jesus himself, or the reports brought from Galilee, drew fresh attention to him. It would not be enough of itself, but it adds to the strength of other indications of the same thing. See on 6™. 2. kat idovres Twas TOV pabyTGv adrod 6rt KoWals yEpai, ToT’ Zorw dvirtols, €cOiovav Tovs aptovs — omit éueuWavro — with this omis- sion it reads, they gather to him, having come from Jerusalem, and having seen that certain of his disciples are eating with common hands, that is, unwashed. bre. . . €xiovary, instead of éoGlovras, Tisch. Treg. RV. 8 BL A 33 (Memph. Pesh.). Omit éudupavro, found fault, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & ABEGHLVX IA one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. kowwats — literally, common. In the Greek, it denotes simply what is common to several people, as common property. It is only in later Greek, that it comes to denote what is ordinary, or vulgar, or profane, as distinguished from select or sacred things. Under this general head, it comes to mean ceremonially unclean. 1 Are gathered, RV., would require the perf. pass. This is the historical present. 126 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [VII. 24 The Pharisees did not seek by these washings to remove dirt, but the defilement produced by contact with profane things. 3. Papicator kal wavtes ot ‘Iovdato.— Zhe Pharisees and all the Jews. This custom had become general among the Jews, though it originated with the Pharisees. avyyy— this means wth the fist. But the awkwardness of the process has led to doubt from the very first, whether this is the meaning intended. But the doubt has not led to the substitution of any justifiable alternative ren- dering. The meanings, up Zo the wrist, or elbow, RV. marg. are both linguistically and grammatically disallowed. With a fist full of water needs too much read between the lines, and, besides, the word denotes the closed fist. Finally, freguently, or diligently, RV., was probably taken in the first instance, in the Lat. Vet. and Syrr., from the reading wuxva. The supposition that ruyyy had come to have this figurative meaning, seems forced, and besides, there is no warrant for it in actual usage. Edersheim quotes from the Jewish ordinance the provision that the hands should be held up in order that the water might run down to the wrist, and says that the provision that washing should be performed with the fist is not found in the Jewish law. This is, of course, a serious con- sideration, but does not seem to compare in importance with the other fact, that the Greek word does not mean this, nor the Greek case. The custom was not necessarily a part of the law, and may have been merely a usage arising from a desire for scrupulous observance. The very fact that the reading rvyyy occasions this difficulty, makes the strong external evidence for that reading still more convincing, and with this reading the only translation possible seems to be with the fist. muxva, Tisch. & mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Syrr. Tyv tapadocw — the tradition. It is the Greek etymological equivalent of ¢vadition, and denotes what is passed along from one to another, and among the Jews, the body of Rabbinical interpretation of the written law, preserved by oral transmission from one generation to another. The word occurs in the Gos- pels only in this account and in the parallel passage in Mt. In attacking this, Jesus was assailing the very citadel of the Judaism of his time.’ tav mpecBuréepwv — the elders. The word is used here in the sense of fathers, or ancestors. 4. éav py Bartiowvta— unless they bathe, Amer. Rev. The contrast between this and the preceding case is indicated by the do a&yopas, from the market place. These words are put first, in order to indicate that this is a special case, inasmuch as in the market place they would contract special defilement, owing to its 1 See Schiirer, V. Zg. II. I. 25, on Scribism. VII. 4-6] TRADITIONALISM _ 127 being a place of public resort, where they would meet all sorts and conditions of men. This case would require special treat- ment, denoted by the difference between vivwvra: r. xeipas, and Bartiowvra, they wash their hands, and they wash themselves all over. This case required the washing of the whole body. For imstamces of such washimgs, sce Ley. 14°? 15°.% & 10. 1 13.16 a 2 7 16* 7476 22° Moreover, Edersheim says that immersion of the things washed was the Jewish ritual provided in such cases. Dr. Morison contends that sprinkling was the ritual method pro- vided in such cases, and attempts to overthrow the plain meaning of the word by the supposed custom. But he does not prove the custom, only the supposed impossibility of wholesale bathing. Moreover, the contrast would be a very lame one in that case, since the custom required careful washing of the hands, and so an actual removal of defilement, but in the case of extreme defile- ment, only a sprinkling of the body for form’s sake is supposed. And his argument, that words constantly undergo such changes, amounts to nothing, as it is unaccompanied by proof that this word has gone through the process.of change. WH. non marg. RV. marg. pavticwrvta, sprinkle, instead of Barri- gwvTat, with & B 40, 53, 71, 86, 237, 240, 244, 259. A manifest emendation. mapéAaBov — the counterpart of zapadocww, denoting the process of receiving a thing by transmission, as the latter does its giving. ToTnpiwvy K. ectav K. xadKiwyw —cups, and wooden vessels, ana brazen vessels. x. kAwov,—and of beds, is omitted.! Edersheim shows that the Jewish ordinance required immersions, Barticpors, of these vessels. Omit kat x.y, Tisch. WH. RV. 8 BL A 102, Memph. 5. Kat émepwracw— and they question. mepimarovow — walk ; the figurative use of this word to denote manner of Life, conduct, is Hebraistic. kal, instead of érecra, then, before érepwraouv, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BDL 1, 33, 209, Latt. Pesh. Memph. Kowvats xepoiv — with unclean hands. kowvats, instead of dvimros, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BD 1, 28, 33, 118, 209, mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. 6. kad@s — well; 7.¢.,in this case, truly. tadv broxpitav — the hypocrites. This is the only passage in Mk. in which this word occurs. It means properly a A/ay-actor, and hence a person who is playing a part in life, whose real character is not represented by what men see. This secondary meaning belongs to Biblical Greek. LAV. tables} 128 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [VII. 6-8 Omit droxpifels, answering, at the beginning of this verse, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BL A 33, 102, Memph. Pesh. Omit 67: before xad@s, Tisch. (Treg.) WH. & BL A 33, 102, most mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Pesh. émpoprev- sev, instead of rpoepnrevoev, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s B* DLA 1, 13, 33, 124, 346. ws yeypamtat ott 6 Aads ovTos — literally, as zt has been written, that this people. Insert dre before 6 Aads, Tisch. WH. s BL Pesh. This quotation is from Is. 29", and conforms for the most part to the LXX., which reads "EyyiZer pot 6 Aads ovTOs év TH oTOpate abrod, Kat év Tals xel\Aeow adTov Tiudoi pe, 7 O€ Kapdia aiTav Toppw dréyer dw éuod; patnv 8 céBovrai pe SidacKovres EvtdApara avOporwv x. dvdackarias — This people draws near to me with tts mouth, and with their lips they honor me, but their heart ts far from me. But in vain they honor me, teaching commandments and teach- ings of men. The Heb. is translated in the RV., Forasmuch as this people draw nigh to me, and with their mouth and with their lips do honor me, but have removed their heart far from me, and their fear of me is a commandment of men which hath been taught them. ‘The principal difference is in this last clause, which in the original charges them with fearing God only in obedience to a human commandment; while in our passage and in the LXX., it states the vanity of their worship, owing to their substitution of human commands for the Divine law. It is this misquoted part which makes the point of the quotation, and it is the misquotation which makes it available. 7. SiddocKovres — the part. gives the reason for the vanity or use- lessness of their worship, and may be translated, while teaching. SiSacKxadias — is in apposition with €vraAyara, and may be trans- lated for teachings. évrdApata avOpiorwv'— commandments of men. These two words contain the gist of the charge, and it is this inculcation of human teachings for the Divine law that is developed in what follows. 8. “Adevres tHv évToAnv Tov Ocov — Leaving the commandment of God. Omit yap after apévres, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BL A* 102, 124, Memph. This statement, that the Scribes and Pharisees leave Divine commands for human, is a singular comment on their attempt to build a hedge about the Law. The oral tradition was intended by them to be an exposition of the Law, and especially of the application of its precepts to life. They devised it so that men should not by ignorance and misunderstanding come short of the 1 évréAuwara belongs to Biblical Greek. évroAy is the GreeX word. Vil. 8-11] TRADITIONALISM 129 righteousness prescribed in the Law. But, in the first place, their method of interpretation was fitted to bring out anything except _ the real meaning of the Scripture, being to the last degree fanciful _and arbitrary ; and then in the second place, they proceeded to ' make this interpretation authoritative, so that really a human word _ got to be substituted for the Divine in most cases. Their mistake _ does not stand by itself ; it has been repeated in every age. Every- _where, the same fatality attends authoritative exposition, nay, is involved in its very nature. The human exposition gets substi- tuted for the Divine word, and so the worship of man becomes _ vain. Omit last part of this verse, beginning Bamrricuovs, washings, Tisch. (Treg.) WH. RV. & BL A 1, 102, 209, 251, Memph. 9. xadas aberetre'— well do you set aside. kad&s is used here ironically, like our word éravely. 10. For quotations, see Ex. 20" and 21”. Oavarw redXevtdérw — let him surely die (RV. marg.), a rendering of the Heb. inf. abs. which simply intensifies the meaning of the verb. This last com- mand, affixing the capital penalty to the sin of reviling parents, is adduced by our Lord to show how seriously the Law takes this fifth commandment. 11. With the omission of kai, and, at the beginning of v.”, the two verses belong together, and read, But you say, “ If a man say to his father or his mother,‘ Anything in which you may be profited by me ts Corban (that ts, an offering),’” you no longer permit him to do anything for his father or his mother? Omit kal, and, at beginning of v.!*, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. BD A1, 13, 28, 69, 102, 346, mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. xopBav is the Hebrew word for an offering. It is the predicate, ha¥ing=The antecedent of the relative for its subj. The meaning is, that a man had only to pronounce this word over anything, 'setting it aside to a Divine use, in order to escape the obligation ‘of giving it for the relief or comfort of his parents. Even when said in good faith, this contravenes the Divine Law, since the duty to the parent takes precedence of the obligation to make offer- ings. The choice in such cases is not between God and man, but between two ways of serving God, the one formal and the other real. Offerings belong to the formal side of worship, whereas God is really served and worshipped in our human duties and affections. \ But it was not necessary that the banning should be carried out jon its positive side. The word having once been uttered, the 1 GOereire is a later Greek word. 2 This is an anacoluthon, as the condition belongs to the saying of the Jews, and the conclusion to the statement of Jesus. vg 130 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ VII. 11-14 ‘man was freed from the human obligation, but needed not to 'make the offering. Nay, he was positively forbidden to use the ‘article any longer for the human purpose with reference to which ‘the Korban had been uttered. The regulation was not invented for this purpose, but was intended to emphasize the sacredness of a thing once set apart, even by a thoughtless word, to Divine uses. But it failed, as the uninspired mind generally does, to define Divine uses, and left out what was of real importance, while em- phasizing and retaining the unimportant. Omit av’rod after marpi, Tisch. Treg. WH. BDL A 28, 69, 240, 244, 245, 346, mss. Lat. Vet. Omit adrod after unrpi s BDL 1, 13, 28, 56, 69, 240, 244, 346, Latt. 13. dxvpotvres — invalidating is an exact translation of the Greek word, which means to deprive a thing of its strength. Tapaddce. tov yn wapedoxate — the tradition which you handed down. It is impossible to render into English the paronomasia here. ‘The verb describes the handing along from one generation to another which constitutes tradition. aapéuou — nearly like. 14. mpookadeodmevos maddy Tov oxAov — Having called up the crowd again. It seems that the previous conference has been held with the Scribes and Pharisees alone. But Jesus wishes what he says now about the matter to be heard by the people. It is a matter, not of private conference or debate, but of the utmost importance for the popular understanding of true religion. maddy, again, instead of ravra, all, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDL A mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Harcl. mang. ’"Axovoaré pov Tavtes K. cvvere— This is no formal introduc- tion, but calls on his hearers to lend him not only their ears, but their understandings, in view of the special importance of what follows. He may well do so, since what he says abrogates the distinction between clean and unclean, which forms so essential a part not only of tradition, but also of the Levitical part of the Law itself. dxovoare, instead of dkovere, Tisch. Treg. WH. BDHL. cuvere,? instead of cvviere, Tisch. Treg. WH. BHL A 238. Oidéy éorw ewhev rod avOpwrov cicropevopevov eis airov, 0 dvva- Tal Kowaca avtov — There ts nothing outside the man entering into him, which can defile him. The reason that Jesus gives for this statement shows that he meant to make the distinction between outward and inward in the sense of material and spiritual. The things from outside cannot defile, because they enter the belly, and 1 This word, which is common in classical Greek, is found only here in the N.T. 2 This form, sec. aor. imp., occurs only here in N.T. The aor. imperatives here are appropriate to the beginning of discourse, VII. 14-19] TRADITIONALISM 131 not the heart, while those from within are evil thoughts of all kinds. This has nothing to do, therefore, with the question, whether, among spiritual things, it is only those from within the man himself that can hurt him. Inwardness in this sense belongs to things within the man himself and within others, and externality is to be taken in the same sense. dAAa Ta éx Tod avOpwrov éxro- pevdopeva eoTt Ta KolwodvTa Tov avOpwrov— but the things coming out of the man are the things which defile the man. The repeti- tion of the noun man, instead of using the pronoun, which here amounts to inelegance, is quite in Mk.’s manner. €x TOO avOpwrov éxropevdueva, coming out from the man, instead of €xtropevoyueva am’ aro, coming out of him, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. X BDLA 33, Latt. Memph. Omit éxetva, those, Tisch. (Treg.) WH. s BL A 102, Memph. Verse 1€ is omitted by Tisch. WH. RV. (bracketed by Treg.) s BL A 28, 102, Memph. 17. tiv mapaBorAnv— the parable (riddle). From the use of this word to represent the Heb. word 5wn, it loses sometimes its proper sense of similitude, and comes to be used of any sententious saying, or apothegm, in which the meaning is partly veiled by the brevity, but especially by the material and outward form of the saying. Here, entering from the outside, and coming out, are used to express the contrasted ideas of material and spiritual, and what the saying gains in pungency and suggestiveness it loses in exact- ness. Hence it is called a rapaPoAy. Thy wapaBorny, the parable, instead of wepi ris wapaBodjs, concerning the parable, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDL A 33, Latt. 18. Kai tpets — You zoo, as well as the multitude. Jesus’ saying was a riddle to them, not only because of the concrete form of statement, but also because of its intrinsic spirituality. They had been trained in Judaism, in which the distinction between clean and unclean is ingrained, and could not understand a statement abrogating this. It was all a riddle to them. mav TO eEwOev . . . ov OtWwaTa . Kowacat— nothing outside can Aefile} 19. This verse gives the reason why outward things cannot defile. They do not enter the inner man, the xapd/a, but the kotAia, Selly, belonging to the outward man, and are passed out into the ddedpav, the privy.” KabapiLwv mwavta Ta Bpwopata—RV. This he said, making all things clean. The part. agrees with the subj. of Acya, he says 1 nav ov divata, everything cannot, is the inexact, Hebrew form of the universal negative ; the logical, Greek form being otSév Svvarat, nothing can. Win. 3¢, I. 2 thy xapdiay is the heart, in the broad, Scriptural sense of the inner man. ade- Sp@va is a barbarous word, probably of Macedonian origin, the proper Greek equivalent being ddodos. 132 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ VII. 19-21 (v."*). That is, the result of this statement of Jesus was to abro- gate the distinction between clean and unclean in articles of food. The use of quotation marks would show this connection as follows : Fe says to them, “ Are ye so without understanding also? Do ye not perceive that nothing which enters into the man from without can defile him; because it does not enter into the heart, but into the belly, and goes out into the privy,” so making all foods clean. With the reading xa@apifov, the part. agrees with the preceding state- ment; that is, the going out into the privy purifies the food, as that receives the refuse parts which have been eliminated in the process of digestion. With the masc., it is possible to connect it with afedpava, but the anacolu- thon involved is rather large-sized and improbable, as only a single word separates the noun from its unruly adjunct. The only probable connection is with the subject of \éye (v.18). kadapifwy, instead of ka@apifov, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABEFGHLSX A I, 13, 28, 69, 124. 20. ro éx T. avOp@rov exropevopev, Exetvo Kowwoi— what cometh out of the man, that defileth the man. Coming out is used here to denote the spiritual, as entering in is to denote the material. Spiritual things can defile the man, and these only, not such material articles as food. And of course, this means that the real man is the spiritual part, and that defilement of the physical part does not extend to the spiritual part, which constitutes the real man. ‘That can be reached only by spiritual things akin to itself. This principle, that spiritual and spiritual go together, and that the material cannot penetrate the spiritual, which is impervious to it, is needed in the interpretation of Christianity, as well as in the reform of Judaism. 21. oi diadoytop0i — The article denotes the class of things col- lectively, whereas the anarthrous noun denotes them individually. This is the general term, under which the things that follow are specifications. The noun denotes the kind of thought which weighs, calculates, and deliberates. It is used here of designs or purposes. It is in accordance with our Lord’s whole course of thought here, that he designates the evil as residing rather in the thought than in the outward act. The order of the first four specifications is as follows: opvetat, kXoral, pdvor, pmorxetat, fornt- cations, thefts, murders, adulteries. The arrangement of the TR. is an attempt at a more studied order, bringing together things that are alike. The only principle of arrangement in Mk.’s enumeration is the distinction between these grosser, more out- ward forms of sin, and the more subtle, inward manifestations which follow in v.”.! jopvetat, Komal, Pbvor, motxetar, instead of porxetar, mopvetar, Pdvo, corral, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BL A Memph. _ 1 On the use of the plural of the abstract noun to denote the forms or manifesta- tions of a quality, see Win. 27, 3. VII. 22-30 | CURE OF A HEATHEN WOMAN 133 22. sovnpiat — In general, this is a generic term for evi7, Where it is used specifically, as here, it probably denotes ma“ice as a dis- tinct form of evil. d0A0s — decez¢ does not convey the flavor of this word, which, starting from the idea of Jazz, comes to denote any “ick, and abstractly, “ickery, cunning, craft. acéXyeua — Here also, the EV. /asciviousness, fails to convey the meaning. The word denotes in a general way the absence of self-restraint, unbridled passion, or cruelty, and the like. License, or wantonness, may be used to translate it. 6@0adApds rovnpos —an evil eye — a Hebrew expression for exvy. PBdAacdyuia —a general word for evil or injurious speech, either of God or man. ‘Toward the former it is blasphemy, toward the latter, sfander. In this con- nection it is probably slander. wtmepndavia —a common Greek word, but found only here in the N.T. It includes pride of self and contempt of others, arrogance. appooivn —/olly translates this better than foolishness, as it denotes the morally foolish. 23. écwbev —from within. ‘These things are morally unclean, while only the physically unclean comes from without. What Jesus says here is directed specially against the traditional law, but the thing condemned, the distinction between clean and unclean, belongs also to the written law. Plainly, then, the distinc- tion between the word of God and the word of man has to be carried within the Scripture, and used in the analysis of its con- tents. The thing that Jesus calls a word of man here is found also in the O.T. itself, and is fundamental in the Levitical law. HEALING OF THE SYROPHGNICIAN WOMAN'S DAUGHTER IN THE VICINITY OF TYRE AND SIDON 24-30. Jesus leaves Galilee and comes into Syrophenicta. A woman of the place asks him to heal her daughter, and overcomes Jesus apparent reluctance by her shrewd wit and Satth. The account reads simply that Jesus departed from that place into the borders of Tyre, where he wished to remain unknown, but could not hide his presence. For a Gentile woman, a Syro- pheenician, found him out, and begged him to cast the evil spirit out of her daughter. Jesus was not there for the purposes of his work, and in general confined himself to the Jews in his ministra- tions. But he feels the irony of the situation that makes the Jew plume himself on his superiority to the Gentile, and reflects it in 134 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [VII. 24 his answer, that it is not a good thing to cast the children’s bread to the dogs. The quick wit of the woman catches at these words, and her faith feels the sympathy veiled in them, so that she answers, yes, and the dogs eat the crumbs. That word is enough; Jesus assures her of her daughter’s cure, and she goes home to find the evil spirit gone. So far the account. But when we find in the succeeding chapters that Jesus’ excursion into the Gentile ter- ritory is not confined to this case, but that he continues there in one place and another, rather than in Galilee, that his teaching is restricted mostly to his disciples, and that he begins to warn them of his approaching fate, it is evident that this journey marks practically the close of our Lord’s ministry in Galilee, and that this dispute with the Pharisees about clean and unclean marks a crisis in his life. These are not missionary journeys, but are undertaken to enable Jesus to be alone with his disciples. 24. “Exeidey d¢ dvactas' dandOev cis Ta dpta Tipov — And from thence he arose and went into the coasts of Tyre. *ExetOev dé, instead of Kai éxet@ev, Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. RV. xs BLA Harcl. marg. dpa, instead of wePdpia, Tisch. Treg. WH. s BDL A 1, 13, 28, 61 marg. 69, 209, 346. Omit kai Zidavos, Tisch. (Treg. marg. WH.) RV. marg. DL A 28 mss. Lat. Vet. It is a case in which a copyist, used to the conjunction of the two places, might easily insert the words, but the omission is improbable for the same reason. And Mk. evidently meant to discriminate, since he says afterwards that Jesus left the region of Tyre, and came through Sidon, v.*! (Tisch. Treg. WH. RV.). 7a opia — The word denotes primarily the boundaries of a terri- tory, and then the country itself included within those limits. It has been contended that the original meaning of the word is to be retained here, and that Jesus did not penetrate Gentile territory, but only its borders, that part of Galilee which bordered on Syro- pheenicia. But this would be the single case of this restricted meaning in the N.T., and the universally accepted reading, da Suddvos (v.*"), shows that he did penetrate the Gentile territory. Mt., however, in accordance with the plan of his Gospel, seems to represent this event as taking place on Jewish soil (15”). Tyre and Sidon belonged to Syrophcenicia, a strip of territory on the Mediterranean, noted for its antiquity, wealth, and civilization, 1 This use of avacras corresponds to the Heb. 57%), and belongs to Oriental ful- ness, if not redundancy, of speech. Win. 64, 4, Note at end, contends that it is not redundant in all cases, but admits its redundancy here. Thay.-Grm. Lex. denies its redundancy altogether. And it is not redundant in one sense, since it is included in the action. But so is the straightening out of the limbs, It is so far redundant that the Greek, with its finer sense of the needful in speech, would omit it. VII. 24-26] CURE OF A HEATHEN WOMAN 135 which had remained practically independent of Jewish, Greek, and Assyrian rule, though subject to the Romans since the time of Augustus. Kal eioeA Oy eis oikiav, ovdeva 4OeA€ yvGvat, Kal ovK Advvacbn Aabeiv — And having entered a house, he wished no one to know it, and he could not be hidden. Omit tiv before ofxiav, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABLNX I AII Pesh. novvacn,! for nduvnOn, Tisch. WH. & B. ovdeva. 7OeA€ yvOvar—he wished no one to know it. ‘This was in accordance with his purpose in. resorting to this unaccustomed place. Morison makes a foolish distinction here between the wish of Jesus and his purpose, evidently with the idea that a purpose of Jesus could not be defeated. But aside from the fact, that N.T. usage does not bear out such a distinction, it would be difficult to draw the line between a wish that one is at pains to carry out, and a purpose. No, this is one of the cases in which the human uncertainty belonging to action based on probabilities, not certain- ties, appears in the life of Jesus. ov« #dvvacOn rAabeiv— he could not be hid. ‘Vhe inability is put over against the wish. This state- ment, which prepares the way for what follows in regard to Jesus’ unreadiness to perform the miracle, is peculiar to Mk. 25. dAX’ edOis axoicaca — but immediately having heard, Jesus had no sooner arrived than this took place. This reading, instead of dxovcaca yap, for having heard, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BL A 33, one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. edd. Harcl. marg. ns exe TO Ovyatpiov aitns — whose daughter had? Tisch. reads eiceNOotca, having entered, instead of éNotoa, having come, with s L A most mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. A very probable reading. 26. “EAAnvis, Svpopowixicoa tH yeve. — a Greek, a Syrophent- cian by race. ‘That is, she was in general a Gentile, and more particularly a Syrophcenician. ‘EAAyvis is literally, a Greek, but used by the Jews to designate any Gentile, owing to the wide diffusion of the Greek race and language. Syrophcenician is a more particular designation of the race to which she belonged. The prefix denotes that part of Phoeenicia which belonged to Syria, in distinction from Libo- phoenicia, or the Carthaginian district in the north of Africa. Lupogorvixccoa, instead of Suvpogoltmoca, Tisch. WH. txt. 8 AKLS marg. V marg. AIL t. 1 On the form, see Thay.-Grm, Lex. 2 This is a literal translation of the Heb. idiom, which inserts the personal pronoun after the relative. 136 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ VII. 26-28 kat Hpwra avtov wa... €kBadty—and she asked him to cast out." éxBadn, instead of ékBaddy, Tisch. Treg. WH. 8 ABDE, etc. 27. Kat éX\eyev — and he satd. This reading, instead of 6 6¢*Inoois eirev, and Fesus said, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BL A 33, Memph. "A des tpOtov xoptacOnvar Ta Texva — let the children be fed first. In this word, frsz, Jesus hints that the time of the Gentiles is coming, as he frequently does in the course of his teaching, while he restricts his own work to the Jews. Mt. omits this, and makes Jesus’ refusal to be much more definite and positive. +. rexv@v . T. Kvvaptots — By these terms, Jesus distinguishes between the Jews, who are the children of the household, and the Gentiles. Dogs is a term expressing the contempt of your true Jew for the heathen, and sounds strange in the mouth of our Lord. Weiss denies the contemptuous use of the term dog, and makes it merely a parable, in which an arrangement of the kingdom of God is expressed in the terms of household economy, in which the contempt for dogs plays no part. But this is to ignore the fact that “dog” is always a term of contempt, especially in the East ; that as such, it was applied by Jews to Gentiles ; and that, if Jesus did not mean to express contempt, his language was singularly ill-chosen, as the woman would be sure to understand him so. See 47d. Dic. But I am inclined to believe that Jesus did not use the term seriously, but with a kind of ironical con- formity to this common sneer, having felt in his own experience how small occasion the Jews of his time had to treat any other people with contempt. He had good reasons for confining his work to the Jews, but they did not arise from any acceptance of their estimate of themselves or of others. It is as if he had put in a ‘you know,” to indicate a common opinion. 28. Nai, xipie* kal Ta Kuvapia . . . €oOiovow — Yes, lord; and Te MOS! 3.0. CQL, Omit yap before 7a kuvdpia, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BH A 13, 28, 33, 69, Memph. Pesh. éc@lovorv, instead of éo ier, Tisch. Treg. WH. s BDLA. This use of Jesus’ own words to neutralize the force of his seeming rebuff has been regarded rightly always as a unique com- bination of faith and wit. But it is not simply a trick of words ; the beauty of it is, that it finds the truth that escapes superficial notice in both the analogy and the spiritual fact represented by it. It means, there is a place for dogs in the household, and _ 1 There isa double irregularity here: first, in the use of jpar7a to denote a request, instead of a question; and secondly, in the use of iva with the subj., instead of the inf., to denote the matter of the petition. Burton, 200, 201, VII. 28-31| A DEAF AND DUMB MAN CURED 137 there is a place for Gentiles in God’s.world. And further, her faith was quickened by what she saw of Jesus. She knew intui- tively that he was a being to take a large and sympathetic view of things, not the hard and narrow one, and that he had really prepared the way for her statement. This is of the essence of faith, to hold fast to what your heart and the highest things in you tell of God, in spite of all appearances to the contrary. 30. 76 raidiov BeBAnpevov emi tr. KAivyv — the child thrown upon the bed. Probably the cure had been attended by violent convul- sions, as in other cases of the same kind in the Gospels.' TO madlov BeBAnuévoy eri THY Krlyny, Kal 7d Sarudmov éFehndvObs, instead of 7d damomov éfehndrvObs, kal 7d madiov BeBAnuevoy eri THs KAlyns, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BDL A most mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Pesh. CURE OF A DEAF AND DUMB MAN IN THE REGION OF DECAPOLIS 31-37. rom the region of Tyre, Jesus went still further north, through Sidon, and then south again to Decapolis, on the SE. shore of the lake. Here they bring him a deaf man, whose speech has been impaired by his deafness, to be cured. Jesus ts not here for the purposes of his mission, and in order to call as little attention to the cure as possible, he takes the man aside from the multitude. And as the man 1s deaf, and Jesus needs to establish communication with him in some way in order to draw out his faith, he employs signs, thrusting his fingers into his ears, and put- ting spittle on his tongue, and casting his eyes to heaven. The man ts cured, and then Jesus enjoins silence in regard to the cure. But in vain, as they are more eager to tell the story of his beneficent power, the more he tries to prevent tt. 31. 7AGev dia Bdavos cis tHv Oadaccav — he came through Sidon to the sea. dia Did@vos eis THv Oddaccay, instead of cai Liddvos, FAPe mpds THy Odraccav, and of Sidon, he came to the sea, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BDL A 33, Latt. Memph. This reading establishes the fact that Jesus entered Gentile ter- ritory in this visit, and also that Mk. does not mean by ra opva 1 See 126 926, 138 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ VII. 31-33 Tupov (v.%), the Galilean territory adjoining Syrophcenicia. The two statements taken together show that he means to distinguish between two districts of Syrophcenicia, the one about Tyre, and the other about Sidon. ava pecov Tay dpiwy AexaroXews — into the midst of the region of Decapolis’ (through the midst, EV.). But plainly Jesus came to, not through, Decapolis, as he went by boat to the west shore of the lake after the feeding of the multitude (8'). Jesus had been in this district before, at the time when he healed the Gadarene demoniac, and had been driven away. He meets with a different reception now. Kkwhov Kat poytAdAov, deaf and having an impediment in his speech. soytAdXov is a Biblical word, found in the Sept., but only here in the NT. Literally, it means speaking with difficulty ; but in the LXX., it is used to translate the Hebrew word meaning dumb. In this case the cure is said to have resulted in the man’s speaking rightly, implying that before he had spoken, but de- fectively. Insert kal before woy:Addoy, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BD A Latt. 33. kal drodaBdpevos adtov ard Tod oxAov Kat’ idtav — and hav- ing taken him aside from the crowd by himself. The AV. gives the meaning of xar’ idvay better than the RV., which translates it privately. It means apart, by himself. éBarxev—he thrust. Put, EV. does not give the force of the word. Our Lord’s symbolic action here is intended to convey by signs to the deaf man’s mind what Jesus means to do for him, and so to give him something for his faith, as well as his intelligence, to act upon. In explaining Jesus’ action in taking the man apart from the multitude, we have to consider two things: first, the condition of the man, and the necessity of concentrating his attention on what Jesus was doing. It goes along with the other signs employed by our Lord to convey his purpose to the man, cut off from other means of communication. And secondly, Jesus’ unusual reasons for desiring secrecy. He was engaged with his disciples on this journey, not with the multitude, and he did not want the one miracle to grow into his ordinary engrossing work. The peculiar methods of this miracle have to be coordinated with those of 8” 6 and it is evident that, in both cases, this motive of secrecy is strong. Jesus avoided publicity in all his miracles, but espe- cially in this period of retirement. kat mTvoas yWato THs yAdooys aiTod, kal dvaBddpas eis Tov ovpa- vov éarevage — and having spit, he touched his tongue (with the spittle), and having looked up to heaven, he groaned. This is a part of the language of signs employed by our Lord, and is 1 On Decapolis, see on 5!-2, VII. 33-37] A DEAF AND DUMB MAN CURED 139 intended to convey to the man’s mind, first the help that he is to receive, the loosening of his tongue, and secondly, the heavenly source from which his help was to come. The groan was an ex- pression of his own feelings, stirred to sympathy by the sight of human suffering, of which there was so much that he could not relieve. ’Eddaba'— Be opened. ‘This is addressed to the man, who was himself to be opened to sound and speech through the opening of his organs. 35. Kal nvotynoav” avrod at dxoai— And his ears were opened. Omit evéws, Tisch. Treg. (Treg. marg.) WH. RV.8 BDL A 33, 102, mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. volynoav, instead of dinvolxdnoayv, Tisch. Treg. WH. x BD A 1, etc. dxoai — literally, hearings, but applied by metonymy to the organs of hearing. deoudos tis yAdoons — bond of his tongue. Probably, as this was a case in which deafness and dumbness went together, the dumbness was occasioned by the deafness, and deopos denotes figuratively whatever stood in the way of his speech, and not necessarily a defect in the organ of speech itself. The bond in this case would be the deafness which tied his tongue. op0as —vright#ly. ‘This confirms the view, that the defect has been primarily in his hearing, and that this had resulted in partial, but incomplete loss of speech. See on poyAdroy, v.”. 36. Kai dueoteiAaro atrois iva pndevi A€ywow* ooov Oe avrois dueoreAXeTO, aitot parArov mepiocorepov exnpvocov—and he com- manded them to tellno one. But the more he commanded them, the more exceedingly they heralded it.’ héywouv, instead of elrwouv, Tisch. Treg. WH. & BL A 28, 33. Omit avros after écov dé, Tisch. Treg. WH. 8 ABLX A 1, mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Insert avrol before waddoyv, Tisch. Treg. WH. 8 B(D)LN A 33, 61, one ms, Lat. Vet. Memph. Pesh. Jesus accompanies this miracle with the ordinary injunction of secrecy, but it only inflamed their zeal to publish it.4 The con- duct of the multitude is a good example of the way in which men treat Jesus, yielding him all homage, except obedience.’ 37. wimepreptsoas —a word not found elsewhere, and expressing, like the double comparative padAov repuradrepov, the excessive feeling and demonstration of the people. éferAnoaovro— another strong word, meaning literally were struck out of their senses.’ Kal dAdAovs AaActyv —and dumb to speak. Omit trovs before dAddous, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BL A 33. 1’E¢dada represents the Aramaic mmanr, the ethpael imper. of the verb nn», Heb, n7». , 2 Both the augment on the prep., and the sec. aor. in jvolynoav belong to later Greek. _ % The regular form of stating this proportion is rogovtw dcov, with a comparative in each member. paAdov strengthens a comparative with which it is joined. 4 See on 144, Cf. 519.43, Note; 645, Note. * See 1 Sam, 1572, 6 See on 122, 140 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [VIII 1-9 MIRACULOUS FEEDING OF THE FOUR THOUSAND vill. 1-9. The report of the miracle performed on the deaf and dumb man seems to have gathered a multitude about Jesus in Decapolis, reproducing the effects of his Galilean ministry. They had been with him three days, enough to exhaust whatever provisions they had brought with them, when Jesus proposes to his disciples, as in the preceding miracle, that they feed them. They meet his proposition with the same incredulity as before, but he simply inquires how many loaves they have. They answer seven, and with these and a few fishes, Jesus proceeds to feed the multitude, numbering four thousand men alone. The objection to the repetition of this miracle seems to be based on a misconception of our Lord’s miracles. If they were acts of thaumaturgy, intended to reveal Jesus’ power, the repeti- tion of this miracle would seem improbable, and the similarity of the two accounts would point with some probability to their identity. But if the real object of the miracles was to meet some human need, then the recurrence of like conditions would lead to a recurrence of the miracle. And, in the life of Jesus, with its frequent resort to solitary places, and the disposition of the multi- tude to follow him wherever he went, the emergency of a hungry crowd in a place where supplies were not to be obtained would be certain to recur. Weiss objects that there was nothing to bring the multitude together, and that the miracle occurred at a time when Jesus had definitely closed his ministry in Galilee. But both Mt. and Mk. lead up naturally to this event, the one stating directly that he was healing the sick of all kinds of a great multi- tude that had resorted to him (Mt. 15°»), and the other narrat- ing the report of his healing of the deaf and dumb man circulated by his friends throughout the region, and the excitement created by it. Moreover, we have here, as Weiss himself admits, the results of Jesus’ previous visit to this region, and of the cure of the Gadarene demoniac, which the healed man had spread abroad in accordance with Jesus’ express command. Do we not have here a solution of the real difficulty underlying Weiss’ objection? wes 2] FOUR THOUSAND FED 141 It is true that we have in the gathering of the multitude, and the stay of three days, in which Jesus must have taught and healed, an episode in this period of retirement that is out of harmony with its evident character and design. But is not the exception justifi- able? Here was a region where Jesus had been prevented from exercising his ministry by the opposition of the people, and now, on his first return to it, he finds the people in a different mood. This causes him to deflect from his purpose of retirement for a time, in order to exercise the ministry from which their previous unbelief had kept him. This seems more natural than to suppose that the evangelists created a second miracle out of certain minor variations in telling the story of the first, and then, having a mira- cle on their hands, proceeded to make a place for it in their nar- rative. This account is found only in Mt. and Mk. The verbal resemblance of the two accounts is remarkable, the following words being identical. mpockadeodpuevos Tovs uabyras .. . omdrayxvigfoua émi Tov dxdov, Ste NON Tpets Nuépat mpoouévovol por, Kai ovK €xovor TL Paywou. . . atodta(w) avrovs vores, ExdvO(joovrar) év TH 66M... of uabnral... wédev... XopTrdca: dpr(wv) . épnul(as) ... mbdaous exeTe dprovs ; of dé eirov, érrd. kal mapnyyere THY SXAW avatrecety érl THs yis, Kat NaBay Tos éErra dprous, evxapioTyoas, €xdacev, kal €didou Tots uadnrais .. . TO OxAW.. . lx OvdLa édiya, Kal Epayov Kal éxopracOncayv... mepicced(uara) krKacudTwv érTda omupidas ... TeTpakicxihio. Among these words, vijcreis, éxdvOjoovrat, €pnulas, and (x @vd.a are peculiar, and especially the construction of 7uépac tpets. Indeed, the occurrence of this peculiar nominative in both accounts would be enough to prove their dependence or interrelation. 1. wddw rodAov oxAov ovtos — there being again a great multi- tude. ‘The reference is to the previous feeding of the five thou- sand (6); and the representation is that in this respect, the circumstances were similar. In both cases, there was a great multitude. x. ua) éxovtwv ti paywor'—and not having anything to eat; this is another circumstance in which the two events were similar. maduv Toddod, instead of rayroddod, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8s BDGLMN A I, 13, 28, 33, 69, etc. Latt. Memph. mpookaderdpevos Tors pabytas rA€yer — having called his disciples, he says. 1 The participle here is plural, because it belongs with a noun of multitude, which is taken distributively. In +i ¢dywo., we have the pronoun and the mood of direct discourse. + is irregularly substituted for or, the indirect interrogative. The mood is quite regular. See Win. 25,1. Goodwin, Greek Moods and Tenses, 71. my relates this not only as a fact, but as it lay in Jesus’ mind and influenced hi action, 142 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ VIII. 2-5 Omit 6 ’Inoots after mpocxadeodpevos, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABDK LMN AII 1, 33, most mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Syrr. Omit adrod after rods wabnras, Tisch. Treg. WH. 8 DLN A 1, 28, 209, Latt. Memph. Harcl. 2. Srrayxvilouae eri Tov 6xAov Ste Hepat TpEts TpoTpevovat jor > — I have compassion on the multitude because they remain with me three days. nuépat, instead of nuépas, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x ALNX TI etc. B juépas Tpici. This three days’ stay of the multitude means of course that Jesus had been deflected from his purpose of retirement during this time, and had been drawn into his ordinary work of teaching and healing. And the sequence of events would indicate that the gathering was caused by the report of the miracle upon the deaf and dumb man. 3. vnores —JSasting. éxAvOnoovrar— they will be exhausted? Kal TLves avTOv aro paxpobev ® yKaor*— and some of them have come Jrom a distance. ‘This is an additional reason for not sending . them away, not the reason of their exhaustion, as in TR. kal roves, instead of rivés yap, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BLA TI, 13, 28, 33, 209, one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. Insert amd before paxpddev, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDL A 1, 13, 28, 33, 69, 209, 346 (Latt.). 4. “Or r0ev Tovrous Suvycetal Tis WE YopTAcal apTwy er Epyuias ; — Whence will any one be able to feed these with bread here in the wilderness? This failure of the disciples to recall the pre- vious miracle is one of the really strong reasons for doubting the repetition of the miracle. The objection is valid; the stupid repetition of the question is psychologically impossible. But this does not disprove the repetition of the miracle, only this incident init. All things considered, it is very much more probable that the accounts got mixed in this particular, than that one miracle should be multiplied into two. So Meyer. yoptaca® ém’ épnuias - —literally, on a desert place; i.e. an uninhabited place, where there are no supplies to be bought. 5. Kai npdéta — And he asked. Oi 8¢ eixav — And they said. npwra, instead of érnpwra, Tisch. Treg. WH. BL A. eizayv, instead of eizrov, Tisch. Treg. WH. s BN A 1On omdrayxvigoua, see on 141, nuépac tpeis is an elliptical construction for the acc. of duration of time. We say, “ it is three days, they remain with me.” Win. 62, 2. 2 Both these words are peculiar. viereis is a good Greek word, but is found in the N.T. only here and in the parallel passage, Mt. 1532. The same is true of éxAvéyjcovra in this sense of exhaustion. 3 This adverb itself belongs to later Greek, and the combination of prep. and adverb is also late. With an adverb of this ending, moreover, the prep. is super- ay badge 54, 1. 65, 2. 4 This perf. from jxw is late. Thay.-Grm, Lex, ee on 6 as = > VIII. 6-13] A SIGN DEMANDED 143 6. Kai rapayyeAAa— And he gives orders for the multitude to recline. The verb is used to denote the transmission of orders through subordinates.’ mapayyérre, instead of raphy yetre, gave orders, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BDL A one ms. Lat. Vet. evxyapiotnoas — having given thanks. We have in this word one side of the invocation at meals, and in etAeyyoas below, the other, the invocation of blessing on the food.’ iva tapatiaow — to set before them. mapariOaaouv, instead of mapabdo., x BCLM A 13, 33, 69, 346. 7. Kai eyav ixOvdia* dAtya Kai etAoynoas aira ele Kal tadta mapatilevat— And they had a few little fishes; and having blessed them, he commanded to place these before them also. eixav, instead of eixov, Tisch. Treg. WH. BD A. Insert adra after evdoyyjoas Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. BCL A 6, 10, 28, 116, Memph. kai TaiTa wapariévar, instead of wapadetvac kal aird, Treg. WH. RV. & BL A, also DM marg. wapar.bévar, and C 115, one ms. Lat. Vet. cat radra. 8. Kat épayov — And they ate. kai €payoyv, instead of payor 6é, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL A 1, 28, 33, 40, 124, Latt. Memph. Pesh. Tepiocevpata KAacpatwv — literally, remnants of fragments ; t.e. consisting of fragments. omvpidas—On this, and the xdduvor used to collect the fragments in the feeding of the five thousand, see on 6*. , 9. joav dé ws TeTpaxicyxiAvo.— and they were about four thousand. Omit of ddyovtes, those eating, Tisch. (Treg.) WH. RV. 8 BL A 33, Memph. JESUS CROSSES TO THE WEST SHORE OF THE LAKE TO DALMANUTHA, AND THE PHARISEES RENEW THEIR ATTACK ON HIM, DEMANDING A SIGN FROM HEAVEN 10-13. After finishing his work in Decapolis, Jesus gets into the boat kept for his use by the disciples, and crosses to the region of Dalmanutha, several miles south of his usual resort. But he does not escape the hostile vigilance 1 Thay.-Grm. Zex., under xedevu. 2 See on 641, 3 On the form ectyav, see Thay.-Grm. Lex. ix@véia is found in the N.T. only here and in the parallel (Mt. 1534). 144 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ VIII. 10, 11 of the Pharisees (Mt. says, Sadducees also), who gather about, demanding a sign from heaven, different from the terrestrial signs to which he has confined himself. Jesus asks merely, why this generation (of all generations) asks for a sign, and solemnly declares that no sign shall be given tt. 10. +6 rAotov — the boat constantly in attendance on him, 3° 4% 6”. AadApavovda — Nothing is known of this place, which is not mentioned elsewhere. Probably, it was a small village near Mag- dala, which is the place mentioned in the parallel account, Mt. 15%. This would make it on the west shore of the lake, and in the southern part of the plain of Gennesareth. 11. e&7Oov ot Papicato. — the Pharisees came out. Jesus has been absent in Gentile territory since his dispute with the Phari- sees about the washing of hands, 7'sqq., and now, immediately on his return, they are on his track again. They came out, Meyer says, from their residences in the neighborhood. But see Mori- son’s Note. All explanations are conjectural and uncertain. Mt. couples together Pharisees and Sadducees, and the same in the warning against their leaven which follows. ‘This is ominous of the final situation in Jerusalem, when the combination of the party of the priests and of the Scribes brought about his fate. ouvenrelvy ate — to discuss with him. onpelov azo Tov ovpavov —a sign from heaven. ‘This was one of their cavils, like their attributing Jesus’ casting out of demons to the power of the prince of demons, by which they sought to dis- credit the miracles performed by him. They made a distinction between miracles that might be explained by reference to some supernatural power operating here in the world, and distinct from God, and those which came visibly from heaven, z.¢e. from the sky. The kind of signs demanded by them we find in the eschatological discourse, ch. 13, this being what they had been led to expect in connection with the Messianic period. See 13°”. The miracles performed by Jesus were none of them, they thought, from this ource. They were walking on the water, creating earthly food, healing human diseases, and so confined to this world. What they wanted was a voice from heaven, or anything coming from above. etpalovres attov — testing him. They wanted to put his power to perform miracles, or to produce them, to the test, and to see if he was able to give them a sign in which there should be no possibility of collusion with the powers that rule this lower 1 The proper meaning of ov¢nreitv is to search or inquire in company. This meaning discuss is peculiar to the N.T, VIII. 11-21] THE LEAVEN OF THE PHARISEES 145 world. The unifurm use of mp? to translate this verb is very misleading. 12. dvactevagas TO mvevpat.— having groaned in spirit, te. inwardly, not audibly. Ti 4 yeved avty Cytret onuciov ; — Why does this generation seek a sign? fnret onuetov, instead of onpuetov émifnre?, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BCDL A 1, 28, 33, 118, 209. ei doOnoerar . . . onpeiov — tf a sign shall be given / This is a case of suppressed apodosis, and is a common Hebrew form of oath or asseveration.. By onpefov is meant a work which has either for its object, or result, the proof of the Divine presence and power. This is a denial that his own miracles had this pur- pose. All of them were uses of Divine power, but not displays of it. Any self-respecting man will refuse to show himself off, but he will constantly do things having other legitimate objects, which do show incidentally his intelligence, or strength, or goodness. This is the attitude of Jesus. He refuses to do anything merely as a sign, and yet his life was full of signs ; nay, it was a sign, he himself was the sign. Indeed, the only element about his mira- cles which will save them from the general disbelief of the mirac- ulous is the consonance of their objects with the character of Jesus. No one could have devised the story of a miracle-working person, and have kept the story true to Jesus’ principles and char- acter. The wonderful thing about the miracles is that the Divine power shown in them is kept to uses befitting the Divine Being. ™ yeved tavtn— to this generation. Jesus refuses especially to give a sign to that generation. It was an age full of signs ; it was the period of the Incarnation, and yet its leaders went about ask- ing for signs, and refused to believe the self-witness of the Son of God. WARNING AGAINST THE LEAVEN OF THE PHARI- SEES AND OF HEROD 13-21. Jesus does not remain in this hostile region, but crosses again to the east side. On the way, he warns the disciples against the unspiritual influences of the Pharisees —men who ask him for a sign—and, tn order that they may not go from formalism to irreligion, also against the leaven of Herod. The disciples, who had forgotten to take bread, think that he ts speaking of literal leaven. Where- 1 See Win. 55, Note at end. 146 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ VIII. 13-17 upon, Jesus asks them uf they are as dull as the rest to his spiritual meanings, and uf they have forgotten how easily he provided for the lack of material food. 13. éuBas radu, arnr\Oev — having embarked again, he departed. Omit efs 7d wotov, in the boat, Tisch. WH. RV. 8 BCL A mss. of Latt. ‘Opare, BAerere ard ths Cipns — Take heed, beware of the leaven. The word vy is used figuratively in Bib. Greek for a pervasive influence, either good or bad, though generally the latter, owing to the ceremonial depreciation of leaven among the Hebrews. The leaven of the Pharisees is their general spirit, including hypocrisy, ostentation, pride, formalism, pettiness, and the like; cf. Mt. 23. Here, where Jesus is fresh from his controversy with them about signs, the thing specially in his mind would be the spirit that leads them to ask for a sign, when his whole life and teaching was assign. It would be, in a word, their unspirituality, their blindness to spiritual things, which led them to seek outward proof of inward realities. The leaven of Herod, on the other hand, was worldliness. The Herods were professed Jews, who sought to leaven Judaism with the customs of heathenism. They represented the escape from the rigors and scruples of Pharisaism into the license and irreligion of the world, instead of into the freedom of a spiritual religion. But the escape from spiritual blindness does not lie that way. 16. Kai dueAoyiLovro pds aAAnAOvs, “Ort aprous odk éxouev (éxovow) — And they reasoned with each other, (it ts) because we have (or they have) no bread. Probably, with either €xouev or €xovow, ore is causal, and there is an ellipsis of the principal clause. Omit Aéyovres, saying, after mpds d\A7H ous, Tisch. Treg. WH. 8 BD 1, 28, 209, mss. Lat. Vet. €xovorv, instead of @xouev, Treg. WH. RV. marg. B 1, 28, 209, two mss. Lat. Vet. Memph., also D mss. Lat. Vet. (quod panes non haberent). The disciples were themselves so blind spiritually, that they attributed a material sense to Christ’s spiritual sayings. They thought that he was warning them, in the very spirit of the Pharisees themselves, against food contaminated by them. Their thoughts were on their neglect to take bread, and so leaven, or yeast, suggested to them bread. 17. Kai yvovs Aé€yet adrots, Ti diadoyiLecOe, Stu dptous ovK exere — And perceiving tt, he says to them, Why do you reason (tt is), because you have no bread ? Omit 6 "Ingots, before éye, Tisch. (Treg.) WH. & B A* one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. 1 This meaning of BAérew is foreign to the verb in earlier Greek, and the con- struction with aro is borrowed from the Heb. It is a pregnant construction, and is resolvable into look to yourselves, and so keep from. Win. 32, I. VIII. 17-26] A BLIND MAN HEALED 147 TETTWPWPLEVHV EXETE THY Kapdlav Duov ;— have you your understana- ing dulled ?' | 18,19. Tisch. punctuates these verses so that they read, Having eyes do you not see, and having ears do you not hear, and do you not remember, when I broke the five loaves among the five thousand, and how many baskets full of fragments you took up? WH. read, Having eyes do you not see, and having ears do you not hear ? And do you not remember, when I broke the five loaves among the five thousand, how many baskets full of fragments you took up? This latter punctuation is the most probable. Insert kai before mécous, Tisch. s CDM A 1, 33, mss. of Latt. By his reference to the miracles of feeding the five thousand, and the four thousand, Jesus means to remind them that he has shown them his ability to provide for their lack of bread in an emergency, so that they need not fix their thoughts on that, nor think that his mind is occupied with it. The question about the baskets of broken pieces is intended to suggest the bounty of the provision made. It is noticeable that the distinction between omvpides and xdguvor in the two miracles is kept up here in Jesus’ allusion to them. 20. Kai rA€yovew (aire), Exra — And they say (to him), seven. kat Aéyouey, instead of Oi dé eirrov, and they said, Tisch. 8 one ms. Lat. Vet. Pesh. kai Aéyovow avrg, Treg. marg. WH. RV. BCL A 115, two mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. 21. Ovzw ovviere ;— Do you not yet understand ? Omit ras, How, Tisch. WH. RV. 8 CKL AII 1, 118, 127, 209, one ms. Lat. Vet. ovmw, instead of od, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ACDs LMNUX AII mss. Lat. Vet. Syrr. HEALING OF A BLIND MAN AT BETHSAIDA 22-26. Jesus and his disciples land at Bethsaida, on the east side of the lake. There a blind man ts brought him to be healed with the usual touch. But Jesus, still in quest of retirement, and so more than ever anxious to avoid the notoriety attending his mtracles, takes the man outside of the village. He employs the same signs to tell him what ts being done for him as in the case of the deaf and dumb man tn Decapolis. But here, for the first and only time, there 1s something to obstruct the immediateness of the cure, 1 On the meaning of twpody rv kapdiav, See ON 3°. 148 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ VIII. 22-25 and at first, the man sees only men looking like trees walk- ing about. Jesus laid his hands again upon his eyes, and the man saw clearly. Then Jesus, in order to prevent the story spreading, ordered him not even to enter the village where he 1s known. 22. Kai épxovra eis ByOcatdav — And they come to Bethsatda. kal pxovrat, instead of épxerat, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL A 13, 28, 33, 69, 124, 346, Latt. Memph. 23. éfnveyxey airov eEw THs KOuns—he brought him outside of the village. In the only other miracle recorded by Mk. alone (77), there is this same privacy observed. The two coming together at the same period of our Lord’s life would seem to indicate that there was some reason for the peculiarity common to them both, arising from the critical character of the period in lis life. It was not the period of his miracles, nor of his public teachings, but of retirement with his disciples; and hence the even unusual secrecy attending such miracles as he did perform. naticas — having spit. This also is peculiar to this pair of miracles. éfjveyxev, instead of éfjyayev, he led him out, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BCL 33. érnpwra avrov et te BAerers ;—he asked him, do you see any- thing ?} This reading, instead of ef re BXére, tf he sees anything, Treg. marg. WH. non marg. RV. BCD* 8 A Memph. 24. Brérw rors avOpwrovs oti, etc.— The AV., J see men as trees walking, ignores this ort. RV., J see men; for I see them as trees walking. ‘That is, what would otherwise be taken by him for trees he knows to be men by their walking around. ‘This indistinctness of vision is due not to the confusion of his ideas arising from his previous blindness, but to the incompleteness of his cure. This is the single case of a gradual cure in our Lord’s life, and the narrative gives us no clue to the meaning of it. But we have no right to argue from this single case that gradualness was the ordinary method of Jesus’ cures.” 25. Hira wadw éreOnxe (€Onxev) — then again he laid. €Onxev, instead of éréOnxev, Treg. WH. BL. 1 This use of ei in direct questions is not found in classical Greek, but belongs to the N.T. period. Win. 57, 2. 2So Weiss, Life of Fesus, 2,97. 3, 23: VIII. 25, 26] A BLIND MAN HEALED 149 kat dueBAeWev, kai drexareorn, kal évéBrerev SyAavyas dravra — and he looked fixedly, and was restored, and saw all things clearly. dcéBAeWev, instead of érolncev adtdv avaBhépa, he made him look up, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BC* L A 1, 28, 209, 346 (one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph.). dmexaréorn, instead of dwoxatecrd6n, Tisch. Treg. WH. x BCL A. dndavydés, instead of tnAavyds, Tisch. WH. marg. x* CL A (33 SjAws). Gdravra, all things, instead of dravras, all men, Tisch. Treg. WH. x BC* DLM ? A 1, 13, 69, mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Syrr. Memph. dueBAeWev denotes the act of fixing his eyes on things, by which he would be able to distinguish them. dyAavyas is compounded of djAos and aiyy, and denotes clearness of vision. ryAavyas, TR., denotes distant sight.’ 26. Myée cis tHv Kopnv ciceAO4s — do not even go into the village. The man was to return to his house, which was outside of the village, and so far from publishing his cure in the village, he was not even to enter it. Omit unde elrys tivi év kwuy, nor tell it to any one in the village, Tisch. (Treg. marg.) RV. WH. 8 * ®24¢¢ BL 1, 209, Memph.? Attention should be called to the characteristics of the two miracles narrated by Mk. alone, both of which, moreover, belong to the period of Jesus’ retirement, and to localities inhabited by a mixed Jewish and heathen population, and unfrequented by him in his previous ministry. In both the healing of the deaf and dumb man in Decapolis, and that of the blind man at Beth- saida, Jesus takes the man aside before performing the cure, and uses spittle on the parts affected. In the second, the healing of the blind man, the cure is gradual. As to the withdrawal from the multitude, the purpose is obvious. The miracles belong to the period of retirement, and Jesus takes more than usual pains to guard against notoriety. A secondary effect, if not purpose, in the case of the deaf and dumb man, would be to fix his attention on what Jesus was about to do for him. As to the use of the spittle, it is commonly regarded as extraordinary, and naturally so, as these are the only cases in the Synoptical Gospels in which Jesus employs any other means than the laying on of hands. In the case of the deaf and dumb man, the reason for this excep- tional treatment appears in the condition of the man. The thrusting of the hands into the man’s ears, the spitting into them, 1 SnAavyas is a rare word, ; rie _ * The translation of unde. . . unde, neither... nor, AV., is wrong. jyéé is dis junctive, and the first zydé is to be rendered Not even. Win. 55,62). I50 THE GOSPEL OF MARK | VIII. 26 the looking up to heaven, are the language of signs, by which Jesus seeks to awaken the faith of the man necessary to his cure. Certainly the thrusting of the hands into his ears is that, and the rest goes along with this symbolical act. In the case of the blind man, extraordinary conditions are not lacking, though not of the same kind. Jesus is in an unfamiliar region, and the man’s blind- ness withdraws him more or less from even the knowledge that those about him would have of this extraordinary personage. In these circumstances, Jesus uses something more than the ordinary laying on of hands, which would tell its story so quickly to a Jew accustomed to his ordinary procedure, and substitutes what we may call a more elaborate and significant ritual of cure. The gradualness of the cure in this case would arise out of the same extraordinary conditions. Jesus is contending here against a dull, slow-moving faith, which hinders the ordinary immediateness of the cure. This explanation matches the extraordinary methods and process of the cure with the extraordinary conditions of the case. On the other hand, Weiss, ignoring the peculiar conditions, treats both the process and the gradualness of the cure as repre- senting Jesus’ ordinary method and the rationale of the miracles. These are the two cases, he says, in which Mk. goes into details in telling the story of the miracles, and the matter contained in them, therefore, is to be read into the other accounts. The diffi- culty in this is to account for the choice of these two isolated cases for the introduction of these details. It is easy to account for them as peculiarities belonging to an exceptional period in the life of Jesus, but not at all easy to account for the choice of these, the very last of the miracles, to bring out material belonging to them all, but hitherto unrelated by Mk., and omitted altogether in the other evangelists. Moreover, it is very singular that this gradual cure occurs in the Gospel which emphasizes most the immediateness of the cures. Out of the eleven miracles of heal- ing recorded in Mk., five speak directly of the immediateness of the cure, and of the rest three give circumstances implying the same. And yet, we are told that in this Gospel, the one account of gradual cure establishes the form to which the others must be conformed. As for the use of the spittle, that is treated as an actual means of cure, not asa symbol or sign. So Meyer. How- VIII. 26, 27| PETER’S CONFESSION I5l ever, it is allowed that the curative power infused into this came from above. And this again is normal, telling us what really hap- pened in the other cases. A means, which yet has no power in itself, only what is infused into it supernaturally. This is truly a tertium quid, and as long as it introduces into the miracles noth- ing of the nature of a secondary cause, it may be ranked among the curiosities of religious speculation. JESUS GOES WITH HIS DISCIPLES INTO THE REGION OF CZ{SAREA PHILIPPI. PETER’S CON- FESSION OF JESUS AS THE MESSIAH 27-30. Jesus having landed at Bethsaida, proceeds to Caesarea Philippi, at the foot of Mt. Hermon, a region hither- tounvisited by him. On the journey here he gains the privacy Jor which he had been seeking, and questions the disciples as to what men say about him. They tell him that he ts called variously John the Baptist, Elijah, and one of the prophets. Then comes the question for which all his life with them had prepared the way, what title they are ready to give him. Peter, speaking for the rest, says, Thou art the Messiah. But Jesus, having drawn this confession Jrom them, charges them to tell no one else. 27. «is tT. kopas Katoapias trys Pirimrov — into the villages of Caesarea Philippi. Mt. says, into the parts of Caesarea Philippi. The district is called here by the name of its principal city, and the villages were those belonging to that district. The city is near the sources of the Jordan, about 25 miles north of the lake of Galilee. Panium was the original name of the city, from the god Pan, who had a sanctuary here. The town was enlarged and beautified by Herod Philip, tetrarch of Trachonitis, to whose territory it belonged, and was given its new name in honor of the emperor and of himself. Philippi distinguishes it from Czsarea on the coast. It marks the most northern part of our Lord’s journeyings. His coming here was for the general purpose of his later Galilean ministry, to talk with his disciples in retirement of the approaching crisis in his life. Tiva pe A€yovow ot avOpwr7rot civac; Who do men say that [am? This is the first time that Jesus has approached this question, even in the circle of his dis- ciples. The characteristic of his teaching has been its imper- 152 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ VIII. 27-29 > sonality. His subject has been the Kingdom of God, its law, the conditions of membership in it, but not the person of its King. He has made approaches to this personal subject in the announce- ment of the coming of the kingdom, implying the presence of the King, and has made a veiled claim to the title in calling himself the Son of Man, but these hints and suggestions have been all. ! We should be inclined to call his styling himself the Son of Man something more than a veiled claim, if it were not that the people and rulers were manifestly in doubt, as this very event shows, as to the nature of his claim. y This constitutes the great difference between the Synoptical Gospels and the fourth Gospel, since in the latter, Jesus discourses principally about himself and his claim. 28. cizav atta r€éyovtes — they told him, saying. The verb and the participle are so nearly identical in meaning, that their juxta- position here is quite difficult to account for. On the different answers to the question of Jesus, —John the Baptist, Elijah, one of the prophets, see on 6”. eiray instead of dmexplOnoav, answered, Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. elrov RV. x BC* 4nd2 [, A one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. Pesh. Insert adr@ Xé- yovres, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BC* DLA 13, 28, 69, 124, 282, 346, mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. ri els Tov rpogdyTtwy, instead of éva rt. m. Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BC* L Memph. 29. Kai airos érynpwta aitois — And he asked them. érnpwta avrovs, instead of Aéyer avrots, he says to them, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BC* DL A 53 mss. Lat. Vet. "Yets S€ riva pe A€yere elvar ; — But who do you say that lam? ‘Yueis is emphatic in itself, and by its position." When the announcement of Jesus’ Messianic character is made, it does not come from himself, but is drawn out of the disciples by this ques- tion. He would have them enjoy the blessedness of not receiving it from flesh and blood, z.e. by oral communication, even from himself, but of that inward reception by silent communication from the Father which is the only source of true knowledge of spiritual things. See Mt. 16%. He manifested himself to them, admitting them to an intimate companionship and intercourse with himself; and when he had made his impression on them, he drew from them the confession made under the guidance of the Spirit, that he was no inferior and preparatory personage in the Messianic Kingdom, but the King himself. Here, as everywhere, Jesus’ method is the truly spiritual one, that depends very little on external helps, but on the silent movings of the Spirit of God. 6 Ilérpos A€ye.— This is the first time in the Gospel that Peter appears as the spokesman of the disciples. 3d & 6 Xpiords — thou art the Christ. On the meaning of Xpucrds, see on 1’. 1 Win. 22, 6. VIII. 30, 31] DEATH AND RESURRECTION PREDICTED 153 30. iva pundevi A€eywouw — that they tell no one. The silence that Jesus enjoins on them is due to the same reasons as his own silence up to this time, and his breaking it only when he was alone with them. It was esoteric doctrine as yet, that only those could receive, who knew something about the Messianic office on the one hand, and about the person of Jesus on the other. In the prevalent misconception of the Messiah, such an announcement would work only disaster.“-The time was coming for it, but when it did come, the tragedy of Jesus’ life followed immediately. } JESUS PREDICTS HIS CRUCIFIXION. PETER REBUKES HIM, AND JESUS REPELS THE EVIL SPIRIT WHO SPEAKS THROUGH HIM 31-33. After drawing out from his disciples the confession of his Messtantc claim, Jesus proceeds to tell them how that claim will be treated by the authorities. In general, it will bring him much suffering, and finally his rejection and violent death at the hands of the Sanhedrim, from which, however, he will be raised after three days. Peter, who evidently regards this as a confession of defeat, and as vacating the claim just made, takes Jesus aside, and begins to rebuke him. But Jesus, recognizing in this the very spirit of the Temptation, meets rebuke with rebuke, telling Peter that he ts acting the part of the Tempter, and that he reflects the mind of men, not of God. 31. ypkaro diddcKxew — he began to teach. This is a true begin- ning, being the first teaching of this kind.’ Se? — ¢¢ ts necessary. The necessity arises, first, from the hostility of men; secondly, from the spiritual nature of his work, which made it impossible for him to oppose force to force ; and thirdly, from the providen- tial purpose of God, who made the death of Jesus the central thing in redemption. But in order to take its place in the Divine order, his death must come in the human, natural order. That is to say, his death is the natural result of the antagonism of his holy nature to the world ; it is the martyr’s death. But it has also a Divine purpose in it, and it is necessary to the accomplish- ment of that purpose. The Divine purpose can use, however, only the death that results from the human necessity, the martyr’s 1 Thay.-Grm, Lex, 154 THE GOSPEL OF MARK \[ VIII. 31, 32 death. Jesus must be put to death by man. roy vidy rot avOpw- mov! woA\Aa rabety — that the Son of Man suffer many things. ‘This is the general statement, under which the rejection and death are specifications. td ray mpecButépwv Kal TOV apxlepéwv K. TOY ypap- paréwy — by the elders and the chief priests and the Scribes. br, by, instead of did,” Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDGKL II. Insert tev, the, before apx.epéwy Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BCDEHMSUVX, and before ypauparéwy Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BCDEFHLSMUV TI. Elders was the general term for the members of the Sanhedrim, and when used as it is here, with the names of classes comprised in that body, it denotes, of course, the other members outside of these classes. The chief priests were members of the high-priestly class, z.e. either the high priest himself, those who had held the office, or members of the privileged families from which the high priests were taken. The three classes together constituted the Sanhedrim, or supreme council of the Jews, by which Jesus pre- dicts that he is to be rejected and put to death.* xai pera rpeis nuepas dvactnvat—and after three days rise again. ‘This is one of the psychological problems with which we are confronted in a history generally answering with considerable exactness to such tests. For when we come to the account of the resurrection, this prophecy plays no part. The event, when it takes place, does not recall the prophecy, and is met with a persistent unbelief which does not seem in any way consonant with the existence of such a prophecy. It would seem as if Jesus must have used lan- guage here, which the disciples did not understand, until after the resurrection itself, to refer to that event. That Jesus predicted the crucifixion and resurrection, there does not seem to be any reasonable doubt. But we find variations in the details, which suggest that these were supplied by-the writers, post eventum, and that the prediction itself was general in its character. Moreover, we find in the eschatological discourse, that Jesus’ language needs a key, and we seem forced to the supposition that the utter failure of the disciples to understand the present prophecy must have been due to a like enigmatical use of language. aaspyoia—with- out any reserve, using entire frankness of speech. Now that the time had come for Jesus to speak about this, he spoke out frankly. 32. wpooAaBouevos aitov—having taken him aside. Peter could not understand plain speech about a matter to be spoken of only under his breath. Metaphorically, he puts his finger on his lips, and says Hush. He does not wish further open discus- sion of so dangerous a topic, and so he takes Jesus aside even to 1 See on 228, 2 On the distinction between iné and amé after passives, see Win. 47 4) Note. 8 See Schiirer, V. Zg. II. I. III. IV. VIII. 32-IX.1] SELF-SACRIFICE TAUGHT 155 remonstrate with him. émriyuayv— fo rebuke. Such an idea as his master had announced was not only to be refuted, but rebuked as unworthy of him. This would be the way in which he would reconcile it with his sense of his Lord’s dignity to rebuke him; a thing that he would not think of doing except as he thought that Jesus was himself underrating that dignity. He had just allowed the Messianic claim made for him by the disciples, and now he seemed to be predicting defeat, whereas it belonged to the Mes- siah not to be defeated. 33. éristpade’s —having turned, that is, upon Peter. But as he turned on him, it brought the rest of the disciples to view, and having seen the effect of Peter’s action on them, he was moved to special plainness of speech. ézeriuyoe Heérpw xai A€yer — he rebuked Peter and says. Notice the repetition of the éwiriav of v.*. Peter had assumed to rebuke him, and now he rebukes meter. kal déyer, instead of Néywr, saying, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A two mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. Pesh. *Yraye oricw wou— Yraye denotes withdrawal, se¢away. And the whole phrase means, Get out of my sight. Zarava— Satan. Our Lord is not calling names here, but indicating in strong language the part that Peter is playing. He is putting temptation in our Lord’s way, and is so acting the rdle of Satan. Jesus recognizes that it is not Peter zm propria persona that is speaking, but the Spirit of evil speaking through him, just as he recognized the invisible Tempter in the wilderness (Mt. 4"). qpovets— thou thinkest not, thou dost not regard. povetv ta Tivos means Zo side with one.’ Peter did not keep in mind God’s purposes, but men’s. He did not look at things as God looks at them, but as men regard them, and hence he played the part of the Adver- sary, the Tempter. And it was not a minor and incidental temptation, but the great thing that separates God’s ways and man’s, the temptation to consider himself, instead of imitating God’s self-sacrifice. JESUS TEACHES THE MULTITUDE THAT THE SELF-— SACRIFICE PRACTISED BY HIMSELF IS THE NEC-— ESSARY CONDITION OF DISCIPLESHIP 34-1X, 1. Jesus now calls up the multitude, having closed the purely esoteric part of his teaching, relating to his own fate, and teaches them that the condition of dtisciple- 1 Thay.-Grm., Lex. 156 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ VIII. 34 ship ts self-denial, and following him even to death. He bases this on the general principle that to lose life ts to save tt, and to save it 1s to lose it. And there 1s no profit in gaining the whole world and losing one’s life, because that zs an irreparable loss. Nothing will buy tt back. These ultimate gains and losses follow a man’s attitude towards Him because the Son of Man 1s to return in the glory of his Father, and will ther be ashamed of the man who is now ashamed of Him. 34. tov dxAov— the multitude. It seems from this, that in spite of his being away from his usual place of work, and in heathen territory, Jesus was surrounded by a crowd of people. And his language implies that they had some knowledge of him. Ei rus OeAeu drriaw pov axoAovbetv— Lf any one wishes to follow after me. A figurative expression of discipleship.’ Ef ris, instead of doris, Treg. WH. RV. s BC* DL A Latt. Harcl. marg. adxodouGery, instead of éAdetv, Tisch. Treg. C* DX 1, 28, most mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. The rare combination, found elsewhere only Mt. 10%°, is fairly conclusive of the originality of the reading. drapvnodcOw éavtov—let him deny himself. The person is made here the direct object of the verb, not the indirect. He is not to deny something to himself, but he is to renounce himself. He is to cease to make himself the object of his life and action. The verb is the same that is used to denote Peter’s denial of his Master, and means to deny that one stands in a supposed relation to another, and hence to reject, or renounce. To deny self is therefore to deny the relation of self-interest and control which a man is supposed to hold to himself, in the interest of humanity and of God ; in other words, to renounce himself. It is the nega- tive side of the command to love, and like that, does not refer to special acts, but to a change of the fundamental principle of life. x. dpdtw tov oravpov aitov—and take up his cross. This is a phase, the extreme phase of the self-denial which Jesus has just demanded. Let him deny himself, and carry out that self- denial even to death. The cross does not mean here any dis- agreeable thing, but the instrument of death. The criminal carried his own cross to the place of execution, and so, to take up the cross means to go to the place. of death. The equivalent of it in our language would be % go éo the gallows or the stake. 1 See on 117-2, The use of omicw after axoAovdety is a Hebraism. Win. 33, Note. Thay.-Grm. Lex. VIII. 34, 35 | SELF-SACRIFICE TAUGHT 157 The idea is, that a disciple is to follow the example of Jesus in giving up everything, even life itself, that belongs to the selfish interests, sooner than anything belonging to the higher purposes of life. xk. dxoAovOeirw por— and follow me. This is not a third thing added to the self-denial and cross-bearing, but a repetition of the éricw pov dxoAovbety of the conditional part of the sentence. The meaning is, that in these two things, self-denial and cross- bearing, is to be found the way to follow him. 35. “Os yap eav 0An—For whoever wishes os 8 dv drrodkeoeu — but whoever shall lose2 cdo aitnv (omit ovtos, this one) will save tt. éav before 6é\7, instead of av, Tisch. Treg. WH. 8 BCKM AIT 1, 28, 33. drodécet, instead of drodéoy, Tisch. Treg. WH. 8 BCD? TA. Omit otros before cace, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABC* DLM* X AII Latt. Memph. Syrr. Jesus has just bidden them to sacrifice even their lives, and this gives the reason for that bidding, showing them that this is really the way to save their lives. The paradox consists in the two meanings of the word “fe. In the first clause, it means the bodily life, and in the second, the true life of the spirit, which is independent of that bodily condition. The general principle is, that there is no such thing as ultimate loss in the kingdom of God. And in this case, a man loses his life only to receive it again enriched and multiplied. He sacrifices himself so far as he is identified with lower interests, only to become absorbed in higher and larger interests, in righteousness and love, in God and man. Evexey €00 Kal Tov evayyeAiov—for the sake of me and of the Gospel. Here we have the higher objects stated, for which a man sacrifices himself, and in which the merely personal life is ab- sorbed. He becomes absorbed, in the first place, in a higher personality, that of Jesus, the Redeemer, and the head of the Messianic kingdom, who represents interests human and universal. And all personal interests become merged in those of the Gospel, the glad-tidings that Jésus brings, that the kingdom of God is coming. This coming is involved in the advent of its king.’ It is as a man loses himself in so great and high things, that he finds himself, and as he sacrifices his life in their behalf, that he saves it. Only in such things is there any true life. 1On the use of éav for av after relatives, see Win. 43, Note atend. Also foot- note 2, p. 156. 2 On the fut. ind. with és av, see Burton, 308, who notes it as a N.T. use. Win. 42, 34, cites only LXX passages, as the N.T. passages occur only in the various critical texts. There is a use of the future indicative in classical Greek with av, but not in conditional or relative clauses. And there is a use of the future in concii- tional relative clauses, but without ay. ‘This construction is therefore anomalous. See Goodwin, Greek Moods and Tenses, 61, 3, Note; 50,1, Note 1; 37, 2, Note I. 8 See on 11. 14.155 cf. Mt. 428 935 2414, 158 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ VIII. 36-38 36. ri yap operct avOpwrov Kepdjoa . . . Kat CypiwFpva.. . 5 — for what does it profita man to gain..., and to forfeit... ? aperei, instead of apeAjoe, Tisch. WH. RV. & BL mss. Lat. Vet. Pesh. Kepojoat, instead of éav xepdjoy, and (nuiwOjvat, instead of éay (nuiw7, Tisch. WH. RV. 8 BL. fnurwOjvar — to forfeit. The word commonly means to lose by way of penalty, to forfeit. The argument is carried forward here no longer in the contrast between the two lives, the yvxy in its two senses, but in the contrast between the Wvy7 and the kdcpos. And this is pertinent, because the earthly life is measured gen- erally by outward gains, while the spiritual life is valued for itself. In the one, a man is worth dollars and cents, in the other, his worth is a matter of his own excellence, the quality and range of his being. The question is thus between that life which consists mainly in having, and that which consists in being. And to be, in the true sense, means to have the life of God inus. The con- trast is made as strong as possible by making the gain the xdcpos, the sum total of things. 37. Ti yap d0c'— For what shalla man give? davtdd\dAaypa— as an exchange. The questions means, if a man has forfeited his life, by what price or ransom can he buy it back? It_is the rhetorical form of saying that the loss is irrevocable. It is the irrevocableness of the loss that makes the gain to be nothing by its side. The whole world, if a man had it, would not buy back his life, if he lost it. rl yap, instead of 7 ri, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BL A 28, one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. 407, instead of dWoe, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8* B (xe L 5@) éav, instead of av, Tisch. Treg. WH. s BCEFLMVX LA. 38. os yap eav—for whoever The argument does not con- nect this with the special statement that immediately precedes,. but with the entire statement of which that forms a part. It shows how these general statements are to be applied to man’s relations to Christ ; how these relations can affect their lives so profoundly —a question that might easily be suggested to his listeners by the amazing character of his assumptions. The pres- ent situation, he says, is to be changed. He who seems to them now so easily to be set aside is to appear eventually as the Son of Man, coming in the glory of his Father, with the holy angels. Now, they are ashamed of him, it may be; then he will be ashamed of them. The announcement of Jesus’ Messiahship (v.”) is followed immediately by the prophecy of his humilia- 1 An irregular form of sec. aor. subj. for 8@. The mood is that of deliberative questions. Win. 41 a, 44. 2 This use of éav for ay is due to the use of av as a contracted form of édv, lead- ing to a mistaken use of the two as interchangeable. See Thay.-Grm. Lex. VIII. 38-IX.1] SELF-SACRIFICE TAUGHT 159 tion and death; and that by the statement that life and death hang upon the acceptance and imitation of him ; now this is justi- fied by the prophecy of his reign. Verily, Jesus’ reticence about himself, that has been so characteristic of his teaching so far, is here broken. potxadcd. — adulterous. The figure represents sin as unfaithfulness to the close relation in which God seeks to put man to himself. It is a favorite figure of the prophets. IX. 1. This verse belongs with the preceding discourse by the most obvious connection of thought. He has spoken of the coming of the Son of Man in the glory of his Father; and _ here he states the time of that coming. For the coming of the Son of Man is everywhere identified with the coming of the kingdom. Cf. Mt. 16%, where this coming is spoken of as the coming of the Son of Man in his kingdom. ‘The reason for placing the verse in the ninth chapter is that those who made the division supposed that the glorifying of Jesus in the Transfiguration was the event referred to here. But that would not be described as a coming of the Son of Man in power; nor would an event only a week dis- tant be spoken of as taking place before some of those present should die. That language implies that most of them would be dead, while a few would live to see the great event. No, this coming of the kingdom is to be identified with the coming of the Son of Man. Nothing else will satisfy the context. And this coincides with everything that Jesus says about the time of that coming. See ch. 13”, and parallel passages in Mt. and Lk. This then lets in a flood of light upon the meaning of that coming, as it declares that it was to be before some of those before him should taste of death. If his words are to stand therefore, it was to be events belonging to the generation after his death which ful- filled the prophecy of his coming, and of the establishment of his kingdom. And in this case, the kingdom was to be spiritual, and the agencies in its establishment were to be the Spirit of God and the providence of God in human affairs. Here, as in the eschatological discourse, ch. 13, the coming is referred to as an understood thing, whereas there has been no teaching in regard to it. The same remark applies here as in the teaching about the death and resurrection. We cannot account for the expectation, which colored the whole life of the early church, without some prophecy of it. But on the other hand, the absence of expectation in the period between the death and resurrection is unaccountable if the prophecy was of this definite character. 160 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [Ix. 2 THE TRANSFIGURATION IX. 2-8. Jesus goes up into a mountain, with Peter, James, and John, and ts transfigured before them. The heavenly visitors. The voice from heaven. A week after the conversation with the disciples in regard to his death, Jesus goes, with the three disciples who stood nearest to him, up into the neighboring mountain, and was transfigured be- fore them. As it is described, this transfiguration consisted in an extraordinary white light emitted from his whole person. Accom- panying this was an appearance of Moses and Elijah talking with him. Peter, frightened out of his wits by the amazing scene, proposes to fix and retain it by building huts for Jesus and the heavenly visitors up there on the mountain side. But a cloud came over them, and a voice proceeded from it, as at the baptism, This ts my beloved Son; hear him. And suddenly, looking around, they saw no one but Jesus. 2. ypepas €€ — six days. Lk. says, about eight days. We can easily get rid of one of the two days which separate these two accounts, as the Jews confounded after seven days with on the seventh day by reckoning both the des a guo and the dies ad quem in the former expression, as in the account of the resurrection. But the other day needs the woet of Lk., about eight days, to re- -move the discrepancy. tr. [lérpov x. T. laxwBov x.(t.) Iwavvnv — These three formed the inner circle of the twelve, whom Jesus took with him on three great occasions, the raising of the d f Jairus, the Trans- figuration, . and the | ‘scene_in the > garden_of Gethsemane. cis Opos Philippi, and so belonged to the Hermon range. See 8”. Kat’ idiav saduione— apart alone. This account gives no reason for this privacy, and Mt. is equally silent. But Lk. tells us that Jesus went up into the mountain to pray. This gives a rational turn to the whole occurrence, leaving us to suppose that the trans- figuration was incidental to it, and not the purpose of our Lord’s going up into the mountain. He was glorified before the dis- ciples, but it is quite out of character for him to deliberately set about such a transaction. This opens the way for another sug- gestion as to the real character of the event. Jesus would be led to special prayer at this time by the events on which it seems that his mind was fixed, and which formed the subject of conversation IX. 2-4] THE TRANSFIGURATION 161 between himself and his disciples. The subject of his discourse at this period was the approaching tragical end of his life. And it is Lk. again, who tells us that this was the subject of conversa- tion between himself and the heavenly visitants at this time. It looks then, as if this was a case in which the mind of the writer was fixed on the surface of things, who has told his story too in such a way as to fix our attention on the mere physical accompani- ments of the scene, the shining of Jesus’ garments, rather than the glory of his countenance, while at the same time, he has himself given us the suggestions for a deeper reading of it. According to the ordinary view, arising from this emphasis of the physical side Lord’s own view, which he came into the world to set up, over against its superficial worldliness, his glory was essentially in his humiliation and death, not in spite of it. And here, his spirit was Slorifed by dwelling in the midst of these high purposes and re- solves until its glory broke through the veil of flesh, ai ted his whole being. = “Kal petevoppwbn!—and was transfigured before them. All the particulars given are, in our account, the shining whiteness of his garments, and in Mt. and Lk. this with the shining or (Lk.) the change of his face. 3. Kal Ta iuaria éyévero oriABovta,” Aevka Aiav (OMit ws xiwv) — and his garments became shining, exceedingly white. Omit as xlwy, as snow, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. BCL A 1, two mss. Lat. Vet. one ms. Vulg. ola yvadeds eri THS yns ov Sivarat ovTws AEvkavat — literally, such as a fuller upon the earth cannot so whiten. Insert ovrws, so, before Nevkdvac Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCLN A 13, 28, 33, 69, 116, 124, 346, two mss. Lat. Vet. Egyptt. 4. “Hreias civ Moioei— Elyah with Moses. Elijah is gen- erally said to be the representative of O.T. prophecy, Moses of the Law. But this distinction is more apparent than real. Moses was a prophet, and the law that he gave was a part of his prophetic utterance; while Elijah had nothing to do with the predictive, certainly with the Messianic side of prophecy, accord- ing to the record, but it was his province to reveal to men the Divine law and make real to them the Divine lawgiver. But these were two men in the O.T. history who made a mysterious exit 1 This Greek word is the exact equivalent of the Latin-English words ¢ransfigure and transform. 2 This word does not occur elsewhere in the N.T. M f | —And a voice came out of the cloud, This is my beloved Son. t ‘ 162 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [IX. 4-8 from this world, and they are the ones selected for a mysterious return in the N.T.’ The subject of their conversation with Jesus is not given in Mt., or Mk., but Lk. tells us that it was “his decease which he was to accomplish at Jerusalem ” (9*"). 5. dmoxpiHeis — answering. ‘That is, responding not to some- thing said, but done. What he said was drawn out not by the words of another, but by the occasion. Mwioel... x. “Hrea — Moses and Eh jah. _Peter_would gather from. the _conyersation who the men were. “What he proposed to build was three huts, ‘such as could be constructed out of the material found on the mountain. oxyvas—is the word for any temporary structure. 6. ov yap yoee ti amoxpiOy —for he did not know what to answer. This implies the strangeness of his proposition. If he had known what to say, he would not have said any so foolish thing. ‘The situation was not one to be prolonged. Heavenly visitors do not come to stay. éxpoBo yap éyevovro—for they became completely frightened, This reading, instead of foav yap e€xpoBa (became, instead of were), Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A 33, most mss. Lat. Vet. droxp.09, answer, instead of Aadjon, say, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BC*L ATI, 28, 33, one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. Rives: 4 N 733 “~ 3 A L ead > 4 Cre. ¢€ , KL EVEVETO povy €K TOV Ovpavov, OuvTOs EaTLY O VLOS LOU O ayaTnTOS | These same words were uttered by the heavenly voice at the bap- di tism, and they are repeated in 2 Pet. 1”, in referring to the trans- figuration. See Mt. 3” 17° Mk. 1" Lk. 3” 9”. For the meaning of Son, see note on 1". éyévero, instead of #\Oe, Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. RV, s BCL A Memph. Pesh. Harcl. marg. Omit Aéyouca, saying, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. » BCN X TI one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. eédriva — suddenly® The vision vanished suddenly, and things returned to their natural condition. There is a difference of opinion whether the adverb belongs with the participle or the verb. It can make little difference, since both denote parts of the same act, looking and seeing. But this very fact shows that the adv. belongs with the part., since to put it with the verb separates the two closely related parts of the same act. In accordance with this principle, we should say, suddenly they looked around and saw, not, they looked around and suddenly saw. And for the same reason, the Greek joins the adverb and 1 See Deut. 346 2 K, 211. 2 The prep. in éxpoBor denotes completeness. (English, out and out.) Thay. Grm. Lex. under éx. 3 étanva is a rare, late word for cfaidvys. IX. 8, 9] ELIJAH AND THE SON OF MAN 163 the part. éfamwva denotes the quick transition from the heavenly vision to ordinary conditions. ei ut) before Tov *Incody, instead of d\Ad, WH. RV. & BDN 33, 61, Latt. Memph. 4Ada is adversative, not meaning exceft, and irregular here, so that internal probability favors that reading. ELIJAH AND THE SON OF MAN 9-13. Conversation with the disciples on the way down the mountain. They question him about the coming of Eliyah. On the way down the mountain, Jesus charges the disciples not to tell any one what they had seen, until the Son of Man is risen from the dead. This strange saying about the resurrection of the Messiah they seized upon, and debated its meaning. Then this appearance of Elijah suggests the question, why the Scribes put that appearance before the Messianic advent, and this question they put to Jesus. He answers that it is true, Elijah does come first, and that this is a fulfilment of prophecy which points to the fulfilment of the other prediction in regard to the suffering and rejection of the Son of Man. And to clinch the matter, he says that John’s fate is only carrying out another writing. 9. kai xataBavovtwy éx Tod dpovs — And as they were coming down out of the mountain. Kail xaraBaivévrwy, instead of karaBavdyrwy dé, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BCDLN A 33, Latt. Memph. Pesh. ék, instead of amd, Treg. marg. WH. BD 33. iva pndevi, etc. — that they tell no one. This command is given for the same reason as the injunction of secrecy in regard to his miracles. These external things are misleading to one who has not attained something like the inner point of view of Jesus. It coincided also with the charge to keep silence about his Messiah- ship. The misconception of the Messianic idea among the people led them to misunderstand everything that might point to his Messiahship. The people were excited with false hopes, which this marvellous story would only intensify. After the resurrection, when his death had put an end to false expectations, and the res- urrection had pointed to his true glory, then, in that new time, stories of his earthly glory and power would help forward the truth. 1 We say out of the mountain in Eng., thinking of it as something to be penetrated. a 164 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [Ix. 9-12 el py oTav — except whenever. orav, whenever, is intended to leave the time of the resurrection indefinite and contingent. 10. rov Adyov éxpatnoay —not to be connected with zpos éavrods, — they kept the saying to themselves, which does not give éxparnoav a proper meaning, and does not accord with the fact that Jesus restricted his announcement of the resurrection only to the twelve, not to the three; nor is to be translated, they kept the saying, in the sense of obedience ; but the meaning is, they seized this word about the resurrection, it clung to them, they did not let go of it." | pos Eavtovs cuvlyntovvres Ti eat. TO Ek veKpOv avacThvat, — guestion- ing among themselves what the rising from the dead is. Not what the resurrection means in general, which they as orthodox Jews at this time would know well enough ; but what it meant in the case of Jesus, involving, as it did, his death. Ll. “Ort A€yovew of ypapparets — why do the Scribes say... ? The difficulty with this rendering is, that the direct question, rendered necessary by the introduction of Aé€yovres, is introduced by the indirect interrogative 67. An alternative rendering is, the Scribes say, the demonstrative or being used to introduce a direct quotation. The difficulty with this is, that it is a statement, instead of the question required by éxynpwrwv. But the question is easily implied. However, the rendering of it as a question is on the whole more probable.? It is suggested by this appearance of Elijah on the mountain, which leads them to ask how it is, that Elijah’s appearance is treated by the scribes as a sign of the advent of the Messiah, while this appearance follows the advent, and Jesus commands them to keep his appearing silent. mpérov —/first, that is, before the manifestation of the Messiah. 12. ‘O & éby — And he said. én, instead of droxpibels, eirev, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A Memph. Pesh. “HAeias pev —The particle here is concessive ; / grant you Elyah does come, and adda introduces the modifying statement about the manner of his coming, which was not in keeping with their expectation. He comes, to be sure, but not as a mere appearance that keeps him out of the hands of men and the grasp of fate, but in such a way that men doas they please with him. doxabiorave navra —restores all things. drokabiordve, instead of droxabiorg, Tisch. Treg. s¢ AB? L A 1, 28, 33, 118. dmoxaricrdve, WH. B*. aroxardorave, x* D. This is Jesus’ brief rendering of the prophecy (Mal. 3°°), that Elijah will turn the hearts of the fathers to the children, and of the 1 See Thay.-Grm. Lex. 2 See Win. 18 a, 3, for the use of the art. with the inf.; also Burton, 392, 393. § See Burton, 349; Win. 24, 4. IX. 12,13] | ELIJAH AND THE SON OF MAN 165 children to the fathers. His coming, too, is put in connection with an injunction to remember the law of Moses, meaning that it signifies an enforcement of the Divine law. Such a restoration, bringing things back to their standard in the law, was accom- plished in the work of John the Baptist, to whom evidently Jesus refers. Mt. 17° says that the disciples understood him to refer to the Baptist. x. r@s yéypamrat éri T. viov Tr. dvOpm7ov; — the ques- tion probably ends here—azd how has tt been written about the Son of Man? The answer is given in iva 7odAa aby k. eEovdevwby, — that he suffer many things and be set at naught. Jesus matches their prophecy quoted by the scribes with another in regard to the Son of Man, meaning to imply that the fulfilment of the one makes probable the fulfilment of the other. The prophecy that the Messiah should suffer (in the prophecy itself it is the Servant of Jehovah) is found in Is. 53. éovd(@)evw(n)64°— be set at naught. 13. ddAG A€yw ipiv Gre x. “HAcias EANAVDev — Sut J say unto you, that also Elijah has come. at before “HAeéas means a/so, he too, as well as the Messiah. This contains the minor premise of the argument, which runs as follows: Zhe fulfilment of the prophecy in regard to Elijah makes probable the fulfilment of that in regard to the Son of Man, the former prophecy has been fulfilled, therefore look for the fulfilment of the other. x. éroincay aita, etc.,— and they did to him whatever they pleased, as tt has been written in regard to him. Here is another fulfilment in regard to the same man, which increases the probability just named. Moreover, this prophecy in regard to his fate puts his case on precisely parallel lines to that of the Messiah. He too, like the Messiah, is the sub- ject of expectation on the one hand, and of prophecy on the other, which are entirely inconsistent. In his case it is the adverse event of prophecy that has been accomplished, which strengthens the conviction that the like will happen to the Messiah. ooa 7eXov — whatever they wished. ‘This might seem an inconclusive state- ment, without the addition of what it was that men wished. But in reality, this is a striking statement of the way in which the Divine plan differs from the human, which made the fate of John and of Jesus certain. Men expected it as a part of the Messianic programme that God would interpose in behalf of his servants, so that men could not do to them what they pleased. But in God’s spiritual kingdom, force is not opposed to force, and so men did to John what they pleased. The inference is, they will do to the Son of Man likewise. Only now, with the introduction of this nOedov, instead of 70éAncay, Tisch. Treg. WH. 8 BC* DL. 1 The answer in full would be, /¢ has been written that he suffer, as if it said, z? has been decreed, that he suffer. Ut is this idea of decree that explains the use of iva. Burton, 212 (a), 223. 2 A Biblical word. . 166 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [IX. 13, 14 daa 70eAov, it becomes no longer a mere fulfilment of prophecy, but an application of the immutable Divine principle to parallel cases. KaOws yéyparta — as it has been written. ‘This might refer to the general statements in regard to the maltreatment of the prophets. But it is perscnal, something written about him, and this makes it more probable that the reference is to Elijah, who suffered for righteousness’ sake in the same way. It is this concrete case of such maltreatment that becomes a prophecy of the fate of the man who has succeeded to his spirit, and so to his fate. See 1 K. 18" sqq. 19 sqq. This becomes thus a good example of the broad way in which Jesus treats prophecy. A DEMONIAC HEALED 14-29. Healing of a demontac, on the return from the mountain, whom the disciples left behind had failed to heal, owing to their lack of farth. On his return from the mountain, Jesus finds a multitude gathered, and a dispute going on between his disciples and some Scribes about a failure of the disciples to heal a demoniac boy, whom his father had brought to them. Jesus cries out against the unbelief which had caused this failure, and orders the boy to be brought to him. After some inquiries about the case, prompted apparently only by his interest in it, Jesus assures him that all things are possible to faith, which draws from the father the pathetic plea that he believes, but begs for help even in case of his unbelief. Whereupon Jesus orders the unclean spirit to leave his victim, which he does with a final convulsion, which seemed like death. But Jesus took him by the hand, and raised him up. 14. Kai €XOovres . . . eldov (-dav) — and having come, they saw. é\Obyres .. . eldov (WH. -dav), instead of éMOdv... cider, having come, he saw, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BL A one ms. Lat. Vet. kal ypappatets ovvlntovvras mpos aitovs — and Scribes disputing against them. ‘The prep. denotes the hostility of the Scribes better than the dat. mpos avrovs, instead of avrots, with them, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x**#°, BCGIL A 1, 28, 118, 124, most mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. This incident of the Scribes is introduced by Mk. alone, who, as usual, brings the scene before us, and not the bare event. Ix. 14-18 | A DEMONIAC HEALED 167 The cause of the dispute was the failure of the disciples to cure the demoniac, which gave the Scribes a chance to throw doubt on their healing power. 15. was 6 dxAos iddvres adrov, e&ebauByOnoav— all the crowd, having seen them, were utterly astonished. iddvres é&ePauBHnOnoayv, instead of idav, éfeOauG7y9n Tisch. Treg. WH. x BCDIL A 1, 13, 27, 28, 33, 69, 124, 209, 346, mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. Pesh. Harcl. marg. Different reasons are given for this astonishment. Either Jesus’ person still retained some of the glory of the transfiguration, or the people were astonished at his sudden and opportune appear- ance. Against the former it seems conclusive that he treats the transfiguration as an esoteric event, which would not have per- mitted him to make his appearance among the people until the effect had entirely passed away. ‘Their surprise was a joyous sur- prise at this unexpected coming, so that they ran and greeted him. 16. éxynpwrncev aitovs — he asked them. The pronoun evi- dently refers to the multitude just mentioned. avrovs, instead of tovs ypauparets, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDL A 1, 28, 209, mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Ti ovvlnteire pos abtovs ;— What are you disputing with them ? avtovs here refers to the disciples. 17. Kai dzexpiOn aité eis — And one... answered him. és —one made answer, though the question was addressed to the crowd. eis is not like the indefinite ris, but calls attention to the number. dmexpl0n air, instead of dmoxpiOeis . . . eiwe, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BDL A 28, 33, mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. mvevpa addakov—a dumb spirit. For other instances of this accompaniment of the disease, see Mt. 9” 12”. 18. dov éav — wherever. éav,? instead of ay, Tisch. Treg. WH. x¢ ABK ATI, pyooe — convulses. This meaning of the word is not very well established, but in ozapacow, the meaning “ear passes over into that of convulse, and it is so used inv.”. This establishes a pre- cedent for the like transformation in this word. The congenital relation of these two verbs makes it improbable that they would be employed in a different sense about the same matter, and is so far against the Revisers’ Translation, dasheth him down. &npaive- Tat —is wasting away. The symptoms mentioned are those of 1 See on éxdo8ar, v.®. 2 On this use of éav, instead of av, see on 838, 168 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [IxX. 18-20 epilepsy. The pyoce, x. appife x. tpie. are connected with drov éav KatadaBy; but Eypaiverac is a general symptom of the disease. The Eng. Ver. connects adpile, x. rpile, x. Enpaiverat, and puts pyooe by itself. It should read, whenever tt seizes him, tt convulses him, and he foams and gnashes his teeth; and he ts wasting away. tots paPnrais — As the man did not find Jesus, he brought him to the disciples. See v.”. Omit av’rod after 65évras, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BC* DLA 1, 13, 33, 59, 69, 73, 209, mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Kai eta Tots waPytals cov iva ait éxBartao. — and I spoke to thy disciples that they should cast it out. eira, instead of elroy, Tisch. Treg. WH. 8 BFL 1, 28, 209. 19. “O 8 daoxpiBels atrots, Aéeyeua— And he answering them, Says. avrots, instead of air@, him, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8s ABDL AII* 1, 28, 33, most mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Syrr. avtois — zo them. Jesus’ reply is not addressed to the man, who seems not to have shown any lack of faith, but to the disciples, who have just been mentioned by the father, and to whom the words specially apply, since it was their unbelief that led to the fiasco. Later, the man seems to have lost heart over the failure of the disciples, so that he puts an zf you can into his appeal to Jesus (v.”). °Q yeved Grtoros, ews wore pos twas Ecouar; ews wore avetouar ipav;— O unbelieving generation, how long shall I be with you ? how long shall I suffer you ? yevea — It is possible to translate this ace, meaning men of a certain stock or family ; but it is more in accordance with almost invariable N.T. usage to translate it generation, men of that time. dmustos — the translation fazth/ess, EV., means generally wnfaith- Sul, perfidious, and is therefore ambiguous. It should be trans- lated unbelieving. éws wore —literally, until when.? mpos tpas écouar; — shall I be with you? The question, as appears from the next question, arises from the almost intolerable nature of his intercourse with a generation so spiritually dull and unsympa- thetic. It is the question of one who feels that his surroundings have become almost unbearable, and who wonders how long they are going to last. dvéfouat tuav ;*— shall [ bear with you ? 20. idiwv— having seen. Regularly, the part. agrees with neither TO veda, NOY avrov after ovveordpagev. According to the sense, 1 On the use of iva after a verb of entreaty, see Burton, 200. 2 This use of éws with a temporal adverb is rare in classical Greek. Win. 54, 6. 3 The acc, is the regular construction after avéyow.a. IX. 20-24] A DEMONIAC HEALED 169 since the action of the verb belongs to the spirit, and is occa- sioned by the action denoted by the participle, it would be the spirit which is described as having seen Jesus. But he does this with the eyes of the man, and hence the masc. form of the part. In all these stories, the man and the evil spirit get mixed up in this way. The outward acts belong to the man, but the informing spirit is sometimes that of the man, and sometimes the evil spirit. cuveorapagsey — convulsed him.’ cvveomdpatev, instead of éordpatev, Tisch. Treg. marg.x BCL A 33, mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. Syrr. exvrietro — he rolled around. Wallow suggests things not im- plied in this verb. 21. ws Todro yéyovey ato — since this has come to him, This conversation with the father has been preserved by Mk. alone, with his customary fulness in the narration of events. All attempts to discover special motives for this question of Jesus, aside from the general interest of a sympathetic person in the case, are un- availing. It has no special bearing on the cure to be performed. "EK radidbev — from childhood? Insert é« before ma:didGev, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDGILN A 1, 33, 118, 209. 22. kai eis Tip... Kk. els VOata — both into fire and into waters. The plur. = dodies of water. ei ri divy—itf you are at all able. There is no inf. implied here, the pronoun being construed with the verb immediately according to the Greek idiom.® 23. To «i dvvn*— (omit moretoa). Lf thou canst. Jesus re- peats the father’s words in order to call attention to them, and to the doubt expressed in them, which would stand in the way of his petition. The art. adds to the emphasis with which he points to these words, as we say, Zhat “if you can.” ravta dwara To muorevovre — Over against the father’s doubt, the Lord puts the omnipotence of faith, which places at man’s disposition the Divine power. Omit misretoa, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BC* L A 1, 118, 209, 244, one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. 24. EvOvs xpatas 6 rarip Tod matdiov éXeye, tiaTevw, Bonde pov TH amiotia— Immediately the father of the boy cried out and said, I believe ; help my unbelief. ‘This does not mean “help me to turn my unbelief into belief,’’ but “‘help me out of my trouble, in spite 1 See on v.18, The compound verb is found elsewhere only in Maximus Tyrius, a writer of the second century B.C. 2 On the pleonasm, see Win. 65, 2. ma.did0ev is a late word. The Greeks said éx travdds. § See Win. 64, 4. 4vvy is a rare poetical and later form for dvvaca. 4 On the use of the art, with ei dvvy, see Win. 18 a, 3. 170 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [IxX. 24-26 of any unbelief that you may find in me.” He claims at first, that he does believe, notwithstanding any appearance to the con- trary in his language. And yet, he does not rest his case there, but pleads with Jesus to show him mercy in any case. He pleads the compassion of Jesus, instead of his own faith, and so uncon- sciously showed a genuine faith. Omit xal Tisch. (Treg.) WH. RV. x¢ BL A one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. Omit pera Saxptwv, with tears, x A* BC* L A 28, one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. Omit Kvpce, Jord, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 ABC* DL 346 mss. Lat. Vet. one ms. Vulg. Syrr. 25. Oru émurvytpexet (6) 6xAos — that a (the) crowd ts running together besides (those already gathered). The evidence for the insertion or omission of the art.is evenly divided. The anarthrous noun is more consistent with the meaning of émurvytpexer. ert — adds to ouvrpéxet, ts running together, the meaning Jdesides, t.e. in addition to those already collected.’ The part. idwy is causal ; it was because Jesus saw this, that he rebuked the demon. He did not wish to attract a larger crowd by prolonging the scene, and so, without any further delay, he proceeded with the cure. It is his usual avoidance of any notoriety in his mira- cles. 1d dAadov kal kwov rvedua— thou dumb and deaf spirit. The story has grown by so much, since the first mention of the spirit. Then it was dumb, which was more than the other Gos- pels tell us, now it has become deaf and dumb. rd &dadov kal kwpdv rvedua, instead of 7d wvetua Td Adadov kal KkwoHdr, Tisch. Treg. WH. s BC* DLA 1, 33, 73, 118, Latt. Memph. 26. kal xpdfas Kal moAAG orapatas, €&frAOe — And having cried out and convulsed (him) violently, he came out. kpdtas Kal . omapdéas, instead of the neuter, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BC* DL(A). Omit airdy, him, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 7 BC* DL A mss. Lat. Vet. KpaSas kK. orapagas — The masc. gender shows that the writer thought of the spirit as a person. éyévero Goel vexpos — he became as if dead. It is impossible to account for this final convulsion. If Jesus, ¢.g., were restoring a drowned person, would the horrible feelings attending a natural restoration be avoided ? And whether any such violent wrench of mind and body would attend a sudden cure of insanity, we do not know. WOTE TOYS TOAAOUS A€yetv > — 50 that the most said. Insert rods before roAXovs Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 ABL A 33. 1 This compound occurs only here in the N.T. and nowhere in profane authors. 2 On the preference of N.T. Grk. for the inf. to express result after dove, see Burton, 235, 369-371. IX. 27-32] SECOND PREDICTION OF DEATH 171 27. kparnoas THS xELpos avTov — having taken his hand. THs xewpds avrov, instead of avrov ris xeipds, him by the hand, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BDLA1, 13, 28, 53, 69, 118, 209, Latt. Memph. 28. kai ciceAOdvtos aitov!— And he having entered. eiceNObvTos avrod, instead of the acc., Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BCDLA I, 13, 28, 69, 118, 209, 346 (Latt.). Ore Hers ovk WuvnOnuev —Why could not we? On the use of ort, see on v.'. There seems to be no reason whatever here for supposing that this is a statement, instead of a question. There is a kind of challenge in the statement, that is evidently not in their minds. They mean simply to ask the question, why they could not perform this miracle, when Jesus had given them power over unclean spirits. 29. tovto To yevos — this kind of thing, t.e. the genus evil spirit ; not this kind of spirit, as if this was a specially vicious kind of spirit, that it took a good deal to exorcise. év mpocevyy — in prayer. ai vynoreia, and fasting, is an evident gloss. It is one of the things that a later asceticism imported into the spiritual teaching of J.sus. It seems to be implied in the question of the disciples that they had expected to cast out th. demon, so that their lack of faith in the matter had not taken the shape of doubt of their power. But what was lacking was prayer, which is the expression of faith considered as dependence on the Divine power and confidence in that. It is the sense of God that con- veys all kinds of spiritual power. But this power was not sub- jective, it did not reside in themselves, but was power to move God, and this precludes the idea that a special degree of this power was necessary in the case of so stubborn a demon as this. But it is a general statement that miracles of any kind are possible only to him who prays. Omit kai vyorelg, Tisch. (Treg. marg.) WH. RV. 8* B one ms. Lat. Vet. It is one of the things that would stand no chance of omission, if found in the original. Evidence shows that it was interpolated in a like passage (1 Cor. 7°). SECOND PREDICTION OF DEATH 30-32. Jesus returns through Galilee, and again seeks to hide his presence, in order to convey to his disciples the eso- teric teaching about his death. The same particulars are 1 On this use of the gen. abs., instead of the participle agreeing with its noun or pronoun found elsewhere in the sentence, see Win, 30, 11, Note. 172 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [IxX. 30—32 given as in the previous announcement, that he will be delivered up, and put to death, and will rise again after three days. But they did not know what he was saying, and were afraid to question him. 30. Kdxeibev eSedOovres (rap) éropevovro— and having gone out from that place, they were coming. The place which they left was the vicinity of Czesarea Philippi. Their journey through Galilee to Capernaum would take them on the west side of the Jordan. éropevovro, instead of raperopevovro, Treg. WH. B* D8 mss. Lat. Vet. Kat ovk nOedev iva tis ywot—and did not wish that any one should know it Jesus’ desire to escape notice is a continuation of the policy pursued by him since his departure to Tyre and Sidon (7%). Since that time, he has been mostly in strange places, accompanied by his disciples alone, and preparing them for the approaching crisis in his life. yvot, instead of yv@, Tisch. Treg. WH. s BCDL. 31. ediSacxev yap etc.—for he was teaching his disciples. ‘This esoteric teaching was the reason of his desire to escape observation. Prediction of things to be done by men is apt to prejudice the event. It was necessary that the disciples should be prepared for so startling an issue, but the world is left wisely to the tutelage of unforeseen events. zapadiSora.—is delivered over. ‘The present is used to denote the certainty of the future event.? pera tpels huepas — after three days. The resurrection was really on the third day. But the usage of speech allowed this to be spoken of in either way. 32. jyvdovv 76 phua— they did not understand the word. This passage and the parallel (Lk. 9) are the only ones in which this verb is used with the meaning understand, and the peculiar use in passages relating to the same event is strongly corroborative of the interdependence of the accounts. éoBodtvro airov érepwrjcat — they feared to question him. They were afraid that further ques- tions would not alleviate, but only aggravate, the situation, and they feared to know the worst. 1 voi is an irregular form of the sec. aor. subj. iva with the subj. after 76eAer is one of the signs of the degeneracy of the language, in which the distinctive meaning of words is gradually weakened, and finally disappears. Burton, 191, 203; Win. _ 2See Burton, 15; Win. 40,2. Win. admits the use of the historical present, but inconsistently denies the use of the pres. for the fut., which involves the same prin- ciple. Future is still future, though conceived as present. IX. 33, 34] MEANING OF GREATNESS 173 MEANING OF GREATNESS 33-37. Dispute among the disciples over the question of precedence among them. Jesus defines true greatness for them. The journey from Czsarea Philippi brings them to Capernaum, where Jesus begins to question them about a dispute which they had had on the road, and which they evidently desire to con- ceal from him. We learn elsewhere that James and John actu- ally asked him for first and second place among his followers, when the time should come to distribute these honors (10%). And probably, this was an outcropping of the same spirit. The first three places were conceded to these two and to Peter. But which was to be primus? Jesus answers this question by putting before them the paradox of the kingdom, that last is first, and service is greatness. Then he takes a child, and teaches them that the spirit of the child is the mark of the king, to receive one such is to receive him, and to receive him is to receive God. 33. Kal 7ADov cis Kadapvaovp — And they came to Capernaum. HrOov, instead of #AGev, he came, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 B(D) 1, 118, 209, most mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Pesh. yevopuevos — being (AV.), and when he was (RV.), do not trans- late this verb, which denotes decoming not being. Having come to be, or having come, translates it. Ti év ty 600 diedoyileobe — The verb is impf. and means were disputing. Omit mpés éavtovs, among yourselves, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BCDL mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. 34. éoldrwv — were silent. But kept silent is better, which is another meaning of the impf. The merging of all these different shades of meaning into the simple past tense is one of the imper- fections of the AV. This silence was due to their shame. They knew Jesus’ opinion of such disputes. dueréxPnoav — they had disputed.’ ris peilwv —who is greatest? That is, which of them ? Winer contends, that the compar. is used here with perfect regu- larity, since the object with which the comparison is made is really only one.? But this would make it possible to substitute the com- par. for the superl. in all cases, since the greatest is always greater 1 On the plup. element in the aor., see Burton, 48, 52. 2 35, 4. 174 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [IX. 34-37 than all the rest, the comparison being made always not with individuals, but with all taken together. But this confusion is one of the signs of degeneracy in a decadent language. 35. ravrwv éxxatos Kal 1. dStaxovos — he shall be least of all, and servant of all, ‘This is the way to be great among the disciples of Jesus. It does not point out the penalty of ambition, as we might gather from the certain disapproval of the ordinary ambition by Jesus, but the way of satisfying Christian ambition. But the method is a paradox, like the beatification of sorrow. The Christian way to be first is to be last, to fall to the rear, to efface yourself. But itis not only humility that is demanded, but service. This again is a paradox, since primacy means dominion, the fac- ulty not of serving, but of levying service on others. But these things, humility and service, in the kingdom of God, not only lead to greatness, they are greatness, z.¢. they are the supreme marks of the Christian quality. And it is one of the signs that the world is becoming a seat of the kingdom of God, that rulers, leaders, employers, and others, are beginning to recognize this idea of service as the meaning of their position. 36. évayxadtcapevos—a Biblical word, corresponding exactly to our embrace, en bras, for which the Greeks said év dyxdAats Aap Bavw. 37. €v tov madiwv Towovtwv — one of such little children. The child meant by our Lord is not a child in years, but in spirit, a person possessed of the childlike quality. The child is the best example of the type just held up before the disciples by our Lord, and he is himself the greatest in the kingdom of heaven. When he says then, that to receive such a childlike person is the same as to receive him, he is affirming again, in his striking way, that humility and service are the marks of greatness in his kingdom ; they are, that is, the things that identify a man with him.’ ds av, instead of os éayv, Tisch. Treg. WH. 8 ABCDL A 1, 13, 28, 69. In the second clause the same, Tisch. Treg. WH. BDL A. éri T@ Gvopati pou — upon my name, i.e. on the strength of my name. ‘The prep. denotes the basis, the ground of the reception. This use of the word évoua to denote the various things about a person recalled by his name, especially in the phrase év or émi ro dvopatt, is not Greek, but Hebrew. The phrase indicates that a person is so connected with another, that he receives whatever consideration belongs to that other. The connection of thought, however, shows that, just as the personal consideration is excluded by this phrase, showing that the man is not received for himself, but because of Jesus; so it cannot be a mere outward connection with our Lord, but because the man’s childlikeness makes him 1 Cf. Mt. 1825, IX. 37-50] EXCLUSIVENESS CONDEMNED 175 like Jesus, so that men are reminded of Jesus when they see him. ovk ene dexerat, GAAG Tov arooTEiNavTaA pe — receives not me but him who sent me. Christ did not represent himself in the world, but the Father, a fact developed at great length in the fourth Gospel. This representative character belongs to him as the one sent by the Father into the world. But in this case also, the connection is not outward, but inward. To be sent by God is to be inspired by him, to be filled with His Spirit, and so the spirit of humility and service, in the disciple, and in Jesus himself, is here carried a step farther back, and is shown to be that of the Father. In such a child, Jesus says, you see me, yes, and God himself. EXCLUSIVENESS CONDEMNED 38-50. The disciples tell Jesus of their interference with one casting out demons in his name, but not following them. Jesus reply. The belief of the disciples in the near approach of the kingdom seems to have wrought in them other effects than ambition. So far, the power to work miracles had been confined to themselves. And it seemed to them a mark of superiority to which they had the exclusive right. So we find John, apparently in the course of this same conversation, telling Jesus of the case of an outsider who had used his name in casting out demons, and had been for- bidden by them any further exercise of a power appropriated to them. Jesus’ answer is substantially that they are right, that the work of a disciple does belong to a disciple ; but that they have turned this the wrong way. It does not lead to officialism, but just the opposite. It follows, not that any one who is outside their circle should be forbidden their work, but that the doing of the work shows that he is like them inwardly, though not out- wardly. Their complaint is, that he is doing their work. Very well, Jesus says, that shows that he is on your side. It is not necessary to do a miracle to show this; a cup of water given to them because they are disciples shows the same thing. But if any one causes the fall of one of the humblest of these disciples, it would be better for him to be cast into the sea, with a millstone round his neck. And since to fall away is so grievous an evil, they would better cut off hand, or foot, or eye, than have any member cause their fall, since this means Gehenna and its fires to 176 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [IX. 38, 39 them. Fire is to salt them all, either the fire of affliction here, or the fire of Gehenna there. Fire is salt, and salt is good; but if any salt loses its flavor, how is salt to be salted? Hence they must have salt in themselves to render these outward purifiers effective, and especially must be at peace among themselves, an injunction which their jealousies and rivalries rendered necessary. 38. "Edy aitd 6 "Iwavvys, Avddoxanre, edopev twa ev TH Ovopari gov éxBddXovra Sapovia, Kal éxwdevopev adTov, OTL OvK HKoAOVHEL yiV — John said to him, Teacher, we saw one casting out demons in thy name, and we forbade him, because he was not following us. "Edn, instead of daexplOn 6¢.. . Néywv. And... answered, saying, Tisch. Treg. (who, however, retains \éywv) WH. RV. x B A Memph. Pesh. In- sert év before 7. évéuare Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDLN A 1, 69, etc. Omit és ovk dkodovbe? Hutv, who does not follow us, WH. RV. BCL A Io, 115, 346, one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. Pesh. ékw)vopev, instead of -dvoa- uev, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BD& L A 1, 209. 7xodovGe, instead of dxonNovGe, after dru ovk, Tisch. WH. RV. 8 BA. A.sdoxare — Teacher, not Master. The word in the vernacu- lar used by him would be Rabbi. év r@ évouari cov— in thy name. See on v.*”. In this case, it means, by the authority of Jesus. Ore odk Korovber — because he was not following. ‘The impf. takes us back to the time of the transaction, when the disciples saw him casting out demons. They were right in assuming this to be an abnormal case, because the proper place for the disciple assuming such powers was with Jesus. The Master kept such in his imme- diate company for instruction, and even his immediate disciples he sent out on such errands only very rarely. But all such restric- tions are themselves limited by the method of the Spirit’s working, which is like the wind, blowing where it will. The disciples had a right to expect that one who had come under the influence of Jesus would, like them, desire to be with him. But they did not take into account the fact that one might, under the influence of such a life, be awakened himself to the want and wretchedness of the world, and wish to put the mysterious power that he felt within him to the test, and that this might overpower even the desire for the companionship of the Lord. 39. xaxodoyjoa— to speak evil.’ Jesus puts the matter imme- diately upon its proper footing, showing the disciples that, reason- ing from the facts within their possession, they ought to have drawn a favorable conclusion. To be sure, it was so far against the man, that he did not company with them; but that was not conclusive. Whereas it was conclusive, that he was able to per- form the miracle. The test whether one is fit to perform an act 1 xaxoAoyjoae Comes within the classical period, but cax@s A¢yerv is more usual, IX. 39-42] EXCLUSIVENESS CONDEMNED 177 is the performance of the act. A man’s fitness to write poetry, to preach, to paint, to perform miracles, is proved by his perform- ance in each case. Can he do the thing? But here there was a further question involved, whether the man really belonged to the disciples of Jesus, and so had a right to use the name that he had used in casting out the demons. The fact, that he did not follow the disciples, seemed to be against his own right as a disciple, but this was entirely overborne by the effect that followed his use of the name. He could not cast out demons, actually cast them out, in the name of Jesus, and then turn around and revile it. Or, as Jesus says, he could not do it raxd, guickly. The two things are incongruous, so that they could not follow each other rapidly. 40. Os ovk éotw Kad nud ireép Yudov — he who is not against us is for us. This is not the opposite of “he that is not against us is for us,” but its complement (Mt. 12”). There Jesus is talking about this same matter of casting out demons, which he had been accused of doing in the name of Beelzebub. But he answers that the act is one of hostility to Satan, and cannot therefore proceed from Satan himself. One cannot be for and against at the same time. Then he applies the same principle to himself, saying that he who is not for him is against him. Here, he shows that this same act of casting out demons is friendly to himself, as it is hostile to Satan, and that he who shows himself thus friendly, can- not be at the same time hostile. The use which is often made of Mt. 12”, to show that there is no such thing as indifference to Jesus, but that seeming indifference is real hostility, is unwarrant- able. ‘The real meaning of both passages is, that friendliness and hostility are incongruous, and cannot therefore exist together. nu@v, us, instead of tua, you, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BCD 1, 13, 69, 209, one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. Harcl. marg. 41. Os yap dv orion iuas rornpiov vdaros ev dvopart 6tt Xpiorod éote— Lor whoever gives you a cup of water to drink on the ground that you belong to Christ. dévopare is used here like the Latin zomen to denote cause or season. RV. decause ye are Christ’s. This confirms the preceding by showing that even a small service done in his name will be taken as showing friendli- ness to him, and so will not lose its reward. It gets its character from its motive of attachment to him. Omit 7@ before évéuar: Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABCLNX II. Omit pov, my, after dvduar. Treg. WH. RV. x¢ ABC* KLN II* 1, 229, 238, 435, Pesh. Harcl. zext. Insert wou Tisch. s* C? DX TAII? Latt. Memph. Harcl. marg. The pleonasm favors this reading, as Tisch. says. Insert bri, that, before ob uh arodécy, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BC* DL A mss. Lat. Vet. one ms. Vulg. Syrr. Memph. a A 42. kal os dv cxavdadioy eva TovTwy TOV pikpOV TOV TLOTEVOVTUY, Kadov éotiv aiT@ pardov, ei rEepixettat pros dviKos — And whoever N ad 178 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [IX. 42, 43 causes the fall of one of these little ones who believe, it is well for him rather, if an upper millstone is hung around his neck. Insert rovtwv, these, before T&v puixpGv, little ones, Tisch. Treg. (Treg. marg.) WH. RV. & ABC*a»d2 DLM? N A 1, mss. of Lat. Vet. Memph. Harcl. Omit els éué, 22 me, after TGv micrevdvTwy, who believe, Tisch. WH. RV. (Treg. marg.) x A mss. Lat. Vet. also C* D one ms. Lat. Vet., which read riot éxdvTwv, have faith, without els éué. pldos ovukods, upper mill- stone, instead of AiPos wuArKés, a mtllstone, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL A Latt. Pesh. This presents the other side, the result of injuring one of his disciples. But it is noticeable that the injury is a spiritual one. Not that other hurts inflicted on them would not be taken as indi- cating hostility to him, but that Jesus, when he thinks of such injuries, singles out those inflicted on their spiritual nature as the only ones that will really harm them, though others show the dis- position to harm them. xaddy éorw aito padrdAov — itt ts well for him rather Regularly, the form of conditional sentence em- ployed would correspond to the assumption that the condition is contrary to the fact ; z.e. past tenses of the ind. would be employed. The English Version indicates this by its translation, 7¢ were better, were hung, and were cas¢. ‘The present corstruction, making it a pure condition, leaves out of sight that the clause os av oxavdarion has already assumed cxavdarilew, — causing to fall, as the actual case. pvAos dvikos — an upper millstone. Both words are Biblical, and évixds is found only here and in the parallel passage (Mt. 18°). This is another case, therefore, in which only the interdependence of the written accounts will account for the identity of the lan- guage. The grist was ground in a mill between an upper and under stone, the under one being stationary, and the upper one turned by an ass, whence the name évikds. 43. kal éav oxavdarion ce 7 XElp Tov, adTOKOWov aiTyV’ KaAdV éoTiV ce kvAXov etc. — and tf your hand causes you to fall, cut tt off ; tt is well for you to enter into life maimed, etc. tKkavdarloy, instead of -¢y, Tisch. WH. RV. 8 BL A mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. éorty ce, instead of co éori, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A 13, 28, 60%”. 346. oKkavoadion — This word forms the connection between this and the preceding discourse. Jesus has begun by speaking of what it is to be identified with him, and incidentally has introduced the subject of the injury inflicted on him by causing the fall of one of his disciples. And in connection with this has come up the ques- tion of comparative values, spiritual and material. This leads him to speak of the things in the man himself that would lead to his fall, and to continue the subject of comparative values in connec- 1 The comp. of cadds (Or «aAws) is found only once in the N.T. (Acts 251°). IX. 43-47 | EXCLUSIVENESS CONDEMNED 179 tion with that. It is well to cut off hand, or foot, or eye, sooner than run the risk through either of them of absolute spiritual loss. eicedety eis r. Cwyv— to enter into life. Life is the word used in the Bible to express the reward of righteousness. And it is the word which expresses the natural, instead of the imposed consequence of conduct. Conduct reacts on the life, the being of the man, and right conduct conduces to health and fulness of life. eis t. Téevvav — into Gehenna. ‘This is the Grecized form of pina the Vale of Hinnom, which is the valley on the SE. side of Jerusalem. This valley had been desecrated by the sacrifice of children to Moloch, and had been used as an accursed place, for the refuse and garbage of the city. Here worms consumed the dead matter, and fires were kept burning to destroy the refuse. Hence it came to be used as a name for the place of future punish- ment. cis TO rp 76 aoBeorov— into the unquenchable fire. This is borrowed from the continual fires of Hinnom spoken of above. And the material figure expresses the idea of destruction, as life denotes the opposite side of retribution. ‘The contrast with Cony would indicate that this is the meaning of the figure here, rather than torment. Jesus follows here his usual habit of borrowing current language, which lends itself, however, to the expression of more radical spiritual ideas than it conveyed to the common understanding. This is not a necessary deduction from the lan- guage, but its aptness for the expression of the deeper thought, and the aptness of Jesus for the deeper thought, combine to create a strong probability of its correctness. Omit v.44, Tisch. WH. RV. 8 BCL A 1, 28, 118, 251. 45. xadov éoriv ce — Zt ts well for you. éorty ce, instead of éori co, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABCEFGHKLVX AII. Omit eis 76 rip 76 doBeorov, into the unquenchable fire, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BCLA 1 28, 118, 251, two mss. Lat. Vet. Pesh. Omit v.46, same authorities as v.*. 47. xadov oé eorw povdpbadrpov eicedAOely cis THY Bacreiav Tov ®cod, 7 Sv0 dpOarpors Exovta BAnOnvar eis THy yéevvav, drov, etc. — It is well for you to enter one-eyed into the kingdom of God, than having two eyes to be cast into Gehenna, where, etc. oé éoriy, instead of co éori, Tisch. Treg. WH. (RV.) & B; éoriv ce of LA. Omit rod rupés, of fire, after yéevvav (Gehenna of fire, not hell fire), Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDL A 1, 28, 118, 209, mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. Kingdom of God is substituted in this case for Zfe. The con- trast with yéevvay shows that it is the future, rather than the present form of the kingdom, that is strictly meant. But in the mouth of Jesus, such a term as kingdom of God has a permanent 180 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [IX. 47-50 meaning, which is never lost among the minor changes. To him it meant simply the realm in which the will of God is done. It is well,’ he says, to enter that realm at any cost. 48. orov 6 oxwdAnf airdv ov TeAEvTA, Kal TO TIP Ov GBevvyTaL — where their worm dies not, and the fire is not quenched. Both worm and fire are here destructive forces, and belong in the same category as life and death, denoting natural and not imposed penalties. Of course, it is the soul that undergoes punishment, and the punishment consists in the forces that prey upon it and destroy it. 6 oxwdAné airav— their worm; the worm, 2.e. that preys upon the inhabitants of this dread realm. ov TeXEvTG, Kat . . . ov oBevvuTac— dies not, and ... ts not quenched. It is the permanence of the retribution that is ex- pressed in these material figures. This is characteristic of natural penalties as distinguished from imposed penalties. Whippings and imprisonments are subject to limitations of time, but the wounds inflicted on the man himself by his sins, the degradation and deterioration of his being, have no such limitation. The worm that gnaws, and the fire that burns inwardly have no limits. They propagate themselves. 49, 50. was yap mupi aAwcOyoera. Kadov To dAa(s) — For every one shall be salted with fire. Salt is good. Omit kal maGoa @Ovola adt adioOjoerar, and every sacrifice shall be salted with salt, Tisch. Treg. marg. (Treg.) WH. RV. BL A 1, 61, 73, 118, 205, 206, 209, 229, 251, 258, 435, one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. edd. This is confessedly one of the most difficult passages to inter- pret in the N.T. In the first place, it seems necessary to con- nect wvpi with zip, v.*, and dAtoOyoerae in v.” with ddas in v.°. And it is this connection with what precedes and follows that makes trouble. For zvpi is also connected with ddAwdyoe- tat, and dAwcOycerat, from its connection with dAas, gets a good meaning, and zvpi, from its connection with zip, gets a bad meaning. ‘That makes the crux of the situation. Meyer is about the only one who faces this, and gives us a key that fits into all the wards of the lock. This he does by obtaining his interpre- tation of dAwcOyjoerar from Lev. 2’, where it is called the salt of the covenant. To be salted would mean, therefore, for any one to have the covenant fulfilled on himself. was would refer thus to those who suffer the doom of Gehenna, and the meaning would be that every one of these shall have the covenant fulfilled on him by its fires. And on the other hand, every sacrifice, such as those make who cut off hand or foot, or eye, to preserve themselves from spiritual loss, will have the covenant fulfilled on them by the 1 On this use of the pos, instead of the comp., wed/, instead of detter, see Win, Ceres Ne a IX. 50] EXCLUSIVENESS CONDEMNED 181 salt of purifying wisdom. The difficulty with this very ingenious, and otherwise satisfactory interpretation is, that it involves a re- condite allusion to the usages and meanings of ceremonial law, which is entirely foreign to our Lord’s manner of speech. And then, it gives also a double meaning to daAas, one in the verb adto@noerat, and another in the noun itself. This breaks up the connection made by the recurrence of the same keywords, not so badly, to be sure, as when different meanings are assigned to rip in v.*-*, but still enough to constitute a difficulty. Another very serious difficulty is, that it requires the retention of the second clause of v.*, x. waoa @voia, etc. This clause is, to say the least, extremely doubtful. And yet, it furnishes the only use of ddas giving us a transition to the dAas of v.”, as the meaning of dAvoOyoerat makes no connection with that. No, we shall have to find an interpretation that will enable us to pass right over from the first clause of v. to v.”, and that at the same time will preserve the connection with v.*. Salt in that case will have to denote a purifying element, to connect “ and *, and fire will have to de- note a destroying element, to connect * and ®. That is, we have brought together in this v.* the purifying element salt, and the destroying element fire, and the statement is that the destructive element performs a purifying part. The object of all retributions, even of the penal retributions of Gehenna, is to purify. They serve, like sickness in the physical being, to warn man against violations of the law of his being. But the statement is not re- stricted to these, but is extended, as the unlimited zas naturally suggests, to the cutting off of hand and foot and eye also. Every one shall be purified either by the loss of parts, self-inflicted to preserve the whole, or by the destroying fires of Gehenna. ‘This is the law of our being, and every one has to submit to it, in one form or another. Kadov TO dAas'— saltis good. The special form of purification meant is that of affliction. But the statement is general — “at which purifies is good. dvadkov— literally saléess. apricere* — will you season? ‘The meaning of the proverb is, that there are certain things in the world having special qualities which they can impart to other substances ; and if they lose these qualities, what can impart them to the very things which possess them as their special character? In other words, what can perfume the rose? what can salt salt? spice spice? or restore grace where it is lost? So, if loss loses its power to chasten, what will chasten loss? 70 dda. 1 Gda in the last clause is formed regularly from dds, which is regular, but not found here; also from aaa, the reading of Tisch. in the first two clauses, and a later form. But it is not to be formed regularly from aAas, though the two are conjoined in the authorities followed by Treg. WH. dadas is also a later form. 2 This word means strictly to prepare food, and only in comic writers and the Bible, 40 season it, 182 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [Ix. 50-X. 12 éxere ev Eavtois dda — have saltin yourselves. Our Lord’s injunction is that they have the purifying element in themselves, instead of being dependent on outside agencies, such as loss and retribution, for it. This is the condition of purifying power in the outward agencies. Taste in the man himself is necessary to the savor of salt, feeling to the heat of fire, faith to the grace of God. cipnvev- ere €v G\AHAOts | — cultivate peace, or be at peace, among yourselves. This injunction is the special form of the previous general admoni- tion fitted to the present case. ‘They had been disputing about precedence among themselves, and about rights with another man, whose place among themselves they ought to have recognized. é&das in the first two clauses of v.59, ABCDNX II etc. dda, Tisch. 8* LA. dda in last clause, Tisch. Treg. WH. s* AB* DL A 1, 28, 209. This discourse is evidently one in which the connections of thought have been obscured, and interpretation hindered, by the imperfectness of the report. But our Gospel has preserved for us, however imperfectly, thoughts and connections both charac- teristic and valuable. In Mt. the setting of the discourse is the same, in Capernaum after the return from the mountain of Trans- figuration. And the connections of thought in the conversation are the same, until we come to Mk.’s peculiar ending. Instead of this, we have the parable of the lost sheep, and from that it runs on into different discourse. Lk. introduces the discourse in the same way, but carries it on only through the part relating to the man healing in hisname. The danger of leading astray a dis- ciple he introduces elsewhere. But Mk.’s ending, however peculiar and difficult, has an air of verisimilitude, not in form, but in matter. JUD2@A. MARRIAGE AND DIVORCE x.1-12. Jesus departs from Galilee, and comes to Judaa and Perea. The Pharisees try him with one of their test- questions, in vegard to divorce. Jesus’ answer. Jesus’ ministry in Galilee is at an end, and he goes into the region of Southern Palestine. Between this beginning and the controversy about divorce which Mk. introduces immediately, there is a gap, which Lk. fills in with his most characteristic matter. This question of divorce was one of the puzzles of the 1To make this phrase consistent, either the pron, should be changed to the reflexive, or the prep. to pera. x. 1-4| JUDA. MARRIAGE AND DIVORCE 183 schools, arising from the ambiguity of the law. Jesus, in his answer, interprets the law in accordance with the liberal school, which allowed laxness of divorce ; but says that this license was due to their spiritual dulness. From the beginning, 7.c., originally and essentially, marriage, being based on the sexual distinction and act, and therefore a Divine institution, is indissoluble, and divorce involves adultery. 1. Kai éxetOev— And from this place. The place meant is Capernaum. See 9”. kai aépay t. ‘lopdavov—and across the Jordan. The general district, ra dpia, into which he came was Southern Palestine, including the region on both sides of the river. mdAw oxAo. — multitudes again. During the last part of the time in Galilee, he was alone with his disciples. See 9. But now, in Judea, he is entering on a new phase of his general mission, the multitudes gather around him again, and he is teach- ing them as usual. The Impf. édédacxey denotes not a single act, but a course of action, and should be translated, was reaching. Kai, instead of 61a rot, before répav, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV.» BC* L Memph. 2. Kai rpoceXOovres Papicaton éxnpdrwv airov— And Pharisees came to him and asked him. mepalovres airov— resting him. This was a test, not a temptation. Heclaimed to bea Rabbi, and they proposed to put him to a test by propounding to him one of their puzzles. The law of divorce itself allowed it in case of the wife’s coming into disfavor with her husband because of his find- ing something unseemly in her. The school of Shammai, which was in general the stricter school, interpreted this to apply only to cases of adultery, while the opposite school of Hillel licensed divorce under it for any cause. See Deut. 24’. The ambiguity of the passage, and the disputes of the Rabbis, made it a cause célébre, fitted to test, and possibly to discredit, the superior wis- dom claimed by Jesus. Omit oi, he, before Papicaior, Treg. WH. RV. ABL TAII, two mss. Lat. Vet. érnpwrwy, instead of érnpaétynoay, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BCDLM A. 3. Tiipiv évere(Aato Mwions ;— What did Moses command you ? Jesus recognizes that this is to them primarily a question of the Mosaic Law, and so, in order to get the matter properly before them, he asks for the law. 4. B¢BAvov'— means a roll, the form in which all written docu- ments were prepared at the time. drooraciov? — of divorce. ‘This 1 gi8d.ov is a diminutive from BiBAos, which denotes primarily the papyrus plant, the bark of which was prepared for writing. k 2 This word is rare, and in the sense of divorce it is peculiar to the Bible. 184 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [Xx. 4-7 reply does not contain the condition of the divorce in the original, which made the subject of dispute between the two schools, viz., that the wife had come into disfavor because the husband found something unseemly in her (Deut. 24'). This is an indication that Jesus’ questioners belonged to the school of Hillel, which found in it practically no barrier to absolute freedom of divorce, so that in citing the law, they would ignore this as having no bear- ing on the case. Mt. 19°” gives a different version of the affair, which, however, defines their position still more distinctly as the liberal position. According to that, their question is, whether it is lawful for a man to divorce his wife for every cause. Jesus answers this by defining his own position forbidding divorce, when they ask, why Moses allowed it then. ‘The order is unimportant, and there is nothing to choose between the two accounts. 5. 6 d€ ‘Ingots dev adtois, pds t. oxAnpoxapdiav ipav éypawev tuly thy évtoAnv tavtnv'— And Jesus said to them out of re- gard to the hardness of your heart, he wrote you this command. oKAypoxapodia* — coarseness of spirit. oxXynpds means hard, in the sense of rough or coarse, rather than wnimpressible. xapdia is the common word for the inner man generally, in the N.T. The whole word denotes the rude nature which belongs to a primitive civilization. This principle of accommodation to the time in Scripture is of inestimable importance, and of course limits finally the absoluteness of its authority. We find that the writers were subject to this limitation, as well as their readers. See also J. 16”. This answer of Jesus admits the correctness of the interpretation of Hillel and his school, as far as it was a matter of interpretation. ‘O 6é, instead of Kat daroxpibels 6, And answering, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BCL A Memph. 6. do d€ dpyns xticews — But from the beginning of creation. Jesus goes back from the Mosaic Law to the original constitution of things, for which he cites Gen. 1”, in connection with 2”. This connection, instead of basing marriage on the taking of woman from man, puts it on the much broader and more rational ground of their sexual relation. dpoev kal OnAv éroinoey abrovs — male and female he made them? Omit 6 Qeds, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A two mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. This conforms to the original, in which 6 @eés belongs to the preceding part of the statement, and is omitted here. 7. evexey TovTov— on this account, viz., because of the physical relation, pointing to an even closer union than that between parent and child. Both belong to the perpetuity of the family, 1 On this meaning of pds, see Win. 49 2, ¢). It is not common Greek usage. 2 gxAnpoxapdia is a Biblical word. 3 Gen. 127, Xx. 7-9] JUDAA. MARRIAGE AND DIVORCE 185 but the relation of husband and wife is, in the nature of things, more intimate and compelling. With the omission of the last clause, and shall cleave to his wife, stress is laid on the separation from father and mother, and so on the superiority of the other union. Omit cai rpocxodAnOjoerar mpds THY yuvaixa avrov, Tisch. (Treg. marg.) WH. RV. marg. s B. 8. x. xovrat ot dvo eis capxa piav—and the two shall become one fiesh.. oi dvo is not found in the Heb., but was introduced into the Sept. It adds nothing to the meaning, though it strengthens the expression of it. écovrat eis is a Hebraism, denoting the coming into a state.” The union pointed out is a physical one, being that to which the sexual relation points — “hey shall become one flesh. ‘The sexual act unites them, makes them one, the same as the junction of two streams make one river, the union of hydro- gen and oxygen in certain proportions makes one substance, water, the mechanical joining of different parts fitted to each other makes the one structure. ore oikéri eioi dv0, dAAG pia cdp§—So that they are no longer two, but one flesh. ‘This is our Lord’s inference from the preceding quotation. The duality no longer exists ; it has been replaced by this structural unity. Before, there had been two beings structurally fitted for each other; now, their union makes this new structural unity. If they had remained two, they would be separate; but being now structurally one, they belong together. 9. 0 ovv 6 Weds ovvelevéev, avOpwros pi) ywpiléerw— what therefore God joined together, let not man separate. The act of joining together is God’s, since the constitution that underlies it is His ; divorce, on the other hand, is a matter of human legislation ; and the human is not to set aside the divine. God has not only created this structural unity in the original creation of man; he has made man himself to recognize this purpose of his structure, and has written this law of his physical being in his spiritual nature, so that what tends in brutes to indiscriminate intercourse, tends in man to the indissoluble and sacred bond of marriage. Jesus nowhere shows the absolute rationality and verity of his thought more than here. Spirituality is the very core of that thought, but it never misleads him so that he misses the material facts. And it is the insistence on these here, that saves him from an immoral sentimentality. Whatever may underlie marriage in the realm of the feelings, it is itself physical, and produces structural unity. And about that, for the profoundest reasons, God gathers all the holiest feelings, and by solemn sanctions, confines them within that circle. Except for that confinement, the feelings themselves lose their sacredness, and become unhallowed and profane. 1 Gen, 274, 2 Heb, ? india 186 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [X. 10-12 10. Kai cis riv oixiav' radw, of paOytai wept tovtov émnpwTwv attov — And (having come) into the house again, the disciples asked him about this. eis Thy olklav, instead of év r7 oixla, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDL A. Omit avrod, his, after of uadnrai, the disciples, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BCL A 28. rovrou, this, instead of rod avrod, the same, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. xs ABCLMNX [A mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. Pesh. é2nparwy, instead of érnpwrnoay, Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A. 11. “Os av azodAvon — Whosoever puts away his wife. av, instead of éay, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL A. Jesus states now what takes place in case of a second marriage following a mere formal divorce. It is to be inferred from the previous statement of the indissolubility of the marriage bond. Any formal sundering of the tie leaves it really whole ; the union being of this natural, physical kind, not accomplished by any for- mal procedure, but in the sexual act uniting man and woman, no formal procedure can break it, but simply leaves it asit was. And so, if any man divorces his wife and marries another, the second marriage goes for naught and the connection is an adulterous one, simply because the divorce is nil ; it does nothing towards dissolv- ing the marriage. 12. x. éav aity dmodvoaca T. avdpa aitas yauynon a\d\ov — and if she, having put away her husband, marries another. Under the Jewish law, the wife could not put away her husband, and while Jesus goes outside of Jewish law and develops general prin- ciples in his teaching, he does not travel outside of Jewish custom in finding the occasion of that teaching. This is one of the things that point to the Gentile surroundings and destination of this Gospel. Though evidently written by a Jew, it grew up in Gentile soil, and there this appendix to Jesus’ own teaching became per- fectly natural. The exception to this prohibition of divorce — except for the cause of adultery — stated in Mt. 19° is reallyimplied in our Lord’s statement of principles as recounted in our Gospel, because adultery is the real dissolution of the marriage tie, as dis- tinguished from the formal divorce.’ Precisely as divorce does not break the marriage tie, adultery does break it. But the state- ment is not full and clear without this, and in this respect the account of Mt. is to be followed. avTH admrodvcaca, instead of yur) drodtcn... kal, a woman puls away ... and, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BCL A Memph. vyaujon &ddop, instead of yaunO7 aw, 7s married to another, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV.8 BC* DLA I, 13, 28, 69, 124, 346, Latt. Memph. 1 This use of cis without even any verb like sc¢ or stand, implying previous action, or motion to a place, is to be noticed. ‘The return to the house is implied without any verb to suggest it. x. 13, 14] LITTLE CHILDREN BLESSED 187 LITTLE CHILDREN BLESSED 13-16. Jesus blesses little children, and rebukes his dis- ciples for repelling those bringing them. Jesus meets with opposition here, but also with trust. They bring to him little children, that they may receive that wonderful touch which has healed so many. ‘The disciples, whose thoughts are busy now with the important affairs of the kingdom, which seemed to them so near, rebuke them for intruding so slight matters on the Messiah. But Jesus became very angry, and bade the children to be brought to him, as representing the very spirit to which the kingdom belongs. Mt. and Mk. are parallel in their account from the close of the Galilean ministry to the final entry into Jerusalem. Lk. introduces, between the departure from Galilee and this point, much of his most characteristic matter. But beginning here, with the events immediately preceding the entry into Jerusalem, the three accounts become parallel. The following is a synopsis of these events: MATTHEW. MARK. LUKE. Question of Divorce. Same. Blessing of Children. in Same. Rich Young Man. a a Parable of Householder. Prophecy of Death. Same. Same. Petition of James and John. = Blind Men at Jericho. Same. 13. iva ayta airav — that he may touch them. The symbolic action accompanying the blessing was the laying on of hands. See v.16. Zouch gives the rationale of that conventional form. The mere touch of that wonderful being had cured, restored, raised. His method in conveying these blessings had been the laying on of hands, and they saw in this the effect of contact with so marvellous a man. €meripwv attois — rebuked them. ‘This re- buke was directed against the presumption of those persons in bringing mere children to the attention of so great and busy a person as Jesus. ‘ avrots, instead of tots mpoogpépova.y, those bringing them, Treg. marg. yw | WH. RV. s BCL A two mss. Lat. Vet. It is against this, that avrots is the \reading of Mt. and Lk. 14. qyavaxtyoe— was indignant. Or rather, in accordance with the use of aor. to denote the entering on a state denoted by the verb, became indignant.' The composition with ayav makes this a strong word. 1 Burton, 41. 188 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [x. 14-16 "Agere ta matdia epyecOar mpds pe’ py KwArdvere adta — Suffer the little children to come to me; forbid them not. The omission ~ cs Ny of the conjunction between the two clauses gives abruptness and force. Omit xal, and, before pi) kwdvere Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. BM* NX TAII Memph. trav yap Toovrwy éoriv 7 Barreca, etc.—for to such belongs the kingdom of God. The gen. is possessive, which is not denoted by of such is, AV.and RV. rév toovrwv denotes those possessing the childlike spirit of docility and humility. Cf. Mt. 18%. The spirit is one that belongs to them as children, and is the result of their position of dependence and subordination, the same as the discipline which belongs to the condition of a soldier. But those who show that disposition, when it is no longer the effect of posi- tion, but a manifestation of character, belong to the kingdom of God. In children therefore, as children, appears the very quality of the kingdom, and this gives them a special distinction in the eyes of its members. They are not to be turned away as unworthy the attention of its king. The kingdom of God in the world con- sists of those who substitute for self-will and independence the will of God, and trust in his wisdom and goodness. And this is the attitude of childhood. What children feel towards their parents man should feel towards God. 15. os dv pr deénra tr. Bacrreiay 7. Oeod ws ratdiov od pH ciceAOH eis abrnv — whoever does not receive the kingdom of God as a little child, shall not enter into it. The kingdom of God is in its idea, its essence, the rule and the authority of God, and then the sphere in which he bears rule, either the spirit of the individual man, or the assemblage of its subjects, the society constituted by them. When Jesus speaks of its acceptance, it is the rule itself which is meant; that is to be accepted with unquestionable obedience, as the child accepts the parental rule. And on the other hand, when he speaks of entrance into it, he means the society of its subjects, the perfect state and order which results from doing the will of God. ay, instead of éay, after os Tisch. Treg. WH. 8 BCDL A 1. 16. Kal évayxadicdpevos' aird, karevroyer” TuBels Tas xelpas er atta — And having taken them in his arms, he blessed them, put- ting his hands on them. Karevdoyer Tibels Tas xelpas ex’ avrd, instead of rifels TGs xetpas ér” aird, nvddye: adrd, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BCL A Memph. 1 See on 936. The word occurs only in these two passages, and in the Sept. 2 xarevAdyer is a compound found only here in the Bible, and not at all outside. On the Hebraistic meaning of evAoyeiv, to invoke blessings on, see on 641, On the /_ augment of verbs beginning with ev, see Win. 12, 3. / X. 17] THE STUMBLING BLOCK OF WEALTH 189 THE STUMBLING BLOCK OF WEALTH 17-31. Jesus 1s asked the way to obtain life by a rich young man, and points him the way of the commandments. The young man professes to have kept these, and then Jesus shows him the way of self-renunciation. His disappoint- ment leads Jesus to speak of the danger of wealth, and of the reward of renunciation. The young man addresses Jesus as Good Teacher, and asks what he shall do to inherit eternal life. Jesus takes up this address first, and asks why he calls him good, when only God is good. And he points him to the commands of God for the answer to his question. The young man claims to have kept these, and as Jesus looks at him, he loves the evident feeling for righteous- ness that leads a man of manifestly moral life to dissatisfaction with himself, and seeing that it is his wealth that stands in the way, he bids him sell out, give to the poor, and follow him. It is evi- * dent that he has probed the difficulty, for the man has too much to give up and sadly turns away. Jesus then turns to his disciples, and shows them that riches are a stumbling block in the way of life. This excites their astonishment, as wealth and respectability go together. Whereupon, Jesus tells them that it is no easy thing to enter into the kingdom of God anyway, and for a rich man next to impossible ; in fact, impossible with men, and only possible with God. Peter, conscious (perhaps a little too conscious) that this demand of self-renunciation has been complied with by the disciples, asks what their reward will be. Jesus answers, rewards in kind here, with persecution; and in the future eternal life. But, lest they should think of themselves as having any exclusive right, or even necessary preéminence in the kingdom, he warns them that many first shall be last, and last first. 17. Kai éxzropevopevov avtov' eis thv 6d0v — And as he went forth into the road. See v.", where he is said to have gone into the house. ets — The numeral is used sometimes, especially in late writers, in the sense of the indef. rs. The usage is so rare, however, as to warrant its rejection, except in sure cases. Here, it means that 1 On this use of the gen. abs., where the noun or pronoun belongs to the structure of the sentence, see Win. 30, 11, Note. 190 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [X. 17-19 one man came by himself to consult Christ." yovurernoas * — having kneeled to him. {Ewnv aidvov kAnpovoynow— to inherit eternal life® Eternal life was the term in common use among the Jews to denote the blessings of the Messianic kingdom, both here and hereafter. 18. Ti pe A€yes dyabov ; — Why do you call me good? ye is not emphatic, as is shown by the use of the enclitic form. The reason of this question, and of the denial of goodness to any one but God which follows it, is that God alone possesses the absolute good. He is what others become. Human goodness is a growth, even when there is no imperfection. It develops, like wisdom, from childhood to youth, and then to manhood. And it was this human goodness which was possessed by Jesus. See Lk. 2”, Heb. 2” 5°. This has a bearing, too, on the question propounded by the young man, since it was not to the good teacher as such, but to the absolutely good God, that questions in regard to the real good that brings the promised reward should be addressed. And this is the form in which question and answer are put in Mt. 19” as follows: “‘What good thing shall I do to inherit eter- nal life?’? “Why do you ask me concerning the good thing? One is good, God.” 19. Tas évrodas oidas — You know the commandments. ‘This is connected immediately with the preceding statement about God. These commands belong to the law of the one only absolutely good Being, and it is therefore in these commands that the young man is bidden to look for the answer to his question. Moreover, he is familiar with these commands, and why therefore seek any further for his answer. There is, however, an answer to this seem- ingly unanswerable question of Jesus. Though the commands are divine, and as divine would be a ne plus ultra, they were revealed through men, and this human element in them makes it possible for men belonging to a more spiritual time, or themselves more spiritual, to go further in revealing the ways of God to men. That is what Jesus himself did in the Sermon on the Mount, set- ting in contrast the imperfect commands of the ancients and his own perfect injunctions. This is one of the cases therefore, in which Jesus suggests more than appears on the surface, viz., that there is a chance that even so-called divine commands may not be ultimate. The suggestion itself is pertinent to a time of transi- tion from one era of divine revelation to another, and the method of suggestion is not absent from the teaching of Jesus, who fre- quently gave men something to think of, some riddle to solve, instead of always throwing so much light himself as to save them 1 Win. 18, 9. 2 yovumerecy is a later Greek word. _ : ; 3 In classical Greek, this verb is restricted to the meaning, to obtain by inheri- tance, and it governs the gen. x. 19-21 | THE STUMBLING BLOCK OF WEALTH IQI alltrouble. In this very case, Jesus proceeds to add something to what he has cited as the divine commands, showing that these do not contain the last words in the matter. The commands cited by him are those of the second table of the law, except the tenth, and with the command defraud not, added. This addition is not to be referred to a single passage like Deut. 24", but is a remi- niscence of many such passages, besides being a self-evident part of the law of righteousness.” 20. Kai édn, ratra ravra épvdakaynv — And he said, all these I kept. ‘Vhis claim of innocence on the part of the young man was evidently not intended to be absolute, but was simply that this had been the general course of his life, viz., a course of observance of the divine law. The cause of his dissatisfaction with himself was not that his obedience to these commands was not perfect, a per- fection which was not expected by Judaism, as their system of sacrifices showed, but a secret feeling that this was not enough. eprvragaunv — I kepi.” Omit droxpileis, answering, Tisch. (Treg. marg.) WH. RV.» B A Memph. é¢7, instead of efrev, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BC A Memph. 21. éuBrdWas aita, nydrnoev adirov —the look was evidently to confirm the impression made by the words of the young man. Here was a constant observer of the law, who yet was not satisfied with himself. Would his looks bear out the impression created by this? Would sincerity, purity, and thoughtfulness appear in his face and bearing? Yes, for Jesus having looked on him, loved him. “Ev ce toreped— One thing you lack. ce, instead of co, Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. RV. 8 BCM II* 28, The commands of the law which had been cited were mostly negative ; they forbade a man’s doing any harm to his neighbor, and in the matter of his goods, they forbade stealing and defraud- ing. And so far in the path of righteousness the young man had gone. The thing which was lacking in him was the positive side, to contribute to his neighbor’s good, and for this purpose, to sacri- fice his own. This was not enjoined by Jesus as an extraordinary goodness, not required of other men (supererogation, counsels of perfection), nor was it intended to apply a test to him, which should reveal to him an entirely different righteousness (Pauline doctrine of faith); but it was just what it purported to be, the discovery to him of a serious defect in an otherwise lovable char- acter. Jesus saw that he clung to his wealth in a way quite incom- patible with any just estimate of the higher good ; that there was 1 See Mal. 35, Ex. 2110 LXX. 2 This serise of Leeping, by way of observing, is in classical Greek confined to the active, and is attached to the middle only in Biblical Greek. 192 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [X. 21-23 hidden in that love of riches a luxurious self-love and a lack of sympathy with the want of men, that made it endanger the very roots of character. The counsel that he gives him, therefore, is adapted to his individual case. There are evidently two grounds for it: one the need of the man himself, and the other the desire of Jesus to attach this choice spirit to himself, to have him in the inner circle of his disciples attending immediately upon himself. He needed to cut away all his attachments to the world, all his temptations to luxurious, self-indulgent living, for his own good, but specially in order to follow the hard and self-denying life of Jesus. This requirement of personal discipleship was what the first disciples had met themselves of their own motion, but they did not have the temptation of wealth to overcome. See 1°”, 2%, 60s (-rots) mrwxots — Without the art. it means, gzve fo poor people, individualizing it. This meets another side of the young man’s lack, his want of sympathy with the poor. ees O@ycavpdy év ov- pave — This is related, first, to the question, what he should do to inherit eternal life, with which he approached Jesus; and secondly, to Jesus’ requirement; he should sell earthly posses- sions in order to obtain treasure in heaven. kai detpo, dxorAovda por — and come, follow me. ‘This means in this case, evidently, become my personal follower, attached to my person. Here was a lovely but weak character, not inured to self-sacrifice nor heroic living ; and it needed, on the one hand, to be initiated into such living, and on the other, the companionship of the strong and sympathetic Master. Omit rots before mrwxoits, Treg. (WH.) RV. ABNX TA. Omit Gpas. Tov otavpor, having taken up the cross, after dxodovder por, follow me, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BCD A 406, mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. edd. 22. ‘O d€ orvyvacas'— And his countenance fell, RV. The word denotes the outward sign of sorrow, gloom. hv yap éxwv Ktypata mok\Ad— for he had great wealth. The grief was caused by his having to go away without obtaining his object ; the going away was caused by what seemed to him the impossibility of Jesus’ conditions. It might be comparatively easy for a man having only small or moderate possessions to give them up, but it involved too great a sacrifice in his case. 23. Ids dvoxoAws of Ta ypyuata éyovres cis Tr. BacirAelav TOV Meov eiceAcvoovtat ; —With what difficulty will those having wealth enter into the kingdom of God? Jesus generalizes here, and the case in hand goes far to confirm what he says, because there is nothing to complicate the conditions ; we can see the working of wealth by it- self. Here is a lovely character, with no other adverse conditions, and yet just the possession of wealth is enough to undermine it. He 1 grvyvécas is a rare word, even in the Bible, and is found outside only in Polybius, 120 B,C, x. 23-25 | THE STUMBLING BLOCK OF WEALTH 193 had gone along through life, choosing purity instead of lust, honesty instead of fraud, truth instead of falsehood, but in all this he had not been called upon to make the supreme choice, his wealth had not stood in the way. But now, he is confronted with a wisdom that is able to show him what is for him the supreme good, and there wealth gets in its deadly work. ‘The lower good proves to be stronger than the higher, and the latter is set aside. There is the difficulty ; the kingdom of God does not consist in the practice of this or that separate virtue, but in the choice of the highest good, which regulates individual acts ; and wealth has the power, beyond most other things, of making itself appear the greatest good. 24. Of 8 pabyrat eOapBotvro emi Trois Adyors avtod!— And the disciples were astonished at his words. The disciples were amazed at these words, the same as every one is amazed now;; or rather, their amazement then corresponds to the entire disuse into which sayings of this class have fallen now. ‘Then, as now, there was an established religion, in which wealth enabled its possessor to come to the front, and occupy the most prominent positions. So far from disqualifying them, it gave its possessors prestige, and always wealth leads to culture and respectability, while poverty is the parent of vice and crime. The ordinary condition of the world is that of routine morals, and it has no ear for revolutionary words like these. 25. mas dvcKodov éotw eis T. 8B... ciceAOciv— how difficult tt ts fo enter into the kingdom of God. ‘The internal evidence is quite in favor of the shorter reading, because it is short, and because it is one of those cases in which a brief and somewhat puzzling saying is a constant temptation to copyists and commentators to introduce something explanatory and alleviating. The longer reading would be intended to modify the preceding statement by showing that it was not the possession of wealth, but the trust in it, confidence in its power to procure all the necessary satisfac- tions and goods of life, that prevented entrance into the kingdom. The shorter reading generalizes still more the preceding state- ment, making the difficulty of entering the kingdom to be inherent in its nature, and so universal, instead of locating it in the class, rich men. It involves the choice of the highest good, which in various ways, and not merely on the side of wealth, interferes with what men consider the more immediate and practical good. Omit rods reroiOéras érl Tots xphuacu, those who trust in riches, Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. RV. marg. 8 BA one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. ed. evKoTMTEpov eoTL KdyinArov bia Tpvparias paidos dieAOeiv * — Lt zs easier for a camel to go through a needle’s eye. The proverb is an 1 On the use of émi to denote the cause of emotion, see Win. 48 ¢, c). 2 eixomwtepoy and tpvwadias are both Biblical words, 1°) ee . eel a nether asneeeeE 194 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [X. 25-27 exaggerated rhetorical statement of the difficulty. In the parallel accounts in Mt. and Lk., some mss. have the reading xdpwAov, meaning @ cable, which is much more apposite. Using the shorter reading in y.”*, as on the whole more probable, the whole would mean, zt 7s hard for any man to get into the kingdom of God, and for a rich man next toimpossible. He is in the position of having the lower good which other men want, and this is more of an obstacle to the perception and choice of the higher good. Omit rfs before rpuuanlas Treg. WH. RV. 8 ACDFKMNU [TAII. Be- fore padldos Treg. WH. RV. s ACDGKMNU AII Memph. d:ed@ezty, instead of elcedOetv, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. BC(D)K II, 1, 69, 124, mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Syrr. 26. wepicoas eferAnooovto — before, they had been astonished ; now, they were excessively beside themselves with amazement. ‘This making the difficulty of entering the kingdom universal, and increasing it in the case of rich men to almost an impossibility, fairly took away their breath. For one of the promises in regard to that kingdom had been, that prosperity and righteousness were to become common in Israel, and even to be extended to the Gentiles. And Jesus seemed to be making it more and more inaccessible than ever. Aeyovtes pos Eavtovs (airov) — saying to themselves (him). avrdéy, instead of éavrous, Treg. marg. WH. RV. BCD Memph. Tisch. urges against this the usage of Mk., who never says Aéyerv pds, except with éaurovs or d\A7ovs. Kat ris Stvatar cwhjvar;— Who then (And who) can be saved ? kal, with interrogatives, makes an abrupt rejoinder to what has been said.’ 27. Ilapa avOpwras advvatrov — With men it is impossible. Sal- vation is impossible with men; but in salvation, we are dealing not with men, but with God. The incarnation and the Holy Spirit are not within the category of human agencies, but of the Divine, and given these, even the impossibilities of human nature have to give way. aavta yap duvara. aavra is emphatic. A things are possible with God, not because he can travel outside the ordinary agencies, and bring things to pass by a simple fiat, but because he has limitless command of all the forces in any department. In the moral and spiritual sphere, he brings things to pass, not by recourse to other than moral and spiritual agencies, but by the word, the Spirit, and the Christ, all of them agencies charged with spiritual power. Omit 6é, and, after éuBdéPas, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BC* A I, Memph. Omit r@ before Ged Tisch. Treg. WH. s BCNX TA. Omit éore after duvard Tisch. Treg. (Treg. marg.) WH. & BC. 1 Win, 53,34. Thay.-Grm, Lex, I. 2g. X. 28, 29 | THE STUMBLING BLOCK OF WEALTH 195 28. “Hpéaro’ A€yev 6 Ierpos avira, "dou, jucis dbyxapev? mdvta, Kat KoAovOnKkapev” co. — Peter began to say to him, Lo, we left all, and have followed thee. Omit Kai, And, before npiaro, began, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BCX TA. HkodovO7jkapev, instead of -capev, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. BCD. npets — we is emphatic, contrasting their conduct with that of the rich young man. Mt. adds what is implied in the other accounts, rx doa éora tyiv; what shall we have therefore? ‘Thisseems to bea most incongruous and unspiritual question to ask in the religious and moral sphere. What we shall get for our self-denial, is a question which shows that the disciples were entirely unable to understand their leader’s ruling ideas. And yet from their posi- tion, the question was inevitable. Because their Scriptures and ecclesiastical writings, which they regarded as authoritative in these matters, are full of descriptions of the prosperity and bliss of the Messianic kingdom, of the temporal and material rewards of the faithful. And so far they had met with nothing in their associa- tion with the man whom they believed to be the Messianic king, but privation ; instead of adding to their worldly good, this asso- ciation had diminished, if not destroyed it. They had borne everything for him; what return would he, in his greatness, make them? 29. “Edy 6 ‘Inoots, Apu A€yw tytv, ovdeis eotiv ds abfKer oikiar, n adeAhovs, 7 ddeAhds, } unTépa, ) TatTépa, 7 TéKva, 7) dypovs, EveKev €“ov Kal evexey TOV evayyediov— Jesus said, Verily I say to you, there ts no one who has left house, or brothers, or sisters, or mother, or father, or children, or fields, for my sake, and for the sake of the glad-tidings (of the kingdom). “Edn 6 “Inoods, instead of dmroxpiels 5€ 6 *Inoods eirev, and Fesus answer- ing said, Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. RV.8 BA Memph. unrépa } rarépa, instead of the reverse order, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. BC A 106, mss. Lat. Vet. one ms. Vulg. Memph. Omit 7 yuvaixa, or wife, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BD A 1, 66, 209, mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Insert évexev before Tov evayyenlov Tisch. Treg. (WH.) RV. & B2or? CDNS? X TAII mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Syrr. It is misleading, here as most everywhere, to translate eciayye- Aiov, gospel, It means glad-tdings, and the special message intended is that of the kingdom of God. Men who make sacri- fices for the benefit of the Messianic king, and of the news of the kingdom, will receive the blessings of the kingdom. éxarov7da- ciova — a hundredfold; there is a reminiscence in this word of the 1 Began to say, instead of merely said, is best explained here as a mere fashion of speech, into which the writer falls, without any special reason for it. 2 The aor. and perf. are here to be distinguished from each other, the aor., we eft, as denoting simple past action, the perf., we Aave followed, as denoting action continuing into the present, 196 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [xX. 29-34 apocalyptic character of the familiar descriptions of the blessings of the Messianic kingdom. But Jesus uses such language from the religious idiom of this time only to idealize it. To be sure, his words imply that the reward will be in kind; they will give up these things only to receive a hundredfold of the same. But, evidently, hundreds of brothers and sisters and mothers is meant to be taken ideally, and means that he will receive what will replace the lost relatives in that degree. ‘The relationships of the kingdom take the place of natural kindred.’ And the member of the kingdom is an heir not only of heaven, but of earth.’ Jesus had nowhere to lay his head, and yet he was conscious of a lordship and possession of the earth, into which every true fol- lower of his can enter. They have nothing, and yet possess all things? pera diwwypav — with persecutions. ‘These, Jesus had already predicted in his talks with his disciples previous to leaving Galilee. The new element introduced by him here is the other side belonging to this ideal life, the compensations and rewards even in this life, belonging to the Christian. €v t@ aiaw Ta épxo- pévw—in the coming age. There is only one passage, Heb. 1’, where aidy is used by metonymy, of space, instead of time. The reference is to the future life, in which the world, as well as the time, is new, but there is no reason why the meaning of aidy should be changed, any more than that of kaipds, “me, in the corresponding clause. fwiv aiwvov—on the use of this term among the Jews, see on v.”. But it is evident that Jesus, in adopting, spiritualized it. Only, in this case, he found the word made ready to his use which expressed in itself just the state intended by him, though encumbered with alien meanings in common use. It is characteristic of his method, that he used the word without any explanation, leaving it to clarify itself as men got into the drift of his teaching. 31. rodAol 8¢ €covrar zpara éryato.— but many first shall be last. This is a warning to the disciples that the mere fact, that they were the earliest disciples and nearest his person, does not necessarily give them preéminence, nor any exclusive right to the blessings promised by him. The parable of the Laborers in the Vineyard, each of whom received his shilling without regard to the time that he had worked, is inserted by Mt. to enforce this saying. THIRD PREDICTION OF DEATH 32-34. On the journey to Jerusalem, Jesus again foretells his death and resurrection. 1 See 355. 2 See Mt. 55. 3 See 2 Cor. 619, x. 32] THIRD PREDICTION OF DEATH 197 They are now on their way to Jerusalem. And there is evi- dently some feeling of fate overhanging them. It is evident enough that they had not understood Jesus’ predictions of the violent death awaiting him in the city., But on their own con- struction of events, the approach to Jerusalem meant the crisis in their fate, the decision of the Messianic claim/\ They were a mere handful, and the authorities were against them. Would the people be with them? And if they were, what of the Roman power? It is no wonder that they were astonished as Jesus put himself at their head, and that some turned back, while others followed with fear. Then Jesus takes the twelve aside, and repeats, with some additional details, the prophecy of his death and resurrection. ‘The prophecy is given here with clearness and particularity, describing the whole course of events. And then follows the clearly impossible request of James and John for the first places in the Messianic kingdom. It is evident that the subsequent history has been read into what must have been at the time distinctly veiled prophecy. 32. fv mpoaywy — was preceding them. ‘The introduction of this apparently commonplace item shows that attention is drawn to it as something out of the common. And in connection with tmapaAaBwv madty, in the following clause, it evidently means that Jesus was not mingling with his disciples as usual, but was going before them. kai €OapPBotvro—and they were amazed. We are not told by what, but the very simple zpoaywy is evidently put forth by the writer as containing the key of the situation. Some- thing in the manner of that invested the whole proceeding with mystery, and brought to their minds the fateful character of this progress to Jerusalem, the tremendous issues to be decided, and the odds against them. And somehow, with all their confidence in Jesus, the question might arise, whether it was confidence for such a crisis. ot d€ dxoAofovvtes — and those following. Without the art., this would refer to the disciples. But with the art., it picks out some from among them, who followed Jesus, while the rest were left behind, too much perplexed to follow him. The statement is, that _ those who followed him did it with fear. Kai raparAaBov radkw — and having taken to himself again. ‘This is opposed to zpodywv (v.”), which represents him as separating himself from them. But it is only the twelve, not the multitude generally, to whom he joins himself, as the teaching that follows is esoteric. He joins himself to them again, after he sees the effect produced on them by his 198 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [X. 32-34 going on before them, and explains to them what it is that has produced the strangeness of his manner. Oi dé, instead of kal, before dxoNovdodvres Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BC* L A 1, Memph. 33. dvaBaivoper eis ‘IepoodAvpa — we are going up to Jerusalem. This is what makes this journey so fateful. In Jerusalem, they will be confronted with the authorities, both Jewish and Roman. ipxiepedot . . . ypapparedor— the chief priests and the scribes. These two classes represented the Sanhedrim, the Great Council among the Jews, before which were tried all the more important cases coming under their own law, though the Roman government reserved to itself the right of capital punishment. kal rapaddcov- ow abrov t. €veo.— This delivering him over to the Gentiles, 7.e. the Roman government, has not been mentioned in the account of the preceding predictions of his death. It was rendered necessary by the determination to put him to death, a power which the Roman government reserved to itself. They could not execute him, they had to procure his execution. t. €bveot — the nations. The term by which the Jews designated all foreign nations. They were the nation; all others were just the nations. 34. éumaifovow . . . eumticovow . . . paotiydcovow — shey will mock... spitupon . .. scourge. These details correspond exactly to what we are told of the event. The scourging was an invariable accompaniment of crucifixion. The general fact of mocking was to be expected, since his supposed claim to be a king would naturally excite the ridicule of Roman soldiers. Jesus might easily, therefore, have put these into his prophecy in a gen- eral way; but the exact form which the prophecy takes, and which is reproduced for substance by the other accounts, is in all probability a reflection of the event, put in by the original narra- tor. Kk. meTa TpEls ucpas dvacrnoerar — and after three days he will rise. The prediction of the crucifixion would rest on some- thing more than ordinary foresight, since the action of the Roman governor must have remained an incalculable element in any such forecast. And the resurrection, in the form in which it actually took place, and on a set day, was necessarily a revelation. ‘This precise prediction, moreover, makes the total want of preparation for the event on the part of the disciples a curious psychological problem. kal éumrticovow avT@, kal waotiydoovo.y av’rév, instead of the reverse order, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A 237, 259, 406, mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Harcl. Omit adrév after droxrevotc.v Tisch. (Treg.) WH. RV. x BL A 1, 209, two mss. Lat. Vet. sera rpets nuépas, instead of rq Tplry nuépa, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BCDL A most mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. Harcl. marg. X. 35| GOD’S IDEA OF GREATNESS 199 GOD'S IDEA OF GREATNESS 35-45. James and John ask for first and second places in his kingdom. Jesus assures them that they will share his lot, but that the decision of precedence does not rest with him, but with the Father. He shows that the conditions and nature of greatness in the kingdom are exactly the reverse of the earthly conditions. The noticeable thing about this event is not only the generally extraordinary character of the request, coming from the disciples of Jesus and just after his prediction of his death, but its ignoring of the claims of Peter, who was given the precedence, so far as there was any, by Jesus himself and by the disciples. This shows a painful state of things among the disciples, who exhibit not merely a desire for the material rewards of discipleship, such as was exhibited in Peter’s question — what shall we have? but the rivalries and jealousies that spring up as the natural fruit of such desire. Our Lord’s method, on the other hand, is conspicuous, not only for the careful and consistent elimination of any such unspiritual element from his kingdom, but equally for the patience with which he dealt with the unspirituality of his disciples, until he had refined it into something like his own spirituality. In this case, he asks them first, if they know what they are asking, and shows them that to be next to him means to share the conspicuous dangers and sacrifices of his position. Then he shows them again, as in their previous dispute over the same matter, that greatness in the kingdom of God is the reverse of earthly greatness, the great one being he who serves, just as the Messianic king serves and is sacrificed. 35. A€yovres adtd, Ardaoxade, OeAopmev iva Oo éav aityowpev oe TOL- joys Hpiv.i.— Saying to him, Teach sh that you do for us Hons Hpiv. aying to him, Teacher, we wis y whatever we ask you. Insert a’r@ after \éyovres Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL A one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. Pesh. Insert ce after alrjowpev Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABCL A mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. Harcl. 1 This use of iva with the subj., instead of the inf. after verbs of desire and command, is common in Hellenistic Greek, but not in the classical writers. See Win. 44, 8. Burton 304. 200 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ x. 36-39 36. Ti Oédrere rornow tyiv; — What do you wish me to do for you? Literally, what do you wish, shall I do for you ?? moijow, instead of morpfoat we, Treg. WH. CD, 1, 13, 69, 209. Add pe Tisch. WH. marg. x¢ B. Versions also favor the subj. 37. Of 8& elrav aitd, Ads qyivy va? eis cou ex defvdy kal els *® é€ dpirrepav Kabiowpey év tH d0& cov'—and they said to him, give us to sit, one on thy right hand, and one on thy left hand, in thy glory. | dpistepay, instead of edwrviuwr, Tisch. Treg. WH. BL A. Omit gov in this place, Treg. WH. RV. BD A 1, mss. Lat. Vet. éx defi@v . . . €& dpiorep@y—these are the positions of honor next to the throne itself, the right hand having the precedence. This leaves Peter out. éy ty d0& cov—in thy glory. The glory, that is, of the Messianic king. 38. Ovx oldare ti aireiobe — You know not what you ask. They did not know how absolutely this is a question of being first, and not of standing first, which makes it a question, not of appoint- ment, but of achievement. Nor did they know that it meant suf- fering, instead of honor, and that this would increase with the advanced position attained. uciv tO mrotypiov— drink the cup. The figurative use of the phrase to denote a man’s portion in life, his hard or easy lot, belongs to other languages than the Greek. See Is. 51”, Jer. 49”, Ps. 16°, 23°. Christ means to ask them if they are able, if they have the necessary fortitude and proper appreciation of values, to share the sacrifices of his position. Being baptized with his baptism is another figurative expression of the same thought, coming from the power of calamity to over- whelm. Can you, he asks, be tmmersed in that which has over- whelmed me? They have looked at only the glory of the coming kingdom. Jesus directs their attention to the sacrifices incurred in establishing that kingdom. H, or, instead of Kal, and, before 7d Barricua, the baptism, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BC* DLN A 1, 13, 28, 69, 124, 346, Latt. Memph. Harcl. marg. 39. TS rornpiov... riecbe* kal ro Barticpa . . . BartiOynoecbe —The cup ... you will drink; and with the baptism .. . you will be baptized. Of this Jesus can assure them, that they will share his sufferings. Omit pév before rorjpiov Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BC* LA mss. Vulg. Memph. Pesh. 1 Here, we have the subj. without iva, which is still more anomalous, being an elliptical combination of two constructions. See Win. 414,44. Burton 171. The subj. is probably in this case the deliberative subj. 2 See note 1, p. 199. 3 The Greeks use els pév, eis 6&, to express this correlation. Win. 26, 24. 4 86a is confined in Greek writers to its proper subjective meaning, opznzon, praise. The meaning, glory, majesty, as an objective state, comes from the Heb. X. 40-42] GOD’S IDEA OF GREATNESS 201 40. 76 8€ xabioa ex SeEiav pov 7 e& edwvipwr! ork eorw epov Sotvat — But to sit on my right hand, or left hand, ts not mine to give. 7, instead of Kai, before é& edwvduwv Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDL A 73. Lat. Vet. Memph. Omit pov after é& edwv. Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. and almost everything. This statement of Jesus it is very easy to interpret superficially, as if it meant simply that the bestowment belonged not to one person, but to another—not to himself, but to the Father. But there is little doubt that Mk. has preserved for us the true form of statement in omitting mention of the Father, and so the con- trast between persons. ‘They cannot have position in his kingdom by applying to either, as if it were a matter of personal preference. Position, it is not in his power to bestow ; it belongs to those for whom tt has been prepared. ‘The meaning is, that this is a matter already disposed of, and so no longer in his power. The verb expresses nearly the idea of ordained. But it adds to this the thought of the preparation of the place. Each one is to have a place prepared and adapted for him. It is not therefore a ques- tion that can be settled as they were trying to settle it, by influence used with him personally. Fitness, and not influence, decides it. This becomes especially clear, when we consider the definition of greatness that follows. It consists in service, and he who serves most is greatest, a greatness already determined by the service, and not to be changed by any personal equation. 41. of deka ypkavto ayavaxreiy® — the ten began to be indignant. There was reason for this strong feeling on the part of the other disciples. The condition seems to have been, that Peter, James, and John were singled out by Jesus himself for such eminence among the twelve, as the twelve had among the other disciples. If there was any jealousy caused by this, it would be allayed by the fact that the Master selected those manifestly fit, and that it was unaccompanied by any outward advantage. But, now, there was an attempt to secure places in the coming kingdom and its glory, and Peter, the real leader of the twelve, was left out of the scheme. It was the introduction of political methods, such as invariably go with the materializing of ideas, the use of principles to secure power, and of power to advance principles in the world. 42. kal mpockaderduevos aitovs 6 "Incots— And Jesus having called them. This reading, instead of 6 5¢ *Incous mpock. avrovs, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x* ete; BCDL A mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. Pesh. 1 ciwv¥uwr is used in the taking of auguries to denote euphemistically those of evil origin, the word itself meaning just the opposite. And so it comes to denote the left hand, that being the hand of evil omen, the sinister hand. 2 See on v.14, 202 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [X. 42-45 oi doxodvtes dpxetv — those who seem to be chief. Jesus has in mind evidently the difference between their primacy and the ideal. dpxeiv is a word that lends itself to such ideal treatment, as it contains in itself the notion of leadership, which is the only proper basis of rule. Men rule by force, by heredity, by fickle choice, by flattery, but how few are real leaders, ruling because possessing the qualities of leadership. kataxvprevoovow — lord it over them (RV.). They become xvpio, lords or maszers, and the people become their servants, doing their will, and ministering to their pleasure. xarefovoidLovow | — exercise authority over them. 43,44. ody ovrw d¢ éotw ev piv’ add’ os Gv GeAn meyas yevéerOau év div, éorat tudv Sidxovos* Kai os dv Oédy Ev spiv evar pros, gcrat mavtwv SovAos — But it is not so among you; but whoever wishes to become great among you, shall be your servant; and whoever wishes to be first among you, shall be bonad-servant of all. éorev, is, instead of €crat, shall be, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BC* DLA most mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. av, instead of éav, after first 6s Tisch. Treg. WH. x BDL A 33, 69, 299. év byiv, instead of buay, before elvar rpGros Treg. marg. WH. RV. s BC* L A Latt. Memph. eivat rp@ros, instead of yevérOa: wpdt., Treg. WH. RV. 8 BC* L A Latt. Memph. obx ovTw b€¢ éorw — but so it is not. This is not the state of things that obtains, as a matter of fact, among you as members of the kingdom of God. The ideal is the essential principle of that kingdom. peyas yeveoOar— zo become great. ‘There is such a thing as ambition, the desire for greatness, in the kingdom of God, but it is the exact opposite of what goes by that name. dudxovos — servant. ‘The word denotes the performer of services, without indicating his exact relation to the person served. dovAos —bond-servant. There is a climax in the statement. To be great requires service, to be first requires bond-service, and this dovArcia is to rdvrwv, all. Here is the paradox of the kingdom of God. Instead of being lords, its great ones become servants, and its chiefs the bond-servants of all. One has only to watch the progress and present condition of things, to see that this state of things is coming to pass, but that it is yet far from accomplish- ment; and furthermore, that in this respect at least, the field is the world, and not the church. 45. xal yap —/foralso. The Son of Man himself is not exempt from this rule. His kingship is also that of service, and not that of lordship. He is the Head of humanity, and yet he serves men, and not men him. ov daxovyPnvat, dAAG Siaxovyoar— not to be served, but to serve, and to give his life a ransom in exchange for many. The vicarious idea is expressed here, but it is not strictly 1 This is a Biblical word, and is not found in the N.T. outside of this and the parallel passage in Mt., making another strong proof of the interdependence of the written accounts, X. 45, 46] HEALING OF A BLIND MAN NEAR JERICHO 203 that his life takes the place of other lives that would have to be sacrificed otherwise in expiation of their sins. All that is required by the statement, not in the way of minimizing it, but to fill out its meaning, is that his life becomes the price by which men are freed from their bondage. The soldiers in the American civil war gave their lives as a Avrpov for the slaves, and every martyr’s death is a Avrpov. There may be more than this involved in the death of the Redeemer, but more than this is not involved in his words here. In this, he carries his service of men to the utmost, and becomes their Head. HEALING OF A BLIND MAN NEAR JERICHO a6—52. In the course of his journeys in Judea, Jesus comes to Jericho, and Bartimeus, a blind man, asks him to take pity on him. The crowd around Jesus seck to repel him, but Jesus calls him and heals him. The blind man follows him. This is the only visit of Jesus to Jericho. The connection of the narrative makes this a stage in the journey to Jerusalem, begun v.”, and ended in the next chapter. The cry of the blind man, Jesus, Son of David, is the first note of the Messianic acclaim with which Jesus enters the city. And his healing at this crisis brings Jesus as the wonder-worker freshly before the minds of the multitude, and raises still higher their excited Messianic hopes. 46. Kal exropevopevov attod aro lepexs — and as he was coming out from Jericho. Lk. says, as he was approaching Jericho, and in the account of Zacchzeus which follows, that he entered, and passed through Jericho. Mk. says that they come to Jericho, and that this happened as he was coming out from Jericho. It breaks up the continuity of both accounts to try to reconcile them in this trivial detail. Kai 6yAov ixavod— and a considerable crowd. There is, probably, this deviation from the meaning gveaf given to it in the EV.) 6 vids Tiwatov, Bapripatos, tupAds zpocairns,” €xaOnto Tapa tiv 6d0v— the Son of Timeus, Bartimeus, a blind beggar, was sitting by the side of the road. 6 vids tod Typaiov, the Son of Timeus, is a translation of Bartimaeus = "x2 73; but it is evi- 1 This use of ixavés in the sense of great, rather than sufficient, is characteristic of Lk. (Lk. and Acts). The only other instance is 1 Cor. 1199, Mt. 2812 is at least doubtful. 2 rpoaaitys belongs to later Greek. Plutarch, Lucian. 204 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ x. 46-51 dently not introduced here for that reason. Bartimzus is the name, and Sox of Zima@us denotes the relation. There was prob- ably some reason for noting this relation, as that Timzeus was a disciple. Insert 6 before vids Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BCDLS A. Omit 6 before tupdds Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. xs BDL A 124, Memph. mopocairns after tupdds, instead of mpocairay after dd0v, a blind beggar, instead of a blind man... begging, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BL A one ms, Lat. Vet. Memph. 47. Kai axovoas ott ‘Incots 6 Nalapyvds éotiv, npgaro xpalew Kai A€yetv, vie Aaveid, “Incod, éXenoov pe — And having heard that tt ts Jesus the Nazarene, he began to cry, and to say, thou Son of David, Jesus, have mercy on me. Nafapnvdés, instead of Nafwpatos, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. BL A 1, 118, 209, most mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. vie, instead of 6 vids, Tisch. Treg. WH. x BCLM marg. A. Jesus of Nazareth, and Son of David are both unfamiliar titles, the former occurring now for the first time since 1™, and the latter only here. Jesus of Nazareth is intended by the multitude to identify him. Sox of David is a distinctly Messianic title, the use of which here, however, we must not suppose is individual and peculiar. It reflects the sentiment of the multitude, who mean to make this a triumphal progress to Jerusalem, though as yet they are preserving a policy of silence.’ 48. iva o.wrnon— that he keep silent. It does not seem prob- able that they would want to prevent the miracle. Rather, they wanted to enforce silence about this premature Son of David, which they meant to reserve for the entry into Jerusalem. 49. gwvycate aitov — call him. dwrnocare avrov, instead of adrov dwrnbAva., that he be called, s BCL A 7, 209, one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. Harcl. marg. eyetpe — 71S€. éverpe, instead of éyerpar, s ABCDLX TI. 50. aroBaXdwv 76 ivatiov — having thrown off his garment. ‘The outer garment, or robe, is meant. dvarndyoas — having leaped up.” Both these acts are introduced to show the man’s eagerness. avarndjoas, instead of dvacrdas, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDLM marg. A Latt. Memph. Harcl. marg. 51. Kai azoxpieis aitad 6 “Inoois elev, ti cor OAs ToLHTw ; — And Jesus answering said to him, What do you wish me to do for ’ you ? & eirev, instead of Aéye, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL A 115, mss. Lat. Vet. one ms. Vulg. Memph. 1 See 1235, 2 A common Greek word, but not found elsewhere in N.T. 3 See on v.55. 36, XX. 51—-XI1. 11] ENTRY INTO JERUSALEM 205 ‘PaBBovvi,’ iva avaBrAapw* — Rabbont, that I may recover my sight. Rabboni is apparently a more dignified title than Rabbi. 52. Kai eifis aveBrcWe, cat xorovOe aird ev tH 660°— And immediately he recovered his sight, and followed him in the way. avrg, instead of 7@ *Inaod, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABCDLM marg. A Latt. Memph. Harcl. marg. JESUS’ ENTRY INTO JERUSALEM XI. 1-11. Jesus comes to Bethany, where he procures a colt, on which he rides into Jerusalem. The multitude strew their garments and layers of leaves in the road, and shout Hosanna, invoking blessings on the coming kingdom. Jesus goes tmmediately to the temple, and satisfying himself for the present with a look at things, goes out to Bethany for the night. Jesus has told his disciples that he is going to Jerusalem only to meet his fate, and be put to death by the authorities, and yet he enters it amidst the acclaims of the multitude, who hail him as the coming King. ‘This acknowledgment, repelled before, he now accepts. But, the claim once made, he proceeds as before, with his merely spiritual work. The key to these apparent incon- sistences is to be found in the splendid self-consistency of Jesus’ procedure, and in its absolute inconsistency with worldly ideas and policies. Jesus knew that the Messianic claim in Jerusalem meant death, and that death meant the ultimate establishment of the claim, not defeat. Every part of his life, but especially its end, means that he aimed to establish the ideal as the law of human life, and that he would use only absolutely spiritual means in the accomplishment of his end. Meantime, everything points to the fact that Jesus deliberately used the enthusiasm of the multitude for the purposes of his entry into Jerusalem, intending to make it the means of a public proc- lamation of his Messianic claim. ‘That proclamation was neces- 1 Apparently, there is a confusion of two Chaldee words in this title, \39. and 12, both of them meaning about the same, ord or chief. 2 gva- in composition has the sense of the Latin re. 3 The distinction between the momentary action of the aor. and the continued action of the impf. is preserved in these verbs, 206 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [xL. 12 sary, because men must understand definitely the issue that he made. The acceptance of him as King, and not merely as Prophet, was what he demanded. And in the events which fol- lowed, it immediately became apparent that the question thus raised was not only a question of his personal claim, but of the nature of his kingdom. The multitude who followed him thought that, with the announcement of the claim, the programme would change. But the unchanged programme meant that Jesus, just as he was, claimed kingship, and would be king only by spiritual enforcements. 1. Kai dre éyyiZovow eis ‘IepovodAvpa, kal cis ByOaviav — And when they draw near to Jerusalem, and to Bethany. kai eis BynOaviav, instead of eis BnOgayn kai BnOaviay, Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. marg. D Latt. The shorter reading seems probable, the longer read- ing having crept into the text from Lk. kat eis BnOaviayv — We have here a case of abbreviated expres- sion, which obstructs clearness. The exact statement is, that they approached Jerusalem, and had come on the way as far as Bethany on the other side of the Mount of Olives. Bethany is mentioned here for the first time in Mk. In fact, according to this account, Jesus is now approaching Jerusalem for the first time. And hence places enter into the account which have not appeared before. Bethany was a small village on the other side of the Mount of Olives, about fifteen furlongs from Jerusalem. In approaching it, therefore, they would be on the way towards the Mount, zpos ro opos. "2. THv Kopnv THY Katévavtt’ tuav— the village that is over against you. Bethany is the village meant here, as Bethphage is the one designated in Mt. 21’. In both cases, the village named is the only one mentioned. The implication evidently is that the road did not pass through the village, but was off one side. moAov —a@ colt. Mt. specifies a she-ass and its colt, and as the ass was the more common beast used for domestic purposes, there is no doubt that the colt here was an ass’s colt.” éd)’ dv ovdels ovTw avOpwruwv éxabicev — on which no one of men yet sat. Lk. also has these words. But they are extremely improbable in the mouth of Jesus. They evidently belong to the narrator, who very likely took a fact that he had discovered about the colt, and which had an undesigned significance, and made it a part of Jesus’ design, an intentional effect in the pageant. There is no indication that 1 xarévav7e is not found in profane writers. In the N.T., it is found in the Synoptics, and in the epistles of Paul. 2 Mt. 212. XI. 2-4] ENTRY INTO JERUSALEM 207 Jesus cared for the ceremonious trappings of an event. Such care belongs to homage, not to the person receiving it. On this demand of newness for sacred purposes, see Num. 19”, Deut. 21°, 2 Sam. 6°. It is evidently the intention of the writers of the Gos- pels here to imply a supernatural knowledge on the part of Jesus. Insert ovrw before dvOpérwy Treg. WH. RV. ABL A mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. After dv@pwrwy, Tisch. 8 C 13, 69, Egyptt. (Pesh.). éxd@urev, instead of xexd@cxe, Treg. marg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A. Xvcare adréyv kal, in- stead of Avoavres avroy, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. BCD Latt. Egyptt. (Syrr.). épere, instead of aydyere, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL Latt. Egyptt. (Syrr.). 3. “O Kuptos atrod xpeiav éxet, kal evOds atrov drrooréAXer dA dE — the Master has need of tt, and will send (sends) it here again tmmediately. Omit “Orc before 6 Kupws Tisch. Treg. (Treg. marg.) WH. RV.B A 2309, 433, mss. Lat. Vet. dmoorédde, instead of drocrede?, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. and most authorities. Insert wad.v, again, after amooré\Xe Tisch. Treg. (Treg. marg.) WH. RV. 8 BC* DL A. 6 Kvptos — the Master. This title was so frequently applied to Jesus by himself and others, that there is little reason to suppose that there is any special significance in its use here. It indicates in general his relation to his disciples, and not any special phase of that relation. It would not be used here, ¢.g., to indicate that he has assumed his Messianic position, since it is a title common to this with the time before. kai evOds airov drooréAXe rdALy woe —and will send (sends) him here again immediately. With this insertion of again, these words make a part of Jesus’ message to the owner of the animal, instead of his announcement to the dis- ciples of what the owner will do in response to the message. He promises to return the animal immediately. 4. Kai ar7jdOov, kat evpov tadov dedeuevov mpos (THV) Ovpav ext Tov auodov — And they departed, and found a colt tied at a (the) door upon the street outside. Kai ar7)Oopv, instead of dr7qOov 6é, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BL A, one ms. Lat. Vet. Omit 76, the, before 7& ov, colt, Treg. WH. RV. ABDLX TIL Memph. Omit 77», the, before @vpav, door, Treg. WH. BL A Egyptt. mpos (tHv) Oipav ew eri tov dudddov— These details are evi- dently the report of an eyewitness. The first part, af the door outside, is easy of explanation. The better class of houses were built about an open court, from which a passageway under the house led to the street outside. It was at this outside opening to the street, that the colt was tied. But the dudddov is more difficult. Probably, it differs from odov simply in denoting a roundabout road. The AV. where two ways met, confounds the prep. audi 208 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [XI 4-9 and dudéw meaning Joti.’ The village may have been built on such a rounding road, that lay off from the straight highway, and the narrator places this in the story of the event in his dudddov. Such a descriptive touch is quite in Mk.’s manner. 5. Ti zwovetre Avovtes T. TOAOV ; — What are you doing, loosing the colt? This ti wovetre we use very frequently in asking the meaning of an action ; only we leave it by itself. What are you doing ?we say. It asks the question, what the act really is, the outward form of which appears in the participial clause. Ot dé cirav avtois, Ka9ws eirev 6 Incots— And they told them, as Jesus said, eirev, said, instead of évereiNato, commanded, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BCL A 1, 28, 124, 209, one ms. Lat. Vet. Egyptt. 6. kal ddykav aitovs — and they permitted them, put no hinder- ance in their way. ‘The expression is elliptical, the full statement including the thing permitted. 7. Kat depovow tov m@Aov ..., Kal émBaddrAovow atte Ta iparia avtav, Kat éxabioey ex attov— And they bring the colt. ..,and put their garments on him, and he seated himself on him. gépovory, instead of 7’yayor, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x¢ BL A. émiBddnov- ov, instead of éréBadov, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL A 1, 28, 91, 201, 299, mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. avréy, instead of adr@ after ér’, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BCDL A. Ta. iwatia — the outer garments. On this form of royal homage, see 2 K. 9”. 8. dAdo de ori Badas KdWavtes Ex TOV aypov —and others layers of leaves, having cut them out of the fields. oriBadas is the object of the preceding éorpwaar. oTiBddas, instead of croBddas,? Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BDEGHKL MU AII. képavres, instead of €xorrov, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. B(C) LA, Theb. aypdv, instead of dévdpwr, trees, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. B (C)L A Theb. Omit last clause of v., same authorities. ortBas is any layer of leaves, twigs, rushes, and the like, used for bedding, or to make a road easy of travel. This throwing their garments on the horse, and strewing the road with garments and layers of leaves, is all in the way of smoothing the road as a part of the homage rendered. 9. éxpalov, Qoavva — cried Hosanna. Omit Aéyorres, saying, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A 115, mess. Lat. Vet. Egyptt. ‘Qcavva — Hosanna.2 This cry is not an acclamation, but a prayer, meaning, save now, and it means either that Jehovah 1 Vulg. d¢vium. 2 ot: Badas is the proper form. groiBddas is a case of mis-spelling. 3 The full form of the original is x)-ny.wn, the Hiph. of yw, with the suffixed particle X} = new. ai: /9; 10] ENTRY INTO JERUSALEM 209 shall be propitious to some one else, conspicuous in the scene, or in connection with him, to the people uttering the cry. In the Ps. 118”°*° from which this invocation is taken, it is probably a prayer that Jehovah will be propitious to his people. While in Mt. 21°, where it reads, ‘Qcavva r. vio Aave’dS — be propitious now to the Son of David, the prayer is for the one whom the multitude recognize as the coming Messiah. Probably, here it is the prayer of the people that the expected salvation may be accomplished now. «vAoynpevos 6 épxopuevos év ovo. Kup. — Blessed is he that cometh in the name of the Lord. It is a question of feeling, whether éor/ or €otw is to be supplied here ; whether it invokes a blessing on the coming king and his kingdom, or pronounces him blessed. Either is grammatically allowable. On the whole, I incline to the latter view. See RV. Kvpéov is a translation of mit, Yahweh, in Ps. 118”, from which all this acclaim is taken. év évop. Kupiov, in the name of the Lord, means that the kingdom of the Messiah is to be a vicegerency, in which the Messiah rep- resents and takes the place of Jehovah. 10. ciAoynpevn 7 Epxomevn Bactrela Tod TwaTpos yuav Aaveid — Blessed is the coming kingdom of our father David. The coming kingdom represents it as already on the way, and drawing near. It is no longer in a postponed and indefinite future, but in sight. It is represented as the kingdom of David, because the promise of it was made to him as a man after God’s own heart, and the king was to be in his line and to succeed to his spirit. The kingdom was to be a reproduction, after a long collapse, of the splendors of the Davidic kingdom.' Omit év dvéuare Kuplov, ix the name of the Lord, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BCDLU A 1, 13, 69, 115, 124, 209, 238, 346, Latt. Egyptt. Pesh. ‘Qoavva év trois ipicrors — Hosanna in the highest (places). ta tyora is a translation of a Heb. word for heaven.? This addition indicates that Hosanna is not here a mere acclaim, a sort of Hurrah! It is a prayer for God to save them in the highest places, where he dwells. This entry into Jerusalem, with its accompaniments of shout- ing multitudes and spontaneous homage, can have only one mean- ing in our Lord’s life. It is his public announcement of himself as the Messiah, or rather his public acceptance of the title that his disciples had been so long anxious to thrust upon him. And yet, after it, his life lapses again into its quiet ways, and he 1 Messianic prophecy proper starts with the promise of the perpetuity of the kingdom in the Davidic line. 2 Sam. 7816 Zech. 1219 13. One of the Rabbinical titles of the Messiah was David. 2 The Heb. word is O92, D219. Job 1619, Is, 5715, LXX. P 210 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ XI. 10-14 becomes once more the teacher and benefactor. And so, the distinct claim to be a king is followed immediately by the revolu- tionizing of the whole idea of kingship. But then, this is only in accordance with what he has already said to his disciples who wished to occupy the places in the kingdom next to the king. “He who desires to be first, let him be least and servant of all.” His teaching and life needed the distinct announcement of his Messianic claim in order that men might understand that this is what is meant by the claim to be ing of men. 11. Kai ciondAOev cis ‘TepoodAvpa, eis TO iepov — And he entered into Jerusalem, into the temple. Omit 6 *Inoods, kai before ets 76 iepdv Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCLA Lat. Vet. Memph. Jesus makes his way immediately, not only into the Holy City, but into the Holy Place, where his claim to lordship over the place can be put to the test. Kat repiBredpevos tava, dpe 45n THs wpas — And having looked round upon all things, the hour being already late. oye, instead of éyias, Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. 8 CL A. This look took in those things which were to receive the next morning so sharp attention from him, but as the hour was already so late, he went out to Bethany. This differs distinctly from Mt., who places the cleansing of the temple immediately after the entrance into the city, and mentions the cursing of the fig tree as on the morning after the cleansing. This is the first time that Bethany appears in the Synoptical narrative, but the appearance is of such a kind as to imply a previous history, or rather a previous appearance of the place in the life of our Lord. John gives us the clue to Jesus’ freedom of the place in the story of the raising of Lazarus, but at the same time, he places the intimacy further back by calling Lazarus the one whom Jesus loved. THE BARREN FIG TREE 12-14. Jesus leaves Bethany the next morning, and on his way to Jerusalem, he sees a fig tree, whose leaves give promise of fruit. But when he comes to it, he finds only leaves. He dooms the tree to perpetual fruitlessness. XI. 12-14] THE BARREN FIG TREE 211 12. Kai ry éravpiov’ . . . émetvace?— And on the morrow... he became hungry. Jesus’ leaving Bethany in the morning and coming to Jerusalem indicates his habit during this last week. His place of action during the day was Jerusalem, his place of rest at night was Bethany. 13. kal idwv ovKqv amd paxpdbev® — and having seen a fig tree at a distance. Insert did before waxpddev Tisch. Treg. WH. RV., and most authorities. éxovoav pvAAa — having leaves. This presence of leaves con- stituted the false appearance of the tree, as on the fig tree these are the sign of fruit. ei dpa tu etpyoe — (to see) whether then he will find anything on it’ dpa is illative, and means here, “ since he saw leaves, whether the fruit that accompanies leaves was there.” 6 yap Kaipos ovK Rv oiKkwv —for the season was not that of figs. ‘This gives the reason why there were no figs, in spite of the presence of leaves. It was about April, whereas the season of figs was not until June for the very early kind, or August for the ordinary crop. e x , > , : > N > ? . 6 yap Katpds ovK nv ciKwy, instead of od yap nv Kaipds cUKwy, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BC* LA Memph. Pesh. 14. Kai droxpieis elrev aity — And answering, he said to it. Omit 6 ‘Incods before eiev Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BCDL A 1, 33, 91, 124, 238, 346 mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Myxéru cis Tov aidva €x god pndels Kaprov dayo. — The position of the words and the double negative make this curse weighty. | The reason of it is to be found in the false pretence of leaves without fruit on a tree in which leaves are a sign of fruit. The apparent unreason is in cursing a fig tree for anything. The prin- ciple that you must not only judge a person by his acts, but some- times judge his acts by the person, applies here. The act appears wanton and petulant, but what we know of Jesus warrants us in setting aside this appearance. Jesus was on the eve of spiritual conflict with a nation whose prime and patent fault was hypocrisy or false pretence, and here he finds a tree guilty of the same 1 77 émavpiov— this use of émavprov as a single word is Biblical. Properly, it is ex’ avptov, Which means on the morrow by itself. The art. is out of place therefore, much as if we should say, on the to-morrow, If anywhere, it belongs between éx and aipiov. See Lk. 1085 Acts 45, 2 The aor. denotes the entrance upon the state denoted by the vb. Burton, 41. 3 waxpdber is itself late, and the prep. redundant, as the adv. itself means from a distance. Win. 65, 2. 4 On the mood of indirect questions, see Burton, 341 (4), 343. 5 See Win. 53, 8 a. 212 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ XI. 14-16 thing. It gives him his opportunity, without hurting anybody, to sit in judgment on the fault. He does not complete the parable by pointing out the application, but leaves this, as he does his spoken parables, to suggest its own meaning, and so to force men to think. Such acted parables were not without precedent among the Jews. See Hos. 17° John 4°" Mt. 13%”. And in Jesus’ own teaching, the recourse to enigmatical methods that should force men to think, was not uncommon. CLEANSING OF THE TEMPLE 15-18. On arriving in Jerusalem, Jesus goes to the temple again, and finds the customary traffic in animals for the Passover sacrifices, and in small change for the purposes of this traffic, going on. Jesus drives out the traffickers, and overturns their tables and chatrs. 15. Kat eiceAOiv cis TO iepov npgato éxBadAEv TOs TwAOVYTAS Kal tous dyopdlovras — and having entered into the temple, he began to cast out those selling and those buying.’ Omit 6 "Ingots after eioeX@av Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL A 1, 33, QI, 124, 238, 346 mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Insert rods before dyopd- govras Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABCKLMNU II. This buying and selling went on in the Court of the Temple, and the merchandise consisted of the animals, incense, oil, and other things required for sacrifice, the demand for which was very great at the time of the annual feasts. trav xoAAvBicrov — this is a word found in the N.T. only in these accounts of the cleansing of the Temple. The word, like its companion keppariorns, denotes one who changed money for the convenience of the buyers and sellers, of course for a consideration—a dealer in small coin. It is supposed by some that these money-changers exchanged for the foreign coin brought by the pilgrims the shekel in which alone the Temple tax could be paid. But the words used both denote dealers in small coins, which is more consonant with the above explanation. The doves were the offering of the poor, who were not able to offer sheep and oxen.’ 16. Kai oix jduev® iva ris duevéeyxn oxedos Sia Tod iepod — and would not allow any one to carry a vessel through the temple. 1 There is no sufficient reason for emphasizing the beginning of the act in this case. It belongs to the Heb. idiom of the writer. 2 Lev. 57 126-8 1514. 29 Num. 610, 3 See on 134, for form jdcev. 4 On this use of tva with subj., see Win. 44, 8. Burton, 210. XI. 16, 17] CLEANSING OF THE TEMPLE 213 axevos — vessel. Used generally for utensils or gear of any kind, even the sails of vessels. The outer Court, and especially the Court of the Gentiles, where this traffic went on, was looked on as a kind of common ground which men might use ag a short cut, Carrying across it various oxevn. 17. kai édidacke, Kai eXeyev aitois —and he taught and said to them. kal €\ever, instead of Aéywy, saying, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV.» BCL A 6, 13, 69, 346, one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. Pesh. oikos mpocevyns! mace Tois €Ovecw—a house of prayer for all nations. The quotation is from Is. 56’, a passage which predicts the admission of strangers who worship God, as well as Jews, to the privileges of the Temple. The rebuke is specific therefore, denouncing not only the misuse of the Temple, but of that part which made it the seat of a universal worship. It was the Court of the Gentiles which they had thought just good enough for these debased uses. o7yAaov Anorav —a cave of robbers, not Lhieves. These words are quoted from Jer. 7". The context in Jer. shows that the name is given there not because of the desecrating uses to which the Temple was put, but because of the character of those who used it. Their use of the Temple was legitimate, but they themselves defiled it by their character and conduct outside. Here, on the contrary, it is their illegitimate use of the Temple which is condemned. The use of this term voddéers by our Lord adds an unexpected element to the denunciation of their practice. Evidently trade as such desecrates the Temple, making its pre- cincts and sacrifices the place and occasion of personal gain. It is the incongruous and unhallowed mixture of God and mammon that Jesus elsewhere condemns. But when he calls it voddery, it is evident he means more than the condemnation of trade in itself in the Temple precincts. And yet, we have no reason to suppose that there was anything extraordinary in this traffic. Jesus would need only to see the opposition of all actual trade in principle to the Golden Rule, to condemn it in this strong language, when it invaded the courts of the Temple. It is the principle of trade to pursue personal advantage alone, and leave the other man to pur- sue his interests, in other words, competition, which makes trade robbery. : memounkare, instead of éro:noare, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. BL A. This was an exercise of Messianic authority on the part of Jesus ; but it did not transcend his rule of purely spiritual king- ship, since the power that he used was simply that of his personal 1 rpocevxis — It is significant of the changes in the language, that this word is not found in the classics, and that the good Greek word cix7 is found in the N.T, but once. 214 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [XI. 18, 19 ascendency. It was an impressive example of the authority of truth and goodness. Men are easily overawed by the indigna- tions of righteousness. We should expect such an access of authority in the action and speech of Jesus after the announce- ment of his Messianic claim, but the element of force, which is the idea of government, is left out. 18. of dpxvepets K. of ypaypareis — the chief priests and the scribes. ‘These were the constituted authorities, who had licensed this desecration of the Temple. They sold these rights to the traders, and they resented this invasion of their constituted rights. Together, they constituted the main body of the Sanhedrim.’ The overthrow of evil everywhere, which was the evident mission of this daring innovator, menaced them. oi apxiepets Kal of ypauparets, instead of the reverse order, 8 ABCDKL AII Latt. Memph. Pesh. és drodécwow, how they may destroy, instead of r&s dmodécovery, how they shall destroy, Tisch. Treg. WH. and most sources. éhoBodvro yap aitov* mas yap 6 dxAos éLerAjooero” eri tH didayy abvtov*® —for they were afraid of him, for all the mulutude was amazed at his teaching. mwas yap, instead of bre was, because all, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BC A I, 13, 28, 69, 346, Memph. The power that Jesus had to carry the multitude with him, so that they stood amazed at the strength and authority of his teach- ing, made the rulers fear him. ry didaxy — his teaching. Doctrine is a poor translation, first because it omits everything belonging to the manner, and secondly, because it has acquired a technical meaning that does not belong to ddax7. THE FIG TREE WITHERED 19-26. The morning of the third day, as they are passing by, they see the fig tree which Jesus had cursed, withered. Jesus commends faith to them, as able to remove not only trees, but mountains. Mk. introduces here the irrelevant matter of forgiveness as the condition of answer to prayer. 19. K. drav dye eyevero— And whenever it came to be evening. This may be taken in two ways, either of which involves an irregu- larity. (1) It may be, And whenever evening came (R.V.), every 1 See on 831, 2 See Win. 33 4, for this use of émi. 3 See on 122, XI. 19-22 | THE FIG TREE WITHERED 215 evening; involving the irregularity of the aor. for the impf. Or (2) it may be, And when tt came to be evening, referring to a single evening, involving the irregularity of 6rav for ére. The latter use is found in Byzantine writers. See Win. 42°. But in judging an irregular style like this, the anomalous use of the aor. seems more easily accountable than that of the more striking érav. Moreover, the translation whenever is more accordant with the impf. in the principal clause. 8ray, instead of bre, when, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BCKL AII* 28, 33. éferopevovro, they would go, instead of éferopevero, he would go, Treg. WH. RV. marg. ABKM®* AII 124, two mss, Lat. Vet. Pesh. Harcl. marg. 21. yv xarnpdow — which you cursed. 22. Kai dzoxpiOels 6 “Incots r€yet adrots, “Exere muotty Ocod” — and answering, Jesus says to them, Have faith in God. Insert 6 before ’Iycots Tisch. Treg. WH. and most authorities. Jesus answers here to the wonder expressed in Peter’s statement, pointing out the source of the wonderful thing, and showing how they too may attain the same power. 1 dpe tovrw— this moun- tain. Primarily, this would be the Mount of Olives, which was in their sight all the way. Jesus’ statement is climacteric. The faith in God by which he has dried up this tree can remove mountains too, and, for that matter, can accomplish all things. But in the language of Jesus, who repudiated all mere thaumaturgic use of miraculous power, moving a@ mountain is not to be taken literally, but stands for any incredible thing, as stupendous as such mov- ing, but not so out of line with the miracles to which Jesus con- fined himself. It is enough to say that neither Jesus nor his disciples ever removed mountains, except metaphorically. kai px SuaxpiOy év tH Kapdia atrod,® ddAa muoredn* dre o Aadel yiverat, eorar aito®—and does not doubt in his heart, but believes that what he speaks comes to pass, tt will come to him. Omit yap, for, at the beginning of this v. Tisch. (Treg). WH. RV. 8 BDN 1, 28, 51, 106, 124, 157, 225, 251, Latt. Pesh. miorevy, instead of mistevon, Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. RV. BL A. 4, instead of a, before Nade?, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BLN A 33, two mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Pesh. aret, speaks, instead of Aéyer, says, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BLN A two mss. Lat. Vet. Omit 6 éav ely, whatever he says, after crac aiT@, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. BCDL A 1, 28, 209, 346, three mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. 1 In earlier Greek, carapdéouar takes the dat. Win. 32,1 4,8. Wéin., however, fails to note the irregularity. 2 @cod is obj. gen. Win. 30, I. 3 ScaxpiOy év TH Kapdia — Doubt is a Biblical sense of dcaxpivouar, but comes natur- ally from the proper meaning, ¢o de divided. This is a good example of the use of xapdia to denote the seat of the intellect rather than the affections, On the evil of doubt, see Jas. 16, 4 The aor. dcaxp6q and pres. morevn are to be discriminated something in this way — does not entertain a doubt, but holds fast to his faith. 5 See Thay.-Grm, Zex, ciui 1V.e. 216 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [XXI. 24, 25 24. dia tovro—on this account, referring to what he has just said of the efficacy of faith. He generalizes from the extreme case of the mountain. avra doa mpocetxerbe k. aitetobe, micreverTeE éte ela Bere — all things whatever ye pray and ask for, believe that you received them. ‘The aor. is a rhetorical exaggeration of the immediateness of the answer: it antedates even the prayer in the mind of the petitioner. mpocevxerbe Kal, instead of av mpocevxduevor, pray and ask, instead of praying ask, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL A mss. Lat. Vet. Pesh. €Ad- Bere, instead of AauBdavere, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A Memph. It is noticeable that here, and in the case of the demoniac fol- lowing the Transfiguration, Jesus seeks to turn the thought of the disciples to faith, as a matter of dependence on God, and to the absoluteness of the power thus invoked by them. If we add to this the desire to impress on them the reality of prayer as a means of securing for themselves the exercise of that power, we shall have the substance of Jesus’ teaching on the subject. The power that we invoke is not an impersonal cause, that grinds out its results with the absoluteness of a machine, but a Person whose limitless power is available for him who fulfils the conditions im- plied in faith. 25. Kai drav ornxere rpocevxopevol, apiere — And whenever you stand praying, forgive. ornxere, instead of orjnxnte, Tisch. Treg. WH. ACDHLM2 VX 1, 124, etc. The subj. is an apparent emendation. Omit v. 26 Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BLS A 2, 27, 63, 64, 121, 157, 258, two mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. edd. This injunction to forgive can be joined logically with the injunction about faith in prayer, since the Divine forgiveness of sins, of which it is the condition, is itself the condition of the Divine favor, without which answer to prayer becomes impossible. But it is, notwithstanding, inapposite and diverting here, where the subject is not prayer, but faith in God, prayer being adduced as an instance of the places in which faith is needed. It is found in its proper place in the discourse on prayer, Mt. 6% sq. More- over, it is still further limited here, being placed in connection with the special prayer for forgiveness, and not with prayer in general, which removes it still further from the general subject. This limitation of the Divine forgiveness is not as if God limited himself by the imperfections of our human conduct. But forgive- ness is a reciprocal act. In its very nature, it cannot act freely, but is conditioned on the state of mind of the offender. And the 1 On the use of d5rav with the ind. see Win. 42, 5; Burton, 309¢. On the atti- tude in prayer, see Mt. 65 Lk, 1811, XI. 25-28] JESUS’ AUTHORITY QUESTIONED 217 unforgiving spirit is specially alien to that state of mind. It shows the offender to be lacking in the proper feeling about sin and forgiveness, which can alone warrant his asking forgiveness. This is an important text in the discussion of justification by faith. JESUS’ AUTHORITY QUESTIONED BY THE REPRE- SENTATIVES OF THE SANHEDRIM 27-33. On Jesus’ return to the city, he comes again to the temple, where the representatives of the Sanhedrim question him as to his authority to cleanse the temple. Jesus an- swers them with a counter-question, whether John’s baptism was human or divine in its origin, which will test their authority to dectde such questions. This puts them in a dilemma, as they had discredited John, making tt necessary for them either to sacrifice conststency or to put themselves out of favor with the people, who believed in John. They are unable to answer, and so Jesus refuses to recognize thetr authority to sit in judgment on him, and remains silent. 27. mpeoBirepo. — elders. The word denotes the other mem- bers of the Sanhedrim, outside of the chief priests and scribes. It is the general word for a member of that council. The whole expression means the chief priests and scribes and other members of the Sanhedrim. Kat éXeyov ait@ — and said to him. édeyor, instead of Aéyougw, say, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A 1, 2009, mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. 28. “Ev ota éfovcia.— By what kind of authority” It is more specific than simply what authority. They knew that Jesus claimed a certain kind of authority, but it seemed to them just the vague and uncertain thing that personal, as distinguished from official authority, always seems to the members of a hierarchy. Tavta moveis ;— do you do these things? things, such as the cleans- ing of the temple, which took place only the day before. 7 ris cot. ovciav tavtnv éduxev, iva tatta roms ;*—or who gave you this authority, to do these things ? 7, instead of kal, and, before ris, Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. RV. 8 BL A 124, Memph. Harcl. marg. 1 Schiirer NV. Zg. II. 1. § 23, III. 2 On the instrumental use of év, see Win. 48, 3 d. 8 On the use of iva with subj., for the inf., see Win. 44.8. Burton 216 (a), 218 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [XI. 28-32 The second question, who gave thee this authority? is different in form, but substantially the same. The idea of a divine au- thority, communicated directly to the man by inward suggestion, and showing its warrant simply in his personal quality, was outside the narrow range of men who recognized only external authority. 29. ‘O d€ ‘Incots eirev airois, Exepwryjocw tuas eva Adyov — And Jesus said to them, I will ask you one question (word, literally). Omit droxpiGels, answering, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BCL A 33, two mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. Pesh. Omit kaya, / also, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. BCL A, one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. 30. Td Bdrricpa “Iwavvov, é& oipavod jv, 7 && avOpwrwv ;— Was the baptism of John from heaven, or from men? ‘This question of Jesus was not meeting their question with another harder one, as if he were matching his wits against theirs. But the question is on the same line as theirs, and is intended to show whether they have the same standards as he for testing the question of Divine authority. It is as if he had asked, How do you judge of such things? If Divine authority is communicated externally and through regular channels in your judgment, 1 have no such cre- dentials. But tf it comes inwardly and ts attested by its fruits in your opinion, then you are in a condition to judge fairly of my authority. The case of John is a test of this fitness to judge the matter of Divine authority. His authority came out of the clouds, so to speak, having only an inward, not an external warrant; and his influence was owing to his restoration of the spiritual note in a fossilized, external religion. Worshippers of the external and regular see in this the mark of subjectivity, and self-constituted authority, and reject it, and the hierarchy seek to destroy it, whether in John, or Jesus, or Paul. Recognition of it on the part of the scribes and chief priests would have shown their fitness to judge the claim of Jesus. 31. Kai duerAoyiLovro mpds éavrovs, Aéeyovres — And they deliber- ated among themselves, saying. duedovyifovro, instead of édAoylfovro, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8° BCDGK LM AII. Awari otv ovk éemuorevoate aito ;— Why then did you not believe him? On this rejection of John by the rulers, see Mt. 3’ sq. 11% 35 A he 32. dAAG elrwpev, EE avOpurwv ; époBotvto tov Aadv. — but shall we say, From men? they feared the people. Omit éav, zf, before etrwpuev, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 ABCL A 33. 1 The structure here is very rugged, and without the excuse, or the capacity for hiding defects that belongs to a long sentence. Having started with a question, the only way to state the conclusion is to include it in the question, ¢.g. Shall we say, from men, and so bring upon us the dislike of the people? Instead of which the writer proceeds with a statement in his own words. Win. 63, II. 2. 60, 9. XI. 32—X1T. 12] PARABLE OF THE VINEYARD 219 Lk. says, the people will stone us.' Herod seems to have had the same wholesome fear of John’s popularity.” davres yap elxov évtws Tov Iwdvyyv, ott tpopyryns hv —for all verily held John to be a prophet2 A prophet is in Greek an interpreter of oracles, in the Biblical language a speaker of Divine oracles, an inspired man. This dilemma of the authorities was owing to the fact that the case cited by Jesus was one in which their verdict did not agree with the popular verdict. The authority of John was approved by the people, and disallowed by them, and the popular feeling was too strong about it for them to defy. dvrws Or, instead of bre dvTws, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8* BCL 13, 69, 346. A dvrws ws mpopyTny. 33. Kat 6 Incots Aéye adtots, Ovde * eyw A€yw tpiv év rota eLovoia tadta mow — And Jesus says to them, Netther do I tell you by what authority I do these things. Omit dzoxpiels, answering, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCLN TA 33, mss. Lat. Vet. Egyptt. We must remember just what is involved in this refusal. These were the constituted authorities in both civil and religious matters, and Jesus’ refusal to submit his claim to them is a denial of their authority. He refuses because they have confessed their inability to judge a precisely similar case, which involved an abdication of their authority. It is well to carry this in mind in considering Jesus’ silence at his trial. PARABLE OF THE VINEYARD 12. 1-12. Jesus, having dented the authority of the rulers, proceeds to show them ina parable the unfatthfulness to their trust which has lost for them thetr authority. The story is that of a vineyard let out on shares to cultivators, who maltreat the servants sent by the owner to collect his share, and finally kill his son, and whom the owner de- stroys, and turns over the vineyard to others. He also cites the proverb of the stone rejected by the builders which becomes the corner stone. The rulers see that the parable is aimed at them, but fear of the multitude holds them in check for the present. 1 Lk. 206, 2 Mt. 14°. 3 On the attraction of ‘Iwdvvyy from the subordinate to the principal clause, see Win. 66, 5 2 4 On the use of ovS¢ without a preceding negative, see Win. 55, 6, 2. 220 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ XII. 1,2 1. Kai ypéaro avrots év mwapaBoArals Aadetv — And he began to say to them in parables. Nadety, instead of Aéyerv, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BGL A 1, 13, 69, 118, 124, 346, mss. Lat. Vet. Egyptt. Pesh. Harcl. marg. avtois evidently refers to the representatives of the Sanhedrim, the parable being a continuation of Jesus’ conversation with them.’ Mt. says that the chief priests and the Pharisees knew that the parable was directed at them ; but he also represents Jesus as say- ing that the kingdom is to be taken from them, and given toa nation producing its fruits.?, But this confusion of rulers and peo- ple must not obscure the plain fact that in Mt. the parable is against the rulers. Lk. says that the parable was spoken to the people, but that the rulers knew that it was spoken against them, two things that are not at all inconsistent.? év zapaBoAats — in parables. This use of the plural indicates that Mk. had other parables in mind, though he gives only one. Mt. gives three, all bearing on the same general subject. Mk. states the general fact of teaching in parables, and selects one from the rest. This is one of the facts which seem to indicate that Mk. had the same collec- tion of the teachings of Jesus as Mt. and Lk. to draw upon, vez. the Logia. “ApreAdva avOpwros épitevcey — A man planted a vine- yard. This figure of the vineyard is taken from Is. 5**. Even the details are reproduced. In the LXX we find ¢paypov zrepe- Onxa . . . wKkoddunoa Tupyov . - . mpoAynviov wpvéa. dpaynov—is any kind of fence, or wall, that separates lands from each other. wtoAjvov— is the receptacle for the juice of the grapes, placed under the Anvés, or winepress, in which the grapes were trodden.* avpyov—is the tower from which the watchman overlooked the vineyard. It was also used as a lodge for the keeper of the vineyard. -yewpyots — means “lers or cultt- vators. e&édero° —amredyunoe — went abroad. Far country, AV. is an exaggeration. é£édero, instead of -doro, Tisch. WH. 8 AB* CKL. 2. to Kaipo —at the season, at the proper time. As this vine- yard was equipped with a winepress, this would not be at the grape harvest, but any time following the winemaking. Ady azo T. Kap7@v — The vineyard was let out on shares, the owner receiv- ing a certain part of the product. T&v Kapt@y, instead of rod xaprod, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCLN A 33) 433, three mss. Lat. Vet. Pesh. 1 See 1133 1212, 2 Mt. 2148. 45, 3 Lk. 209. 19, 4 AV. wine-fat. Fat is an old English word for vat. RV., pit for the winepress. 5 This vb. is common in Grk., but occurs in N.T. only in this parable in the Synoptics. The irregular form, ¢£¢Se7o for -So70, is also repeated. XII. 3-6] PARABLE OF THE VINEYARD 221 3. Kai AaBovres abrov éSetpav'— And they took (him), and beat him. kal, instead of oi dé, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BDL A 33, mss. Lat. Vet- Memph. 4. Kaxeivov éxepadiwcav” Kai ATiwacav—and that one they beat about the head, and insulted. Omit AGoBodjoavres, having stoned, before éxepadtwoay, Tisch. Treg WH. RV. BDL A 1, 28, 33, 91, 118, 299, Latt. Egyptt. éxedariwoay instead of -aiwoay, Tisch. WH. RV. 8 BL. 7rimacay, instead of dmréoreu: Aav nT uWwwuevor, Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. 8 BL 33, Latt. Egyptt. 47lun- cav Treg. RV. D. 5. Kai ddAdov arecrevAe — And he sent another. Omit radu, again, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL A 33, mss. Lat. Vet. Egyptt. ovs before wey instead of rods, Tisch. Treg. WH. 8 BDL A 1, 33, and before 6é€ same except D. / Kal moAAovs aAXous, ovs pev S€povres, ovs S€ droxrévvovtes — and many others (they maltreated), beating some, and killing some. The verb to be supplied here has to be taken from the general statement of the treatment of the messengers by the cultivators of the vineyard, as the participles must agree with of yewpyoé understood, and denote the several kinds of maltreatment. There is no doubt that Jesus has in mind here the treatment of the prophets by the rulers and people, of which there is frequent mention by the O.T. writers. The parable is thus not an analogy, but an allegory. 6. "Eze eva cixev, viov ayamntov’ améoreAe aitov éxyatov mpos avrovs — Still (after losing all these), he had one (other to send), a beloved son: he sent him last to them. évtpamnoovrat Tov viov pov — they will respect my Son. The Son in the allegory represents Jesus himself. The nation, which had rejected God’s servants, the prophets, will finally put to death the Son himself, the Messianic King. eixev vidv, instead of vidvy éxywy, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BC? L A 33, Harcl. (Pesh.). Omit adrod his after ayarnréy, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL A mss. Lat. Vet. Egyptt. Vulg. Pesh. Omit xai after dméoreiXe Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BLX? A 13, one ms. Lat. Vet. Pesh. 1 €Seupavy means they flayed him, literally. This modified meaning, they deat him, does not belong to the best usage, though it is found sometimes from Aristophanes down. 2 éxehadiwoav is evidently a corrupt form of écepadaiwoav, and that word is treated as if it came from xedady, Instead of xedddacov. Properly, it means fo bring under heads, to summarize, but here, apparently, to wound in the head. It occurs only here in the N.T. Thay.-Grm. Lex. 3 2 Chr. 3615.16 Neh. 9% Jer. 255-7. 4 On the use of the acc., instead of the regular dat., see Win. 32, 14, a. 222 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ XII. 8-11 8. Kal e€€Barov atirov éw Tod duzeXGvos |'— and threw him out of the vineyard. ‘They put this indignity on his body, as this fol- lowed the killing. Insert avrov after é£éBadov, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABCDMN III mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. Syrr. 9. Ti roijoe: 6 KUpios TOD dumeA@vos ;— What will the master of the vineyard do? Omit od», then, after rl, Tisch. WH. BL one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. €XevoeTat Kal amrodece — he will come and destroy. According to Mt. 21%, Jesus drew this answer from the chief priests and scribes themselves. 10. Ovde? tiv ypadyy mavrnv avéeyvwre ; — And did you not read this Scripture ?* In the original, this stone, rejected by the builders, but become the head of the corner, is Israel itself, rejected by the nations, / defeated and exiled, but destined by God for the chief place among them all. The Psalm was sung probably after the return from the exile, when everything indicates that the hopes of the nation were raised to the highest pitch ; when it seemed as if God was taking the first step towards the aggrandizement of the chosen people. eyevnOn eis* Kehadrnv ywvias°— became the head of the corner, denoting the corner stone, which binds together the two sides of the building, and so becomes architecturally the most important stone in the structure. The story that there was a stone in the building of the Temple which had such a history, is unnecessary to account for so natural a metaphor, and evidently arose from the metaphorical use here. ll. wapa xvupiov éyevero atty— this (corner stone) came from the Lord. avry evidently refers to xedadyy ywvias. In the orig- inal, the feminine is used, but obviously according to Hebrew usage, for the neuter, referring to the event itself as ordered by Jehovah. But the use of the fem. to translate this Heb. fem. is quite without precedent in the N.T., and is unnecessary here, as we have a grammatical reference to the fem. xepadyv. The meaning is “ Zhis corner stone came from the Lord, and is won-' derful in our eyes.” This use of the passage from the Ps. by Jesus is a very good illustration of the Messianic application of O.T. writings. There 1 On this use of the adv. as a prep., see Win. 54, 6. 2 On the meaning of ovde gee a preceding negative, see Win. 55, 6, 2. 8 The passage is Ps, 11872. 4 A translation of the Heb. pe mn, Win. 29, 3 2. 5 A translation of the Heb. map “OND. XII. 12] PARABLE OF THE VINEYARD 223 can be no doubt from the context that the historical reference is to the people of Israel. But what is said of Israel was a common and proverbial happening, that might come true of any one whose being contained within itself the promise of better things than belonged to his start in life, and is especially true of the truly reli- gious person or nation. Cf. the parable of the mustard seed, and Is. 53. Asa principle, therefore, it would apply especially to the Messiah. ‘The question, whether Jesus used the passage accord- ing to a common view of his time as directly Messianic, or only as a statement of this principle, depends on our view of him. It seems to be a rational inference, from what we know of Jesus, that he had derived his idea of the Messianic office partly from the O.T., and that that idea is possible only with a rational treatment of the O.T., while the current view of his time would be derived from a literalistic and irrational treatment of it. And in general, we know that he so far transcended his age as to take a spiritual view of the O.T., and there is no reason to suppose that this would not include the rational treatment of a passage like this. That is, Jesus would see in it not a direct reference to himself, but only the statement of a principle applicable to himself. 12. éyvwoav yap ott mpos adrovs THv TapafPorAny eime—for they knew that he spoke the parable against them. ‘This is the reason for their seeking to take him, not for their fear of the people. But as the latter statement is the last made, Meyer makes the sub- ject of éyvwoav to be the 6yAos just mentioned, in which case this would be a reason for their fear of the people. But there is a total absence of anything to indicate such a change of subject in éyvwoav, and this is a greater difficulty than the one which Meyer seeks to remove. Meyer’s view also deprives the statement of its appositeness.' The statement that they knew that Jesus spoke this parable against them is conclusive in regard to the meaning of it, and falls in with the parable itself, and with its context, placed as it is in the midst of a controversy between himself and the authorities. It is directed against the Jewish hierarchy, pointing out their sin in rejecting one after another of the prophets, culminating in their murder of the Messiah himself, and predicting their fate in con- sequence. But Mt., while he makes the same statement, v.”, —— 1 See Win. 61, 7 2. 224 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ XII. 13 about the reference of the parable, makes Jesus say, v.”, that the kingdom shall be taken from them, and given to a mation produc- ing its fruits. This would seem to make the parable apply to the nation, and not to the hierarchy. Everything else, however, in Mt., as in Mk. and Lk., points to the hierarchy. It seems prob- able that Mt. therefore, in v.*, adds to the parable, post eventum, that the nation was to share the fate of its rulers, and be super- seded in their theocratic position by another (Gentile) nation. It plainly does not belong here, as the effect would be to bring rulers and people together against Jesus, whereas the statement is repeatedly made that, so far, it is Jesus and the people against the rulers. THE QUESTION OF PAYING TRIBUTE TO ROME 13-17. Jesus 1s approached by Pharisees and Herodtans wzth the question whether it ts authorized under the the- ocracy to pay tribute to the Roman emperor, hoping to draw Jrom him an answer, compromising him either with the Roman government or with the people. Jesus answers by pointing to the image and inscription of the emperor on the coin as a proof of their obligation to him, and bids them pay to Cesar what belongs to him, and to God what belongs to him. 13. Papicaiwy x. 7. ‘Hpwdiavwv — These emissaries were chosen, because they occupied different sides of the question proposed to him. ‘The Pharisees owed their popularity partly to their intense nationality and their hatred of foreign rule. The Herodians, on the other hand, were adherents of the Herods, who owed what power they possessed to the Roman government. Neither party, however, took an extreme position. The Pharisees are not to be confounded with the Zealots; they submitted to the inevitable. Nor is it to be supposed that the Herods had any particular love for the government that had helped them to power, to be sure, but had taken advantage of their weakness to make themselves supreme, and the Herods only their tributaries. Still, as to the question of the paying of tribute, with all the corollaries, they would be divided, and Jesus must offend one, or the other, by his answer. dypevowor Oyo — they may catch him with a word. The word is to be not his own, but their question, artfully contrived to XII. 13-15 | THE QUESTION OF TRIBUTE 225 entangle him. The figure is that of the hunter with his net or snare.’ 14. Kai éAOovres Néyovow aire — and coming, they say to him. kat instead of of dé, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL A 33, mss. Lat. Vet. Egyptt. This address of his artful enemies is well described in the aypevowor. The question which they have to propose is one bristling with dangers, du¢ “hen, they tell him, ¢haz zs just what you do not care for. You have a sole regard for the truth, not for consequences nor persons. Adaoxarke — Teacher. They said Radédz. GAnOns — true, t.e. truthful. Kai ob pérer oor epi ovdevos — and carest not for any one. This shows the particular kind of regard for the truth which they had in mind. It was one which did not stand in fear of man, would not be hindered by awe of kings, not even of the Roman emperor. ov yap BAémets cis tpdowrov — for thou dost not look at the person of men, dost not pay attention to those things which belong to outward condition, such as rank or wealth. This is a widening of the meaning of zpdcwzov, belong- ing to the Heb. riyv 680v r. @eod — the way of God, the course pre- scribed for men by God? é&eore xnvoov® Kaicapi* dodvar 7 ov ; — Is it right to give tribute to Cesar or not? ‘This question took on a special form among the Jews, who claimed to be the members of a theocracy, so that paying tribute to a foreigner would seem like disloyalty to the Divine government. ‘The question of policy, or necessity, is kept in the background, and the problem is con- fined to the rightfulness of paying such tribute. 7 oJ —7 py.” 15. ‘O d€ cidws (idwv) atrav thy imoxpiaw — But he, knowing (seeing) their dissimulanon. idwv, instead of ews, Tisch. 8* D 13, 28, 69, 346, mss. Lat. Vet. troxpioww — this word has been transliterated into our word hyprocrisy at a great loss of picturesqueness and force. It means acting, from which the transition to the meaning assimulation is easy. What Jesus knew about these men was, that they were playing a part in their compliments, and their request for advice. They were acting the part of inquirers ; really, they were plotters. They were trying to compromise him either with the government or the people. In his trial before Pilate we see what use they in- 1 Thay.-Grm. Lex. 2 This use of odds is familiar in the Heb. but uncommon, though not unknown, in oe Greek. 3 xjvoov is the Latin word census, meaning a registration of persons and prop- erty on which taxation is based. In the N.T., it denotes the tax itself. 4 Kaioap: — there is a mixture here of the ’ personal and the titular use of this name. Asa title of the Roman emperors, it takes the article properly. 5 od is used in the first question, because it is one of objective fact. yin the second, because it is a question of proposed action, subjective. Win. 55, Ia. Q 226 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [XII. 15-17 tended to make of one of the two answers to which they thought he was reduced. Lk. 23°. ri pe wetpalere; — why do you try me ? Our word semi, in the sense of solicit to evil, is out of place here. What they were doing was to put him to the test maliciously. Snvapiov — @ shilling? The point of Jesus’ reply is, that the very coin in which the tribute is paid bears on its face the proof not only of their sub- jection to the foreign government, but of their obligation to it. Coinage is a privilege claimed by government, but it is one of the things in which the government most clearly represents the interest of the governed. ‘Tribute becomes in this way, not an extortion, or exaction, but a return for service rendered. 17. ‘O dé “Inoots cizev atrois, Ta Kaicapos arddore Kaioapt — And Jesus said to them, The things belonging to Cesar pay to Cesar. ‘O 6é, instead of Kal amoxpifeis 6, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A 33, Theb. dddore — pay. They had said, dodva, give. Jesus makes it a matter of payment. ra Kaicapos — the things of Cesar. Strictly speaking, this means, Pay fo the Roman government Roman coin. They themselves were tacitly recognizing the government, and availing themselves of their privileges under it by using its coin, and that left them no pretext for denying its rights. The coin represents simply the right of the government. The image and superscription on it show the government maintaining to the people the position not only of power, but of rights. It is in this, as in all things, the defender of rights. This gives to the government itself rights, of which tribute is representative. But our Lord’s reply is entirely characteristic. It suggests, rather than amplifies or explains. x. Ta 7. @cod tro Oc — and the things be- longing to God to God. The way in which they had presented the question implied that there was a conflict between the claims of the earthly and heavenly governments. But Jesus shows them as each having claims. Cesar has claims, and also God; pay both. The difficulty with the Jews, and with all bodies claiming to represent God, is that they are zealous for him in a partisan way, jealous of his prerogatives, dignities, and the like, and make that do service for a real loyalty to him. These men were eager to assert God’s claim against a foreign king. Jesus was anxious that they should recognize his real claims, those that involved no real conflict, but belonged.in the wider sphere of common duties. Kk. €€eOavpalov — and they wondered. Well they might. Jesus 1 See RV. American readings. Classes of Passages. 2 Penny, EV. is specially misleading, since the denarius had not only the nomi- nal value of our shilling, but a far greater relative value, as it was a day’s wages. The denarius was a Roman coin, equivalent to ten asses, a ten as piece. XII. 17, 18] SKEPTICISM OF THE SADDUCEES 227 had not only parried their attack, which was a small matter, but had thrown light on a very difficult question. The conflict of duties is one of the perplexities of life, and the question of the relation of the Christian to civil government is often one of the most trying forms of the general problem. Jesus’ answer is prac- tically, Do not try to make one duty exclude another, but fulfil one so as to consist with all the rest. As far as the special matter is concerned, it recognizes the right of civil government, the obliga- tion of those who live under a theocracy to be subject to civil authority, an obligation not abrogated, but enforced by their duty to God ; that the Divine obedience does not exclude, but include other obediences ; and finally, that human government, as included thus within the Divine scheme of things, is among the economies to be conformed to its perfect idea. é&eBavpuafoy, instead of éGavuacay, Tisch. WH. RV. s B. JESUS ANSWERS THE PUZZLE OF THE SADDUCEES ABOUT THE RESURRECTION 18-27. The next attack on Jesus comes from another source. The Sadducees, the priestly class, being disbelievers in the resurrection, bring to him what 1s apparently thetr standing objection, of a woman having seven husbands here, and ask him whose wife she will be in the resurrection. ‘Jesus’ answer 1s in two parts: first, that there 1s no mar- riage in the resurrection state; and secondly, that when God calls himself the God of Abraham, Isaac, and Jacob, thetr continued life 1s implied. Anything else is inconsistent with that relation. 18. Saddovcato. —The word denotes the sect as Zadokites. There is little doubt that the word itself comes from this proper name Zadok, and not from p™z, meaning righteous. Probably, the particular Zadok meant is the priest who distinguished himself by his fidelity in the time of David. 2 Sam. 15” sq., 1 K. 1” sq. After the return from the exile, among the different families con- stituting the priesthood, the sons of Zadok seem to have occupied the chief place. They were the aristocracy of the priesthood, and Ezekiel assigns them exclusive rights to its functions. Ez. 40% 43% 44% 48%. The Sadducees, that is to say, were the party of the priests, and especially of the priestly aristocracy. As a school of opinion, they were characterized by the denial of the 228 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [XIi. 18-23 authority of tradition, maintaining the sole authority of the written Scriptures. As corollaries of this, they denied the resurrection, and the existence of angels or spirits.’ kal érnpatwv avtrov, Xé- yovres — and they questioned him, saying. érnpwrwy, instead of érnpwéryncayr, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL A 33, Latt. Pesh. Memph. 19. kai py aby téxvov, va AGBy 6 adeAHos abrov THY yuvaika — and leave no child, that his brother take the woman. téxvoy, instead of téxva, Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. RV. x BL A 1, 18, 241, 299, mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. Omit adrot after thy yuvatka, Tisch. Treg. WH. & BCL A 1, 61, 209, one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. This quotation is from Deut. 25°°. It is introduced in order to show that the law itself provides for these successive marriages, thus expressly legalizing these successive relations, which the res- urrection would make simultaneous. Their question is, therefore, whether the same Scriptures teach this, and the resurrection, which is inconsistent with it. The quotation does not attempt to repro- duce the language. 21. py Katadirwv oréppa” — not having left seed. bh KaTadurey, instead of kai ovdé adris apjKe, and neither did he leave, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A 33, one ms. Lat. Vet. Egyptt. 22. kai of éxta ovK adyKav oréepua — and the seven left no seed. Omit €\aBov airiv... kal before ovk dpjKxav, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL A 28, 33, Memph. This childlessness is specified as the chief element in the inde- terminateness of the question, since if either of them had had children, that might have decided the question to whom the woman belonged. €oxatov mavtwy® Kat 4 yuvy arébavev — last of all the woman died also. éoxaroy, instead of éoxdrn, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BCGHKL AIT 1, 13, 28, 33, 69, mss. Lat. Vet. Egyptt. Pesh. 23. évy Tn dvactdacel Tivos a’Tay éotat yuvy ;— Ln the resurrection, whose wife shall she be of them? ‘his was probably the standing puzzle of the Sadducees, in which they sought to discredit the resurrection by reducing it to an absurdity. Omit ody, therefore, before avacrdce, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BC* EF HLSUVX III two mss. Lat. Vet. Omit érav avacrdow.w, whenever they arise. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL A 28, 33, two mss. Lat. Vet. Egyptt. Pesh. 1 See Schiirer, II. 2, 26, IT. 2 #y is used here, instead of ov, because the denial is in some way subjective. BN gives it something the tone of ‘so the story goes,’ 3 écxarov is here an adv. and denotes the last of a series of events, and its con- junction with rgvrwy denoting persons is therefore incongruous. Hence the sub- stitution of ésxarn by some copyist. Cf. 1 Cor, 158. XII. 24-27 | SKEPTICISM OF THE SADDUCEES 229 24. "Edy airois 6 ‘Ingots, Od &a TottTo rAavacbe, pi eiddres Tas ypapas, nde tTHv Svvapy Tod Weot ; Jesus said to them, Is it not on this account that you err, because you know not the Scriptures, nor the power of God? a Tovro points forward to the pr «iddres," the part. being used causally. What follows in vy.” *, develops these two defects in their consideration of the matter. Their ignorance of the power of God is taken up first, in v.”. "Edn avrots 6 “Incods, instead of Kat dzoxpibels 6 *Inoods etrev adrots, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A 33, Memph. Pesh. 25. This verse contains Jesus’ statement of the power of God in the resurrection. He has power not only to raise, but so to change the body, that marriage ceases to be one of its functions. It was because they were ignorant of this, that the Sadducees thought their case of seven husbands would be an argument against the resurrection. drav .. . avaoraow — whenever they arise. srtav leaves the time of the resurrection indefinite. yayiZovras — denotes the act of the father in bestowing his daughter in marriage.” as dyyeAo. — the angels come as a race, not from procreation, but directly from creation. ‘The power of God appears in this, in the transforma- tion and clarifying of the resurrection body, so that marriage is not a part of the future state. yapulfovra:, instead of yauloxovra, Tisch. Treg. WH. s BCDGLU At, 124, 209. Omit of after &yyedo, Tisch. (Treg.) WH. RV. 8 CDFKLMU AII Memph. Harcl. 26. This verse shows their ignorance of the Scriptures, which speaks of God as the God of their ancestors, language which is inconsistent with their mortality. év TH BiBAw*® Moicéus, eri rod Barov* — in the book of Moses, at the place concerning the bush. Tov, instead of r7s, before Barov, Tisch. Treg. WH. s ABCLX [IAII. as, instead of ws, before eizrev, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCLU A 108, 131. Omit 6, the, before Oeds "Ioadx, and Oeds "IaxwB, Treg. WH. RV. BD, two passages in Origen. 27. Ovx gory Weds vexpov addrdrAa CLovrov — Without the art., @eos becomes the pred., not the subj., and vexpdyv is also anarthrous, so that it reads, He ts nota God of dead men, but of living. 1 »y is the negative used, because the statement is made by Jesus as a conject- ure, of which he asks their opinion. 2 See 1 Cor. 738. yayuigovra is a Biblical word. 3 BiBAos is originally the name of the papyrus plant, from which paper was made, and then a book or scroll. The quotation is from Ex. 36. 4 The use of émi is analogous to that with the gen. of persons or things to locate an event by its connection with some person or thing; at the passage which tells _ about the bush. Win. 47, g, a. 230 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [| XII. 27-34 As this is commonly explained, it is made to hinge on the use of the present, instead of the past. The statement is, he zs their God, not he was, and hence, they are still living. But this is a non sequitur, since it is a Common expression in regard to both dead and living, and would be taken in the same sense, or used in the same sense, by either Pharisees or Sadducees. But it follows from the nature of God that, when he calls himself the God of any people, certain things are implied in the statement about these people, ¢.g. that they are righteous, not sinners ; blessed, not wretched ; and here living, not dead. ‘That is, immortality may be inferred from the nature of God himself in the case of those whom he calls his. But Jesus applies it to the resurrection of the dead generally, and not simply of the righteous dead. What the Sadducees denied was the possibility of the resurrection on mate- rialistic grounds ; at the basis of their denial of the resurrection was the other denial of spiritual being. But Jesus proves the possibility of the resurrection by examples. Notice that Jesus does not reveal the fact of the resurrection, but argues it from acknowledged premises. Given, he says, the fact of God, and the resurrection follows. He recognizes the rational ground of im- mortality. And what is of more importance, he recognizes the validity of our intuition about God. We can say that certain things may be assumed about him on first principles. Omit 6 before Oeds, Treg. WH. RV. BDKLM marvg. ATI. Omit Geds before (évTwy, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8s ABCDFKM marg. UX AII Latt. Egyptt. Pesh. mov tAavacbe — you make a great mistake. ‘This concise state- ment at the close makes an abrupt, but for that reason, forcible ending of the conversation. Omit vpets ody, you therefore, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. A SCRIBE QUESTIONS JESUS CONCERNING THE FIRST COMMANDMENT 28-34. A Scribe, apparently without the usual prejudices of his class, and impressed by his answer to the Sadducees, 1 See Acts 238. 2 Compare Paul's proof of the resurrection by the case of Jesus. 1 Cor. 1512 sqq. XII. 28] THE FIRST COMMANDMENT 231 approaches Jesus with an honest question as to the first of the commandments of the Law. Jesus answers with the guotation from Deut. used at the beginning of morning and evening prayer, affirming the unity of God, and the conse- guent duty of loving him with an undivided heart. He adds a second command from Lev., bidding the people of God to love their neighbors as themselves. The Scribe assents to this, and adds that obedience to this law of love 7s a greater thing than all sacrifices. Whereupon, Jesus assures him that he 1s not far from the kingdom of God. But his enemies are evidently satisfied — they do not dare to question him further. Judging from the fact, that he was led to put this question by seeing how well Jesus had answered the Sadducees, and from his commendation of our Lord’s reply to himself, as also from our ‘Lord’s commendation of his answer, it seems probable that the Scribe did not ask this question in a captious spirit. He thought, Flere is possibly an opportunity to get an answer to our standing ‘question, about the first commandment. Mt. states the matter differently, making him one of a group of Pharisees, who gathered about Jesus with the usual purpose of testing him. He also omits the mutual commendation of Jesus and the Scribe.! Lk. puts this scene at the beginning of Jesus’ ministry in Southern Palestine. He coincides with Mt. in regard to the purpose of the question, saying that the lawyer dvéorn éxrepdlwv. 28. idwv (cidws) Gre Kad@s daexpiOn avrois, éernpwtycey airor, Tlofa €ori évtohky mpwtn mavtwv® — seeing (knowing) that he answered them well, asked him, What (sort of) commandment as first of all? idwv, instead of eidas, Tisch. Treg. s* CDL 1, 13, 28, 69, mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. é€vToAn rpdrn ravTwy, instead of rpdtn racdv Tdv évrodGy, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCLU A 33, 108, 127, 131, Memph. Syrr. moia asks about the quality of command, as if the scribe had in mind the different classes of laws. This is indicated also by his reply, v.®. 1 Mt, 2234-40, 2 Lk. 1025-37, 3 On the gender of rdvrwy, see Win. 27,6, On this use of ravrwy with superla- tive, the only case in N.T., see Win. 36, note, a2 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ XII. 29-31 29. *AzexpiOn 6 "Inaods, "Ore rpurn éeoriv — Jesus answered, The first ts. "AmexplOn 6 *Incods, instead of ‘O 5¢ “Incods dexplOn, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BL A 33, Memph. Pesh. Omit air, Tisch. (Treg.) WH. RV. on same authority. éorlv, instead of mac@v r&v évrodGy, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BL A Memph. “Axove, IopandA, Kvpios 6 Weds Hudv, Kipios els €or’ — Hear, O Israel, The Lord our God, the Lord ts one.’ These words, calling the attention of Israel to the oneness of Jehovah, were used at the beginning of morning and evening prayer in the temple, as a call to worship. Kuptos, Zord, is the translation of the Heb. Yahweh, and it is probable therefore that the second Kupuos is subject in- stead of predicate.? This unity has for its conclusion, that worship is not to be divided among several deities, but concentrated on one. 30. ayaryoes — thou shalt love. Love is the duty of man toward God, and this is in itself a revelation of the nature of God. It is only one who loves who demands love, and only one in whom love is supreme demands love as the supreme duty. He requires of men what is consonant with his own being. é€ 6Ans THs Kapdias — Jrom all the heart. ‘The preposition denotes the source of the love. It is to be from all the heart on the same principle of the unity of God. Being one, he requires an undivided love. ‘This is added to the Sept. statement, which includes only the diavoias, Wuxi, and icxvos. The Heb. includes the xapdéas, but omits diavoias. kapoa is the general word for the inner man; Wvyv7 is the soul, the life-principle, duavoéa is the mind, and icyvs is the spiritual strength. There is no attempt at classification, or exactness of statement, but simply to express in a strong way the whole being. Omit avrn mpérn évrodh, chis is the first commandment, Tisch. (Treg. marg.) WH. RV. 8 BEL A Egyptt. 31. Acurépa avty — The second ts this. Omit Kai, And, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BL A mss, Lat. Vet. Memph. Omit opola, Zike, Tisch. (Treg. marg.) WH. RV. 8 BL A Egyptt. The Scribe did not ask for the second commandment, but the statement is incomplete without it. Our Lord wished to show that this first commandment did not stand at the head of a long list of heterogeneous commands, among which it was simply f77- mus inter pares, but that it was one of two homogeneous com- mands, which exhausted the idea of righteousness. This second commandment does not stand in the O.T. in the commanding position of the first, but is brought in only incidentally in Ley. 1 Deut. 64-5, This is quoted just as it stands in the Sept. 2 See Deut. 64, RV. marg. Q25%r°x" 5. =o eee ee ——————— LL eee i XII. 31-33] THE FIRST COMMANDMENT 233 19'*, where, moreover, xezghdor is evidently restricted to a brother Jew. Jesus puts itin a commanding position, and widens the mean- ing of neighbor to felowman. ws ceavrdv—the degree of the love to God is expressed by “ from all thy heart”; the degree of human love is “as thyself.”” The love of God includes in itself all other affections, but this love of the neighbor has over against it a love of self, with which Jesus allows it to divide the man. This self-love is already there, monopolizing the man, and the com- mand is to subordinate it to the love of God, and to co6rdinate it with the love of man. 32. Kad@s, SidaoKxare* ex aAnOeias elres, Gre cis éori—Well, teacher ! you said truly that he ts one. AV. Well, Master; thou didst speak the truth; for, etc. Thisis not wrong, but what follows ott is so nearly what Jesus said, that it seems more natural to make it a repetition of that, than a reason for the scribe’s approval of it. RV. Of a truth, Master, thou hast well said, that, etc. The distribution of the words and of emphasis is against this. It would read éx’ dAnOeias Kadds etzes. Omit Oeds, God, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABKLMSUX TI AII one ms. Lat. Vet. many mss. Vulg. Pesh. ovK é€oTiv adAos TAHV aitod — there is no other but he. This addition to Jesus’ words is taken by the Scribe from Deut. 4”°®. His enumeration of the parts of man entering into the love of God differs again from that of Jesus. The following table shows them all together. Heb. kxapdia, Wux7, ioxvs. Sept. diavola, pux7, icxus. Jesus. xkapdia, pux7, diavola, ioxds. Scribe. kapdia, cvveots, icxus. But of course, this is a matter of no importance, the two latter representing only the ovato variata of the writer. 33. Omit kai é& 8dns ris Puxijs, and from all the soul, Tisch. (Treg. marg.) WH. RV. & BL A 1, 118, 209, 299, one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. mepioodbrepor, instead of mXetov, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BL A 33. Omit t@v before @vo.mv, Treg. WH. ABDX III. TepiaaoTepov — a more eminent thing. The positive expresses the idea of eminence, of surpassing other things, and the com- parative denotes a higher degree of this quality. 6Aoxavrwyd- tov '— whole burnt offerings” These words of the Scribe are an addition to what Jesus says about the superiority of these two commands. Jesus had compared them simply with other laws. The Scribe compares them specially with the laws of sacrifice, after the manner of the prophets. 1 The classical Greek has the verb déAcxavréw, to burn whole, but this word is con- fined to the Bible and to Philo, 2 See Ps. 408 5116 so%l5 Is, 111 Hos. 58, 234 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ XII. 34, 35 34. vovvexyas — intelligently.’ ov paxpav € amd THs Bactdelas 7. @cov — You are not far from the kingdom of God. ‘The evident enthusiasm with which the Scribe received the statement of Jesus, and his ability to enter into the spirit of it so as to develop it in his own way, showed that he himself could not be far from the kingdom, with whose law he has shown himself to be in sympathy. To be friendly to its ideas, and sympathetic with its spirit, was the “next thing to actual submission to it. ovdels ovkéri érdApa avTov érepwrnoat — no one dared to question him further. The question of the Scribe was friendly, but the whole series of questions to which it belonged was far from friendly; it was captious and hostile, having for its object to destroy the authority of Jesus by showing that he was no more than any other teacher when he came to face the real puzzles of the learned men. But Jesus had shown in his answers no mere mastery of the usual weapons of debate, but a grasp of the principles involved in each case, so that the purpose of his enemies was foiled, and his authority stood stronger than ever. It was no use to ask him questions therefore, which only recoiled on the questioners. JESUS’ QUESTION, HOW THE MESSIAH CAN BE BOTH SON AND LORD OF DAVID 35-37. Jesus now raises a question himself. Their ques- ‘tons have been really a challenge of his Messtantc claim. (Tis question ts a criticism of their Messianic tdea. They call the Messiah Son of David, and Jesus asks how the exalted language of the Psalm in which David calls him Lord can be applied to one who ts only David’s son. 35. dmoxpiHeis — Answering their questions now by propounding one in his turn. mas A€yovow ot ypapparels ; — How do the Scribes say... 2? According to the statement of Mt., he asked the Scribes, What do you think about the Messiah? whose son ts he? And when they answered David’s, then he raises his difficulty. This simply emphasizes what is stated also in our account, that this title is treated by him as Rabbinical rather than Scriptural. This is not a conundrum, a Scriptural puzzle, but a criticism of the Messianic teaching of the Rabbis. By emphasizing his descent from David as the essential thing about him, they were in danger of passing over the really important matter, which made him not 1 This word does not occur elsewhere in the N.T. XII. 35] SON OF DAVID 235 so much David’s son, but his Lord. He felt that the title, Son of David, into which the Scribes compressed their conception of the Messianic position, misrepresented by its narrowness the pro- phetic statement of the Messianic kingdom, and involved in itself all the errors of current Jewish Messianism. And he was con- scious himself of a greatness that could not be ascribed to his descent from David, but was the result only of his unique relation to God. Hence his question, which does not intend to match their riddles with another, but is intended to expose the insuffi- ciency of the Messianic idea taught by the Rabbis. For this pur- pose he selects a passage from Ps. 110, which was currently ascribed to David and was classed as Messianic. In this Psalm, so interpreted, David is made to address the Messianic king as his Lord. And the argument is made to hinge on this address — How can David call him Lord, when he is David's son? Right here, then, we have the gravest difficulty to be encountered any- where in regard to the N.T. acceptance of the traditional view of the O.T. For criticism rejects the Davidic authorship of this Psalm. It does not allege plain anachronisms, as in many Psalms, e.g. the mention of the temple, or of the destruction of Jerusalem, in Psalms ascribed to David. But there are other signs which point plainly to the great improbability of Davidic authorship. In the first place, it belongs to a group of Psalms, Books IV. and V., of the Psalter, which is evidently of late date ; and the reasons would have to be special and obvious which would lead us to detach it from the rest. Whereas, it bears all the marks common to the class. Moreover, if it was written by David, then we have to suppose that there was some person occupying his own position of theocratic king, but so much more exalted than he that he calls him Lord. And this could only be the Messiah, the final flower of the Davidic line, whom David sees in vision. But the Psalm in that case would stand entirely by itself as being simply a vision of an indefinite future, having no roots in the circumstances of the times, whereas all O.T. prophecy is of an immediate future growing directly out of the present. This leads immediately to the conclusion that the Psalm is addressed by the Psalmist to some reigning king, who is also somehow a priest, and that the writer cannot himself be a king. And, finally, the Messianic conception in the time of David had reached no further than this, that his 236 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ XII. 36 royal line was not to fail, even if his sons and successors proved sometimes unworthy. But the idea of a Messianic king, who was to be the ideal and climax of the Davidic line, and whom David himself could call Lord, was the fruit only of a long period of national disaster, creating the feeling that only such a unique person could restore the national hopes. ‘The idea of a personal Messiah belongs to the period succeeding the close of the canon. This is the essential reason for rejecting the Davidic authorship. How, then, if David did not write the Psalm, can we account for our Lord’s ascription of it to him? ‘The explanation that will account for all the other cases of this kind, viz., that the authorship is of no account, leaving him free to accept the current view as a mere matter of nomenclature and identification, without committing him to an endorsement of it, will not do here, since the argument turns on the authorship. But the real explanation of all the cases is, that inspiration, which accounts for whatever extraordinary knowledge belonged to Jesus in his earthly life, does not extend to such matters of critical research as authorship. Inspiration belongs to the sphere of the moral and religious intuitions, and did not keep even Jesus from ignorance of matters outside of its sphere. And here, in its proper sphere, it gave him a view of the deeper meaning of Scripture, that led to his declaration that So of David would come very far from adequately stating their view of the Messianic king. That would include the universalism of the prophets, and the suffering servant of Jehovah of Isaiah. Moreover, it would include a unique relation to God, and to universal manhood, that would place him in a different class from David, and an exalted position, which would be indicated by the titles chosen by himself, Son of Man and Son of God, rather than Son of David. 36. adros Aaveld efrev év 76 Tvevpare ro ‘Ayid, Eirev (6) Kiptos* 7S kupio wou— David himself said in the Holy Spirit, the Lord said to my lord. Omit yap, for, after avrés, Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. RV. BLT?¢ A 13. 28, 59, 69, two mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. Omit 6 before Kupios, Treg. WH. BD. B omits it in Sept. év 7G Ivevpart to ‘Ayiw—in the Holy Spirit. This phrase denotes inspiration. David said this with the authority that 1 On xvpios without the art. See Win. 19, ra. XII. 36-38 | WARNING AGAINST THE SCRIBES 237 belongs to an inspired man.’ (6) Kvptos — in the original, this is Yahweh (Jehovah), of which 6 Kvpsos is the translation in the Sept.” trorddiov ray rodav cov — a footstool of thy feet. vroxatw, under, instead of vrorddiov, WH. RV. marg. BD8 T4 28, Egyptt. 37. Airds Aaveid A€eyer aitov Kiiptov— David himself calls him Lord. This makes the difficulty of their position — how lordship and sonship go together. Omit od», therefore, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDLT¢ A 28, 106, 251, mss. Lat. Vet. Egyptt. 6 todvs dyAos — the great multitude present at the feast, the multitude being distinguished from the leaders. This statement is parallel to those which represent Jesus, all through this contro- versy, as carrying the people with him. WARNING AGAINST THE SCRIBES 38-40. Somewhere in the course of his teaching on this last day of public instruction, Jesus introduces a warning against the Scribes, the religious teachers and leaders of his time. He charges them with ostentation, an unhealthy craving for position and flattery, and a fearful inconsistency between the profuseness of their worship and the cruel meanness of their lives. Their condemnation, he says, will be greater than if they had been consistently wicked. 38. év rH didaxy airov —in the course of his teaching. Mk. does not place this warning exactly. Nor Lk. Mt. says then. All of them introduce it in this place. But the warning is not against those qualities of the Scribes that would be suggested by their misconception of the Messianic idea. Brérere avo — Beware of? év orodals repixateiv — to walk about in long robes. These orodai were the dress of dignitaries, such as kings and priests — long robes reaching to the feet. domwacpovs — salutations of respect. 39. mpwroKxabedpias *— first seats. 1 Mt. says év mvevuart. This is the only case of the use of this phrase in the Gospels. 2 This passage is quoted from the Sept. without change. 8 See on 815, 4 This word is found only here and in the parallel passages from Mt. and Lk. in the N.T., and elsewhere, in ecclesiastical writings. 238 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ XII. 39-41 apwroxdictas '— chief (reclining) places, not rooms, AV. What this chief place at table was, the varying custom prevents our saying. 40. of xareoOiovres — If this is a continuation of the preceding sentence, the nom. is an irregularity, as its noun is in the gen.” It is better, therefore, to begin a new sentence here, making ot xate- obiovres the subj. of AnuWovrac— those who devour, etc., shall receive.’ This devouring of widows’ houses would be under the forms of civil law, but in contravention of the Divine law of love. mpopace.— for a covering. ‘That is, they tried to hide their covetousness behind a show of piety. See 1 Thess. 2°, where the meaning is, that the apostle did not use his preaching of the Gos- pel as a mere cloak of covetousness. epiccdrepov Kpiua — more abundant, or overflowing condemnation. ‘The adjective is strong. The comparison is with what they would receive if they made no pretence of piety. Notice that the show, as it is commonly with men, is of religion, while the offence is against humanity. The warning is addressed to the people, and bids them beware of religious leaders who affect the outward titles and trappings of their office, and offset their lack of humanity by a show of piety. The exact verbal correspondence of Mk. and Lk. in this warn- ing is proof positive of their interdependence. JESUS’ COMMENDATION OF THE WIDOW’S OFFERING 41-44. The day closes with a scene in the treasury of the temple. Jesus ts watching the multitude casting their offerings into the trumpet-shaped mouths of this receptacle, and among them many rich men casting in much. But there ts one poor widow, who casts in two small coins, worth about a third of a cent, and Jesus commends her as having given more than all the rest. They, he says, gave out of their excess; she, out of her lack, gave all her living. 41. Kai xaficas xatrevavtt tod yalopadvkiov — And having taken @ seat over against the treasury. Omit 6 "Ingots, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BL A two mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. 1 This word is also found only in the parallel accounts of this discourse, and in ecclesiastical writings. 2 See Win., who treats it as an annex with an independent structure. 59, 84, 62, 3. 8 So Grotius, and following him, Bengel, Meyer, and others. XII. 41-44] THE WIDOW’S OFFERING 239 yalopvAakiou — treasury.' The treasury meant is probably that in the outer court of the temple, having thirteen openings shaped like trumpets, for the reception of temple offerings and of gifts for the poor. yadKdov— literally, dvass, but, like the Latin @s, a general word for all money. €BadAov — were casting, denoting the repeated act. 42. wia xnpa—one widow, contrasted with the many rich. dv0 Aerrd, 6 €oTe Kodpavtns — the Aerrov was the eighth part of an as, the value of which was one and two-thirds cents, so that two Aerra were about two-fifths of a cent. Kodpavrys is the Latin word guadrans, meaning a quarter of an as. But the real value appears only from the fact that the denarius, or ten asses, was a day’s wages. 43. elrev avrors, “Api eyo o upiv, OTL 9 XNPA avTH 7 TTwWXI) 7AELOV mavTwv éBartev Tov BaddrdvTwv eis TO yalopudaxtov — satd to them, Verily I say to you, that this poor widow cast in more than all who are casting into the treasury. eimrev, instead of Aéyer, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABDKLU AIL, two mss. Lat. Vet. Egyptt. Syrr. €BaXev, instead of BéBAnxe, Treg. WH. RV. xe (x* €Badrev) ABDL A 33. Badddvrwy, instead of Baddvrwy, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. xs ABDLX I AII. . whelov mavtwv éBarev tov Baddovtwv — cast in more than all who are casting. ‘This is a case where the use of the comp., instead of the superl., is misleading, as the superl. means most of them all, whereas the comp. strictly means more than all together. 44. ictepyoews —This expression is the exact opposite of zep- urcevovTos, one meaning more than enough, and the other Zess than enough; excess and deficiency. RV. superfiluity and want. ddov tov Biov — all her living, her resources. The idea of zepiocevevov- tos is that they did not trench on their resources, but gave a part only of what they had over and above that, while the poor widow gave all her resources. Hence, while the real value of their gifts was many times greater than hers, the ideal value of hers was the greatest of them all. Money values are not the standard of gifts in the kingdom of God, but only these ideal values. It is only as the gift measures the moral value of the giver, that it counts with him who looks at the heart. It is noticeable that Mk. closes his account of this stormy scene in the Temple with this idyl. The connection is not the verbal and superficial relation to the widows of v., but the contrast between the outward meagreness and inward richness of the widow’s service, and the outward ostentation and inward barren- ness of the Pharisees’ religion. 1 A Scriptural word, of which the first part is a Persian word for treasure. 240 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ XIII. 1-37 JESUS’ DISCOURSE ABOUT THE DESTRUCTION OF THE TEMPLE XIII. 1-37. As they are coming out of the temple, the disciples call Jesus’ attention to the greatness of the stones, and of the building itself. Jesus predicts tts complete de- struction. They ask him the sign of this, and Jesus shows them first, the danger that they will be deceived by false Messiahs, and by premature omens. They are not to be disturbed by these, but are to look out for themselves, exposed to great dangers, and burdened with the great re- sponsibility of making known thetr message to all nations (v.'"). But when they see the desolating abomination, the Roman army, standing where tt ought not, before the city ztself, then they ave to get out of the city, and not stand on the order of their going. That ts to be a time of unpar- alleled distress, of false and specially plausible Messiahs, and ts to be followed tmmedtately by the coming of the Son of Man with the usual Divine portents (v.*"). As to the time of these events, it is to be within that generation, but no one, not even the Son of Man, knows the exact time. They need to be on the watch, therefore (v.*"). There have been, up to recent times, two interpretations of this discourse. Both of them separate it into two principal parts: the prediction of the destruction of Jerusalem, and the prophecy of the consummation of all things with the advent of the Messiah in glory. But one of them, the traditional interpretation, postpones the latter part indefinitely, and is still looking for the world-catas- trophe which its advocates suppose to be predicted here. The difficulties in the way of this interpretation are grave and insuper- able. It ignores the coupling together of the two parts in the discourse, as belonging to one great event. Mt. ’v.”, says that they will follow each other immediately. Mk., that they belong to the same general period. It passes over also, or attempts to explain away, the obvious notes of time. All of the accounts wait until they have come to the end of the prophecy, including both XIII. 1] COMING OF THE SON OF MAN 241 parts, before they introduce the statement of the time of all these events, and the statement itself is, that that generation was not to pass away till all these things came to pass. Further, it leaves unexplained the expectation of an immediate coming which colors all the other N. .T. books, and all the life of the Church in the sub- sequent period. But especially, it runs counter to the historical interpretation of prophecy, which gives us the only key to its rational exegesis, by postponing to an indefinite future events which the prophecy itself regards as growing out of the present situation. The other interpretation, the common one at present, interpret- ing the prophecy itself in the same way, places the time of its fulfilment in that generation. That is, they involve Jesus himself in the evident error of the other N.T. writings and of the Church in the subsequent period. The error of this interpretation, exe- getically not so serious as the other, is that it takes literally lan- guage which can be shown to be figurative. But the other and more serious difficulty is, that it commits Jesus to a programme of the future which is directly counter to all his teachings in regard to the kingdom of God. A third interpretation, the one adopted here, holds that the event predicted in the second part did take place in that gener- ation, and in connection with the destruction of Jerusalem. The event itself, and the signs of it, it interprets according to the analogy of prophecy, figuratively. It finds numerous instances of such use in O.T. prophecy. God coming in the clouds of heaven with his angels, and preceded or announced by disturbances in the heavenly bodies, is the ordinary prophetic manner of describ- ing any special Divine interference in the affairs of nations. See especially Dan. 7° *”, where this language is used of the coming of the Son of Man, z.e. of the kingdom of the saints, to take the place of the world-kingdoms. The prophecy becomes thus a prediction of the setting up of the kingdom, and especially of its definite inauguration as a universal kingdom, with the removal of the chief obstacle to that in the destruction of Jerusalem. 1. Kai éxropevopevov ex tov tepod — And as he was coming out of the temple. ‘The previous scene was in the court of the temple. tepov denotes the whole temple-enclosure. fs rav pabyrav — one of his disciples. We are not told who it was. Mt. says, hés R 242 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ XIII. 1-4 disciples; Lk., certain people.’ roramot iGo. — what manner of stones.? Josephus gives the dimensions of these stones as 25 cubits in length, 12 in breadth, and 8 in height. Ferguson, in Bib. Dic., gives the measurements of the temple proper, the vaos, as about 100 cubits by 60, with inner enclosure about 180 cubits by 240, and an outer enclosure 400 cubits square, the enclosures being adorned with porticoes and gates of great magnificence. 2. Kat 6Iyoois ctrev aire, Brérets Tadras Tas peyaAas oikodopas ; od py adbeO7 Bde ABos exit AHov, os od pH KatardvOq — And Jesus said to him, Seest thou these great structures? There will not be left here stone upon stone, which will not be destroyed. ‘This is a rhetorical statement of utter destruction. It would not be a non- fulfilment of this prophecy to find parts of the original structure still standing. Omit droxpibels, answering, after “Incots, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BL 33, 115, 237, 255, one ms. Lat. Vet. Egyptt. Pesh. Insert woe, here, after rn apeOn7, Treg. WH. RV. s BDGLM? U A mss. Lat. Vet. Pesh. Tisch. objects to this insertion as being taken from Mt., where it occurs without variation. dlOov, instead of AlOw, after émi, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BGLMUX IAlI 1, 13, 28, 33, 69, etc. D and a number of mss. of Lat. Vet. add here, and after three days, another will rise up without hands ! See); 2). 3. kal xaOnpévov adrod eis TO dpos T. eAaiwv® — And he seating himself on the Mount of Olives. Mk. alone adds, over against the temple, as the situation would recall the previous conversation on coming out of the temple. ézypwra airdoy kar’ idiav Ilérpos kat - "TdxwBos x. lwdvyns x. "Avdpeas— Peter and James and John and Andrew asked him privately. Mk. retains here the order of these names given by him in the account of the appointment of the twelve.* érnpwra, instead of érnpwrwy, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BL 13, 28, 33, 69, 229, Harcl. marg. eimév, instead of efré, Tisch. Treg. WH. 8 BDL 1, 13, 28, 33, 69, 346. 4. Eirov® jpiv, wore tadta eorar — Tell us, when these things will be. tadra refers to the destruction of the temple just mentioned.® But in giving the answer of Jesus, Mk. introduces false Messiahs in such a way as to seem to imply a previous reference to his own reappearance, so that Mk.’s report taken as a whole would imply more than this single reference of the ratra. But this appearance 1 Mt. 241 Lk. 215. 2 roraroi is a later form for the Greek rodaroi. On the etymology of the word, see Liddell and Scott, Thay.-Grm. Lex. Properly, the word denotes origin — from what country?—but from Demos. on, it has also the meaning, of what sort? Here, it is exclamatory, calling attention to the greatness of the temple buildings. 3 On this use of eis with a verb of rest, see Thay.-Grm. Lex. 4 See 316-18, 5 The imper. eimov is from sec, aor. etra. 6 The plural is used because this event is complex, including in itself a multiplied series of events. XIII. 4—7| COMING OF THE SON OF MAN 243 of false Messiahs in Mk.’s account may easily be explained as one of the premature signs of the catastrophe which makes the single subject of the prophecy so far. Moreover, the way in which the destruction of the temple, the reappearance of Jesus, and the consummation of the age are introduced in Mt. (24°°) shows con- clusively that in that Gospel the three are all treated as parts and titles of the one event. 5. ‘O 8 “Inoots npgaro deve airois, Bérere py'— And Jesus began to say to them, Beware lest. Omit droxpibeis, answering, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BL 33, Egyptt. Pesh. 6. zodAol éAevoovrat eri TO dvopati pou — Many will come in my mame. ° Omit yap, for, Tisch. (Treg. marg.) WH. RV. x* B Egyptt. This warning against false Messiahs coming in his name is oc- casioned apparently by a part of their question, given by Mt. alone, who states their inquiry thus — what ts the sign of thy coming, and of the end of the age? Nothing has been said by Mk. to lead up to this warning. The prophecy has been the destruction of the Temple, and the question of the apostles has been when that is to take place. But nothing has been said of his coming. The ac- count of the previous conversation in Mt. would seem necessary therefore to supplement the account of Mk. But see note on tavta, v.*.. Moreover, the zapovoia, the coming, of Mt. has no ante- cedents, and yet it is introduced as something well understood by the disciples, of which they inquired only the time. Before this, the Gospels have taken us only as far as the resurrection of Jesus predicted by himself. And even that prediction they tell us that the disciples did not understand. And yet, here they are talking of his coming again as an understood fact. If it was, then their dismay at his death, and their unbelief of his resurrection, are un- accountable. ézi To évopati pov, in my name. Not his personal name, but his official title. They would not assume to be Jesus returned to the earth, but they would claim his title of Messiah. 7. mwoA€uous K. akoas toAguwy— wars and rumors of wars. Jesus speaks first of false Messiahs, against whom he warns them. Now, he comes to those commotions which are apt to be taken by men living in critical times and looking forward to great events, as signs of the future. jr) Opoeto Oe — be not alarmed? The reason of this injunction is given in what follows, det yevéoOa, they have to come, although yap after de? is to be omitted.* These wars and 1 On this unclassical use of BAéwecv, see on 424, 2 A late meaning of the word, which means properly, do not make an outcry. 3 Notice the asyndetic character of the entire discourse, so peculiar to Mk.’s abrupt style. 244 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ XIII. 7-9 rumors of wars are necessary, being involved in the nature of things ; they are always happening, and so men are not to be dis- _ turbed by them as if they were things out of the ordinary course to be construed as signs. They are necessary, but they are not signs of the end; the end is not yet. Omit yap, for, after det, z¢ 2s necessary, Tisch. (Treg. marg.) WH. RV. x* B Egyptt. 8. “EyepOjcerat yap eOvos éx €Ovos — For nation will rise against nation. A confirmation of the preceding statement, that wars must be. écovrat ceiopot Kata Toros |— there will be earthquakes in divers places. éocovrat Aoi — there will be famines. The statement gains in impressiveness by the omission of xai before these clauses ; it reads, For nation will rise against nation, and kingdom against kingdom, there will be earthquakes in divers places; there will be famines. Omit kal, and, before €covra: cecpuol, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BDL 28, 124, 299, Egyptt. Omit cai before €covra: Atuol, Tisch. (Treg.) WH. RV. x¢ BL 28, Memph. Omit kai rapayal, and tumuits, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x *ande BDL mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. . apxn wdivwy tatta — these things are a beginning of travails. The word wdivwv was in popular use to denote the calamities pre- ceding the advent of the Messiah, and the reason of the figure is to be found not only in the pains, but in the joyous event which they ushered in. But they do not mark the end, but the begin- ning of that process of travail by which the new birth of the world is to be brought about. The whole paragraph, so far, is a state- ment of things which need not alarm them, since they are not, as men take them to be, signs of the end. apxn, instead of dpxai, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BDKLS* U AII* mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. 9. Brerere dé tpels Eavtovs. tyes is emphatic. But do ye take heed to yourselves. They are not to go about after false Mes- siahs nor studying portents ; they will have their work to do in looking after themselves. zapadacovat ipas — they will deliver you up. ovvedpia— councils. ‘The word is used of the local tribunals to be found in Jewish towns, modelled somewhat after the San- hedrim, the great council of Jerusalem. kai cis cvvaywyas — and into synagogues. The words belong to the preceding zapaducov- ow, and dapyoecbe stands by itself. It reads, They will deliver you up to councils and to synagogues. You will be beaten.” The 1 On this distributive use of cara, see Win. 49 d, 4). 2 So Erasmus, Tyndale, Meyer, Treg. Morison. The more common interpreta- tion makes cis cuvaywyas a pregnant construction after dapycecGe — you will be (taken) into synagogues (and) beaten. Meyer points out that to leave Sapjaccbe ae disconnected agrees admirably with the general asyndetic character of the iscourse, ITT. 9-11] COMING OF THE SON OF MAN 245 synagogues were the ecclesiastical tribunal of the town, as the cuvédpia were the municipal court. #yeudvwy — the word used in Greek to denote the Roman provincial governors. To sum up, cuvedpia and ovvaywyat were Jewish tribunals,’ and jyenoves and BactArcis were Gentile rulers. They were to be brought before both. évexey €uot — for my sake. It was to be because of their attachment to him, that they were to be brought to trial. «is paptuptoy avtois — for a testimony to them. ‘This was the Divine purpose of their appearance before earthly tribunals. They were to stand there to testify to Jesus. Omit yap after mapadwoovor, Tisch. (Treg.) Treg. marg. WH. BL Memph. 10. K. eis ravta ta €Ovn — And in all the nations must the glad tidings first be heralded. ‘This is suggested by the mention of Gentile rulers in the preceding. It is a part of that, moreover, which makes it necessary for them to look out for themselves dur- ing this period. They are to be subject not only to private persecutions, Lut to governmental oppositions and under that pressure they are nevertheless to become heralds of the good news of the kingdom of God in every nation, b fore the end comes. Hence they have themselves to look out for, and not / rumors and portents and signs. Moreover, this shows what he — means by the care of themselves that he enjoins upon them. It | is not care for their safety, but for their spiritual condition in the — face of such opposition, and of so difficult a work. 11. Kai érav dywowy tpas rapadidovres — This is difficult to ren- der. It means, whenever, in the act of delivering them up, men are leading them to the authorities. Kal drav, instead of Oray dé, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDL 33, mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. dywour, instead of aydywour, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABDGHKLMUX III. py mpopepivare? ti AaAHonTE, GAN’ oO éav S007 duiv ev Exeivy TH wpa, TovTo Aadcire— do not be anxious beforehand what to say; but whatever is given you in that hour, this speak. The etymologi- cal sense of rpomepusvare fits in here ; do not be distracted before- hand ; do not let your attention be divided and drawn off from the more important matters before you. év éxeivy TH wpe — what to speak will be given you at the time of your trial, contrasted with mpouepysvate. The fact, that it is the Holy Spirit which is to speak in them, shows that it is not their defence of which Jesus is think- ing, but of the testimony to the kingdom, v.°, which is the Divine purpose in bringing them there. This title, Holy Spirit, which | 1 See Schiirer II. 1, § 23, II.; II. 2, § 27. 2 This verb is found only here in the N.T., and elsewhere only in ecclesiastical writings. 246 ' THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ XIII. 11-14 became so common in Christian phraseology, is found already in the Jewish writings (not the O.T.) Sap. 1°. See note on 1°. Omit undé pederare, nor rehearse, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BDL 1, 33, 69, 157, 209, mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Egyptt. 12. Kai rapadwca ddeAdds adeAdov cis Gavarov— And brother will deliver up brother to death. Kai rapadwce., instead of rapadwoe dé, 8 BDL mss. Lat. Vet. Egyptt. They will be subject not only to governmental opposition, but to private persecution, and this will extend even to members of their own families, so bitter will be the hostility awakened against them. 13. 6 d€ tropeivas eis TéeAos — But he who has remained steadfast to the end. wropxevw denotes steadfastness under trial and opposi- tion. This closes Jesus’ statement of the reason for their taking heed to themselves. They will be persecuted by the powers of the world, and hated by everybody, even in their own families, and in the face of this opposition will have to carry the Gospel to all nations, and the price of their salvation will be steadfastness under it all, even to the end. 14. "Orayv dé idynre 7d BddAvypa THs Epnuwoews ExTHKOTA Gov Ov det — Jesus comes now to the real cause of alarm, the sign of the end. It is the BdeAvypa THs Epnudcews, the abomination of desola- tion, or the desolating abomination, standing where tt ought not. This title is taken directly from the Sept. of Dan. 11°! 12", where it refers probably to the idol altar placed on the altar of burnt offerings by Antiochus Epiphanes. But it seems probable here, that the words, as is frequently the case in N.T. quotations from the O.T., are to be taken not in their historical sense, but in a sense more applicable to the N.T. occasion, and easily contained within the words themselves. Lk. supplies us with this interpreta- tion, when he makes Jerusalem surrounded by armies to be the sign of the end. Jerusalem would be the holy place (Mt. 24”) where the abomination of desolation ought not to stand, and the abomination of desolation would be the abhorred and devastat- ing armies of Rome. Wars and rumors of wars, as long as they keep away from the holy place, are not signs of the end, but when they attack the holy city, then beware. 6 dvaywwoxwv voeirw — Let him that reads understand. There has been much debate whether these words belong to Jesus’ discourse, or have been interpolated by the writer. The use of dvaywockwv, instead of axovwv, decides this, as the omission of the words 76 pyfev dia AavA, tr. rpod, which was spoken of by Daniel the prophet, leaves nothing for avaywwokwv to refer to, except what Jesus himself says, and it is only after that has been committed to writing, that avaywaokwv can be used in reference to it. Mk. intends to call special atten- IIT. 14-20 | COMING OF THE SON OF MAN 247 tion to this part of Jesus’ prophecy. And evidently this is because his readers stood in the shadow of this approaching event, and it became them therefore to read intelligently what Jesus has to say about it. If it is asked why attention is called to this particular part of the prophecy, it is because Jesus himself calls attention to it as containing the key to the situation ; this is the sign of the end. When that takes place, they need expect no other result of the siege, than that predicted. eis ra opn — into the mountains. Mountains are mentioned as the natural places of refuge. 15. 6 (de) émi rod Swparos pn KataBdrw, pyde eiveAOatw' dapat Tu ex THs oikias a’tou — (And) letnot him whois upon the house descend, nor go tn to take anything out of the house. They are not to descend, but flee immediately by the external approach to the } roof, instead of going down into the house for any purpose. The whole is an expression of the haste necessary to escape the im- pending event. Omit 6¢ (Treg. marg.) WH. BFH, one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. Omit eis Thy oikiav, into the house, Tisch. WH. RV. 8 BL two mss. Lat. Vet. Egyptt. Pesh. elcedOdrw, instead of -6érw, Tisch. Treg. WH. ADL A 13, 28, 346. 16. Kai 6 eis Tov aypov pn ertorpedrw eis TA Gricw apat TO iua- tiov— and let not him who is in the field turn back to take his outer garment. ‘The picture is of a man who has left his outer garment in the house for work in the field. Omit wy after dypdv, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDL A 1, 28, 209, 245, 299, mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. 18. mpocevxerOe Sé iva py yevytar xeywdvos — And pray that it may not take place tn the winter time. ‘The catastrophe is meant, ‘| and not their flight. The reason given, viz. the unheard-of great- ness of the calamity, shows this. Omit 7 guy} buav, your flight, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x*8ndca BDL most mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. 19. gcovrat yap ai nyepar éx. OAs — for those days will be tribulation, instead of a time of tribulation. Wetstein translates the expression, one prolonged calamity. oia od yéyove TowavtTn — literally, such as there has not been such? nv, instead of 7s, after kricews, Tisch. Treg. WH. x BC* L 28. 20. Kai ei un éxorAdBwoev® Kipios Tas Huépas, ovK av éodOn Trace aoap§ — And of the Lord had not shortened those days, no flesh would have been saved. The aor. tenses put this action in the 1 On this form, see Win. 13, I. 2 On this redundancy, see Win. 22, 44. 8 écoAdBwoev is used in the Greek only of physical mutilation. In the N.T., it is used only here and in the parallel passage in Mt., of cutting short time. A striking instance of the interdependence of the Synoptics. 248 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ XIII. 20-22 past — if the Lord had not shortened the time, no flesh would have been saved. The language is proleptic, stating the event as it already existed in the Divine decree.’ It is needless to say that éawOy is used of physical deliverance, though it has been inter- preted of the deliverance from temptation to unfaithfulness in such an hour of trial. rovs éxAexrovs ovs é&eAcbaro — the elect, whom he elected There will be some among that multitude given ‘over to destruction who are God’s own chosen ones, and on their ‘account he shortened (in the Divine decree) these days. It would be the number, and not the length of those days, that God would shorten. 21. Kai tore éay tis tyiy ely, “Ide, woe 6 Xpuoros, ide, Exel, py moarevere— And then, if any one says to you, See, here the Messiah, see, there, believe it not. ore, then, is added to the warning against false Messiahs appearing in the preceding period (v.°). "Ide, instead of the first id0v, Tisch. Treg. WH. BL. “Ide, instead of second ’Idov, Tisch. Treg. WH. s BDL 28. Omit 7, or, before it, Tisch. WH. xs LU 40, 69, 127, 131, 157, two mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. miorevere, instead of mucrevonre, Tisch. Treg. WH. s ABCDEFHLYV A. 22. éyepOncovrar yap (de) Wevddypicro Kai Wevdorpopyrat,® Kai dwcover (roijcover) onpeia Kal Tépata,* mpds TO arrorAavay, ei Svuva- Tov, Tous éxrextovs —for (and) false Messiahs and false prophets will arise, and will give (do) signs and prodigies, in order to deceive, if possible, the elect. dwcovor belongs especially to onpeta, rather than répara. A sign is something given in proof of one’s claim. répara denotes miracles as wonders, abortive, unearthly, and portentous phe- nomena, and thus corresponds most exactly to our word mzraciles. mpos TO azromAavav® may denote result, as well as object.° But «i duvarov, tf possible, points to the signification of object. éxAexrovs, here and in v.”, does not have its dogmatic sense, but the literary sense of choice or picked men seems to accord with the spirit of the passage. ‘They are distinguished from the common crowd. This manifestation of false Messiahs and prophets is to be dis- tinguished from the one in v.®, in the time before the end, being accompanied by these miracles and signs, so that the danger of deception is greater. Tisch. reads dé, instead of yap, at the beginning of the verse with x C, regarding yap as copied from Mt., where it is the invariable reading. Also 1 Win. 42,25; Mey. on Mt. 2422, 2 On this redundancy, and the similar fulness of expression in xricews Hy exticer, creation which he created, v.19, see Meyer’s Note. 3 Words compounded with wevso- are common in later Greek, but not in the classical period. wevdduavrts is the Greek word for false prophet. 4 répara occurs only here and in the parallel passage in Mt., in the Synoptics. Its most frequent use is in the Acts. 5 amonAavgv occurs elsewhere in the N.T. only in 1 Tim. 61°, 6 Win, 49 &. XIII. 23, 24] COMING OF THE SON OF MAN 249 mowjoovgty, instead of dwoover, with D 13, 28, 69, 91, 124, 299, 346, two mss. Lat. Vet., for the same reason. Omit cai before rods éxXexrovs, Tisch. (Treg.) WH. RV. & BDe«, It is singular to see David George (1556), Lodowick Muggle- ton (1746), John Cochran (1868), enumerated among the Mes- siahs foretold in this prophecy. (Morison.) Whatever opinion is held as to the contents of the prophecy, whether it refers simply to the destruction of Jerusalem with whatever significance may be attached to that, or includes also the visible coming of the Lord and the final judgment, there is general consent now that the prophecy is restricted in time to that generation, v.*. In general, the historical interpretation of prophecy is fairly settled. 23. ipeis de BrAérere — But do you be on the lookout. The effect of the insertion of the pronoun is to emphasize it. ‘The purpose of the false prophets and Messiahs is to deceive even the elect. But they, the elect, are to take heed. They do not belong to the unprepared multitude, but have been prepared by their Master. Those who divide the prophecy into two parts, one referring to the destruction of Jerusalem, and the other to the end of the world, make the division at v.”. But this iwets Brezere is strongly against any interpretation which makes the warning refer to a time when none of the disciples to whom it was addressed were living. The warning might include others besides these, but should certainly include them. Omit (dov, /o, before rpoelpnxa, LT have told you beforehand, Tisch. ‘Treg. WH. BL 28 one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. We come now to the coming of the Son of Man, with its accom- panying portents, v.*77. It is placed after the destruction of Jerusalem, but in the same general period: 7” those days, after that affiction. ‘The portents, the darkening of the sun and moon, and the falling of the stars, belong to that event, and not to the destruction of Jerusalem. This separation of the two events which might seem to belong together, means that the fall of Jeru- salem is a preparation for the Advent, which cannot take place without it. It is that end of the old order which must precede the beginning of the new. 24. év éxeivais Tals nepars — in those days. These words denote the general period which he is describing, the fall of Jerusalem. This coming of the Son of Man belongs to that epoch. pera tyv Ori exetvnv— after that calamity. The Odds referred to is that of v.”®; so that what follows is included in the period, but a = 250 THE GOSPEL OF MARK | XIII. 24—26 placed after the calamity. 6 Atos oxoricOyoera — the sun will be darkened. This disturbance of the heavenly bodies, and the prediction of the coming of the Son of Man, have been supposed to be decisive of the view that this prophecy looks beyond the fall of Jerusalem to the end of the world. But this darkening and fall of the heavenly bodies is so common an accompaniment of O.T. prophecy, and its place is so definitely and certainly fixed there, as belonging to the Apocalyptic imagery of prophecy, and not to the prediction of events, that it presents no difficulty what- ever, and does not even create a presumption in favor of the view that this is a prophecy of the final catastrophe. In Is. 13”, it reads, “ For the stars of heaven and the constellations thereof shall not give their light ; the sun shall be darkened in his going forth, and the moon shall not cause her light to shine. . . . I will make the heaven to tremble, and the earth shall be shaken out of her place.” But this is a part of the prophecy of the destruction of Babylon by the Medes. In Is. 34%, it reads, “And all the host of heaven shall be dissolved, and the heavens shall be rolled together as a scroll, and all their host shall fade away as the leaf fadeth from off the vine, and as a fading leaf from the fig tree,” where the event predicted is the judgment of Edom. In Ez. 3278, similar language is used of the judgment of Egypt, and in Amos 8°, of the northern kingdom. In Joel 2”, 3”, where the subject is the judgment of the nations in connection with the return of Judah from captivity (see 3'), it says : “I will show won- ders in the heavens above, and in the earth blood and fire, and pillars of smoke. ‘The sun shall be turned into darkness, and the moon into blood, before the great and terrible day of the Lord come. . . . The sun and the moon are darkened, and the stars withdraw their shining.”’ That is to say, this language is intended to portray the greatness of the doom of such nations as come under the judgment of God. When he comes in judgment, the earth and even the heavens dissolve before him. Butit is needless to minimize these words into eclipses, or earthquakes, or meteoric showers, or to magnify them into actual destruction of sun and moon and stars. They are not events, but only imaginative por- trayal of what it means for God to interfere in the history of nations. af Suvdpets al év r. oipavois. Svvayus is used frequently in Greek writers of armies, hosts, and hence it is used to translate the Heb. nwa sax the host of heaven, a phrase used of the stars (2 K. 17% 23°:4s. 34°). See Thay.-Grm. Lez, Zcovrat €x Tov ovpavod, instead of Tod ovpavod ecovra, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x ABCU II* mss. Lat. Vet. Egyptt. Pesh. mlmrovres, instead of éxalmrovres, same editors, and xs BCDL II* mss. Lat. Vet. , »” 26. xal rore GWovrat Tov vidv T. GvOpdrov Epyouevov ev veperats — And then they will see the Son of Man coming in clouds. This XIII. 26] COMING OF THE SON OF MAN 251 language is not to be taken literally, any more than that about the heavenly bodies. That is, usage makes it unnecessary, and in this case, the immediate connection with the destruction of Jeru- salem makes it impossible. In Ps. 97'°, the reign of God on earth has the same accompaniment of clouds, darkness, and fire. In Is. 19', Yahweh is represented as coming on a swift cloud to Egypt. In Zech. 9“, when God stirs the sons of Zion against the sons of Greece, he, himself, is seen above the combatants, send- ing forth his arrows like lightning, blowing the trumpet, and coming in the whirlwinds of the south. And in Ps. 18>" is the locus classicus, where all the powers of nature are made to con- tribute to the pomp of Yahweh’s coming to the rescue of his servant. But the passage from which this language is taken is Dan. 7", in which one like a Son of Man comes with the clouds of heaven, and the Ancient of Days gives him an everlasting and uni- versal kingdom. The writer has seen a vision of four beasts, which are four kingdoms, and then he has a vision not of a beast, but of a Son of Man, to whom is given not a perishable kingdom like that of the beasts, but an everlasting kingdom. And when he explains this kingdom like the others, it appears to be the kingdom of the saints of the Most High. But the point is, that in this vision, the clouds are not to be taken literally ; they make a part of the picture, intended to represent that this kingdom to be set up on the earth is after all not an earthly kingdom, but one coming down out of heaven, a theocracy. If any one had sug- gested to the writer, that it was to have a literal fulfilment, he would have said that that was not in his mind. Jesus then, in adopting this language, meant that this prophecy out of the O.T. was to be fulfilled in himself at the time of the destruction of Jerusalem. Then the kingdom of God is to be set up in the world, that unworldly and everlasting kingdom of which the sign is not a beast, but one like a Son of Man coming in the clouds. But here, we face the question, what there was in this catastrophe of the Jewish nation which can be described as a coming of the Son of Man in the clouds with power and great glory. All the marks of time in the chapter point to that one time and confine us to that; and, as we have seen, the language, which seems to point to a world-catastrophe and the consummation of all things, does not take us beyond that, since it is used elsewhere of events, such as the destruction of Babylon and the judgment of Edom, which have the same general character as this destruction of Jeru- salem. But what is there about this event that can be called a coming of the Son of Man with power and great glory? The answer to this is to be found in the fact that Christ is said in the N.T., to have assumed the seat of power at the right hand of God, and especially that the government of the world has been com- mitted to him. The same language that has been used in the 252 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ XIII. 26, 27 O.T., therefore, to represent a Divine intervention in the affairs of the world, especially in great national crises, is now applied to the Messianic King, who rules, not on an earthly but a heavenly throne. And neither in the one case nor the other is a visible coming implied. But Mt., in the account of the trial of Jesus before the Sanhedrim, uses a word which is decisive of the way in which the coming of the Son of Man isto be taken. Jesus says, Mt. 26™, aw dpre oweoOe tr. vidv tr. avOpwrov Kabnpevov éx de€tOv Tr. duvapews, kK. Epxopuevov ert T. vepeAov — Henceforth, from this time on, you will see the Son of Man seated on the right hand of the Power, and coming on the clouds of heaven. ‘This settles two things: first, that the coming is not a single event, any more than the sitting on the right hand of Power ; and second, that it was a thing which was to begin with the very time of our Lord’s departure from the world. Moreover, the two things, the sitting at the right hand of Power, and the coming, are connected in such a way as to mean that he is to assume power in heaven and exercise it here in the world. The period beginning with the departure of Jesus from the world was to be marked by this assumption of heavenly power by the Christ, and by repeated interferences in crises of the world’s his- tory, of which this destruction of Jerusalem was the first. With it, there was to be a consummation of that age, cvvréAeta Tov ai@vos, a winding up of the Jewish period, and with it the great obstacle at that time to the setting up of the kingdom of God in the world. 27. x. TOTE amoaTEXE TOs ayyéeAous, K. Eritvvager T. EkAEKTOUs, etc.—And then he will send forth the angels, and will gather (Ais) elect. This gathering of the elect is the process of estab- lishing the kingdom, and has been going on from the beginning. All the processes by which men are brought to the acknowledg- ment of Christ and the obedience of the kingdom belong to the gathering of the elect. The angels represent the invisible heavenly agencies in an earthly event. The introduction of them means that there is that invisible, Divine side to a human transac- tion. Back of all that men are doing for the conversion of the world, is the Lord Christ with the hosts of heaven, see J. 1°. As for the time, it begins then, at the time of the consummation of the Jewish age, because Judaism was the great obstacle at that time to the universal spread of the kingdom. Under its influence, Christianity threatened to become a mere appendage of Judaism, to have the particularism, formalism, and legalism of that religion grafted upon it in such a way that it could never become a uni- versal religion. With the removal of this obstacle, could begin, not the gathering of the elect, but the gathering of them from the four quarters of the world, the universal gathering. Omit avrod, his, after rods ayyédous, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. BDL mss. Lat. Vet. Omit avrod after éxXexrovs, Tisch. Treg. (WH.) DL 1, 28, 91. 299, mss. Lat. Vet. Tisch. regards a’rod as taken from Mt. 243}. tate beeen, XIII. 28-32 | COMING OF THE SON OF MAN 253 28. tiv tapaBoAnv — the parable, the illustration or analogy to be drawn from the fig tree. drav... 6 KAddos . .. dwadds yévynrat — whenever tts branch has become tender. When the young branches, or twigs, that produce the leaves are softened by the sap flowing through them. These things are a sign of approach- ing summer, and signs are just as reliable in the world of events as in the physical world. But they are signs of the same kind. Causes are to be found in effects, and effects in causes in both spheres. } 29. ovrw xal ipvets— the pronoun is emphatic, distinguishing the restricted dteis, addressed only to his disciples, from the general jets implied in the preceding ywacxere. You know, and so does everybody, the natural sign; and you disciples are to know in like manner these signs of coming events. rtatta— these things, the besieging armies, and the sufferings of the siege, see v.". eyyus €orw — tt is near, the subject is taken for granted as being in all their minds. ézi @vpats — at the doors, a common figurative expression of nearness. 30. 7 yeved avty — this generation. The word is always used 7 by Jesus to denote the men living at that time. This use is suff- cient against the supposition that it means the Jewish race, or the human race, devices introduced to make it possible to interpret the prophecy as applying to the end of the world. But what meaning would either have as marks of time for the general wind- ing up of human affairs? No, the statement means that these events are to take place during the lifetime of Jesus’ contempo- raries, and the events are, therefore, what the whole prophecy surely indicates, those connected with the fall of the Jewish state and the destruction of Jerusalem. sdvra ratra — Here is the answer to those who suppose that the prophecy is to be divided into two parts, one predicting the Jewish catastrophe, and the other the world-catastrophe. All these things, and not the minor part of ‘them, are to take place within that generation. 31. A proverbial statement of the inevitableness of his words. The most stable and enduring of all physical things, in fact the whole physical frame of things, will pass away, z.e. will perish and _come to naught ; but his words are imperishable. mapehevoovrat, instead of rapeAOGou, Tisch. Treg. WH 8 BL. Omit ui, WH: BD*. 32. epi O€ THS Huepas exeivns 7 THS pas — Jesus has given them the signs by which they may recognize the event when it comes, and has told them generally that it will be within that generation, but more specifically, the day, or the hour, no one knows. ovde ..-ovde. The use of ovde forbids our translating this ether, nor. The first means oft even and the second mor. ovdé is disjunctive, whereas wetther, nor, is conjunctive. The preceding verses have 254 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ XIII. 32, 33 fixed the time; this declares it to be unknown. And from this an inference has been made favorable to the view that the prophecy is divided into two parts, the fixed and near time being assigned to the near event, and the unknown time to the far event of the general catastrophe. But the conjunction of day and hour in the statement serves to call attention to the exact? time, and to the greater or less approximateness of knowledge which Jesus dis- claims in regard to it. This is emphasized, rather than a certain period contrasted with another. Moreover, here as elsewhere in the discourse, there is an absence of everything to mark off the two periods from each other. ovde 6 vids — This denial of omniscience to the Son has caused all manner of theological tinkering. It means, say some, that he did not know it on his human side; or by a refinement, he did know it as man, but the knowledge was not derived from his human nature, but from the Divine; or he had no knowledge of it that he was authorized to impart, he was not supposed to know it; or the knowledge lay within his reach, but he did not choose to take it up into his consciousness ; and some go so far even as to make the passage an Arian interpolation. But the statement need create no surprise in those who accept the statement of our Lord’s humanity, especially when it is accompanied by statements of this particular limitation of his humanity; cf. Lk. 2 Mk. 11°, ci py 6 matnp — literally, except the Father. This belongs with ovdeis oidev, and should follow it immediately — xo one knows, except the Father. The intervening clauses make an adversative statement more normal. This limitation corresponds to what we know of the nature of inspiration. It increases human knowledge, but does not alter the nature of it. It conveys a knowledge of the future as contained in the present, and so an approximate knowl- edge of the time, e.g. that the fall of the Jewish nation would come in that generation. But it would not enable a man to pre- dict the exact time, the day, or the hour. 7, instead of kai, before r#s wpas, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. ABCEGHK LMS? UVW? X TAIT mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Harcl. Omit of before év odpavg, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s DK* LUW 11, 28, 115, 262, 299, mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Pesh. 33. Brérere, dyputvetre'— Take heed, be watchful. This duty of watchfulness arises from the uncertainty of the time. Knowl- edge of it would leave time for them to be off their guard. Omit kai mpocevxecbe, and pray, Tisch. (Treg.) WH. RV. marg. BD 122, mss. Lat. Vet. one ms. Vulg. l Gypumveire is compounded of a privative and imvos, and means literally de sleepless. This and the parallel passage, Lk. 2186, are the only places where the word occurs in the Gospels, so that this is another instance of the quite certain interdependence of the Synoptical Gospels. XIII. 34—-XIV.] CONSPIRACY AND ANOINTING 255 34. ws ayOpwros amddqnmos . . . Kal TO Ovpwpe éveretAarto iva ypy- yopn, ypnyopecre — There is nothing to be supplied before as like éoriv, but the correlative of ws is ypnyopetre. It reads— As a man away from home, having left his house, and having given the charge to his servants, also gave orders to the porter to watch, watch ye therefore. The full statement of the comparison would be, so 1 say to you, watch. The abruptness of the statement in its pres- ent form makes it more forcible. Omit kal before éxdorw, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BC* DL 238, 248, mss. Lat. Vet. n Owe, pecoviKTiov, » dAEKTopopwvias,' 7 mpwt— either in the evening, or at midnight, or at cock-crowing, or in the morning. These words denote the four watches of the night, from six to six.? Insert 7 before é6yé, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BCL A one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. Harcl. marg. eoovvxr.ov,® instead of -riov, Tisch. Treg. WH. BCT A. 36. ui) eADwy eSaipvys evpy tuas KabevOovras — lest coming sud- denly he find you sleeping. This clause depends on ypnyopetre, v.” — watch, lest he find you sleeping. The last clause of v.® is parenthetical. 37. 0 d€ ipiv A€yw, Tact A€yw, Tpyyopetre — and what I say to you, I say to all, Watch. What Jesus had said before applied especially to the apostles, whose duties, like those of porter in a house, required special watchfulness. But in the kingdom of God, this watchfulness is required of all, though it is specially necessary in those left in charge of things. It is not intended to carry out the comparison any further than this, that the apostles, like a door- keeper in a house, needed specially to be on the watch. CONSPIRACY AND ANOINTING XIV. 1-11. The Sanhedrim plan to arrest Jesus stealthtly, and to put him to death, Hews anointed by a woman at the house of Simon the leper. Judas conspires with the Sanhediim to deliver him up to them. jesus spends the last two days in Bethany. During his absence, the authorities consult about the ways and means of putting him to death, and decide to postpone it till after the feast, when the people, whom they know to be friendly to Jesus, will have left Jerusalem. At some time during these two days, Jesus is enter- tained at the house of Simon the leper, and during the supper, a 1 This word belongs to later Greek. 2 See Thay.-Grm. Lex. adrexrpodwvia. 3 On this use of the acc. to denote approximately the time of an event, see Win, 36, 2. ri 256 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [XIv.1, 2 woman (John says, Mary, the sister of Lazarus) anoints him with a costly ointment, worth upwards of three hundred denaries (shil- lings nominally, really more nearly dollars). Some of those pres- ent (Mt. says, disciples) were indignant at this waste. But Jesus justifies her act as befitting the time when he is about to be taken away, and when the act therefore acquires the unconscious signifi- cance of an anointing for his burial. And he prophesies that the beauty of the act will keep it alive in the memories of men wher- ever the glad tidings is proclaimed. Apparently from this very feast, Judas goes to the authorities, and conspires to deliver him up to them, causing another change in their plans, so that the intended delay till the close of the feast is given up. 1. 76 macxya Kal ta ac¢vya— Both of these words are used originally to denote the things entering into the feast of the Pass- over, the sacrifice of the paschal lamb and the eating of un- leavened bread, and then they came to be used, one or the other, to denote the feast itself. The unusual thing here is the use of the two terms to denote with fulness the character of the feast by the mention of both its characteristic marks. This is the first mention of the Passover in connection with these events. Probably, it is introduced to explain the conclusion of the authorities to postpone the execution of their plot till after the feast, as it was only two days to the beginning of it (v.”). ot apxlepets Kal ot ypapparets — the chief priests and the scribes. A designation of the Sanhedrim by the two principal classes com- posing it. év d0Ae — dy cunning ; not openly. 2. é\eyov yap —for they said, etc. This is intended to prove the preceding statement that they plotted to take him by cunning, not openly. The determination not to take him during the Pass- over, with the almost necessary publicity which would attend that, shows the secrecy which made a part of their plan. My &v ty éoptn — LVot during the feast. The reason for this is given in what follows. They feared an uprising of the people, whom they knew to be favorable to Jesus, especially the Galilean pilgrims, and so they postponed their attempt till after the feast, when the multitudes attending the feast would be gone, and they could accomplish their purpose quietly. This part of their plan they gave up afterwards, owing to the opportunity which Judas put in their way. pymrore éotat OdpuvBos'— lest perchance there shall be an uproar® of the people. 1 On the use of the future with pijmore, see Burton, 199. The meaning, Zest per- chance, belonging to zrore in the N.T., is characteristic of later Greek. 2 @6puBos is used properly of the noise and disturbance of an excited crowd. a _— XIV. 3] CONSPIRACY AND ANOINTING 257 yap, instead of 6é, after €Xeyov, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. » BCDL, wuss. Latt. Memph. Harcl. marg. 3. Siuwvos tov Aerpov —The circumstances differ too much to permit the identification of this anointing with that at the house of Simon the Pharisee in Lk. 7°. The points of likeness are simply the anointing and the name of the host. But in Lk.’s account the salient features are, that the woman was a sinner, that Simon was lacking in ordinary courtesy to his guest, and Jesus’ answer to the charge of permitting such attentions from a woman of this character. Here, the extravagance of the act is the thing complained of. On the other hand, there is every indication that the event is the same as that in J. 12’*. The only difference is, that the Synoptists (Mt. and Mk.) give the name of the host, which is omitted in J., and J., on the other hand, gives the name of Mary, and connects her with Lazarus and Martha. But in case of the identity of these accounts, there is a difference of four days in the time, J. putting it six days before the Passover, and the Synoptists two days. This Simon the leper is not mentioned elsewhere. Evidently, his leprosy had been healed, and so he may have been one of those healed by Jesus. ywv7y —J. says that this was Mary, the sister of Lazarus. ddaBaorpov’ pipov vdapdov TuoTlKHS ToAvTEAOUs — an Alabaster box of costly ointment of pure nard, or spikenard. This word miorixns has caused much dispute. Our English version, sfzkenard, comes from the Vulg., nara spi- cat, and that is probably a modification of the Old Latin, zardi pistict, which is merely a transliteration of a term which bothered the translators. Fritzche and others translate it pofad/e, deriving it either from zivw or zizioxw. But while this etymology is defen- sible, the word does not occur in that sense. But the word is used in the sense of persuasive, or in the latter language, trust worthy, which as applied to things, would come to mean genuine. This is, on the whole, the accepted opinion now, being supported by Grmm, Robinson, Meyer, DeWette, Morison, and others. There was a pseudo-nard, with which the genuine nard was often adulterated. ris xeparns — the head. J. says, the feet, following in this particular the account of the anointing at the house of Simon the Pharisee, Lk. 7“. It is not unlikely, though the two events are distinct, that the accounts have become a little mixed. avvtpivaca Thy (Tov) dAdBacrtpov Karéxeev adTod THs Kepadryns — hav- ing broken the alabaster box, she poured it upon his head. Omit xal before cuvrpivaca, Tisch. (Treg. marg.) WH. RV. 8 BL Memph. ov before ad\dBacrpov, Tisch. 8* ADEFHKSUVW? X IIL. Thy, Treg. WH. s*° BCL A. Omit xara? before rs kepadfs, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCL A 1, 28, 435. 1 The proper form of this word is aAdBacrov, without the p. The usage seems to vary between the masc. and fem. 2 On this omission of card after verb compounded with it, see Thay.-Grm. Lex, Ss 258 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [XIV. 4-7 4. yoav 8€ tives dyavaxTovvTEs mpods EavTovs, His ti 7 ardXela avTy — And there were some indignant to themselves.—“Why this destruction,” etc.? mpds éavrovs means probably that they kept their indignation to themselves, though it may mean among them- selves, denoting an indignation which they expressed to each other.’ The omission of kai A€yovres, and saying, adds to the force of the statement, while detracting from its smoothness. Omit kai Aéyorres, Tisch. (Treg.) WH. RV. s BC* L, one ms. Lat. Vet. Mt. 268 says that it was the disciples who expressed this indigna- tion. J.says it was Judas Iscariot, and attributes it to his peculat- ing habits, which this interfered with. It is a part of J.’s evident attempt to belittle Judas. Obviously, the true account is given by Mt., who gives us the ugly form of the fact. 5. dnvapiwy tpiaxociwy — 300 denartes, or shillings. Or, since the real value of the denarius at the time was a day’s wages, it would amount to more than as many dollars. This explains the indignation. The act was extravagant, certainly. Here and in v., in the description of the ointment, J. betrays his dependence on th: Synoptical source, by the same identity of language which shows the interdependence of the Synoptists. éveBpinavtro — were very angry.” Both of the words used to express their feelings are very strong. Insert 76 pvpov, ointment, after rotro, this, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. ABCKLU AII, one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. Harcl. marg. 6. Kadov épyov ynpyacaro év éuoi—it 7s a good work that she wrought on meé. Kadgov épyov is emphatic, contrasted with their depreciation of what she had done. It is not estimated by our Lord according t a utilitarian standard, by which it would have little or no value. But he was at a crisis of his life when it was of the utmost value to him to know that he had won a place in a human heart. And for any one to be reckless or even extravagant, not calculating, in the expression of this was to him a good turn. It was the fragrance of a loving heart that was brought to him by the costly nard. Generally, Jesus would have men serve him in the persons of his poor. But such a vicarious transfer always in- volves reflection, and sometimes spontaneousness is worth more than reflection. npyaoaro, instead of efpydcaro, Tisch. WH. s* B* D 69, 150. év euol, instead of eis éué, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. and almost all sources. 7. mavTOTE yap TOUS TTWXOUS ... Eve bE OV mavtrore — for the poor you have always... but me not always. This was the reason, not why the woman anointed him, but why such anointing was a 1 Thay.-Grm. Lex. gives both meanings. 2See on 148, = 8 Deut, 151, XIV. 7-10] CONSPIRACY AND ANOINTING 259 good work, which he therefore encouraged. The whole transac- tion, as appears also from the mpdeAaBe prpioa that follows, is given a special meaning and value in the mind of Jesus by the approach of his death. If it had not been for that, if they could have had him always with them, as they had the poor, this would not have touched so tender a spot, would not have been so good a work on him. ov wavrore is a case of language gaining force from extenuated expression. 8. 0 éoxev eroinae — She did what she could.’ mpoédafe pupioa — She anticipated the anointing.” ‘This is an unintended meaning which the act gains from its place so near our Lord’s death. Un- consciously, she has rendered to him, while still living, the honors of burial. évradiacudv®— preparation for burial. J. says, “ Suf- fer her to keep it for the day of my preparation for burial,” * a decided lowering of the meaning. Omit avrn, this (woman), Tisch. (Treg.) WH. RV. s BL 1, 13, 28, 69, 209, 346, two mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. Harcl. éoxev, instead of eixev, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. and most sources. 9. PApay de Agyo t bby, “Orov €av KnpvxOn TO evayyéAwoy eis OXOV TOV KOT MOV, Kal O erotnoEv avTN AadnOjoera — A nd verily I say to you, Wherever the glad tidings ts proclaimed in all the world, also what this woman did will be spoken. Not shall be spoken of, as if Jesus meant to procure this mention himself in some way ; but will be spoken of, a thing that he foresees. He sees that the beauty of this act, unappreciated now by his disciples, is such that it will win its way to this universal mention. pyynpoovvov — a memorial” WHoltzmann treats the use of evayyeAvov in this verse as an instance of the meaning Gosfe/ in the sense of an account of Jesus’ life. But the use of xnpvx8y is against this. Insert dé after Auiyy, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BDst EGKLSVW? LATI, one ms. Lat. Vet. éav, instead of a», after ézrov, Tisch. WH. s ABCLW® X TAII. Omit rodro, this, after evayyéov, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDL 13, 28, 69, mss. Lat. Vet. 10. Kai "Tovdas _Toxapiad® . . . amnrde Bh Tovs dpxvepeis, iva aitov mapadot avtots — And Judas Iscariot . . . went away to the chief priests, to deliver him up to them. éis trav 8wdexa — one of the twelve. ‘This is simply a necessary part of the story, and this accounts sufficiently for its insertion, without supposing any rhe- torical purpose in the writer. But its effect is tremendous. It does not appear from Mk.’s account that there was any con- nection between this and the preceding event, as if Judas was led 1 On the use of éxw in the oe of Zossum, see Thay.-Grm. = 2 Win. 54, 4. 3 A Biblical word. il ee 5 A rare word, found only once besides in the N.T. The occurrence of it therefore, here, in both Mt. and Mk., confirms again the interdependence of the Synoptics. 6 See on 319. 260 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ XIV. 10-12 by it to what he did, though J. does tell us that Judas was specially aggrieved by the waste of the ointment. But the council of the Sanhedrim, the feast and the anointing, and the conspiracy of Judas, are simply put together as the events of this day. It has been assumed that we must find a logical connection of these events, and considerable ingenuity has been expended in account- ing for the anointing on this ground. But the chronological con- nection explains everything. Notice that the chief priests become the leading actors in the proceedings against Jesus after his entry into Jerusalem, instead of the Scribes. Omit 6 before ’Iovdas, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABCDELM LIAII. Omit 6 before Ioxapid8, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s* BC* D. ‘Iokapid0, instead of -érns, Tisch. WH. s BC* L mess. Lat. Vet. mapado?, instead of rapadg, Tisch. Treg. WH. BD. 11. dpyvpiov— money. Mt. mentions the amount as rptdKovra dpyvpta, thirty shekels, or twenty dollars. For curious parallels to this price, see Ex. 21° Zech. 11”, cf. Mt. 27°. edxaipws — oppor- tunely. Lk. states more exactly how he sought to deliver him up, Viz. atep OxAov, 7% the absence of the multitude. mapaoot is substituted for rapad@ in this verse, on the same authority as in v.19, PREPARATION FOR THE PASSOVER 12-16. Ox the first day of the Passover feast, the disciples ask for instructions in regard to their preparations for the Passover meal. Jesus tells two of them to go to the city and to follow a man whom they will meet there carrying a jar of water. At the house which he enters, they will find the owner prepared to show them a large room ready for their purpose. And there they will prepare for the feast. They follow his directions, and find everything as he tells them. 12. rH mpwrn ypepa TOV aliuwv — the first day of unleavened bread. Strictly speaking, the feast did not begin till six o’clock of the afternoon, z.e. not until the beginning of the next day, the fifteenth of the month.’ o6re ro tacyxa éOvov— when they sacrificed the paschal lamb? The killing of the paschal lamb was done by the priests at the temple, originally by the head of the family.’ Gers Erorndowpev — Wo you wish us to prepare ?* This celebration of the Passover among themselves, instead of with their families, 1 Ex, 126, 2 The impf. denotes a customary act. 3 Ex, 1221 Deut. 16°, 4 On this use of the subj. without iva after @éAev, see Win. 41 2,4 4; Burton, 171, XIV. 12-21] BETRAYAL PREDICTED 261 shows how their association with Jesus had come to take the place of ordinary ties with the twelve. 13. 8¥o rév droordAwvy — Lk. 22° names Peter and John as the two. Kepdy.ov —Etymologically, this word denotes any earthen- ware vessel, but in use, it is restricted to a jar or pitcher. It is a question, whether this sign of a man bearing a jar of water on his head had been prearranged between Jesus and the oixodeordrns, or whether this is an instance of Jesus’ supernatural knowledge of events. The manner of narration seems to imply that the evan- gelist meant us to understand the latter. There can be little doubt that the rest of the matter had been arranged with the host. 14. oikoderrdory — master of the house.’ od éore 76 xatadvpa’ pov ...3; Where is my aining room... ? Insert wou after kardduua, Tisch. Treg. (Treg. marg.) WH. RV. x BCDL A I, 13, 28, 69, mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. Harcl. sang. 15. xai avros tiv detSer dvayasov® péya eotpwdpevov €rormov* Kal éxet Eroluacate yulv—and he will show you a large upper room Jurnished and ready; and there prepare for us. éotpwpevov— Spread or strewn. It is used of making up a bed or couch, and here of making up, or furnishing a room with couches. kai éxe? €rouuagcatre — Kai Connects éroiuacare with t7a- yete, dxoXovOyoate, and ciate. dvdya.ov, instead of dvwyeov, Tisch. Tres. WH. 8s AB* CDEFGHKLPV II. Insert kai before éxei, Tisch. Treg. WH. 8 BCDL 346, two mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Kai eéAOov ot pabnral, kat yAOov— And the disciples went out, and came. Omit avrod, h2s, after wa@nrai, Tisch. (Treg.) WH. RV. s BL A Egyptt. AT THE PASSOVER, JESUS PREDICTS HIS BETRAYAL 17-21. As they were reclining at the Passover meal, Jesus announces that one of them, a disciple who eats with him, and is near enough to dip into the same dish with him, will deliver him up to the authorities. This is only ful- filling his destiny, but gust the same tt ts woe to the man who betrays him. He had better never have been born. 1 The common Greek usage separates this word into its parts, oixov Seordrp. 2 ckardAvma is etymologically, a place to relax; hence an inn, or a dining-room. The word belongs to Biblical Greek. See Thay.-Grm. Lex., catadvw (¢). % This word is variously spelled — avayaov, avwyatov, avwyeov, avwoyews, avayewvr But these are all variant readings, as here. Liddell & Scott, avwyeor. 262 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [XIV. 18-21 18. zapaddce — will deliver up, to the authorities. The word for betrayal is rpodiddvar. 6 éoOiwv per éuov— he who eateth with me. ‘This is not a specification of the one of the twelve who was to do the deed, but of that which he does in common with the rest. It is this which has led to the reading trav éoOidvtwy, WH. marg. ‘This is shown first, by the act itself, as they all ate with him; and secondly, by the questions which follow, which show that the traitor is still unknown. ‘The designation points out not the traitor, but the treachery of the act.’ T&v échbvrwv, (one of you) who eat, instead of 6 écOlwy, (one) who eats, WH. marg. B Egyptt. 19. "Hpgavto Avreicba, cal Eye aiTw eis Kata eis,” Myre eye ;° — And they began to grieve, and to say to him, one by one, Ls 1t L? Omit Oi dé at beginning of verse, Tisch. Treg. WH. 8 BL Memph. kara, instead of xa’, before efs, Tisch. Treg. WH. BLA. Omit kai dddos, Myre éyo; and another, Is it [? Tisch. Treg. (Treg. marg.) WH. RV. s BCLP A, two mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Egyptt. Syrr. 20. ‘O 8 cizev atrots, His rév Swdexa, 6 éuBarropevos per enov eis TO TpvBAtov*— And he said to them, One of the twelve, who dips with me in the dish. ‘This comes nearer to pointing out the betrayer than the preceding 6 éo6/wv per éuov, as this would be shared in only by those in his immediate vicinity. It adds to the sitting at table with him, nearness to him at the table. Mk. and Lk. do not relate that the traitor was more closely indicated than this. Mt., on the other hand, says that Judas was told himself that he was the betrayer. And in Mt., the 6 éeuBawas . . . ovros is evidently intended to point him out to the rest, by indicating the one who dipped his hand into the dish with Jesus at a particular time. This difference between the two accounts is evidently intentional. Mk. does not mean to indicate the traitor, but only to emphasize the treachery of the act. Mt. means to relate the discovery of the betrayer. The individual handling of common material is evident. tpvG@Xéov is the dish containing the sauce of figs, dates, almonds, spice and vinegar, which is called in the Mishna nenn, charoseth. Omit droxpiels, answering, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BCDL, mss. Lat. Vet. Egyptt. Pesh. Omit é« before r&v d5adexa, Tisch. (Treg. marg.) WH. x BCL 38, 60, 78, 127, Egyptt. 21. ort 6 pev vids Tod avOpurov iraye — because the Son of Man goes. ‘This confirms the statement of the betrayal by that of his 1 Cf. Ps. 419. = On this construction, common in later Greek, see Thay.-Grm. Lex. efs, 4¢; Win. 37, 3. 3 On the distinction between u7 and pri, see on 421, 4 Both éuBarréuevos and rpvBdAiov in this statement occur only in this account in the N.T., and their use by both Mt. and Mk. is thus another strong confirmation of the interdependence of the Synoptics. XIV. 21, 22] THE LORD’S SUPPER 263 departure from this world, doubt of which would render the other doubtful. It is the general fact, the admission of which opens the way for belief in the betrayal. Insert é71, decause, Tisch. (Treg.) WH. RV. & BL Egyptt. KaOws yéyparrat rept avtov — As it ts written of him. Lk. says, KaTa TO Opispevoyv — according to the decree. The O.T. prophecy to this effect is Is. 53. ‘The primary reference of the passage is to the suffering servant of Yahweh, who is defined in the prophecy itself to be the righteous Israel. But, as in the case of many of these prophecies, the principle involved makes it applicable to the fate of our Lord. ‘This principle, that it is the fate of righteous- ness to suffer in this evil world, makes Jesus predict also the per- secution of his followers as well as of himself. ‘The O.T. prophets, himself, and his followers are involved in a like fate. ovat dé — but woe. ‘This is not a malediction, in the sense of a wish or prayer that this vengeance may follow the traitor, but a solemn announcement of the Divine judgment. It differs in this respect from the comminatory Psalms. 6 vids TOD dvOparov traye.— 6 vids Tov avOpwrov Tapadidora: — oval TO dvOparw exeivw — ci otk eyevvHIn 6 avOpwros Exeivos — The Son of Man goes — The Son of Man ts delivered up — woe to that man —if that man had not been born. The repetition of the title 6 vids ToD dvOpw7ov is emphatic, and serves to bring it into tragic conjunction with zapadiédora. 6 avOpwros éxetvos is repeated on the same principle, and with the same effect. Kadov atr@, «i ovx eyevvnOn — well for him, if... had not been born. ‘This puts the condition in the past, and the conclusion in the present. The ex- pression is evidently rhetorical, rather than exact. Omit 4», 2¢ would be, after xaddv, Tisch. (Treg. marg.) WH. RV. BL, mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. THE INSTITUTION OF THE LORD’S SUPPER 22-25. In the course of the Passover meal, Jesus takes a portion of the bread from the table, and gives ut to the dts- ciples after the ordinary blessing or giving of thanks, saying, This is my body. And the cup of wine he blessed in the same way, and gave it to them, saying, This is my blood of the covenant, which is poured out for many. TZhzs 7s the last time, he says, that he will drink with them, until they share with him the new wine of the kingdom. 22. Kai écOidvrwv airay— And as they were eating. In the course of the meal, therefore. But none of the evangelists state 264 | THE GOSPEL OF MARK | XIV. 22-24 the time more exactly. AaBwv dprov eirAoyyoas exlace — he took bread, and having blessed he broke it. The object of etAoyjoas may be God, in which case, it means having praised, its ordinary sense ; or it may be the bread, in which case, it means, having invoked a blessing on, a Biblical use. The former meaning is suggested by the use of evyapioryoas in Lk. 22, and 1 Cor. 11%. As a matter of fact, the invocations at meals among the Jews in- termingled thanksgiving and blessing. AdaPere, rovTo €or TO THA pov. Lk. adds 76 trép tpav diddpevov, which ts given for you, and 1 Cor. the same without dddéuevov. Both add rovro woveire eis tiv éunv avapvyow. As to the meaning of the words, ¢hzs zs my body, it is enough to say that any insistence on their literal meaning is entirely contrary to linguistic laws and usage. They may mean, this represents my body, just as well as, this ts Literally my body. Meyer refers for examples of this use of efva: to Lk. 12'— the leaven of the Pharisees, which ts hypocrisy; J. 10'—TL am the door of the sheep; 145 — TI am the way, the truth, and the life; Gal. 47 — these (two sons of Abraham) ave two covenants; Heb. 10” — the veil, that is his flesh. But it is useless to multiply in- stances of so common and evident a usage. And yet, the one that evidently disproves the literal meaning, not merely establish- ing the possibility of the symbolic use here, but making the literal meaning impossible, is right at hand. For in the account of the consecration of the cup, Lk. 22”, 1 Cor. 11”, it reads rovro 76 moTyptov 4 Katvy dtaOyKn év TO aliuati pov, This cup is the new covenant in my blood. No one would contend for the literalness of the language in this case, and yet it is perfectly evident that the copula is used in the same sense in both cases, giving the meaning of the bread in the one case, and of the cup in the other, but not saying that the bread is actually flesh, nor the cup a covenant. All this without taking into account our Lord’s manner of speech. We have some right to judge what any person says in a particular case by his habit of thought and speech. This warrants us in saying that the literal meaning is impossible to Jesus. It would pull down all that he had been at pains to set up throughout his ministry —a spiritual religion. Omit 6 *Ingods, Tisch. (Treg.) WH. RV. x* BD, mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. Omit gayere, eat, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABCDKLM* PU II 1, mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Egyptt. 23. Kal AaBwv mornpwv— And having taken a cup. edbyxapio- thoas —having given thanks. Like eidoynoas, v.”, it denotes some form of thanksgiving for the good things of God. Omit 76, ¢e, before ror7piov, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BCDLW? X A 1, It, ope: ; 24. Totré éori 76 alpa pov THs diabyKns — this is my blood of the covenant. sayy in classical Greek means @ will, or testament. XIV. 24, 25| THE LORD’S SUPPER 265 But in the N.T., the only examples of this use are in Heb. 9!©", where by a play upon the double meaning of the word, the writer justifies his statement that a covenant (da@y«y) is ratified by blood by showing that a testament (d:a6)«n) comes into force only with the death of the testator. Everywhere else it has the purely Biblical and ecclesiastical meaning, a covenant. These words, the blood of the covenant, are borrowed from the institution of the Law, regarded as a covenant between God and the Jews (Ex. 248, Lev. 17"). Moses sprinkled the people with the blood of sacri- fice, as a seal of the covenant between God and them in the giving of the Law. And now, the new covenant, see Lk. 22” t Cor. 11”, in which the law is written in the heart, Jer. 312°, is established, and that is sealed with the blood of him who died to bring it about. It is through his blood that the law of God is written inwardly in the heart, and so it becomes the blood of the new covenant. 706 éxxvvouevoy trép toAAGY — which is poured out Jor many. This fixes the sacrificial meaning of the flesh and blood. The pouring out of the blood signifies a violent death, and tép zoAA@yv denotes that this death was suffered in behalf of others. wtmép may be used to express the vicarious idea, zzstead of, but it does not necessitate it, as dvré does. Christ leaves this whole question of the exact part played by his death quite open. He does not anticipate any of the later lines of N.T. treatment of this subject. But one more element needs to be considered in estimating the meaning of the Eucharist, as it came from the hands of our Lord. The bread and wine were to be eaten and drunk. ‘The meaning is thus a partaking of the Lord, the feeding of our spirit with the crucified Jesus. That is to say, it is Jesus our life, rather than the externally atoning aspect of his death, that is imparted to us in the sacrament (cf. J.°). Jesus’ use of the language of sacrifice in connection with his death does not indicate that he means to give to that death the current idea of sacrifice, but that he means to illumine the idea of sacrifice by his own death. As if he had said, “Here is the true meaning of sacrifice.” The Gospels do not give us any com- mand for the repetition of the supper, nor for its continuance as a church institution. That is implied in 1 Cor. 11”. Omit 76 before rs (katv9s) SuaOjKns, Tisch. WH. RV. s BCD? ELVW? X II, 157. Omit cawvis, mew, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BCDL, one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph.®. Theb. wtmép, instead of epi, before roAdGy, Tisch. Treg, WH. RV. 8 BCDL A 13, 69, 124. 25. yevjpatos Tov duméAov — fruit of the vine. yevnuatos, instead of yevynuaros, Tisch. Treg. WH. x ABCEFHLMSU VW? X AII. The form yévynua is rare, not occurring outside of Biblical Greek, and yevyjuaros becomes thus an obvious correction. 266 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ XIV. 25-27 dws THS Hmepas exeivns Gtav etc.— until that day when I drink tt new in the kingdom of God. Lk. 22'*"* makes Jesus say this in general of the Passover meal at the beginning, before the institu- tion of the sacrament. «xavdv is not the word for new wine, for which véor is used, but xasydv denotes a new kind of wine. In the making of all things new, the dvaxaivwors, there is to be a new festal meeting and association of Christ and his disciples, a realiza- tion of these earthly feasts and symposia, which are brought to an end in this last supper. There is thus a note of sadness, a word of breaking up, closing these human associations, but a more solemn note of gladness, looking forward to the new spiritual associations and joys of the Messianic kingdom. JESUS PREDICTS THE SCATTERING OF THE DIS- CIPLES, AND THE DENIAL OF HIM BY PETER 26-31. After singing the Hallel, they go out to the Mount of Olives. On the way, Jesus warns the disciples that they will all fall away from him that night. He quotes a pas- sage from Zechariah, showing that scattering of the sheep follows the smiting of the shepherd. After his resurrection, he will go before them into Galilee. Peter protests that he at least will not prove unfaithful, whereupon Jesus predicts that before the second crowing of the cock, he will deny him thrice. Peter again protests vehemently that he will sooner die with him, than deny him, and the rest of the disciples join him. 26. ipvncavres —The hymn sung by the Jews at the Passover supper was the Great Hallel, consisting of Ps. 113-118, 136. It was the second part of this, 115-118, according to the school of Shammai 114-118, which they sang at this time, after the Pass- over meal. 16 dpos rOv éAaiww—the name of the hill covered with olives, lying east of Jerusalem, and about half a mile from the city. 27. “Ori mavres oxavoadicecGe*! Stu yéypamrat, Tlaragw tov mot- péva, Kal Ta tpdBata SiacKopricOycovta.— AY of you will fall away. For itis written, 1 will smite the shepherd, and the sheep will be scattered. The quotation is from Zech. 13. In the original, it reads, smzte the shepherd. But since it is Jehovah who invokes the sword against the shepherd in the original, this tardgw 1 See on 41”, XIV. 27-30] | PETER’S DENIAL PREDICTED 267 renders the sense of the passage. The whole passage in the original is involved in obscurity, but there is the same indication as in all the O.T. prophecies of the application to an immediate, and not a remote future ; cf. v.6.. The application to this event in the life of Jesus is because the relation between shepherd and sheep leads to the same result in both cases. Probably the shep- herd in Zech. is the king, and the sheep are the people. Omit év éuol, because of me, after cxavdaricecbe, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BC* DHLSVW? X LAII’, two mss. Lat. Vet. Memph.e44-, Omit év 79 vuxti Tavrn, this night, about the same. dracKkopmicOnoovra., instead of -ceTat, Tisch. Treg. WH. s ABCDFGKLN A. 28. éyepOjvar— this is the common word for the resurrection, but it acquires here a special meaning from the preceding zardfw, denoting his rising from the earth to which he has been smitten. apoaéw— this word also gets its special sense here from the figure of the sheep and shepherd. He will go before them, as a shep- herd leads his flock, z.e. he will resume toward them his office of shepherd, and go before them to the familiar scenes of his earthly ministry. See J. 10%. The fact that there is no appearance to the disciples in Galilee in Mk. 16°”, in connection with this pre- diction, is one of the conclusive proofs that that passage is from another hand. 29. Ei xal ravres cxavdadtcOynoovrat, GAN’ ovK éyw — Even tf all fall away, yet not TI. Strictly speaking, ei xai does not strengthen the statement as much as Kai ef. But the difference is too minute for a style like that of the N.T. Greek.’ Ei xa, instead of kal ei, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCGL 1, 13, 69. 30. dru ci ojpepov Tatty TH vuKTI, mpiv 7 Sis adeKTopa Pwvycat, tpis me drapvnon — that you to-day, this night, before the cock crows twice, will thrice deny me. Peter in his boast emphasizes the mavres. Jesus in his rebuke emphasizes the ov— you who feel so confident. Peter had singled himself out as the one to be faithful in the midst of general defection. Jesus singles him out as the one out of them all todeny him. onpepov tatty tH vuKti— to-day, this night, the very day in which you have shown such self-con- fidence. dis dAéxropa dwvijcat— This is the only gospel in which this 8/s occurs, both in the prediction of Jesus, and in the account of the denials. Those two fatal cock-crowings had stuck in Peter’s memory, and so find their way into the Gospel which gets its in- spiration from him. dwvjyca — this is a general word for sounds of all kinds. But the instances are rare in profane authors of its use for animal cries. dzapvyon — thou wilt deny. As applied to persons, it means denial of acquaintance or connection with them. el 1 See Thay.-Grm. Lex, ci, III. 6, 7. 268 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ XIV. 31, 32 Insert od before ojpepov, Tisch. Treg. WH. ABEFGHKLMNSUVW? X III, two mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Egyptt. Syrr. ravry 77 vuxri, instead of ép Tq vuxti ravry, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s BCDL, mss. Lat. Vet. 31. 6 dé éxmepiaoads éhakac— But he spoke with utter vehemence. nepiooas by itself means znordinatzely, and is used of anything that exceeds bounds. é« adds to it the sense completely, utterly.’ éxrepisa Os, instead of éx mepiocod, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCD 56, 58, 61. éAddAe, instead of éXeve, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDL, mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Omit uddrdov, more, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BCDL, mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Egyptt. Harcl. wcattws S€ kal mavtes eAeyov—and so said also all. Peter, according to this, did not occupy a singular position, but simply took his place of leader and spokesman, speaking out what was in the minds of all, to which they all assented. THE AGONY IN GETHSEMANE 32-42. Jesus comes with his disciples to Gethsemane, an olive orchard on the western slope of the Mount of Olives. Here he leaves the rest of them, and retires with Peter, James, and John, to pray. Beginning to be oppressed with the approaching trial, he bids them watch, and retires still further, where he prays that his impending fate may be averted, submitting himself, however, to the Divine wll. Returning to the three dtsciples, he finds them asleep, and again bids them watch, adding as a reason this time that they themselves need to pray that they may be delivered from temptation. A second time, he prays, and returns to find them sleeping. The third time, finding them still asleep, he bids them at first sleep on; and then announces the approach of the betrayer. 32. ywpiov —a diminutive from x#pa, denoting a small enclo- sure, a field. TeOonuavee—Greek form of a Hebrew name, meaning o7/-press. It indicates that the place was an olive orchard, with an oil-press as one of the appurtenances, like a sugar house in a maple grove. J. 18' locates it on the farther side of the brook Kedron. xaOicare ode — sit here. The scene was one of those sacred things in a man’s life, in which his best instincts bid him be alone. ‘The other cases in our Lord’s life of which we are told l éxmepiaows Occurs Only here. XIV. 32-35] THE AGONY IN GETHSEMANE 269 _ were the temptation, the raising of the daughter of Jairus, and the transfiguration. Peter, James, and John were taken nearer to the scenes of his soul’s wrestling with impending fate, but even they were to remain outside, and watch. Te6onyavel, instead of TePonuavy, Tisch. WH. (Treg. -ve?) s ABCDEFG HLMNSV Theb. 33. Kai rapadauBaver tov Iérpov Kai “laxwBov Kat “Iwévynv per’ avrov — And he takes with him Peter, and James, and John. Omit rév before *IdxwBov, Tisch. Treg. WH. marg. s COEFGHMNSU VW?X TAII?. yer’ avrod, instead of ue’ Eavrod, Tisch. Treg. WH. s BCD 57, 69, 346. 34. éxOapBetobar kal ddnuovetv—to be utterly amazed and troubled. One derivation makes ddnuovetv from ddnuos, homesick, and the other from ddeiv, zo de sated. Either derivation makes it very expressive. ‘The strong statement of his amazement opens before us a curious problem. His fate, as he comes to face it, is not only troubling, but amazing. His rejection by men, their fierce hatred of him, his isolation of spirit, even among his own— all these things coming to the Son of Man, the lover of his kind, whose whole life was wrought by love into the fibre and tissue of the common human life, and was individual in no sense — amazed him utterly. wepiAvros — encompassed by grief. éws bavarov — unto death. My sorrow ts killing me, is the thought ; z¢ zs crushing the life out of me. Kat ypnyopetre— and watch. It is possible to take these words in a merely external sense. He knew that his enemies were at hand, and he might want some one to be on the watch for them. But it seems more probable that, as Mt. puts it (26%), he wanted them to watch wth him, to share his vigil, not against human foes, but against the flood of woes overwhelming his soul. If possible, he would have companionship in his extreme hour. See also v.®. 35. 7 wpa — the hour; the time used for the event with which it was big. There is a theologizing attempt to minimize it, as if it referred not to the sacrificial death, which our Lord had no desire to escape, but to the unnecessary incidents of it, from the denial by Peter, and the betrayal by Judas, to the crucifixion itself, as if these were not the very things that made his death sacrificial. It was the bitterness put into death by human sin that gave it its significance as a sin-offering. ei dvvatov éori— if it ts possible. This possibility is limited only by the accomplishment of his work. If it is possible for him to do his work of redemption without that sacrificial death, he would escape that tragic fate. But it is not the bitterness of death itself, nor even the agonies of crucifixion, that he would escape, but the bitterness poured into it by the sin of men, which makes his cross to be the place where all the horror 270 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ XIV. 35-38 of sin gathered itself together to strike him down, and made his torn and bleeding heart to become then and there the sin- bearer for the race. émurrev, instead of érecev, Tisch. Treg. marg. WH. RV. 8 BL Memph. edd. 36. ‘ABBa 6 watyp. This combination of the Greek and Hebrew words would not of course appear in the speech of our Lord, who used only the Hebrew. Neither is the 6 zarnp explanatory of the “ABBa, as the Evangelists employ for this the formulas, 6 éore peOepunvevopevov, or simply 6 éorr, Mt. 1” 27% Mk. 3” 5*1 15°. But this is a combination of the two, belonging to the later usage, and put here by the evangelist into the mouth of Jesus. zavra duvaré co. — all things are possible to thee. Here the condition, zf z¢ zs possible, is changed into the statement, a7 things are possible to thee, and so, as for the matter of possibility, the prayer is left unconditioned, remove this cup from me. But the condition is made now the will of God. ‘This is Jesus’ wish and prayer, to have the cup removed. But, after all, he knows that not his will, but that of the Father, will be carried out, and with that he is content. 37. kal épxerat— and he comes. Jesus is not concerned about himself alone in this critical hour, but about his disciples as well. And so he interrupts even this agony of prayer, in order to see after their watchfulness. ‘This is the one attitude of mind neces- sary in them from this time on,—see his prophetic discourse, ch. 13,— and now, in the crisis of his fate and theirs, he is anxious to impress the lesson on them. He has just predicted that they will desert him, and that Simon will deny him this very night. But this prediction, like all prediction, is intended to avert whatever evil it foretells. If it could only become a warning to them, they would be aroused past all danger of sleeping, and might have watched past all danger of desertion and denial. 38. ypyyopeire Kai mpocedyecbe, iva pip EAOnTE cis TELpacpov — watch and pray, that you come not into temptation. In v.™, he has enjoined watching on them in connection with his own awful sor- row. Now, without emphasizing the change, he enjoins it as necessary for themselves. And so, now he adds prayer, and makes the object of both to be, that they enter not into tempta- tion. The temptation is located not in external conditions, which constitute only a trial or test, but in the internal conditions, the evil desires of the heart, the weakness of the flesh. The outward attack on their steadfastness was right on them, and was not to be averted. They were to pray that this might not be an occasion of inward weakness, which would lead them into sin. To pev 1 wetpacudv is a Biblical word. oo a ee XIV. 38-41] THE AGONY IN GETHSEMANE 271 rvevpa mpoOvpov, 9 caps acdevns — The spirit is willing, but the fiesh ts weak. ‘The rvevua and the capé are not contrasted else- where in this Gospel, nor in the teachings of Jesus. They denote the two extremes of human nature, rvetua being the highest word used to describe the spiritual part of man, and hence, where dis- tinctions are made within the soul itself, being the word used to denote the higher part ; and capé being used to denote the animal nature with its passions, and hence everything that belongs to the lower nature, everything that is debased and weak, whether pro- ceeding from the flesh or not. The two terms cover much the same ground in this popular use as our terms higher and lower nature. Jesus is not pleading this as an excuse for his disciples’ sleepfulness, but as a reason why they should watch and pray. The spirit is tpoOupov, eager, ready, to stand by me, even to death, as you have just shown in your protestations; but the flesh is weak, the lower nature fears death and danger, and that exposes you to temptation. €dOnre, instead of eicéNOnre, enter, Tisch. WH. x* B 346, one ms. Lat. Vet. 39. tov avtov Adyov — the same word. Aédyov is used here col- lectively of the language used by Jesus in his prayer. Mt. changes the prayer here, making it one of submission. Father, if tt 1s not possible that this cup pass from me, except I drink it, thy will be done. 40. kal maAw éADwv evpev adtovs Kabetdovtas* Roav yap aiTay of 6~barpot KataBapvvonevoe'—and again, having come, he found them sleeping; for their eyes were (being) weighed down. ‘The present part, xaraBapvyduevor. denotes the process, not the com- pleted state. kai ovx ydercav—this belongs with the principal clause, not with the subordinate introduced by yap. He found them sleeping ; for their eyes were heavy; and they knew not what to reply to him. So in the AV. and the RV., though the Greek is pointed the other way. Both their shame and their drowsiness would make them dumb. kaTtaBapuvouevor, instead of BeBapnuévor, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s¢ ABKLNU AII* 1, 11, 13, 69, 106. 41. xaevdere TO Aowrov Kk. dvaravecOe — sleep on now, and rest. This is a free, but not at all a bad translation. Own expresses very well the meaning of the pres. imp., which does not command the beginning of an action, but the continuance of an action already begun. 106 Aowrov means the rest of the time, and is con- trasted with the preceding time, when he has bidden them keep awake. Vow is thus not a bad translation of it. As for the feel- 1 xataBapvvoueva is found only here in the N.T., and is rare in Greek writers. 272 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ XIV. 41-52 ing with which Jesus would say this, it is impossible to keep out of it a certain kind of sad bitterness. dméye.— itis enough.’ This meaning is found in only one, possibly two other passages. But the other meaning, fo de distant, is always used with some measure of distance. Morison supposes that the English version dates from the Vulgate, and that most everybody who has adopted it, has taken it from the Latin without much thought. But where did the Vulg. get it, and how does it happen that a mere hit, like that, should be justified by two recondite passages? It is shown to be a meaning of the word, it fits here, and it does not have against it the objection that Morison’s own translation has. This apparently abrupt disturbance of their sleep after he had just told them to sleep, would imply that there was some time between it and that permission. 7A0ev 7 wpa — literally, the hour came. ‘The hour is that of the delivering up of the Son of Man, the announce- ment of which immediately follows. zapaéid0ra.—is delivered up.” The word for betrayal, xpod:dovat, is not used anywhere in connection with this event. rav dpaprwrAov — the sinners. The article denotes the class, not individuals of the class. The signal thing about the career of Jesus had been his non-assumption of the power associated with his position, while yet he claimed to be the Messianic king; not simply a king, but the ideal king. And it seemed to be a sufficient answer to his claims to be a king, that he was not a king. But so far, he had at least kept out of the hands of his enemies, owing to their fear of the people and of Jesus’ influence over them. Now, the crisis of his fate had come ; the hour had struck ; and the Son of Man, personating as he does in the prophecy, the kingdom of the saints of the Most High, an everlasting kingdom, and an endless dominion, is actually to be delivered up into the hands of the opposing party, the sinners. To our ears, it has a familiar sound, and we are accustomed to the whole train of ideas associated with it. But to the disciples, it must have sounded like the stroke of doom. And Jesus does not even try to escape it; he goes forth to meet his fate. CAPTURE OF JESUS BY AN IRREGULAR FORCE SENT OUT BY THE SANHEDRIM, PILOTED BY JUDAS ISCARIOT 43-52. The party that captured Jesus ts vepresented as a crowd from the Sanhedrim armed with swords and clubs. Judas had given them a sign by which they would recognize 1 Thay.-Grm. Lex. 2 The pres. used to denote a certain future event. In this case, it is actually beginning with the advent of his captors, v.4, XIV. 43] CAPTURE OF JESUS 273 Jesus, arranging that the one to whom he gave the kiss of salutation they were to take and hold fast. This meant simply that the one whom he saluted as master was the leader whom they were sent out to capture, and this pro- gramme was carried out. One of the disciples (John says, Peter), not yet convinced that all was lost, and carrying out his purpose to dite with his lord, uf necessary, drew his sword, and with a random blow cut off the ear of the high priest's servant. But Jesus says to his captors, Why do you use force against me, as if I were a highwayman? Why did you not take me quietly when I was teaching every day in the temple? But this treatment of me as a malefactor is only a fulfilment of the fate marked out for me by the Scriptures. AZ this, the disciples, seeing that Jesus does not mean to defend himself, and in that the destruction of all thetr hopes, forsook him and fled. One, however, a young man, who had been roused from his bed by the tumult, and had thrown a sheet about him, was taken by them, and escaped only by leaving the sheet in their hands. 43. Kal ed0us, € €TL adrod AaXovvros, mapayiveTat Tovdas (6 “Tokapt- orns) : cis TOV dudexa, Kat per” avrov dxAos pera paxatpov Kal EvAwv, Tapa TOV apxlepewv Kal TOV ypaypatéwy Kal (TavV) tpecBuTépwv— And immediately, while he was still speaking, there comes a crowd with swords and clubs, from the chief priests, and the scribes, and (the) elders. Insert 6 “Ioxapusrns after *Iovéas, Tisch. (Treg.) ADKMUW? II Latt. Syrr. Omit wy, dezng, after els, one, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABCDKLN SUW? II Latt. Egyptt. Pesh. Omit rods, greaz, after dx os, crowd, Tisch. Treg. (Treg. marg.) WH. RV. & BL 13, 69, mss. of Latt. Egyptt. Pesh. Omit trav, the, before mpecButépwr, elders, Tisch. 8* AU 1, 69, 115, 131, 251, 282, 346, Orig. eis Tv Swdexa— one of the twelve. This is repeated from v.”, to keep this tragic element of the situation before us. 6yAos — a crowd. ‘The apprehending force is shown by this word 6yAos to have been of the nature of a mob, an irregular and unorganized force. J. 18°, on the contrary, says that it was the o7etpa, the Roman cohort, or a detachment representing it, under the com- mand of the chiliarch, its commanding officer, together with the official attendants of the Sanhedrim. apXlepewy . . . Ypapparéwy x, ’HAci, which is the form given by Mt. 2746. cafSay@avei is the Chaldaic form for the Heb. »)n 319 azabtant. Mk. reproduces the language of Jesus, which translates the Heb, into the current language. The Grk. 6 Ocds pov, 6 eds jou, cis 7é (ivari) éyxare= Aurés we; iS from the Sept. : XV. 35-39] THE CRUCIFIXION 295 fashion. ‘The prophetic association of Elijah with the day of the Lord would help this misunderstanding.’ 36. Apapwr S€ tis, yepioas ordyyov o£ous, mepiOeis Kadduw, érdrt- fev airov, A€ywv, “Agere, etc.— And one ran, and filled a sponge with sour wine, which he put on a reed, and gave him drink, saying, Let be; etc. This is evidently a merciful act, and the "Agere indicates that there was some opposition to it offered or expected, which this supposed call upon Elijah gave the man a pretext for setting aside. He said virtually, Let me give him this, and so prolong his life, and then we shall get an opportunity to see whether Elijah comes to help him or not. As Mt. tells it,’ these are probably the words with which the bystanders try to restrain his gracious act. They say virtually, Don’t interfere; let Elijah help him. Tis, instead of ets, the indef., instead of the numeral one, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. xs BLA. Omit cai, and, before yeuloas, WH. RV. BL, one ms. Lat. Vet. Memph. Omit re after wepiGels, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x BD& L 33, 67, Memph. 37. adels puvnv peytAnv *— having sent forth, or uttered a great cry. ‘The final cry of his agony, with which he expired. 38. 76 Kata7réracpa Tov vaov — the vail, or curtain of the sanctu- ary. va0s is the shrine of a temple, and in the Jewish temple, the Holy of Holies, in which was the Ark of the Covenant. The curtain was that which separated this from the Holy Place. The vads was the place where God manifested himself, into which the High Priest only had access once a year. The rend- ing of the vail would signify therefore the removal of the separa- tion between God and the people, and the access into his presence. It is narrated by all the Synoptists. 39. Kevtupiwy® — centurion. ovtw eérvevoev— So expired. The only thing narrated by Mk. to which the ovrw can refer is the dark- ness over all the land. So Lk. Mt. adds to this an earthquake. The portent(s) accompanying the death of Jesus convinced the centurion that he was vids Oeov, not the Son of God, but a son of God, a hero after the heathen conception. Lk. says d/katos, @ righteous man. Omit xpdéas after ovrw, Tisch. WH. x BL Memph. It changes the state- ment from he expired with this cry to he so expired. The former would really give no reason for the centurion’s exclamation. 1 See Mal. 4°. 2 The translation vixegar, EV., is incorrect, as it denotes the wine after it has passed the acetous fermentation; but this is simply the ordinary sour wine of the country, which would be procured probably from the soldiers. 3 Mt. 2748. 49, 4 Lat. emittere vocem. 5 xevtupiwy is the Latin name of the officer in charge of the execution. Mt. and Lk. give the Greek name éxarovrapyns. The centurion commanded a maniple, or century, sixty of which made up the legion, 296 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [XV. 40, 41 40. 4 Maydardnvn — the Magdalene, the same as we say, the Nazarene. It denotes an inhabitant of Magdala, a town on the W. shore of the Lake of Galilee, three miles north of Tiberias. The only identification of her given in the Gospel is in Lk. 8’, where she is said to be one out of whom Jesus had cast seven devils. There is absolutely no support for the tradition that she was the sinful woman who anointed the feet of Jesus (Lk. 7% sq.). Mapéa 9 IaxwBov rod puxpov k. ‘Iwontos — Mary, the mother of James the little, and of Joses. In the list of the apostles, James is called the son of Alphzeus, while in J. 19”, the name of one of the women standing by the cross is given as Mary, the wife of Clopas. These coincidences have led to the conjecture that Alphzeus and Clopas are identical, both being Greek forms of the Aramaic ‘p5n, and that, therefore, this Mary was the mother of the second James in the list of the apostles. The further conjecture that she was the sister of Mary, the mother of Jesus, is based on the unnecessary supposition that Mapia in J. 19”, is in apposition with 7 adeA¢7. It involves the further difficulty of two sisters of the same name. It is connected, moreover, with the theory that the brothers of Jesus were cousins, the sons of this Mary, and apostles. This theory has against it, the fact that it is in the interest of the dogma ~ of the perpetual virginity of Mary, the mother of Jesus. It also makes the brothers of Jesus apostles, which is clearly against the record! SaAdun—the mother of James and John. This is not directly stated, but it is inferred from a comparison of Mt. 27° with this passage. A further comparison with J. 19” has led to the con- jecture that she is the sister of the mother of Jesus mentioned there. This might account for Jesus’ commending his mother to John, but it is conjecture only, and will remain so. James is called 6 puxpos, the Uitte, to distinguish him from the other “ celebrities’ of the name. But whether it designates him as less in stature, or in age, or of less importance, there are no data for determining. Omit 7» after év als, Tisch. (Treg.) WH. RV. 8 BL, mss. Vulg. Omit tov before *IaxwéBov, Tisch. Treg. WH. s BCKU AII* 1, 11. “Iwojros, instead of *"Iwo#, Tisch. Treg. WH. x* BD&- L A 13, 33, 69, 346, two mess. Lat. Vet. Memph. 41. ai, dre Hv év TH TadtAaia, nxorovGovy aire — who, when he was in Galilee, followed him. ‘These three had been associated with Jesus in his Galilean ministry, and the dyxovouy, ministered, shows that they had been the women who attended to his wants, the women of the family-group surrounding him. Besides these, there were others who had attached themselves to him in the same way, when he came up to Jerusalem. Omit xal after ai, Tisch. (Treg.) WH. RV. 8 B 33, 131, mss. Lat. Vet. Memph. Pesh. 1 For statements of the two sides of this question, see 2. D, Art. James and Brother. XV. 42, 43] THE BURIAL 297 THE BURIAL OF JESUS 42-47. Jesus died at about three in the afternoon, and as the Sabbath began with the sunset, it was necessary that whatever was done about his burial be accomplished before that time. So Joseph of Arimathea, who ts represented in this Gospel, not as a disciple, but as somehow in sympathy with him, summoned up courage to go to Pilate, and beg the body of Jesus. Pilate wondered at the short time which tt had taken the usually slow torture of crucifixion to do its work, and asked the centurion tf he had been dead any length of time. Having got this information, he gave the body to Joseph. He removed the body from the cross, wrapped it in linen, and placed it in a sepulchre hewn out of the rock. As the women were intending to embalm the body after the Sab- bath, Mary Magdalene and Mary the mother of Joses saw where tt was laid. 42. érei jv mapacKkevy — since tt was preparation day (for the Sabbath). This gives the reason why Joseph took this step at this time. The removal of the body would have been unlawful on the Sabbath. 6 éore rpocaBBatrov'— which is the day before the Sabbath. We are told by Josephus that this preparation for the Sabbath began on the ninth hour of the sixth day. It is not mentioned in the O.T. | 43. €MOwv ‘Iwonp 6 ard “Apwabaias — Joseph of Arimathea, having come. Arimathea, the Heb. Ramah, was the name of several places in Palestine. Probably, this was the one mentioned in the O.T. as the birthplace of Samuel in Mt. Ephraim.? Mt. tells us about this Joseph that he was rich, and a disciple of Jesus. Lk., that he was a righteous man, and not implicated in the plot of the Jews against Jesus, and that he was expecting the kingdom of God. J., that he was a secret disciple. eioynuwv* BovAevrns —an honorable member of the council (Sanhedrim). ToApnoas — having gathered courage. Waving laid aside the fear of the odium which would attach to his act. os kai avtds mpoo- dexouevos tHv BactAciav tov @eotv — This language is inconsistent with the supposition that this account regards him as a disciple of Jesus. It evidently means that he was in sympathy with the dis- 1 A Biblical word, found in the N.T. only here. 2158, 11.19, 8 evox7uwv Means primarily e/egant in appearance. 298 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [KV. 43-47 ciples in this element of their faith. He was not a follower of Jesus, but in common with him he was awaiting the kingdom of God, and wished to do honor to one who had suffered in its behalf. dav, instead of dev, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. s ABCKLMU Lal, Memph. Insert rév before Ile:Adrov, Tisch. Treg. WH. 8 BL A 33. Te- Aarov, instead of IltAdrov, Tisch. WH. x AB* A. 44. 6 d¢ TleAaros €Oavpalev(-cev) ei 7d TéOvnke* Kal... ernpwory- cev ei waAat (yon) aréGave— And Pilate was wondering (wondered) if he ts already dead, and... asked him tf it 1s any while since he died. Generally, death was more lingering, the great cruelty of crucifixion being in its slow torture. ‘The question which Pilate asked of the centurion who had charge of the execution was in- tended to remove the doubt by showing that sufficient time had elapsed to establish the fact of Jesus’ death. IlecAGros, instead of II:ANGros, same authorities as in v.48, é@avuater, instead of -cev, Tisch. 8 D mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. The impf. is more in Mk.’s manner, the aor. more common. 767, instead of mda, Treg. WH. RV. marg. BD Memph. Hier. mda: is the more difficult reading to account for, if not in the original. 45. Kai yvovs do Tov KevTupiwvos, dwpycato 76 TTHpa’ THO Iwond — And having found out from the centurion, he gave the body to Joseph. The information that he obtained from the centurion was the official confirmation of Jesus’ death, necessary before the body could be taken down. ar @pa, instead of cdua, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDL. 46. Kat dyopacas owvddva, kafedwv adrov, éveiAnoe TH odd, Kal €Onxev avrov ev pynpat.— And having bought a linen cloth, he took him down, wrapped him in the linen cloth, and put him in a tomb. There was no time before the Sabbath for any further preparation of the body for burial.? J., however, says that he was embalmed at this time.? The synoptical account is evidently correct. Omit xal before cadeday, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BDL Memph. é6nkxev, instead of xaré@nxev, Treg. WH. RV. x BC? DL. mrijpari, instead of ury- pelw, Tisch. WH. » B. 47. ‘H d€ Mapia 7 Maydadnvy kai Mapia ‘Iwojros eGedpovy rod rébearac— And Mary (the) Magdalene, and Mary the mother of Joses, were observing where he was laid. . Beheld, EV., is inade- quate to translate the verb here, as it leaves out the idea of pur- pose. It is evident that they constituted themselves a party of observation. réGe.rat, instead of rl@erat, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. x© ABCDL ATI 33, 69, 131, 229, 238. 1 For this word, see on 629, 2 See 161, 5 J. 19°9- 4, XVI. 1-3] ANNOUNCEMENT OF THE RESURRECTION 299 AN ANGEL ANNOUNCES THE RESURRECTION OF JESUS XVI. 1-8. With the end of the Sabbath, the women, who are the only ones left to perform the service, bought the spices necessary, and came at sunrise to the tomb to anoint the body of Jesus. On the way, they discussed among them- selves whom they should get to roll away the heavy stone from the entrance of the tomb. But they found tt removed, and on entering, they saw a young man seated at the right clothed in a long white robe. Naturally, they were amazed, but he tells them that there ts no reason for their amazement ; that Jesus whom they are seeking, the Nazarene, the cructfied, zs not there, he is risen! And he points them to the place where they had put him, in proof. But he bids them an- nounce to the disciples, and especially to Peter, that he ts going before them into Galilee, and that they will see him there, as he had told them on the night of the betrayal. The effect of this on the women was fear and amazement, such that they filed from the place and were restrained by their fear from telling any one. 1. jydpacav apdpata — they bought spices. Lk. says that they bought the spices on the day of his crucifixion, and rested on the Sabbath. As the day closed at sunset, they may have bought the spices that evening. They went to the tomb at sunrise, which would not allow time to buy them in the morning. dreifwouw — anoint, ‘The process was not an embalming, which was unknown to the Jews, but simply an anointing. 2. Kai Atav zpwi (TH) pd Tov caBBarwv' Epxovrat éxi TO pvy- peiov, avateiAavtos Tov HAtov— And very early, the first day of the week, they come to the tomb, the sun having risen. Not at the rising of the sun. AV. TH pid, instead of rHs pds, Tisch. RV. (Treg. marg. WH.) 8 LA 33, Memph. md, without 77, Treg. WH. Br. Insert r&v before caBBdrwr, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. 8 BKL A 33, 69. 3. €d\eyov pos éavtas — they were saying to each other” The impf. denotes what they were saying on the way. 177 wig tov caBBatwy is a purely Hebrew phrase, using the cardinal for the ordinal, and the plural cafSdrwv for the week. Win. 37, 1. 2 On this reciprocal use of the reflexive pronoun, see Thay.-Grm. Lex. 300 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [XVI 4-7 4. dvaxexvAtctat 6 AWGos* Av yap peyas opddpa— the stone has been rolled back; for it was very great. The greatness of the stone is really the reason of their question, but he adds to the question the way that it turned out, as a part of the one event, before he introduces the explanation. dvaxextNicrat, instead of droxextNorat, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. and practically all sources. 5. ciceOoica cis tT. pvnuetov— having entered into the tomb. Mt. says that the angel was sitting on the stone outside.’ Lk., that there were two angels, who appeared to the women, not on their first entrance into the tomb, but in the midst of their per- plexity at not finding the body of Jesus.” J. speaks of only one woman, Mary Magdalene, who came to the sepulchre, and got no farther than to see the stone rolled away, when she turned back and told Peter and John, who came immediately and found the tomb empty. Mary meantime had returned and saw two angels in the sepulchre, and then Jesus himself.* veavicxov —a@ young man. This is the form which the angel took. e&ebayByOnoav — they were utterly amazed. éx in com- position means “¢terly, out and out. 6. “Incotv .. . tov Nalapnvov tr. éoravpwpevov — Jesus the Naza- rene, the crucified. Mt. omits tov Nafapnvov.* Lk. makes the angels ask, why seek the hving among the dead?° The exact language is not preserved in such cases. ‘The statement common to all the narratives is, that the one whom they are seeking is not there, but is risen. ide, 6 roros — see, the place.® 7. dAAG trayere, ciate Tots pabytais aitod Kai to Ieérpw — but go, tell his disciples and Peter. Peter’s name is not mentioned separately because his denial puts him out of the group of dis- ciples, but it specifies him among the disciples as the one whose faith, having been most shaken, needs most the restoring effect of this announcement. podye tyas eis ryv TadtAatav — he goes before you into Galilee. This is in accordance with our Lord’s predic- tion in 14%. xaOws eizev tyiv— as he told you. He has not told them directly that they will see him, but that is implied in the rest of the statement, that he will rise and will go before them into Galilee. This does not absolutely rule out the appearances in Jerusalem, which are narrated in v.*”, but it makes it probable that they were not included in the scheme of this book. We can scarcely think of a writer recording this language who had in his mind several appearances in Judza before they went into Galilee. And especially, it is quite improbable that the promise should be 1 Mt. 282, 2 Lk. 244. 8 J. 201-14, 4 Mt. 28. 5 Lk. 245. 6 On this use of is as an interjection,—in this case not governing the noun which follows, — see on 1535, XVI. 7, 8] THE APPENDIX gor of appearances in Galilee, and that the appearances themselves in the same account should be all in Judza. 8. Kai éLehPoioa Epvyov ard Tot pynpeiov’ elxe yap airas Tpdmos K. €xotac.s — and having gone out, they fled from the tomb, for trembling and amazement possessed them. éxotacis is a transport of wonder, and amazement that carries men out of themselves, makes them beside themselves. époSotvro — for they were afraid. This shows the state of mind that produced the rpopos xat éxora- ots. Mt. says that great joy, as well as fear, entered into their feelings." Here probably our Gospel ends. What follows comes evidently from a later hand, and is intended to remove the abrupt- ness of the ending of the original. All that Mk. tells us there- fore of the resurrection is the announcement of it by the angel, and the promise that Jesus would appear to his disciples in Galilee, showing that this appearance is included in the scheme of this book, though not narrated by it. The appendix contains no account of this appearance in Galilee, but only of appearances in Jerusalem and its vicinity. This confinement of the appearances of Jesus to Galilee is common to this Gospel with Mt.? Lk., on the other hand, records only appearances in Jerusalem and its neighborhood, and while his narrative does not so definitely exclude appearances in Galilee, as Mt. and Mk. do appearances in Judza, it certainly leaves that impression. Omit raxv, guickly, before €puyov, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. and most sources. dp, for, instead of dé, and, after eixe, Tisch. Treg. WH. RV. & BD, mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Memph. Pesh. THE APPENDIX Verses*” are omitted by Tisch., double-bracketed by WH., inserted in the Revisers’ Text, but with a space between it and the preceding passage, and Treg. inserts in the same space xara Mapxov. WH., in their Notes on Special Passages, pronounce against the genuineness. This is done primarily on the authority of x B, one ms. Lat. Vet. and mss. of the Arm. and Atth. versions. L, 274 marg., the ms. of Lat. Vet. mentioned above, Harcl. marg. and Aith.™*™*"¢* give what is known as the Shorter Conclusion, as follows: Ilavra d€ ra mapnyyeApeva Tots Tepi Tov [érpov cvvTopas eényyeAav’ peta S€ Tara Kal aitds 6 Incods ard avatoAns Kal ayxpt dvicews efareoreadrey &’ aitav TO iepov Kal dpOaprov kypvyya THs aiwviov cwrnpias — And they reported briefly to Peter and those in 1 Mt. 288. 2 Mt. 2810. 16-20, 302 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ XVI. 9-20 his company all the things commanded. And after these things Jesus himself also sent forth through them from the east even to the west the holy and incorruptible message of eternal salvation. L virtually closes the Gospel with v.’, and gives this shorter end- ing as current in some places, and then the longer ending as also current. The testimony of Eusebius, Victor, and Jerome is that these versions were to be found in some mss., but not in the oldest or best. They are not recognized in the Ammonian sections nor the Eusebian canons. And there is an ominous lack of reference to them in those passages of the Fathers which treat, for instance, of baptism, the resurrection, and the ascension. It is very true that this external evidence is not enough by itself, though it is always to be remembered that & B are the most important witnesses to the text. But the internal evidence for the omission is much stronger than the external, proving conclusively that these verses could not have been written by Mk. The ‘linguistic differences alone are enough to settle this, — enough to show, even if we had Mk.’s autograph, that they were not original with him, but copied directly from another source. éxeivos is used in the passage five times in a way quite unknown to the Synoptics, but common to the fourth Gospel. opevouai is used three times, but does not occur elsewhere in the Gospel. This is the more remarkable, as it is in itself so common a word, and the occasions for its use occur on every page. In this section, it is the favorite word for going. ois per’ avrov yevouevots, as a designation of the disciples, is another unfamiliar expression. Oedouor, as a verb of seeing, does not occur elsewhere in Mk., and is infrequent elsewhere, but is used twice in this passage. In fact, it is the only verb for seezng in the passage. dm.oréw also occurs twice in this passage, but not elsewhere in this Gospel. Mera (d€) ratra is a phrase not found in Mt. or Mk. It occurs a few times in Lk., and constantly in Jn. *Yorepov is another expression used to denote succession of events, not found elsewhere in Mk. Oavdo.poy occurs only here in the N.T. BAdmrw occurs elsewhere in the N.T. only in Lk. 4”. cuvepyowvros is a good Pauline word, and is found once in Jas., but only here in the Gospels. BeBasody is found in Paul’s epistles and in Heb., but not elsewhere in the Gospels. éaxoXAovOely occurs twice in 1 Tim., and once in 1 Pet., but not elsewhere in XVI. 9-20] THE APPENDIX 303 the Gospels. To sum up, there are in all 163 words in this passage, and of these, 19 words and 2 phrases are peculiar, not occurring elsewhere in this Gospel. There are 109 different words, and of these, 11 words and 2 phrases do not occur elsewhere in this Gospel. Of these, the use of zopevouat, éxet- vos, and @edouor, would of themselves constitute a case, being, from the frequency of their use, characteristic and distinctive in this vocabulary, while the entire disuse of these common words is a peculiarity of the rest of the Gospel. But the argument from the general character of the section is stronger still. In the first place, it is a mere summarizing of the appearances of our Lord, a manner of narration entirely foreign to this Gospel. Mark is the most vivid and picturesque of the evangelists, abbreviating discourse, but amplifying narration. But this isa mere enumeration. ‘The first part of the chapter, relating the appearance of the angels to the women, is a good example of his style, and is in marked contrast to this section. But a graver objection arises from the character of the onpeta that are promised here to follow believers. The casting out of demons, and the cure of the sick, belong strictly to the class of miracles performed by our Lord. They are miracles of benefi- cence performed on others. And in the speaking with tongues, possibly we do not get outside of that sphere. But we do have an anticipation of the new conditions of the apostolic era and of the charismata which distinguish its activity from our Lord’s, that is, to say the least, unexampled in the teaching of Jesus. More- over, this refers either to the speaking with foreign tongues of the day of Pentecost, or to the ecstatic speech which St. Paul calls speaking with tongues in 1 Cor. If the former, then it is not re- peated. And if the latter, then St. Paul depreciates it, and for good reasons. Either would be against our Lord’s selection of it here as a representative miracle. But the taking up serpents, and the drinking of deadly things without harm, belong strictly to the category of mere thaumaturgy ruled out by Jesus. Our Lord does not exempt himself nor his disciples from the natural con- sequences of their acts. The very principle of his kingdom is, that he and they shall take their place in the ordinary conditions of human life, and shall there be exposed, not only to the ordi- nary dangers of that life, but to the extraordinary perils incident 304 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [XVI. 9-20 to an uncompromising righteousness in an evil world, and with- out any miraculous safeguards. But here, that miraculous safe- guarding is promised as the condition distinctly supplanting the ordinary. But the most serious difficulty with this passage is, that it is in- consistent with the preceding part of the chapter in regard to the place and time of the appearances to the disciples, following Lk.’s account, whereas the first part accords with Mt.’s very dif- ferent scheme. The angels tell the women that Jesus precedes them into Galilee, and will be seen by his disciples there. But the appearance to Mary Magdalene was on the day of the re- surrection, and near the tomb. The appearance to the two on their way into the country was evidently that to the disciples going to Emmaus, also on the day of the resurrection. And that to the eleven as they were reclining at table, was evidently also identical with that recorded in Lk. 24* sq., and was therefore in Jerusalem, and on the evening of the resurrection. Immediately after this, in both accounts, comes the ascension, and leaves no time for appearances in Galilee. In St. Matthew, on the other hand, there are no appearances in Judzea, except that to the women on their way from the sepulchre. They have received from the angels the same message as in Mk. 16’, that Jesus precedes them into Galilee, and in accordance with this, the disciples go there, and Jesus appears to them on the mountain. Plainly, then, the first verses of our chapter are framed on Mt.’s scheme of the Galilean appearances, and v.*” on Lk.’s scheme of appearances in Judza. And the two are mutually exclusive. On the other hand, the ending of the Gospel, with these verses omitted, is abrupt. But if this abruptness were foreign to Mk.’s manner, it would not show that this ending is genuine, only that the difficulty was felt by copyists, one of whom supplied this ending, and another the shorter ending. The existence of the two is presumptive proof of the original omission. But really, the brevity of this ending is quite parallel to the beginning of the Gospel, the beginning and ending being both alike outside the main purpose of the evangelist. It is not strange therefore, but rather consonant with Mk.’s manner." 1 See Introduction. XVI. 9] APPEARANCES TO THE DISCIPLES 305 VARIOUS APPEARANCES TO THE DISCIPLES 9-20. The first appearance 1s said to be to Mary Mag. dalene, from whom he had cast out seven demons. Then there ts the appearance “in another form’ to two of the dts- ciples on thetr way into the country. Both of these reports were brought to the disciples, and were received with in- credulity. The third appearance ts to the eleven as they were reclining at table, when Jesus rebukes their lack of faith and their spiritual obtuseness, and gives them his final in- structions and promises. They were to go into all the world, and proclaim the glad-tidings to all creation. He whe believes their message and ts baptized will be saved; and he who disbelieves will be condemned. Moreover, believers were to be accredited by certain signs done in his name. They were to cast out demons, speak with tongues, handle serpents and drink poisons with impunity, and heal the sick with the laying on of hands. After this discourse, the Lord was taken up into heaven, and sat on the right hand of God. And the disciples went out everywhere with their message, the Lord helping them, and confirming their word wrth the promised signs. 9. “Avacras 5¢ rpwi tpaoty caBBarov épavn tpatov Mapiaty May- darnvyn, tap’ ns exBeBAnKe Extra Sauovia— And having arisen early on the first day of the week, he appears first to Mary Magdalene, Srom whom he had cast out seven demons. This is not a calida junctura, and could scarcely have been written by Mk. himself, with what he had just written in mind. The identification of Mary Magdalene, after she had been mentioned three times in the preceding narrative, is especially inconsistent. ap’ 7s — this is the only case of the use of this prep. in describing the casting out of demons, and it is as strange as it is unexampled. This appear- ance to Mary Magdalene is given in J. 20%. ‘The story of the different appearances, in this paragraph, though taken from differ- ent gospels, is told by the compiler in his own manner, with some marked variations, and in all cases in a condensed form. ‘The in- cident of the seven demons is from Lk. 87. wap’ ms, instead of ad’ 7s, Treg. WH. RV. CDL 33. It should be remembered that 8 B do not contain this paragraph. x 306 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [XVI. 10-14 10. éxeivy—this unemphatic use of éxeivos reminds us of the fourth Gospel, but is foreign to Mk. And yet, in this paragraph, it is found in v."-*, The use in v.', while it is more or less emphatic, is foreign to Mk.’s style. opev0etoa — Here is a more striking anomaly. For this word, though it occurs here three times, v.’°*— in fact, is the staple word for go:mg,—Jis not found elsewhere in Mk., though it is so common a word, and the occasions for its use are so frequent. This makes the striking feature, that this common word is dropped from Mk.’s vocabulary, and suddenly appears here. The other evangelists use it con- stantly. rots per’ avrov yevouevors— fo those who had come to be (associated) with him. ‘This paraphrase for hzs disciples is also unknown to Mk., and to the other evangelists. ev@ovc. — weeping. This word zevotc is also a word occurring only here in this gospel, but that does not count, as it is about the rate of its use in the other books of the N.T. 11. Mark agrees with Luke that the first report of the resur- rection was disbelieved.1 Mt., however, states that the message of Jesus was acted upon, and so implies their belief in the report of the resurrection.2 This appearance to Mary Magdalene is condensed from J. 20"""*. The verbal anomalies are in the use of éxeivol, €0ed0n, and yriotnoav. €GedOy is used twice in the para- graph here, and in v.", and nowhere else in Mk. yziornoay is found here and in v."® (twice in Lk.), and nowhere else in Mk. 12,13. This appearance to the two on their way into the country is condensed from Lk.’s account of the appearance to the two disciples on their way to Emmaus.’ It differs from that in its account of their non-recognition of Jesus, and of the reception given to their story. Instead of the éy érépa poppy, 2m another form, Lk. attributes their failure to recognize him to the fact that their eyes were restrained from knowing him. And instead of the unbelief of their story told here, Lk., on the contrary, says that the eleven met them with the story of Christ’s actual resurrection (dvrws) and his appearance to Peter.‘ The verbal peculiarities are in the use of pera tadra and zopevopévors. peta tavra is found in Lk., is very frequent in J., but is not found in Mt. and Mk. 14. This appearance to the eleven on the evening following the resurrection is given in both Lk. and J.’ It differs from both ac- counts again in the matter of Jesus’ reproach of their unbelief of the stories of his resurrection. In Lk. it is not this for which he chides them, but for their idea, in spite of their acceptance of those stories, that his present appearance was that of a ghost. J. records only their gladness.® The verbal peculiarities are in the A Gs MONA» NAMA eS Ee 1 Lk. 2411, 4 Lk. 2416. 34, 2 Mt, 2810. 16, 5 Lk, 243649 J. 2019-23, 3 Lk. 2413-4, 6 Lk. 2454. 37 J, 2020, XVI. 14-19] APPEARANCES TO THE DISCIPLES 307 use of torepov, and Oeacapevots. vorepov is found in the other gospels, but not elsewhere in Mk. Insert 5¢ after vorepov, Treg. (Treg. marg. WH.) RV. AD, mess. Latt. Memph. Syrr. Add ék vexp@v, from the dead (Treg. marg. WH.) AC* X A Harcl. 15. These last words in Mt. are given on the mountain in Galilee.) In Lk., the farewell is said at Bethany.” These instructions in Lk. are given, the same as here, at the supper in Jerusalem, but they are separated from the ascension and the final words.’ zdaoy tm Ktice.— to all creation. Every creature, AV., would require the omission of the article. The two elements prominent in these instructions, the preaching and the baptizing, are common to Mt. and Mk. 16. We have here a group of things common to the apostolic teaching, but new to the Gospels. This is the first mention of baptism since the baptism of John. In the fourth Gospel even, it is not mentioned after the early Judzan ministry of our Lord.‘ Then, while faith is enjoined in Jesus’ teaching, it is nowhere, in the Synoptics, singled out as the condition of salvation, as, of course, baptism is not, since it is not mentioned at all. In fact, if one should gather up into a single statement our Lord’s teach- ing about the condition of salvation, the necessary attitude of men towards the word, it would be obedience. ‘This statement inaugu- rates and prepares the way for the apostolic teaching. 17, 18. Of the signs promised here, the healing, and the casting out of demons, are characteristic of our Lord’s activity ; the s}.eak- ing with tongues is new, and belongs to the apostolic period ; and the taking up of serpents and drinking poisons with impunity is absolutely foreign to our Lord’s principle.’ The verbal peculiari- ties are in the use of zapaxoAovOnoe( ?), and Gavacipov, the former occurring only here in Mk., and the latter only here in N.T. dxoNovO7jce, instead of rapaxodovOjoea, Treg. WH.CL. mapaxodovdjce, AC? 33 (A paxodovéjce). There is a meaning of closeness of attendance which makes mapaxodov@7ce much more individual and probable. Omit Kavats, new, after yAwooas, Treg. WH. RV. marg. CL A Memph. Insert kal év rats xepoiv, and in their hands, before bes dpoto., Treg. (Treg. marg. WH.) C*#242 LM marg. X A Grk. 1, 22, 33, Memph. Cur. Harcl. THE ASCENSION 19. pera To AaARoat aitois — after speaking to them. ‘This can refer only to the words spoken by our Lord at the supper in Jerusalem. If it had been after the entire event, and not a part 1 Mt, 2816-20, ® Lk. 2447-49, 5 See Note on the Appendix. 2 Lk, 2450. 51, 4 J. 326 gl 2, 308 THE GOSPEL OF MARK [ XVI. 19, 20 of the event coming after the discourse, something less specific than this pera ro AaAjoa would have been given as the mark of time. The ascension therefore, according to this, was on the evening after the resurrection. So Lk., even supposing that the omission of xal dvepépero eis Tov ovpavoy (Tisch. omits, and WH. RV. marg. double bracket) is accepted.’ Mt., however, gives the appearance to the disciples on a mountain in Galilee. xai éxa@- cev €x deEtav TOU Meod — and sat down on the right hand of God. This belongs to the creed, not to history. Insert "Incods after 6 Kipios, Treg. (Treg. marg. WH.) RV. CKL A 1, 22, 33, 124, mss. Lat. Vet. Vulg. Syrr. Memph. 20. The Lord helps the disciples in their subsequent work. ‘This statement is introduced to show how both command and promise were fulfilled in the missionary activity of the disciples. The verbal peculiarities are in the use of éxetvar, ravtaxov, ovvepyouvTos, BeBaotvros, and ézaxoAovbowTwv. aavraxov is not found elsewhere in Mk. (once in Lk.). ouvepyotvros, BeBatotvros, éxaxoAovGovvTwv, are not found elsewhere in the Gospels. They belong to the vocabulary of the Pauline Epistles. Omit ’Ayujv at the end, Treg. WH. (Tisch.) AC* 1, 33, mss. Latt. Syrr. THE RESURRECTION Mk. does not himself recount any appearance of the risen Lord. But he makes the angel at the tomb announce the resurrection, and promise that the Lord would meet his disciples in Galilee. The difficulty with this part of the history is that Mt. and Mk. give one version of it, Lk. another, the Acts still a third, and 1 Cor. a fourth. The account in Acts coincides with Lk. in regard to the final appearance, but, in regard to the time, differs from it more radically than either of the others, while Paul differs from them all in regard to the persons to whom Jesus appeared. But these differences of detail do not invalidate the main fact. The testimony of Paul is invaluable here. He writes his account about A.D. 58, and we know that he had had intercourse with both Peter and John, and James, who are named by him as among those to whom Jesus appeared after his resurrection. This first-hand testi- mony to the fact of the resurrection entirely outweighs any dis- crepancy in the details. It puts the latter in the class of varieties 1 Lk. 2451-53, 2 Mt, 2816-20, XVI] THE ASCENSION 309 of account which do not invalidate nor weaken the historicity of any record. There is a false impression made by the unusual consistency of the Synoptical Gospels which weakens unduly their _testimony in the parts where they show more independence and variety. Of course, Mt. and Mk., on the one hand, and Lk., on the other, give independent and varying accounts of the resurrec- tion. But the variety is caused by the independence; it is no greater than the ordinary variations of independent narratives, and it does not therefore invalidate the main fact of the resurrec- tion. But the Synoptical Gospels, in the main, in their record of the public ministry of Jesus, are interdependent, and so there is an unusual sameness about them. This should not weaken their testimony, when they become independent, and so variant. THE ASCENSION The result of textual criticism is to render it doubtful if there is any account of the ascension of our Lord in the Gospels. Mt., Mk., and J. contain no account of it. And the passage in Lk. which gives it is put in the column of doubtful passages, being omitted by Tisch., and double-bracketed by WH. RV. On the other hand, there is no doubt that Lk. means by the &éorn az’ avtav, he was parted from them, a final separation from the disci- ples on that first day following the resurrection. And this brings it directly into conflict with the account of the forty days in Acts. Moreover, the story in Acts is the only one that relates, or even implies, a visible ascent. The ave@épero in Lk., and dveAndOy in Mk., though their presence in the originals is impossible in Mk., and doubtful in Lk., can be traced back to first century sources through the old Latin and Syriac versions, so that they can be taken as witnesses to the event. But neither of them can be taken as independent witnesses to a visible ascent. That is sup- plied by the account in Acts. INDEX’ Abiathar, 275, Allegory, 12°, Anointing, 613, Antiochus Epiphanes, 134, Bartholomew, 3}. Bartimzus, 10%, Beelzebul, 32%. Beginning of Sabbath, 1°, Bethany, 111. Bethsaida, 6*. Beyschlag, Life of Fesus, 448 et passim. Boanerges, 3". Brothers of our Lord, 3}%- 31, Burton, V.7. Moods and Tenses, 11° et passim. Czesarea Philippi, 827. Camel’s hair, 1°. Capernaum, 171, Chief priest, 8%1. Children and dogs, 727. Cleansing all foods, 71%, Cure by touch, 3, Cyrene, 1579. Dalmanutha, 81, Decapolis, 5”. Disciples of Pharisees, 218. Edersheim, Life of Fesus, 7° et passim. Elder, 821. - Elijah, 1° 615 155, Evidence of a passover, 6%9 7}, Fasting, 218, First last, 1031, Four watches, 13%, Galilee, 114; Sea of, 116, Galilean ministry, 1148, Gardiner, Harmony, 3, Gehenna, 9*°. Gennesaret, 6°, Gerasenes, 5}. Gethsemane, 14°. Giving to him who hath, 425, Golgotha, 1572. Hackett, ///ustrations of Scripture, 4°, Hardness of heart, 6°2. Hebrew inf. absolute, 729, Herod Antipas, 614. Herodians, 3°. Herodias, 6, Hillel, 107. Holtzmann, Commentary, 1? et passim. Hosanna, 11%: 22, Idumeza, 3°. Inner circle of disciples, 9?. Inscription on the cross, 157, Interpolation, kai vnorelg, 9. Iscariot, 31%. Jairus, 57. James of Alphzeus, 3%. Jesus’ humanity, 6!4 724 $2 1118 133%; prayers, 64°; anger, 3°; silence, 14°, 1 In these lists, g denotes matter of a general character preceding or following a verse, 311 312 Jewish criminal procedure, 15}. Joseph of Arimathza, 15%. INDEX Relation of John to Synoptics, 316 6% 89. 45 y p11 7 443. 44. 47. 58. 58. 69 y 515. 24. 43. 46 16°. Kingdom of God, 115 9#7 101415; of| Repetition of miracle of feeding mul- David, 117°. Lamp, 471. Laying on of hands, 141, Leaves on fig tree, 113, Legion, 5°. Leper, 1%. 4, Levi, 214, Liddell and Scott, Zex., 15° e¢ passim. Locusts, 1°. Mark, manner, 2} 13 48 55 67 1528, Mary, mother of James and Joses, 154°. Meyer, Commentary, 1* # 2) et passim. Miracles kept secret, 1# 537 $28, Mission of twelve, 67 andg, Morison, Commentary, 378 et passim. Mount of Olives, 1476. Moving a mountain, 1172, Myrrh, 1523. Nathaniel, 318. Nazareth, 19 61, Nazarene, 1047, O.T. parallels, 1411. Passover hymn, 14%. Philip, 32°. Place of eating with publicans, 2), Principle of accommodation, 10°. Prophet, 1122, Publicans, 25, Relation of Synoptics to each other, 19. 13. 20. 28. 34 26.18 316. 22. 35g gl. 31. 35. 36 51g: 2. 5.7. 9.10. 13. 21. 25g G1. 8.8.9. 19. 32 gig 22. 50 1018.46 yyll yal. 28g. 35 131 14? 20. 47. 53. 59. 65. 69. 70 7 5L $. 17. 32. 36. 39. 43 16): 5. € titude, 81s. Representative miracle, 15%, Roadside, 4%. Roman policy, 15% 15, Salome, 154°. Sanhedrim, 831, Satan, 3%. Saving by losing, 8%. Scene of Jesus’ ministry, 21%, Scribes, 122; of Pharisees, 215, Self-denial, 34. Shammai, 107. Sidon, 3° 7™. Sign from heaven, 84. Simon the Cyrenian, 1529, Son of David, 10%; of God, 1-1! 31 15”) efi, 2. Supernatural darkness, 15%8, Synagogue, r°landg, Syrophcenicia, 774. Taking up cross, 8%, Thaddeus, 338. Thayer-Grimm, Zex., 214 e¢ passim. Veil of temple, 15%. Watches of night, 648. Weiss, Commentary, Life of Fesus, 5% et passim. Wife putting away husband, 1o!2. Wid honey, 1°. Winer, V. 7. Gram., 1° et passim. Woman with issue of blood, 578. Young man who followed Jesus after arrest, 1451, Zebedee, 119, INDEX 313 GREEK WORDS ABBG 6 rarip, 14%, ayaboraéw, 34, ayyapetw, 9%. ayvoew, 982, avypés, 514, dypuTrvéw, 13%, ddnuovéw, 144, dgvua, 141. aiwy épxduevos, 10°, dKodovbéw, 214, ddard tw, 588, aduets, 117, adpuaprwrés, 215, "Auny, 378, dudodos, 115, dvaB\érw, 10°, avdya.ov, 1415, dvabenarliw, 147, dvamrnddw, 10°, améxer, 1441, dmrdpaxpobev, 1454, drokpivouat, 3°8, améarodos, 6°9, amrordccoua, 64%, dpro ths mpobécews, 276, dpxicuvayuryos, 572, aoédyera, 72, domdfouat, 1518, avrAy, 1536, ddpootvn, 772, Barritw, 7%. Bdrricpa, 14, Bacavitoua 648, BiBruoy, 104. Brdaord, 427. Bracpnuéw, 27 329, Bracgnula, 722, Brérw eis mpbowmov, 124; pH, 135; tt dxovere, 4%, yatopuddxioy, 1471, yeulterba, 457, "yeved, 919, yevéowa, 61, yévnua, 1425, yewpyds, 12}, ylvopat, 9°38; eis, 1210, yovureréw, 149 tol, Satuovltoua, 182, dépw, 1238, dedre, 117, dnAavyGs, 3%, Snvdpiov, 687 145, diaBrérw, 825, diadjkn, 14%. Siaxplvouar, 1122, diadoyiopds, 721, didax%, 42 1118, 56dos, 722, SUvapyus, 1375, éyelpw, 181 212, évyévero F#dGev, 19. ei in oaths, 812; in direct questions, $28, eiut eis, 108. elpjyn, 5°. els, 1219; oixov, 37°. els, 1219; xard eis, 1419; —xal els, 1087; for rpG@ros, 16%. éxBddrw, 148, éxXexr és, 1322, éxrrepioo Gs, 1451, ékrd\joow, 122, éxpoBos, 9°. "EdAnvls, 7°. éuBdrrw, 14%, éuBpiudoua, 14 4 44 145, éy mvevuars axabdpry, 173; dyduari, gf, évayxanrifoua, 9%, évdid0oKomat, 1516, évéxw, 619, évvuxa, 15, 314 é&daruva, 9°. é&édero, 121, éfouodoyéw, 15 éfougla, 122, tw THs xwpas, 52. éravpiov, TH, 1112, éri T@ évbuart, 9°". émiBdddw, 1472. émisuvTpéxw, 97. evayyédov, 11-14, evddxnoa, 111, edObs, 123: 28.29.42 36, evkaipbw, 631, evKoT WTepov, 2%. eddoryetv, 641, eddoyntos, 14°, evxapirréw, 8°, "Edgada, 7%4. éxw = possum, 148, cnuidw, 86, coun, 338. ¢w7, 94% 1017, Hyeuwy, 13° 1536, nptaro, with inf., 67 108, novev, 1116, *Inoods, 11. ixavdbs, 17 1046, iuds, 17. iva, after verbs of desire, 10%, Kabws, 423, kat with interrogative, 10%, Kaicap, 1214. kakodoyéw, 989, Kavavaioy, 338. kapola, 2°. kaprés, 4°. karaBaptvw, 14%, Karakuptevw, 1042, karddvpa, 1414, karagiréw, 1445, karévavtt, 114, katezouoid iw, 1042, INDEX karevdoyéw, 1016, Kavpatliw, 4%. keppatlorns, 1115, Kkeparatdw, 124, Kepady ywrlas, 121, Kijvoov, 1214, Knptcow, 14-7 314, KAnpovoméw, 1017, Kodpavrns, 1242, kowvds, 77. Ko\duBiorns, 111, kodoBbw, 1379, KopBay», 711, xpdBBaroy, 24, kpdomedov, 6°, Kparetv déyor, 919, Kpnuves, 52%, kuNiw, 979, kpwos, 12 519 713-9, hatray, 437. Aaréw, 154, Adxavoy, 4°, Aerrov, 1242, AnorHs, 144%. Abyos, 22. padnrhs, 215, paoré, 310, peyioray, 671, perdvo.a, 14, BH, 2%. pnkvvoua, 427, pare, 474, priya, 5°. poytAddos, 722, podios, 471, pvdos dvixés, 942, pvothp.or, 421, vouvex as, 12°3, Oddy trocety, 228, oi rap’ a’rod, 371, oixodeomérns, 1434, oikov Qeod, 275, ddokavTrwua, 12, déos, 15°. ds édv, 8%, bray éyévero, 1119, érav with impft. 34. 8 ru in direct questions, 28, ovd, 157%, oval, 1471, 6pOadpods trovnpds, 722, épia, 647, wary, 21.13 3h 20 4}. wavraxod, 178, mwapdBacts, 717, mapaBory, 373, mapadéxouat, 429, mapadldwm, 1438, mapadot, 428, mapadoors, 7°. mapanuTikos, 23, mapacKevy, 1542, waoxa, 14}, meipacw, 113 Bil 7215, meipacpos, 1478, mepiraréw, 7°, mepiorepa, 119, Tlérpos, 326. mweTp@oes, 4°. mirrevw, 115, mioTikos, 14%, awrnpow, 115, mvedpua, 14°38; &y.ov, 18; axddaproy, 173, movetv bwexa, 314. mpacid, 649, mpeoBUTepos, 7° 1177, mpoépxoua, 673, Tpouepiuvaw, 1311, mpocdBBarov, 1542, mpocairns, 10%, mpocavr.ov, 14°, mpockaprepéw, 3%. mpockuvéw, 5° 1519 mpopacis, 124°, mpopynrns, 64. mpwt, 155, mpwrokdala, 12°, rra@pa, 629, TvyHT, 7°. Tupwos THs Kapdlas, 35, *‘PaBBovvt, 10°, pjow, 9}, oaBBara, 171, Zaravas, 115, oxavdanriferv, 417 68, oKevos, 1116, ok\npoxapdla, 10°. oKUArW, 5°, oTrapacocw, 126, ometpa, 1516, omekovAdTwp, 627, omrayxvigoua, 8%, oriBas, 118, TOA, 1229, oTpovvupu, 141, oTuyvagw, 1072, ov Néyers, 152. gudduTréw, 3°. gupBoddoy, 15}, ouprviyw, 49, cuptoc.ov, 699, cuvaywy%, 171 139, cuvavaketuat, 21, cuvédpiov, 139. Téxtwy, 6%, Teruo, 214, Trerwvns, 21, 1 22 Tt duvayat, 974. ti nuiv Kai col; 174, - , Zz 8 TQ) TWVEVLATL YLYWOKELV, 2°, viol Tod vuudavos, 219%, vids Tod Geos, 111, brepnpava, 772. broxpiots, 1215, broxpiT7s, 7°. vrodhvov, 12), bropévw, 1338, dipdw, 125 439, poBeicAar poBor, 4. 316 pparyedrow, 1515, poverty Ta Tivos, $18, gurdoow, 1070, xarxbs, 124, xAlapxos, 621, xopracw, 641, INDEX Xpiorés, 11, xwpéw, 2, Yevdorpopyrns, 13%, Pevdoxpirrs, 1323, wdivos, 13°. NOTES ON SPECIAL SUBJECTS Beginning of the Glad Tidings, 118. Messianic use of O.T. prophecy, 1? %, Baptism of John and Jesus, 18. Mark’s use of the Zagza, 1°. Baptism of Jesus, 1%: 1° Temptation of Jesus, 1)? 18. Beginning of the Ministry, 148. Announcement of the Kingdom, 1), The First Miracle, 17/8. Scribes, 122. Demoniacal possession, 123: 5, Injunction of silence about miracles, 125g. 45, Prayers of Jesus, 1°. Jesus’ relation to ceremonial law, 14%“, Miracles of Jesus, 1*°8. Period of conflict, 2!£ 338. Relation of faith to miracles, 25, Son of man, 21°, Flexibility of method, 212. Eating with tax-gatherers (publicans), 26. 17, Nonconformity in matter of fasting, 218g, Principle of fasting, 2%. New and old, 278. Alleged violation of Sabbath, 278. Rabbinical treatment of Sabbath law, = Jesus’ treatment of Sabbath, 227 34. Growth of popularity, 378. Appointment of twelve, 3188: 14 19, Charge of diabolism, 38: 22. 427, Blasphemy against Holy Spirit, 37°. An eternal sin, 3”. Parables of Jesus, 418. Mystery of kingdom, 4. Reason of parables, 411-12, Satan in parable of sower, 415, Parable of earth producing automati- cally, 4768. 28. 29g, Common features of parables, 43°8, Difficulties in story of Gergesene de- moniac, 513, Woman with issue of blood, 58: 3, Daughter of Jairus, Miracle, 5°48, Prophet without honor, 648. Imprisonment and execution of John, 617g, Herod Philip, 618. Scene of execution of John, 6”. Miraculous feeding of multitude, 68, Walking on the water, 648. Eating with unwashed hands, 718, Baptisms, 74. 78.7 in Sept. and Heb. 78, Traditionalism, 7°. Korban, 7". Without and within, 716 2, Peculiarity of Miracles, 73!-37 822-26 326g, Feeding of four thousand, 818, Signs, 81, Leaven of Pharisees and of Herod, 813, Impersonality of Jesus’ teaching, 827. Manner of making Messianic claim, 8, Esoteric teaching, 8% 99-51, Necessity of suffering, $#1. INDEX 317 Prediction of death and resurrection, | Sadducees, 1218, 831, Silence about himself broken, 88. Coming of Son of Man, 9}. Transfiguration, 92. Return of Elijah, 9°. First last, 9°°. Exclusiveness condemned, 9%: 39, For and against, 9%. Permanence of retribution, 9%. Salted with fire, 949. Different views of divorce, 102, Forbidding divorce, 10% 1. 12, The childlike spirit, 1014. Rich young man, 1017. 21, Human goodness of Jesus, 1018, Ultimateness of the commandments, Danger of wealth, 1078. [10!9, Reward of self-denial, 107854-, Prediction modified by event, 10%4. Rivalry among disciples, 10*8. Position in kingdom decided by fit- ness, 10%, Greatness in kingdom, 10*, Christ a ransom, 10*. Entry into Jerusalem, 1118-10, Barren figtree, 1114, Cleansing of temple, 112", Forgiveness the condition of answer to prayer, 112°. Jesus’ test of authority of Sanhedrim, 1 127g. 30. 33, Jesus’ use of O.T., 1211 1421-27. 8, Attitude of people to Jesus, 12!1 1511. 12. 13, Pharisees and Herodians, 1218, Things of Czesar, 1217. Conflict of duties, 1217, Power of God in resurrection, 1225, Jesus’ proof of resurrection, 1227, First two commandments, 1229, Criticism of title “Son of David” for Messiah, 12°, Eschatological discourse, 13}8, Abomination of Desolation, 1314. Various false Messiahs, 1322. Coming of Son of Man, 13748: 6 1462, Apocalyptic imagery, 13748, Gathering of elect, 1327. Time of coming, 13°9. Limitation of Jesus’ knowledge, 13%2. Anointing in Mk., Lk., and J., 143-4, Meaning of the eucharist, 1422, New covenant, 1474. Flesh and Spirit, 1438. Jesus’ non-resistance, 144 50 1581, Motive of betrayal, 14*. Jesus before the Sanhedrim, 1453 ndg, Son of the Blessed, 14°, Jesus’ confession before Sanhedrim, 14°, Peter’s denial, 14%, Jesus before Pilate, 1518. Jesus’ confession before Pilate, 152. Pilate’s understanding of Jesus’ case, 153-4, Barabbas’s offence, 157. The crucifixion, 1578-4, Taunts of rulers and others, 155. ® Jesus’ cry on the cross, 15%4. Brothers of our Lord, 15%. Burial of Jesus, 15428. Appendix, 16°. Resurrection Ascension Notes following Ap- pendix. ca Di - ie Ph ny TRAN Bair is cat by y y ay f , i i ‘ if ' p © ' v j ay ] : ee } ‘ 5 - % i ‘ J ‘Ss \ a . r, i Pad + + : + ' + ae oe { ) ro os TU i a : ( Rah At & gt'h in Pid Gian sy A if Net Pai Oa ' 1's. eri = + s . —— ; 1 ce) 7 wu 1 ; + oe Le LS ‘ tree ie { ) ; \ i ; j : 7 me ‘ ; i) & j | f j / ‘* ‘ i Di " 5 1 ‘ 4 ‘ 2 i / i f ‘ ; i 4) ‘ ‘ ; ? ; 4% iy GAYLORD PAINTED INU.B.A. oe Vig fe is as i BS2585 .G696 A critical and exegetical commentary on Princeton Theologi Seminary—Speer Libr LA NM 1 1012 00155 6564 —